FORUM FUNDS INC
497, 1998-04-17
Previous: UNIQUE MOBILITY INC, S-3, 1998-04-17
Next: FUNDAMENTAL FUNDS INC, PRES14A, 1998-04-17






                         INVESTORS HIGH GRADE BOND FUND
                               INVESTORS BOND FUND
                               TAXSAVER BOND FUND
                            MAINE MUNICIPAL BOND FUND
                             NEW HAMPSHIRE BOND FUND

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Account Information and
Shareholder Servicing:                 Distributor:
         Forum Financial Corp.                  Forum Financial Services, Inc.
         P.O. Box 446                           Two Portland Square
         Portland, Maine 04112                  Portland, Maine  04101
         207-879-0001                           207-879-1900

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                       STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

                                January 1, 1998,
                            as amended April 15, 1998

Forum Funds (the  "Trust") is a registered  open-end  investment  company.  This
Statement of Additional  Information  supplements the Prospectuses dated January
1, 1998 offering  shares of the Investors  High Grade Bond Fund,  Investors Bond
Fund and TaxSaver Bond Fund, and the Prospectuses  dated August 1, 1997 offering
shares of Maine  Municipal Bond Fund and New Hampshire  Bond Fund  (collectively
the "Funds" and  individually  a "Fund") and should be read only in  conjunction
with  the  Prospectus,  a copy  of  which  may be  obtained  without  charge  by
contacting the Trust's Shareholder Servicing agent at the address listed above.

TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                            PAGE

    1.       General......................................................     2
    2.       Investment Policies..........................................     3
    3.       Investment Limitations.......................................    15
    4.       Performance Data.............................................    19
    5.       Management...................................................    22
    6.       Determination of Net Asset Value.............................    30
    7.       Portfolio Transactions.......................................    30
    8.       Additional Purchase and
             Redemption Information.......................................    31
    9.       Taxation.....................................................    32
    10.      Other Information............................................    33

             Appendix A - Description of Securities Ratings
             Appendix B - Description of Municipal Securities
             Appendix C - Hedging Strategies - Investors Bond Fund and TaxSaver
                 Bond Fund
             Appendix D - Hedging Strategies - Maine Municipal Bond Fund
             Appendix E - Text of Forum Brochure
             Appendix F - Text of Peoples Heritage News Release

THIS  STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL  INFORMATION IS NOT A PROSPECTUS AND IS AUTHORIZED
FOR DISTRIBUTION TO PROSPECTIVE  INVESTORS ONLY IF PRECEDED OR ACCOMPANIED BY AN
EFFECTIVE PROSPECTUS.

<PAGE>

1.  GENERAL

THE  TRUST.  The  Trust is  registered  with the U.S.  Securities  and  Exchange
Commission as an open-end,  management investment company and was organized as a
business  trust under the laws of the State of Delaware on August 29,  1995.  On
January  5, 1996 the Trust  succeeded  to the assets  and  liabilities  of Forum
Funds, Inc. Forum Funds, Inc. was incorporated on March 24, 1980 and assumed the
name of Forum  Funds,  Inc. on March 16,  1987.  The Board has the  authority to
issue an unlimited  number of shares of beneficial  interest of separate  series
with no par value per share and to create separate classes of shares within each
series.  The Trust currently offers shares of twenty-four  series. The series of
the Trust are as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>       <C>                                                    <C>
          Daily Assets Treasury Fund                            Austin Global Equity Fund
          Daily Assets Treasury Obligations Fund                Oak Hall Equity Fund
          Daily Assets Government Fund
          Daily Assets Cash Fund                                Quadra Limited Maturity Treasury Fund
          Daily Assets Tax-Exempt Fund                          Quadra Value Equity Fund
                                                                Quadra Growth Fund
          Investors High Grade Bond Fund                        Quadra International Equity Fund
          Investors Bond Fund                                   Quadra Opportunistic Bond Fund
          TaxSaver Bond Fund
          Maine Municipal Bond Fund                             S&P 500 Index Fund
          New Hampshire Bond Fund                               Investors Growth Fund
                                                                Investors Equity Fund
          Payson Value Fund                                     International Equity Fund
          Payson Balanced Fund.                                 Emerging Markets Fund
</TABLE>

DEFINITIONS. As used in this Statement of Additional Information,  the following
terms shall have the meanings listed:

"Adviser" means Forum Investment Advisors, LLC.

"Board" means the Board of Trustees of Forum Funds.

"FAS" means Forum Administrative Services, LLC.

"FAcS" means Forum Accounting Services, LLC.

"FFC" means Forum Financial Corp.

"FFSI" means Forum Financial Services, Inc.

"Fund" means Investors High Grade Bond Fund,  Investors Bond Fund, Taxsaver Bond
Fund, Maine Municipal Bond Fund and New Hampshire Bond Fund

"Fund Business Day" has the meaning ascribed thereto in the current Prospectuses
of the Funds.

"NRSRO" means a nationally recognized statistical rating organization.

"SAI" means this Statement of Additional Information.

"SEC" means the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.

"Trust" means Forum Funds, a Delaware business trust.

"U.S.  Government  Securities" has the meaning  ascribed  thereto by the current
Prospectuses of the Funds.

"1940 Act" means the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.


                                       2
<PAGE>

2. INVESTMENT POLICIES

GENERAL

RATINGS AS INVESTMENT CRITERIA

Moody's  Investors  Service,  Inc.  ("Moody's"),  Standard & Poor's  Corporation
("S&P")  and  other  nationally  recognized   statistical  rating  organizations
("NRSROs")  are private  services that provide  ratings of the credit quality of
debt obligations,  including convertible securities.  A description of the range
of ratings  assigned to various  types of bonds and other  securities by several
NRSROs is included in Appendix A to this  Statement of  Additional  Information.
The Funds may use these ratings to determine whether to purchase, sell or hold a
security.  However,  ratings  are  general  and are not  absolute  standards  of
quality.  Consequently,  securities  with the same  maturity,  interest rate and
rating may have different market prices.  If an issue of securities ceases to be
rated  or if its  rating  is  reduced  after  it is  purchased  by a  Fund,  the
investment  adviser of the Fund will determine  whether the Fund should continue
to hold the  obligation.  Credit  ratings  attempt  to  evaluate  the  safety of
principal and interest payments and do not evaluate the risks of fluctuations in
market value.  Also,  rating  agencies may fail to make timely changes in credit
ratings.  An issuer's current financial  condition may be better or worse than a
rating indicates.

Each Fund may retain  securities  whose rating has been lowered below the lowest
permissible  rating  category  (or  that  are  unrated  and  determined  by  the
investment  adviser  to be of  comparable  quality)  if the  investment  adviser
determines that retaining such security is in the best interests of the Fund.

WHEN-ISSUED SECURITIES AND FORWARD COMMITMENTS

Each Fund may  purchase  securities  offered  on a  "when-issued"  basis and may
purchase  or  sell  securities  on  a  "forward  commitment"  basis.  When  such
transactions are negotiated,  the price,  which is generally  expressed in yield
terms, is fixed at the time the commitment is made, but delivery and payment for
the securities take place at a later date. Normally,  the settlement date occurs
within two months after the  transaction,  but  settlements  delayed  beyond two
months may be negotiated. During the period between a commitment and settlement,
no payment is made for the  securities  purchased by the purchaser and, thus, no
interest accrues to the purchaser from the transaction. At the time a Fund makes
the  commitment  to purchase  securities on a  when-issued  or delayed  delivery
basis, the Fund will record the transaction as a purchase and thereafter reflect
the value each day of such securities in determining its net asset value.

The use of when-issued transactions and forward commitments enables the Funds to
hedge against anticipated changes in interest rates and prices. For instance, in
periods of rising  interest  rates and falling  bond  prices,  a Fund might sell
securities which it owned on a forward commitment basis to limit its exposure to
falling prices.  In periods of falling  interest rates and rising bond prices, a
Fund might sell a security  and  purchase  the same or a similar  security  on a
when-issued  or forward  commitment  basis,  thereby  obtaining  the  benefit of
currently higher cash yields.  However, if the investment adviser to a Fund were
to forecast incorrectly the direction of interest rate movements, the Fund might
be required to complete such when-issued or forward  commitment  transactions at
prices inferior to the current market values.

When-issued  securities  and  forward  commitments  may  be  sold  prior  to the
settlement  date, but the Funds enter into  when-issued  and forward  commitment
transactions  only with the intention of actually  receiving or  delivering  the
securities,  as the case may be. If a Fund,  however,  chooses to dispose of the
right to acquire a when-issued  security prior to its  acquisition or to dispose
of its right to deliver or receive against a forward commitment,  it can incur a
gain or loss.  When-issued securities may include bonds purchased on a "when, as
and if issued" basis under which the issuance of the securities depends upon the
occurrence of a subsequent event. Any significant  commitment of a Fund's assets
to the purchase of securities  on a "when,  as and if issued" basis may increase
the volatility of its net asset value.

                                       3
<PAGE>

Each Fund will establish and maintain with its custodian a separate account with
cash, U.S. Government Securities (as defined in the Prospectus) and other liquid
high-grade  debt  securities in an amount at least equal to its  commitments  to
purchase securities on a when-issued or delayed delivery basis.

ILLIQUID SECURITIES

Each Fund may invest up to 15% of its net  assets in  illiquid  securities.  The
term  "illiquid  securities"  for this purpose means  securities  that cannot be
disposed  of  within  seven  days  in  the   ordinary   course  of  business  at
approximately  the  amount  at which  the Fund has  valued  the  securities  and
includes,  among other  things,  purchased  over-the-counter  (OTC)  options and
repurchase agreements maturing in more than seven days.

The Trust's  Board of Directors  ("Board") has the ultimate  responsibility  for
determining  whether specific  securities are liquid or illiquid.  The Board has
delegated the function of making  day-to-day  determinations of liquidity to the
investment adviser of each Fund,  pursuant to guidelines  approved by the Board.
The  investment  adviser  takes into  account a number of  factors  in  reaching
liquidity  decisions,  including but not limited to: (1) the frequency of trades
and quotations for the security;  (2) the number of dealers  willing to purchase
or  sell  the  security  and the  number  of  other  potential  buyers;  (3) the
willingness  of dealers to undertake to make a market in the  security;  and (4)
the nature of the  marketplace  trades,  including the time needed to dispose of
the security, the method of soliciting offers and the mechanics of the transfer.
The investment  adviser  monitors the liquidity of the securities in each Fund's
portfolio and reports periodically on such decisions to the Board.

REPURCHASE AGREEMENTS

The Funds may seek  additional  income by entering into  repurchase  agreements.
Repurchase  agreements are transactions in which a Fund purchases a security and
simultaneously  commits to resell that security to the seller at an  agreed-upon
price on an  agreed-upon  future  date,  normally  one to seven days later.  The
resale  price  reflects a market  rate of  interest  that is not  related to the
coupon  rate or  maturity  of the  purchased  security.  The  Trust's  custodian
maintains  possession of the underlying  collateral,  which is maintained at not
less than 100% of the  repurchase  price,  and  which  consists  of the types of
securities in which the Fund may invest directly.

LENDING OF PORTFOLIO SECURITIES

Each Fund may from time to time lend  securities  from its portfolio to brokers,
dealers and other financial institutions.  Securities loans must be continuously
secured by cash or U.S.  Government  Securities with a market value,  determined
daily, at least equal to the value of the Fund's  securities  loaned,  including
accrued interest. The Fund receives interest in respect of securities loans from
the  borrower  or from  investing  cash  collateral.  The  Funds may pay fees to
arrange the loans.  Each Fund will, as a fundamental  policy,  limit  securities
lending to not more than 10% of the value of its total assets.

TEMPORARY DEFENSIVE POSITION

When a Fund assumes a temporary  defensive  position it may invest without limit
in (i) short-term  U.S.  Government  Securities,  (ii)  certificates of deposit,
bankers' acceptances and  interest-bearing  savings deposits of commercial banks
doing business in the United States that have, at the time of investment,  total
assets in excess of one  billion  dollars  and that are  insured by the  Federal
Deposit  Insurance  Corporation,  (iii)  commercial paper of prime quality rated
Prime-2  or  higher  by  Moody's  or A-2 or  higher  by S&P  or,  if not  rated,
determined  by  the  adviser  to  be  of  comparable  quality,  (iv)  repurchase
agreements  covering any of the securities in which the Fund may invest directly
and (v) money market mutual funds.

OTHER INVESTMENT COMPANIES

The Funds may invest in the securities of other investment  companies within the
limits proscribed by the 1940 Act. Under normal circumstances, each Fund intends
to invest less than 5% of the value of its net assets in the securities of other
investment companies.  In addition to the Fund's expenses (including the various
fees), as a shareholder in 


                                       4
<PAGE>

another investment  company, a Fund would bear its pro rata portion of the other
investment company's expenses (including fees).

INVESTORS HIGH GRADE BOND FUND, INVESTORS BOND FUND AND TAXSAVER BOND FUND

FUTURES CONTRACTS AND OPTIONS

Currently Investors High Grade Bond Fund and TaxSaver Bond Fund do not invest in
futures  contracts and options.  Investors  Bond Fund (and, in the future,  each
other  Fund) may in the future  seek to hedge  against a decline in the value of
securities it owns or an increase in the price of  securities  which it plans to
purchase   through   the   writing   and   purchase   of   exchange-traded   and
over-the-counter  options and the  purchase  and sale of futures  contracts  and
options on those futures contracts. TaxSaver Bond Fund may buy or sell municipal
bond index futures contracts and both Funds may buy or sell futures contracts on
Treasury bills,  Treasury bonds and other financial  instruments.  The Funds may
write covered options and buy options on the futures contracts in which they may
invest.

If the  Adviser  anticipates  that  interest  rates will  rise,  a Fund may sell
futures  contracts  as a hedge  against a  decrease  in the value of the  Fund's
portfolio  securities.  Conversely,  if the  Adviser  anticipates  a decline  in
interest rates, a Fund may purchase futures  contracts to protect itself against
an  increase  in the price of the debt  securities  that the Fund  might wish to
purchase.

In addition, each Fund may write (sell) covered put and call options and may buy
put and call options on debt  securities and bond indices.  An option is covered
if, so long as the Fund is  obligated  under the option,  it owns an  offsetting
position in the underlying  security,  currency or futures contract or maintains
cash, U.S. Government  Securities or other liquid assets in a segregated account
with a value at all times  sufficient to cover the Fund's  obligation  under the
option.

The Funds' use of options  and  futures  contracts  would  subject  the Funds to
certain investment risks and transaction costs to which they might not otherwise
be subject.  These risks  include:  (1)  dependence on the Adviser's  ability to
predict movements in the prices of individual securities and fluctuations in the
general securities markets;  (2) imperfect  correlation between movements in the
prices of options,  futures  contracts or related  options and  movements in the
price of the securities  hedged or used for cover;  (3) the fact that skills and
techniques  needed to trade these instruments are different from those needed to
select the other  securities  in which the Funds  invest;  (4) lack of assurance
that a liquid secondary  market will exist for any particular  instrument at any
particular  time;  and (5) the  possible  need to defer  closing  out of certain
options,   futures   contracts   and  related   options  to  avoid  adverse  tax
consequences.  Other risks  include the  inability of the Fund, as the writer of
covered  call  options,  to  benefit  from the  appreciation  of the  underlying
securities  above the exercise price and the possible loss of the entire premium
paid for  options  purchased  by the Fund.  In  addition,  options  and  futures
contracts do not pay interest, but may produce taxable capital gains.

Each Fund will not hedge more than 30% of its total  assets by  selling  futures
contracts,  buying put options and writing call options. In addition,  each Fund
will not buy futures  contracts  or write put  options  whose  underlying  value
exceeds 5% of the Fund's total assets and will not purchase  call options if the
value of purchased  call options would exceed 5% of the Fund's total  assets.  A
Fund will not enter into futures  contracts and options  thereon if  immediately
thereafter  more  than 5% of the  value  of the  Fund's  total  assets  would be
invested in these options or committed to margin on futures contracts.

A Fund will only invest in futures and options  contracts after providing notice
to its shareholders,  filing a notice of eligibility (if required) and otherwise
complying with the  requirements  of the Commodity  Futures  Trading  Commission
("CFTC").  The CFTC's  rules  provide  that the Funds are  permitted to purchase
futures or options contracts subject to CFTC jurisdiction only (1) for bona fide
hedging purposes within the meaning of the rules of the CFTC; provided, however,
that in the  alternative  with  respect  to each long  position  in a futures or
options contract entered into by a Fund, the underlying  commodity value of such
contract at all times does not exceed the sum of cash,  short-term United States
debt  obligations  or other United States dollar  denominated  short-term  money
market  instruments  set aside for this purpose by the Fund,  cash proceeds from
existing Fund investments due in 30


                                       5
<PAGE>

days  and  accrued  profit  on the  contract  held  with a  futures  commissions
merchant; and (2) subject to certain limitations.

INVESTORS HIGH GRADE BOND FUND AND INVESTORS BOND FUND

MORTGAGE-RELATED  SECURITIES.  As described in the  Prospectus,  Investors  High
Grade Bond Fund and Investors  Bond Fund and Investors  High Grade Bond Fund may
invest  in  mortgage-related   securities,   including  Collateralized  Mortgage
Obligations ("CMOs").  CMOs are typically structured with a number of classes or
series (often  referred to as tranches) that have  different  maturities and are
generally  retired in sequence.  Each class of bonds receives  periodic interest
payments  according  to the  coupon  rate on the  bonds.  However,  all  monthly
principal  payments and any prepayments  from the collateral pool are paid first
to the "Class 1" bondholders.  The principal  payments are such that the Class 1
bonds will be completely repaid no later than, for example, five years after the
offering date.  Thereafter,  all payments of principal are allocated to the next
most  senior  class of bonds  until that  class of bonds has been fully  repaid.
Although  full  payoff of each  class of bonds is  contractually  required  by a
certain  date,  any or all classes of bonds may be paid off sooner than expected
because of an  acceleration  in  prepayments of the  obligations  comprising the
collateral pool.

The final  tranche  of a CMO may be  structured  as an accrual  bond  (sometimes
referred to as a  Z-tranche).  Holders of accrual bonds receive no cash payments
for an  extended  period of time.  During  the time that  earlier  tranches  are
outstanding,  accrual  bonds  receive  accrued  interest  which is a credit  for
periodic  interest  payments that increases the face amount of the security at a
compounded rate, but is not paid to the bond holder. After all previous tranches
are retired,  accrual bond holders  start  receiving  cash payments that include
both  principal and continuing  interest.  The market value of accrual bonds can
fluctuate  widely and their average life depends on the other aspects of the CMO
offering.  Interest on accrual  bonds is taxable  when  accrued  even though the
holders  receive  no  accrual  payment.  The  Fund  distributes  all of its  net
investment  income,  and may have to sell  portfolio  securities  to  distribute
imputed income, which may occur at a time when the Adviser would not have chosen
to sell such  securities  and which may  result in a taxable  gain or loss.  The
Adviser's  analyses of particular  CMO issues and  estimates of future  economic
indicators  (such as interest rates) become more important to the performance of
a Fund as the securities become more complicated.

ASSET-BACKED  SECURITIES.  As described in the Prospectus,  Investors High Grade
Bond Fund and Investors Bond Fund may invest in asset-backed  securities,  which
have structural  characteristics similar to mortgage-backed  securities but have
underlying  assets that are not mortgage  loans or interests in mortgage  loans.
Asset-backed  securities  are  securities  that  represent  direct  or  indirect
participations  in, or are  secured by and  payable  from,  assets such as motor
vehicle  installment  sales  contracts,  installment  loan contracts,  leases of
various  types of real and personal  property  and  receivables  from  revolving
credit (credit card) agreements.  Such assets are securitized through the use of
trusts and special purpose corporations.

Asset-backed  securities are often backed by a pool of assets  representing  the
obligations of a number of different parties. Payments of principal and interest
may be  guaranteed  up to certain  amounts  and for a certain  time  period by a
letter of credit issued by a financial institution.

Asset-backed  securities  present  certain  risks  that  are  not  presented  by
mortgage-related  debt  securities or other  securities in which  Investors Bond
Fund may invest. Primarily, these securities do not always have the benefit of a
security  interest  in  comparable  collateral.   Credit  card  receivables  are
generally  unsecured and the debtors are entitled to the  protection of a number
of state and Federal  consumer  credit laws, many of which give such debtors the
right to set off certain amounts owed on the credit cards,  thereby reducing the
balance due. Automobile  receivables  generally are secured,  but by automobiles
rather than  residential real property.  Most issuers of automobile  receivables
permit the loan servicers to retain possession of the underlying obligations. If
the servicer were to sell these  obligations to another  party,  there is a risk
that the purchaser would acquire an interest  superior to that of the holders of
the  asset-backed  securities.  In  addition,  because  of the  large  number of
vehicles involved in a typical issuance and technical  requirements  under state
laws, the trustee for the holders of the automobile  receivables  may not have a
proper security interest in the underlying automobiles.  Therefore, there is the
possibility that recoveries on repossessed collateral may not, in some cases, be
available  to  support  payments  on  these  


                                       6
<PAGE>

securities.  Because  asset-backed  securities  are  relatively  new, the market
experience in these  securities  is limited and the market's  ability to sustain
liquidity through all phases of the market cycle has not been tested.

TAXSAVER BOND FUND, MAINE MUNICIPAL BOND FUND
AND NEW HAMPSHIRE BOND FUND

MUNICIPAL SECURITIES

The term "municipal securities," as used in the Prospectus and this Statement of
Additional  Information  means  obligations  of the type described in Appendix B
issued by or on behalf of states,  territories,  and  possessions  of the United
States and their political  subdivisions,  agencies and  instrumentalities,  the
interest on which is exempt from Federal income tax. The municipal securities in
which the Funds  invest are  limited to those  obligations  which at the time of
purchase:  (i) in the case of TaxSaver  Bond Fund,  are backed by the full faith
and credit of the  United  States;  (ii) are  municipal  notes  rated in the two
highest  rating  categories  by an NRSRO,  or, if not rated,  are of  comparable
quality as determined by the Adviser; (iii) are municipal bonds rated in the six
highest  rating  categories  by an NRSRO or,  if not  rated,  are of  comparable
quality as determined by the Fund's investment  adviser; or (iv) are other types
of  municipal  securities,  provided  that such  obligations  are of  comparable
quality,  as determined  by the Adviser,  to  instruments  in which the Fund may
invest.

MUNICIPAL NOTES.  Municipal notes,  which may be either "general  obligation" or
"revenue"  securities,  are  intended to fulfill  short-term  capital  needs and
generally  have  original  maturities  of 397 days or  less.  They  include  tax
anticipation  notes,   revenue  anticipation  notes,  bond  anticipation  notes,
construction loan notes and tax-exempt commercial paper.

MUNICIPAL  LEASES.  Municipal leases  frequently have special risks not normally
associated  with  general  obligation  or  revenue  bonds or  notes.  Lease  and
installment  purchase or conditional  sale contracts (which normally provide for
title to the leased  assets to pass  eventually to the  government  issuer) have
evolved as a means for  governmental  issuers to acquire  property and equipment
without meeting the constitutional  and statutory  requirements for the issuance
of debt. The debt-issuance  limitations of many state constitutions and statutes
are  deemed  to be  inapplicable  because  of the  inclusion  in many  leases or
contracts of  "non-appropriation"  clauses  that  provide that the  governmental
issuer has no  obligation  to make future  payments  under the lease or contract
unless money is  appropriated  for such purpose by the  appropriate  legislative
body on a yearly or other  periodic  basis.  To reduce this risk,  TaxSaver Bond
Fund will only purchase municipal leases subject to a  non-appropriation  clause
when the payment of principal and accrued interest is backed by an unconditional
irrevocable  letter of credit or  guarantee  of a bank or other  entity that has
long  term  outstanding  debt  securities  rated  in one of the top  two  rating
categories by an NRSRO.

VARIABLE AND FLOATING RATE  OBLIGATIONS.  The interest  rates payable on certain
municipal securities, including municipal leases, in which a Fund may invest are
not fixed and may fluctuate based upon changes in market rates. These securities
are referred to as variable rate or floating rate obligations. Other features of
these  obligations may include the right whereby the Fund may demand  prepayment
of the principal  amount of the obligation  prior to its stated maturity and the
right of the issuer to prepay the principal  amount prior to maturity.  The main
benefit of a variable or floating rate  municipal  security is that the interest
rate adjustment  minimizes  changes in the market value of the obligation.  As a
result, the purchase of these municipal  securities enhances the ability of each
Fund to sell an obligation prior to maturity at a price  approximating  the full
principal  amount of the  obligation.  The payment of principal  and interest by
issuers of certain municipal securities purchased by a Fund may be guaranteed by
letters of credit or other credit facilities offered by banks or other financial
institutions.  Such  guarantees  will be  considered  in  determining  whether a
municipal  security  meets  the  Fund's  investment  quality  requirements.  The
investment  adviser will monitor the pricing,  quality and liquidity of variable
rate and  floating  rate  demand  obligations  held by each Fund on the basis of
published  financial  information,  rating  agency  reports  and other  research
services to which a Fund or the Adviser may subscribe.

PARTICIPATION  INTERESTS.  Each Fund may  purchase  participation  interests  in
municipal bonds, including private activity bonds and floating and variable rate
securities  that  are  owned  by  banks  or  other  financial  institutions.   A

                                       7
<PAGE>

participation  interest  gives  a Fund  an  undivided  interest  in a  municipal
security owned by a bank or other financial institution. These instruments carry
a demand feature  permitting the holder to tender them back to the bank or other
institution  and are  generally  backed  by an  irrevocable  letter of credit or
guarantee of the bank or  institution.  The Fund can exercise the right,  on not
more than thirty days' notice,  to sell such an  instrument  back to the bank or
institution  from which it purchased  the  instrument  and draw on the letter of
credit for all or any part of the principal  amount of the Fund's  participation
interest in the instrument, plus accrued interest.  Generally, a Fund will do so
only (i) as required to provide  liquidity to the Fund,  (ii) to maintain a high
quality  investment  portfolio,  or (iii) upon a default  under the terms of the
demand instrument. Banks and other financial institutions retain portions of the
interest paid on such  participation  interests as their fees for servicing such
instruments  and the  issuance  of related  letters of  credit,  guarantees  and
repurchase  commitments.  Exposure to credit  losses  arising  from the possible
financial   difficulties   of  borrowers   might  affect  the  bank's  or  other
institution's  ability  to meet its  obligations  under its  letter of credit or
other guarantee.

No Fund will purchase participation interests unless it is advised by counsel or
receives a ruling of the Internal  Revenue  Service that interest  earned by the
Fund from the  obligations in which it holds  participation  interests is exempt
from Federal  income tax. The Internal  Revenue  Service has  announced  that it
ordinarily  will not issue advance  rulings on certain of the Federal income tax
consequences  applicable to  securities,  or  participation  interests  therein,
subject to a put. The Adviser will monitor the pricing, quality and liquidity of
participation  interests  held by each Fund on the basis of published  financial
information,  rating  agency  reports and other  research  services to which the
Funds or the Adviser may subscribe.

STAND-BY  COMMITMENTS.   Each  Fund  acquires  stand-by  commitments  solely  to
facilitate  portfolio  liquidity and does not exercise its rights thereunder for
trading purposes.  Since the value of a stand-by  commitment is dependent on the
ability of the stand-by  commitment writer to meet its obligation to repurchase,
each Fund's policy is to enter into stand-by  commitment  transactions only with
municipal securities dealers which in the opinion of the Adviser present minimal
credit risks.

The  acquisition  of a stand-by  commitment  does not affect  the  valuation  or
maturity of the underlying  municipal  securities which continue to be valued in
accordance with the amortized cost method.  Stand-by  commitments  acquired by a
Fund are  valued  at zero in  determining  net  asset  value.  When a Fund  pays
directly or  indirectly  for a stand-by  commitment,  its cost is  reflected  as
unrealized  depreciation  for the period  during which the  commitment  is held.
Stand-by  commitments  do not affect the average  weighted  maturity of a Fund's
portfolio of securities.

GENERAL.  Yields on municipal  securities are dependent on a variety of factors,
including the general  conditions of the money market and of the municipal  bond
and municipal note markets, the size of a particular  offering,  the maturity of
the obligation  and the rating of the issue.  Municipal  securities  with longer
maturities  tend to produce  higher yields and are generally  subject to greater
price  movements  than  obligations  with  shorter  maturities.  An  increase in
interest rates will generally reduce the market value of portfolio  investments,
and a decline in interest rates will  generally  increase the value of portfolio
investments.

There  can be no  assurance  that a  Fund's  objective  will  be  achieved.  The
achievement  of a  Fund's  investment  objective  is  dependent  in  part on the
continuing  ability of the  issuers of  municipal  securities  in which the Fund
invests to meet their obligations for the payment of principal and interest when
due.  Municipal  securities  historically  have not been subject to registration
with the Securities and Exchange Commission,  although there have been proposals
which would require registration in the future.

The  obligations  of  municipal  securities  issuers may become  subject to laws
enacted in the future by Congress,  state  legislatures,  or referenda extending
the time for payment of principal and/or interest, or imposing other constraints
upon  enforcement of such obligations or upon the ability of  municipalities  to
levy taxes.  There is also the  possibility  that,  as a result of litigation or
other  conditions,  the ability of any issuer to pay, when due, the principal of
and interest on its municipal securities may be materially affected.

                                       8
<PAGE>

CERTAIN INFORMATION CONCERNING THE STATE OF MAINE

Material in this section has been compiled from numerous sources  including "The
Maine Economy: Year-End Review and Outlook, 1996," and "Maine Counties, Selected
Economic  Measures,  History and Forecasts - May 1997" prepared and published by
the Economics Division of the Maine State Planning Office. In addition,  certain
information  was  obtained  from the  Official  Statement  of the State of Maine
published in  connection  with the issuance of  $42,700,000  general  obligation
bonds dated May 1, 1997. Other  information  concerning Maine budgetary  matters
was obtained from official legislative documents, the Office of the Commissioner
of the Maine Department of Administrative and Financial Services,  the Office of
the  Treasurer  of the State of  Maine,  the  Bureau of the  Budget of the Maine
Department of Administrative  and Financial  Services,  the Office of Fiscal and
Program Review of the Maine Legislature, the Maine Department of Human Services,
the Maine Department of Labor, and the Maine State Retirement  System.  The most
recent  information  concerning credit ratings on debt issued by or on behalf of
the State of Maine and its subordinate agencies was obtained from credit reports
for the State of Maine  published by S&P on September 23, 1996 and May 12, 1997,
by Moody's on May 13, 1997, and by Fitch IBCA, Inc.. ("Fitch"), on May 9, 1997.

Although  the  information  derived  from the above  sources is  believed  to be
accurate,  none of the information obtained from these sources has been verified
independently.  While the  following  summarizes  the most  current  information
available from the above  sources,  it does not reflect  economic  conditions or
developments which may have occurred or trends which may have materialized since
the dates indicated.

The State of Maine, which includes nearly one-half of the total land area of the
six New England states,  currently has a population of approximately  1,242,000.
The  structure of the Maine economy is similar to that of the nation as a whole,
except  that  the  Maine   economy   historically   has  had  more  activity  in
manufacturing,  defense-related  activities,  and tourism,  and less activity in
finance and services.  Recently,  however, the manufacturing and defense-related
sectors  of  Maine's  economy  have  decreased  significantly,  and the  service
industry,  retail,  and  financial  services  sectors  of Maine's  economy  have
increased significantly.

During the 1980's,  Maine's economy surpassed national averages in virtually all
significant measures of economic growth. During this ten-year period, Maine real
economic  growth was 40% as measured by the Maine Economic Growth Index ("EGI"),
a broad-based measure of economic growth which is corrected for inflation.  This
economic  growth  compares to national real economic growth during the 1980's of
26% and 29%,  measured by the United States Economic Growth Index and real Gross
National Product respectively.  During this time period,  resident employment in
Maine increased by 21%, while resident employment  nationally  increased by 19%.
Inflation-adjusted retail sales in Maine during this period increased by 72%, as
opposed to a 32%  increase in such retail sales  nationally.  During the 1980's,
per capita  personal  income in Maine  rose from 44th in the nation in 1979,  to
26th in the nation in 1989,  or from 81% to 92% of the  national  average of per
capita personal income.

Beginning in the fourth quarter of 1989, however,  the Maine economy experienced
a substantial  temporary decline.  For example, the Maine economy sustained only
0.8% real growth in 1989, and experienced real growth of -1.1% in 1990 and -2.6%
in 1991.  Data show that the Maine economy began a sustained  decline during the
fourth  quarter  of  1989,  and  the  second  quarter  of 1991  saw the  seventh
consecutive quarterly decline in the Maine EGI. The third and fourth quarters of
1991  showed  barely  positive  economic  growth of 0.9% and 0.2%  respectively.
Economic  recovery  in Maine also has been  hindered  by  significant  losses in
defense-related  jobs, with the State losing since 1990 approximately 20% of its
defense-dependent  employment  which  peaked at 63,000 jobs in 1989.  During the
1989-1991 period also, the State lost 6% of its entire job base.

Since 1991 the Maine economy has  experienced  a modest and sustained  recovery,
and this recovery has continued slowly through the end of calendar year 1996. In
the words of the Economics  Division of the Maine State Planning Office,  "Maine
economic  performance in 1996 was mixed, with the major indicators,  on balance,
describing continued slow growth." In addition, the growth of Maine's economy in
1996 also  continued  to lag  behind  that of the  nation as a whole,  with real
growth in the Maine  economy  during 1996 of 2.1% compared to real growth in the
national  Gross  Domestic  Product  ("GDP") during 1996 of 2.4%. Of the 17 major
Maine economic indicators tracked by the Maine State Planning Office in calendar
year 1996, eight were positive,  eight were negative, and one (building permits)
showed no significant change.

                                       9
<PAGE>

On the positive side, after five full years of slow economic recovery, the Maine
economy in 1996 finally  regained  its  pre-recession  job count of 545,000.  In
addition,  at the end of 1996,  Maine's labor  participation rate (the number of
persons  employed  as a  percentage  of the number of persons in the working age
population,  ages 16 through 64) was very close to the record high 69%  measured
in 1989, at the peak of the 1980's economic boom. Also, during 1996 unemployment
rates in Maine dropped  significantly and consistently  throughout the State. In
1996,  every county in Maine  experienced a significant drop in its unemployment
rate. In November of 1996,  seasonally  unadjusted  unemployment rates in all 16
Maine counties were  significantly  lower than in November  1995;  most counties
experienced a typical 1.2 - 1.5% drop over the previous November's  unemployment
rate; five Maine counties recorded seasonally unadjusted unemployment rates well
below  4%;  and  one  county  (Cumberland)   recorded  a  seasonally  unadjusted
unemployment rate below 3%, at 2.3%. In November 1996, the seasonally unadjusted
unemployment rate for Maine as a whole dropped to 4.4% from 5.7% during November
1995. This trend has continued through the Spring of 1997. The latest seasonally
unadjusted  unemployment  rates  available  (May 1997) show  Maine's  seasonally
unadjusted  unemployment  rate for May 1997 at 4.6% vs.  5.1% for May 1996.  The
unemployment rates in some Maine counties are approaching levels that economists
traditionally  have  viewed as  incompressible.  In the  words of the  Economics
Division of the Maine State Planning  Office,  currently in Maine "there are few
people left who want jobs and don't have them."

Also, on the positive side, in contrast to calendar year 1995 and the first half
of 1996, numerous Maine employers  announced,  or are proceeding with, plans for
significant   business   expansions   in  the  State.   For  example,   National
Semiconductor  Corporation  is proceeding  with  construction  of a $830 million
wafer chip  manufacturing  facility in South Portland,  which is expected to add
800 new jobs to the greater  Portland area. MBNA America Bank,  N.A., the second
largest issuer of credit cards in the nation,  recently has invested $37 million
in new  facilities in five Maine  communities  and has created 1,700 skilled and
semi-skilled jobs in Maine. In addition, MBNA is expected to add 2,000 more jobs
to its Maine  payrolls  in the next 2 1/2 years.  Guilford  of Maine,  Inc.  has
recently completed construction of a $30 million textile factory,  reputed to be
the worlds' most modern,  in Piscataquis  County,  and is actively  training new
employees in cooperation  with local  secondary  schools.  John J. Nissen Baking
Company has announced  plans to invest $40 million to build the world's  largest
bakery in Biddeford, Maine. Finally, Tambrands, Inc. is investing $36 million to
consolidate all of its manufacturing activities in Auburn, Maine.

A  further  positive  factor in the  growth of  Maine's  economy  is that  Maine
employers   recently  have  experienced  a  substantial   decrease  in  workers'
compensation  costs.  For many  years,  Maine  possessed  the  highest  workers'
compensation  insurance rates in the country.  The issue was so devisive that it
caused a shutdown of State  government in 1992.  Since that time,  however,  the
Maine  Legislature has created the Maine Employers' Mutual Insurance Co. and has
passed  numerous  reforms in Maine's  workers'  compensation  laws. As a result,
workers'  compensation  insurance  rates in Maine have  dropped  34% since 1994.
Another positive step concerning workers' compensation  insurance rates in Maine
was taken in May of this year when the Maine Legislature,  at the request of the
Governor,  refused to accede to a effort by organized labor to roll back many of
the reforms in Maine's workers' compensation laws enacted since 1992.

An  additional  positive  indicator  for the Maine economy is that Maine taxable
consumer  retail sales were up 5.3% for the first ten months of 1996 compared to
the same period in 1995. This is a noteworthy  improvement over 1995, when sales
were only up only 1.7% over 1994.  These consumer  retail sales data  (including
among other items  taxable  retail sales  related to the tourist  industry)  are
particularly  significant  for State of Maine  credit  purposes.  Since  roughly
one-third of Maine State government  general fund revenues are derived from a 6%
retail sales tax, the  performance  of taxable retail sales in Maine is directly
related to the ability of Maine State government to fund necessary  governmental
expenditures. Additionally on the positive side during 1996, unit sales of homes
in Maine  increased  5% over 1995,  the  average  sales price of a home in Maine
increased to over $113,000, and the average time on the market prior to sale for
homes in Maine declined.

On the negative  side,  Maine's  economic  recovery as a whole  continues to lag
behind the national and New England  averages.  For example,  between the second
quarter  of 1995  and the  second  quarter  of 1996  personal  income  in  Maine
increased by only 3.5%. By  comparison,  for the same period  national  personal
income increased by 5.5% and personal income in New England as a whole increased
by 4.8%.  Similarly,  during 1996 Maine  payroll  employment  growth  (people on
payrolls,  not including the  self-employed)  was very slow.  Such Maine payroll
employment  growth grew only 0.4% during 1996  compared to 1.9% and 2.3% in 1995
and 1994 respectively. These statistics only underscore the fact that employment
growth at the  national  level  continues  to far  outpace New England and Maine
employment  growth.  Since  the


                                       10
<PAGE>

trough of the recession in 1991,  national  employment has increased a full 12%,
or approximately 2% annually.  By comparison,  New England employment growth for
the same  period  has been only 7%,  and Maine  employment  growth  for the same
period has been only 6%, or 1/2 the national average. In addition,  despite very
low  unemployment  rates and what the Economics  Division of the State  Planning
Office has alluded to as "tight  labor  market  conditions"  in many of the most
populous counties of the State,  bankruptcy  filings,  predominantly  filings by
individual  debtors rather  businesses,  have in the words of the State Planning
Office,  "skyrocketed  through 1996." Such bankruptcy filings reached a level of
2,954 filings in 1996, or 30% higher on an annual basis than was  experienced in
the depths of the recent economic  recession.  In addition,  the number of Maine
residents receiving food stamps has remained at very high levels,  rising nearly
80% during the economic  recession,  and  dropping  only 10% through the present
when  virtually all of the jobs lost in the recession  have been  recovered.  In
addition,  through most of 1996, construction contract awards in Maine were down
5% from the previous year.  These  statistics  show a very mixed picture for the
performance of the Maine economy  during 1996, and in some instances  during the
first six months of 1997,  and they pose a continuing  management  challenge for
those legislators and State officials responsible for State fiscal policy.

The fiscal policies of the State of Maine are very  conservative,  and the State
is  required  by its  Constitution  to operate on a balanced  budget.  The Maine
Constitution does this by prohibiting the Legislature,  by itself,  from issuing
any debt by or on  behalf of the  State  which  exceeds  $2,000,000  "except  to
suppress insurrection, to repel invasion, or for purposes of war, and except for
temporary  loans to be paid out of money  raised by  taxation  during the fiscal
year in which they are  made."  The Maine  Constitution  also  provides  for the
prohibition  of debt  issued  by or on  behalf  of the  State  to fund  "current
expenditures." The Maine Constitution allows the issuance of long-term debt when
two-thirds of both houses of the Legislature pass a law authorizing the issuance
of such debt,  and when the voters of the State ratify and enact such a law at a
general or special statewide election. Amendments to the Maine Constitution also
have been adopted to permit the  Legislature  to authorize the issuance of bonds
to insure  payment of up to: (i) $6,000,000 of revenue bonds of the Maine School
Building  Authority;  (ii)  $4,000,000  of  loans to  Maine  students  attending
institutions of higher education;  (iii) $1,000,000 of mortgage loans for Indian
housing;  (iv) $4,000,000 of mortgage loans to resident Maine veterans including
businesses  owned by resident Maine  veterans;  and (v)  $90,000,000 of mortgage
loans for industrial,  manufacturing,  fishing,  agricultural  and  recreational
enterprises.  The Maine  Constitution  provides that if the Legislature fails to
appropriate sufficient funds to pay principal and interest on general obligation
bonds of the State,  the State  Treasurer  is required  to set aside  sufficient
funds from the first General Fund revenues  received  thereafter by the State to
make such payments.

In recent years,  Maine State  government  has skirted the Maine  constitutional
balanced  budget  requirement  by annually  issuing  significant  amounts of tax
anticipation notes ("TANs") during the first few days after the July 1 beginning
of each new fiscal  year and  leaving  such TANs  outstanding  until  almost the
beginning  of the next  fiscal  year.  For  example,  on June 26, 1996 the State
issued $150,000,000 in TANs due June 27, 1997. Both the size of these issues and
fiscal  legitimacy for them,  however,  have recently been  criticized,  and the
State is becoming  more  conservative  with  regard to what  amounts to a former
practice of maintaining almost permanent TANS of significant size. This has been
made possible largely by the continued  imposition of tightly conservative State
fiscal  policies  that  allowed the State to end fiscal year 1997 solidly in the
black with an  estimated  approximate  $50  million  surplus.  No TAN was issued
immediately following the July 1 start of the 1997 fiscal year, and its issuance
was put off at least until August 1997. Recently, the State has been considering
further  putting  off the  issuance  of any TAN for State  cash  flow  purposes,
because the need for such an issuance has not yet legitimately presented itself.

As of March 31, 1997,  there were  outstanding  general  obligation bonds of the
State in the principal amount of $444,157,945. On June 5, 1997, the State issued
$42,700,000  general  obligation  bonds  dated May 1,  1997.  On June 27,  1997,
$150,000,000  outstanding tax anticipation notes of the State matured, and after
the  start of the new  fiscal  year on July 1,  1997 the State did not issue new
TANs to roll over this debt.  Various  other  Maine  governmental  agencies  and
quasi-governmental  agencies including,  but not limited to, the Maine Municipal
Bond Bank,  the Maine Court  Facilities  Authority,  the Maine Health and Higher
Educational  Facilities  Authority,  Maine Turnpike  Authority,  the Maine State
Housing  Authority,  the Maine  Public  Utility  Financing  Bank,  and the Maine
Educational Loan Authority, issue debt for Maine governmental purposes, but this
debt does not pledge the credit of the State.

The  strength  of  Maine's  economy  during  the  1980's  enabled  the  State to
accumulate  relatively large unappropriated  surpluses of general fund revenues.
During the  economic  recession  of 1989  through  1992,  however,  Maine  State
government  repeatedly  reduced  its  expenditures  in order to comply  with the
requirement  of the  Maine  Constitution  that 


                                       11
<PAGE>

State  government  operate on a balanced  budget.  More  recently,  Maine  State
government has continued to downsize and  restructure  its operations as part of
an overall effort to improve the management of numerous  governmental  programs.
For example,  recently the Maine Legislature created a Productivity  Realization
Task Force and charged it with  identifying  more than $45,000,000 of savings in
State General Fund expenditures  during the 1996-1997 fiscal biennium.  The Task
Force,  in fact,  completed  the  identification  of $45.28  million  in cuts to
General Fund expenditures and passed  legislation to implement those cuts during
the  1996-1997  biennium.  The  work of the  Task  Force  also  will  result  in
additional ongoing cuts of $60.1 million in General Fund expenditures during the
1998-1999  biennium,  and the permanent  elimination of approximately 1352 State
jobs. Such cuts in General Fund expenditures,  other fiscal cost reductions, and
a continuing policy by the Governor not to allow the creation of significant new
State  governmental  programs  or the taxes to fund such  programs,  allowed the
Governor, on March 26, 1997, to sign a balanced budget for fiscal years 1998 and
1999 which  provides:  (i) for fiscal year 1998,  General Fund  expenditures  of
$1,825,047,780  and Highway  Fund  expenditures  of  $217,416,987;  and (ii) for
fiscal year 1999,  General Fund Expenditures of $1,984,859,413  and Highway Fund
Expenditures of $218,026,687.

During the First Regular Session of the 118th Maine  Legislature which adjourned
on March 27, 1997, and the First Special Session of the 118th Maine  Legislature
which  adjourned on June 1, 1997,  the Governor  and the  Legislature  also took
several steps to improve the State's fiscal  condition.  First,  the Legislature
passed and the  Governor  signed  into law a repeal of an across the board State
income tax cap that was enacted in 1995 and  scheduled to go into effect on July
1, 1997. If this State income tax cap had not been repealed, income tax revenues
expendable by the State beginning in fiscal year 1998 would have been restricted
to $676,230,000.  Second,  the Legislature and the Governor refused to eliminate
prior to its scheduled  elimination on June 30, 1998, an excise tax on the value
of gross hospital patient service  revenue,  and increased this tax for hospital
payment  years  that end in fiscal  year 1998 from  3.56% to 5.27%.  Third,  the
Legislature  and the  Governor  enacted  into law a "Tax  Relief  Fund for Maine
Residents"  which  requires,  according  to a formula,  that 75% of General Fund
Revenues  which  exceed  officially  accepted  estimates be used to increase the
personal  exemption amount of the Maine Individual Income Tax up to the personal
exemption  amount of the Federal  Individual  Income Tax. Also  according to the
formula provided by the tax-relief  statute,  25% of General Fund revenues which
exceed accepted  estimates must be used to reduce the unfunded  liability of the
Maine State  Retirement  System.  As of the close of State's fiscal year on June
30,  1997,  Maine  General  Fund  Revenues   exceeded   accepted   estimates  by
approximately  $50  million.  This means that 75% of such  excess  General  Fund
revenues,  or an estimated  $37.5  million,  will be allocated to tax relief for
Maine residents,  and 25% of such excess General Fund revenues,  or an estimated
$12.5  million will be  allocated to reduce the unfunded  liability of the Maine
State Retirement  System. The State also maintains a "Rainy Day Fund" to be used
for significant unforeseen capital and operational  expenditures.  To the extent
that General Fund revenues which exceed  accepted  estimates are diverted to the
purposes  of tax  relief  for Maine  residents  and  reduction  of the  unfunded
liability of the Maine State  Retirement  System,  lesser amounts of such excess
General Fund Revenues will be available to fund the Rainy Day Fund.
As of July 14, 1997 the balance in the State's Rainy Day Fund was $45,497,470.

There can be no  assurance  that the budget acts for fiscal years 1998 and 1999,
and the various other statutes passed by the Maine  Legislature which affect the
State's fiscal  position,  will not be amended by the  Legislature  from time to
time.

The unfunded  liability of the Maine State  Retirement  System is a  significant
problem  for Maine  State  government.  This  unfunded  liability  currently  is
certified by the State's independent actuaries to be approximately $2.9 billion.
Because of this, the State has adopted a  constitutional  amendment (Me.  Const.
art. IX, S18-B)  that requires the Maine Legislature,  beginning in fiscal year
1997,  annually  to  appropriate  funds that will retire in 31 years or less the
System's unfunded  liability  attributable to State employees and teachers.  The
State has also adopted a separate constitutional  amendment (Me. Const. art. IX,
ss.18-A)  that  requires the Maine  Legislature,  beginning in fiscal year 1997,
annually to appropriate  monies to fund the System on an actuarily  sound basis.
Under  Article  IX,  S18-B  of  the  Maine  Constitution,  unfunded  liabilities
henceforth  may not be  created  for the  System  except  those  resulting  from
experience  losses,  and such unfunded  liabilities  resulting  from  experience
losses must be retired over a period not exceeding 10 years.

Because of Maine's conservative debt policies and its constitutional requirement
that the  State  government  operate  under a  balanced  budget,  Maine  general
obligation bonds had been rated AAA by S&P and Aa1 by Moody's for many years.

On June 6,  1991,  however,  S&P  lowered  its credit  rating for Maine  general
obligation bonds from AAA to AA+, and at the same time lowered its credit rating
on bonds issued by the Maine Municipal Bond Bank and the Maine Court  Facilities

                                       12
<PAGE>

Authority,  and on State of Maine  Certificates  of  Participation  for  highway
equipment, from AA to A+. In taking this action, S&P said, "The rating action is
a result of declines in key financial indicators,  and continued softness in the
state  economy.  The new rating  continues to reflect the low debt burden of the
state, an economic base that has gained greater income levels and diversity over
the 1980's,  and a legislative  history of dealing  effectively  with  financial
difficulties." These ratings have remained unchanged since June 6, 1991. Because
of slow but continuing improvements in the State of Maine economy, S&P currently
views the State's  financial outlook as "stable," stating in its most recent May
12, 1997 credit  report:  "The outlook  reflects the state's  manageable  budget
estimates and careful  monitoring of revenues and expenditures.  Economic growth
should continue at a slow, sustainable pace."

On August 24, 1993, citing the "effects of protracted  economic slowdown and the
expectation  that Maine's  economy will not soon return to the pattern of robust
growth evident in the  mid-1980's,"  Moody's  lowered its State of Maine general
obligation  bond rating from Aa1 to Aa. At the same time,  Moody's  lowered from
Aa1 to Aa the ratings  assigned to  state-guaranteed  bonds of the Maine  School
Building  Authority and the Finance  Authority of Maine, and confirmed at A1 the
ratings assigned to the bonds of the Maine Court Facilities  Authority and State
of Maine  Certificates of Participation.  These ratings remained unchanged until
the current year. In its most recent credit report for the State of Maine, dated
May 13, 1997, Moody's "confirmed and refined from Aa to Aa3" the State's general
obligation bond rating. Moody's refinement of the State's bond rating on May 13,
1997 was part of a general  redefinition  by Moody's of its bond rating  symbols
published on January 13, 1997. In its May 13, 1997 credit report,  Moody's said:
"Among the factors  contributing  to the high grade rating are the state's sound
debt profile, with a moderate level of borrowing scheduled for rapid retirement,
and an improving financial trend,  reflecting economic gains of recent years and
a fiscal policy aimed at achieving  budgetary  balance through steady government
cost-cutting  and reduced  reliance on one-time  measures."  In this same credit
report,  however,  Moody's  also  recognized  specific  negative  factors  which
affected the rating,  saying:  "The rating also  recognizes the state's  lagging
recovery from the recession of the early 1990s and  continuing,  though reduced,
exposure to potential  defense  contracting  cutbacks;  its narrow  General Fund
position,  whether  measured  on a GAAP or a cash  basis;  and  its  substantial
unfunded pension  obligation  which, by a variety of measures,  is several times
the size of its direct debt."

For its June 5, 1997 general obligation bond issue dated May 1, 1997, Maine also
received a credit  report from Fitch.  In this credit  report  dated May 9, 1997
Fitch  assigned  a  rating  of AA to Maine  general  obligation  bonds,  saying:
"Maine's general  obligations are well secured,  with strength in the low burden
that debt places on resources and in the unusually  rapid rate of  amortization.
The  economy  continues  to  recover  from the  severity  of the  recession  and
financial operations have regained normality.  Institutionalization of financial
reforms,  including accounting,  the revenue estimation process and debt control
will be of benefit and the reserve is reasonably funded."

CERTAIN INFORMATION CONCERNING THE STATE OF NEW HAMPSHIRE

Material in this  section has been  abstracted  from the State of New  Hampshire
Official Statement dated May 28, 1997, which is compiled by the Treasurer of the
State of New Hampshire and which is provided to  prospective  purchasers of debt
securities  offered by the State. While information in the Official Statement is
believed  to be  accurate,  none  of that  information  has  been  independently
verified. Also, it does not reflect economic conditions or developments that may
have  occurred  or  trends  that may  have  materialized  since  the date of the
Official Statement.  Additionally,  economic and fiscal conditions in individual
municipalities  within  the State  may vary from  general  economic  and  fiscal
conditions.

New Hampshire is located in the New England Region and is bordered by the states
of Maine,  Massachusetts,  and Vermont and the Province of Quebec,  Canada.  New
Hampshire's  geographic  area is 9,304 square miles and its 1996  population was
1,163,000,  representing  a 1.3%  increase  from 1995  levels.  New  Hampshire's
population had increased by more than 25% in the 1980-1996 period.

New Hampshire's per capita personal income  increased by 106.4% between 1980 and
1990. In 1991 it continued to grow faster than the New England region as a whole
and in 1992 and 1993 it grew at a slightly lower rate than the region,  resuming
faster  growth  relative  to the region in 1994 and 1995.  New  Hampshire's  per
capita personal  income in 1996 was 109% of the national  level,  ranking 8th in
the United States.

                                       13
<PAGE>

In 1996, New Hampshire's largest employment sector was the service sector (28.8%
of  employment),  followed by retail and wholesale  trade (25.8% of employment).
Manufacturing   was  the   third   largest   sector   (18.9%   of   employment).
Non-agricultural employment levels have remained fairly stable. The unemployment
rate declined to 4.2% in 1996, less than the national  average,  and preliminary
data for the month of March  1997  (seasonally  adjusted)  show New  Hampshire's
unemployment rate at 2.1%, compared to a national average of 5.2%.

After a  significant  growth in  residential  building  activity  in the  period
1980-86  (data  based  on  residential   building   permits),   New  Hampshire's
residential  building  activity  declined  beginning in 1987, and declined below
1980  levels in 1990,  1991 and 1992.  In 1993,  residential  building  activity
surpassed 1980 levels and activity in 1994, 1995 and 1996 surpassed 1993.

New Hampshire  finances the operations of state government  through  specialized
taxes,  user  charges and  revenues  received  from the State  liquor  sales and
distribution  system. There is no general tax on sales or earned income. The two
highest  revenue-producing  taxes are the  Meals and Rooms Tax and the  Business
Profits  Tax. In 1992,  State and local  taxes  amounted to $98.10 per $1,000 of
personal  income,  which was the fourth  lowest in the United  States.  However,
because local property  taxes are the principal  source of funding for municipal
operations and primary and secondary education,  New Hampshire was highest among
all states in local property tax collections per $1,000 of personal income.

New Hampshire  State  government's  budget is enacted to cover a biennial period
through  a  series  of  legislative  bills  that  establish  appropriations  and
estimated   revenues  for  each  sub-unit  of  State   government,   along  with
supplemental  and  special  legislation.  By  statute,  the  budget  process  is
initiated  by the  Governor,  who is  required to submit  operating  and capital
budget  proposals to the Legislature by February 15 in each  odd-numbered  year.
While the Governor is required to state the means through which all expenditures
will be financed,  there is no constitutional or statutory  requirement that the
Governor  propose  or the  Legislature  adopt  a  budget  without  resorting  to
borrowing. There is no line item veto.

State  government funds include the General Fund, four special purpose funds and
three enterprise funds, as well as certain "fiduciary" funds. All obligations of
the State are paid from the State Treasury,  and must be authorized by a warrant
signed by the  Governor  and  approved  by the  Executive  Council,  except  for
payments  of debt  obligations,  which  are paid by the  State  Treasurer  under
statutory authority.

By statute, at the close of each fiscal year, any General Fund operating surplus
up to 5% of General  Fund  unrestricted  revenue  must be deposited in a Revenue
Stabilization   Reserve  Account  ("Rainy  Day  Fund").  With  approval  of  the
Legislative Fiscal Committee,  the Governor and the Executive Council, the Rainy
Day Fund is available to defray operating  deficits in ensuing years if there is
a shortfall in forecast revenue. By statute,  the Rainy Day Fund may not be used
for any other purpose except by special appropriation  approved by two-thirds of
each  Legislative  chamber  and the  Governor.  As of June 30,  1996 there was a
designated balance of $20 million in the Rainy Day Fund.

The  Department of  Administrative  Services is responsible  for  maintenance of
State  government's   accounting  system,  annual  reports  and  general  budget
oversight.   Expenditures  are  controlled  against  appropriations  through  an
integrated  accounting  system which compares the amount of an  appropriation to
expenditures  and  encumbrances  previously  charged against that  appropriation
before creating an expenditure.  By law, with certain exceptions  unexpended and
unencumbered  balances of appropriations lapse to surplus in the applicable fund
at the end of each fiscal year, along with unappropriated  revenues in excess of
legislative  estimates.  Legislative  financial  controls  involve the Office of
Legislative  Budget  Assistant  ("LBA")  which  acts  under  supervision  of the
Legislative  Fiscal  Committee and Joint  Legislative  Capital  Budget  Overview
Committee.  LBA conducts overall post-audit and review of the budgetary process.
State government  financial statements are prepared in accordance with generally
accepted accounting principles ("GAAP") and are independently audited annually.

During the 1992-1993 biennium,  State revenues began recovering from the decline
that had  characterized  the recession years of 1989, 1990 and 1991. The General
Fund  undesignated  fund  balance  at June 30,  1992  was  $43.1  Million,  with
accumulated  undesignated  fund balance of $18.6 Million;  at June 30, 1993, the
General Fund 


                                       14
<PAGE>

undesignated fund balance was $31.5 Million and at June 30, 1994, $12.0 Million.
For the fiscal year ended June 30,  1995,  the General  Fund  undesignated  fund
balance  was  zero,  after   transferring  $35.1  Million  from  the  Healthcare
Transition   Fund  to  offset  a  delay  in  receipt   of  federal   funds  from
disproportionate  share  expenditures  under the Medicaid  program.  At June 30,
1996, the General Fund undesignated fund balance was ($44.2 Million) after a net
transfer to the Healthcare Transition Fund of $21.9 Million, and is projected at
($25.8 Million) at June 30, 1997.

There is no  constitutional  limit on the State's power to issue  obligations or
incur  indebtedness,   and  no  constitutional  requirement  for  referendum  to
authorize incurrence of indebtedness by the State. Authorization and issuance of
debt is governed  entirely by statute.  New Hampshire  pursues a debt management
program  designed to minimize use of short-term debt for operating  purposes and
to coordinate issuance of tax-exempt securities by the State and its agencies.

State-guaranteed bonded indebtedness is authorized not only for general purposes
of State government,  but also for the New Hampshire Turnpike System, University
System of New Hampshire,  water supply and pollution  control,  water  resources
acquisition and  construction,  School  Building  Authority,  Pease  Development
Authority,  Business  Finance  Authority,  Municipal  Bond Bank and  cleanup  of
municipal  Super Fund sites and  landfills.  In  addition,  the Housing  Finance
Authority and Higher Education and Health Facilities Authority are authorized to
issue bonds that do not constitute debts or obligations of the State.

Procedure for incurrence of bonded indebtedness by individual  municipalities is
governed by State  statutes,  which  prescribe  actions  that must be pursued by
municipalities in incurring bonded indebtedness and limitations on the amount of
such  indebtedness.   In  general,   incurrence  of  bonded  indebtedness  by  a
municipality  must  be for a  statutorily  authorized  purpose  and  requires  a
two-thirds majority vote of the municipality's legislative body.

On December 30, 1993,  the New Hampshire  Supreme Court  reinstated and remanded
for trial a lawsuit challenging the  constitutionality  of the State's system of
financing public schools primarily through local property taxes. The Court ruled
that the New Hampshire  Constitution imposes an enforceable duty on the State to
provide  an  "adequate"  education  to every  educable  child  and to  guarantee
adequate  funding.  However,  the Court did not  determine  the  adequacy of the
State's current  education  programs or current  funding  levels,  leaving those
matters to the  Legislative  and  Executive  branches to  determine in the first
instance.  The lawsuit was tried in the Spring of 1996,  resulting in a decision
by the trial  court  denying  any  relief to the  plaintiffs.  The  decision  is
currently under appeal to the New Hampshire Supreme Court. The potential impact,
if  any,  of  this  litigation  on the  State's  finances  cannot  presently  be
determined.

3. INVESTMENT LIMITATIONS

Investors  High Grade Bond Fund,  Investors  Bond Fund,  TaxSaver  Bond Fund and
Maine  Municipal  Bond Fund have adopted the  following  fundamental  investment
limitations  which are in addition to those  contained in the Funds'  Prospectus
and which may not be changed without shareholder approval. No Fund may:

         (1)      Borrow  money,  except for  temporary  or  emergency  purposes
                  (including the meeting of redemption  requests) and except for
                  entering into reverse repurchase agreements, and provided that
                  borrowings  do not exceed 33 1/3% of the Fund's  total  assets
                  (computed immediately after the borrowing).

         (2)      Act as an underwriter  of securities of other issuers,  except
                  to the extent that,  in  connection  with the  disposition  of
                  portfolio  securities,  the  Fund  may  be  deemed  to  be  an
                  underwriter for purposes of the Securities Act of 1933.

         (3)      Make  loans to other  persons  except  for loans of  portfolio
                  securities and except through the use of repurchase agreements
                  and  through  the  purchase  of   commercial   paper  or  debt
                  securities which are otherwise permissible investments.

                                       15
<PAGE>

         (4)      Purchase or sell real estate or any interest  therein,  except
                  that the Fund may invest in securities issued or guaranteed by
                  corporate or governmental  entities  secured by real estate or
                  interests   therein,   such  as  mortgage   pass-throughs  and
                  collateralized  mortgage  obligations,  or issued by companies
                  that invest in real estate or interests therein.

         (5)      Purchase or sell physical commodities or contracts relating to
                  physical    commodities,    provided   that   currencies   and
                  currency-related  contracts  will not be deemed to be physical
                  commodities.

         (6)      Issue senior  securities  except pursuant to Section 18 of the
                  Investment  Company Act of 1940  ("1940  Act") and except that
                  the Fund may borrow money  subject to  investment  limitations
                  specified in the Fund's Prospectus.

         (7)      Invest  in  interests  in oil or gas  or  interests  in  other
                  mineral exploration or development programs.

In addition to the  foregoing,  Investors  Bond Fund and TaxSaver Bond Fund have
adopted   the   following   fundamental    investment   limitations   concerning
diversification and industry concentration. The Funds may not:

         (1)      Purchase securities, other than U.S. Government Securities, of
                  any one issuer, if (a) more than 5% of the Fund's total assets
                  taken  at  market  value  would  at the  time of  purchase  be
                  invested  in the  securities  of  that  issuer,  or  (b)  such
                  purchase  would at the time of purchase cause the Fund to hold
                  more than 10% of the  outstanding  voting  securities  of that
                  issuer.  Up to 50% of the Fund's  total assets may be invested
                  without regard to this limitation.

         (2)      Purchase  securities,  other than U.S. Government  Securities,
                  if,  immediately  after  each  purchase,  more than 25% of the
                  Fund's total assets taken at market value would be invested in
                  securities  of issuers  conducting  their  principal  business
                  activity in the same industry.

Investors High Grade Bond Fund has adopted the following fundamental  investment
limitations concerning diversification and industry concentration.  The Fund may
not:

         (1)      With respect to 75% of its assets, purchase securities,  other
                  than U.S.  Government  Securities,  of any one issuer,  if (a)
                  more than 5% of the Fund's  total assets taken at market value
                  would at the time of purchase be invested in the securities of
                  that  issuer,  or (b)  such  purchase  would  at the  time  of
                  purchase  cause  the  Fund  to  hold  more  than  10%  of  the
                  outstanding voting securities of that issuer.

         (2)      Purchase  securities,  other than U.S. Government  Securities,
                  if,  immediately  after  each  purchase,  more than 25% of the
                  Fund's total assets taken at market value would be invested in
                  securities  of issuers  conducting  their  principal  business
                  activity in the same industry.

Maine  Municipal  Bond Fund has adopted  the  following  fundamental  investment
limitations  concerning investment in securities of issuers in the same industry
and investment in securities having voting rights. The Fund may not:

         (1)      Purchase  securities,  other than U.S. Government  Securities,
                  if,  immediately  after  each  purchase,  more than 25% of the
                  Fund's total assets taken at market value would be invested in
                  securities  of issuers  conducting  their  principal  business
                  activity  in the same  industry.  For this  purpose,  consumer
                  finance  companies,  industrial  finance  companies,  and gas,
                  electric,  water  and  telephone  utility  companies  are each
                  considered to be separate industries.

         (2)      Purchase securities having voting rights  except securities of
                  other investment companies.

                                       16
<PAGE>

Investors  Bond Fund,  Investors  High Grade Bond Fund,  TaxSaver  Bond Fund and
Maine Municipal Bond Fund have adopted the following  nonfundamental  investment
limitations that may be changed by the Board without  shareholder  approval.  No
Fund may:

         (a)      Pledge,  mortgage or hypothecate its assets,  except to secure
                  permitted indebtedness. The deposit in escrow of securities in
                  connection   with  the  writing  of  put  and  call   options,
                  collateralized loans of securities and collateral arrangements
                  with respect to margin for futures contracts are not deemed to
                  be pledges or hypothecations for this purpose.

         (b)      Invest in securities of another registered investment company,
                  except in connection with a merger, consolidation, acquisition
                  or  reorganization;  and  except  that the Fund may  invest in
                  money  market  funds  and  privately-issued  mortgage  related
                  securities to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act.

         (c)      Purchase   securities  on  margin,  or  make  short  sales  of
                  securities,  except for the use of short-term credit necessary
                  for  the   clearance  of  purchases  and  sales  of  portfolio
                  securities,  except that the Fund may make margin  deposits in
                  connection  with permitted  transactions  in options,  futures
                  contracts and options on futures contracts.

         (d)      Invest in  securities  (other than  fully-collateralized  debt
                  obligations)   issued  by   companies   that  have   conducted
                  continuous operations for less than three years, including the
                  operations of predecessors,  unless guaranteed as to principal
                  and interest by an issuer in whose  securities  the Fund could
                  invest,  if as a  result,  more  than 5% of the  value  of the
                  Fund's total assets would be so invested.

         (e)      Invest in or hold  securities  of any issuer if  officers  and
                  directors  of the  Trust  or the  Fund's  investment  adviser,
                  individually  owning  beneficially  more than 1/2 of 1% of the
                  securities of the issuer, in the aggregate own more than 5% of
                  the issuer's securities.

         (f)      Purchase   securities  for  investment   while  any  borrowing
                  equaling 10% or more of the Fund's total assets is outstanding
                  or borrow for purposes  other than meeting  redemptions  in an
                  amount exceeding 10% of the value of the Fund's total assets.

         (g)      Acquire  securities  or invest in repurchase  agreements  with
                  respect to any securities  if, as a result,  more than (i) 15%
                  of the  Fund's net assets  (taken at current  value)  would be
                  invested in repurchase  agreements not entitling the holder to
                  payment of principal within seven days and in securities which
                  are not  readily  marketable,  including  securities  that are
                  illiquid  by  virtue  of  restrictions  on the  sale  of  such
                  securities  to  the  public  without  registration  under  the
                  Securities Act of 1933  ("Restricted  Securities") or (ii) 10%
                  of the Fund's  total  assets  would be invested in  Restricted
                  Securities.

         (h)      Purchase  or sell  real  property  leases  (including  limited
                  partnership   interests,   but  excluding  readily  marketable
                  interests  in  real  estate   investment   trusts  or  readily
                  marketable  securities  of  companies  which  invest  in  real
                  estate.)

In addition to the  foregoing,  Investors  Bond Fund,  Investors High Grade Bond
Fund and TaxSaver Bond Fund have adopted the following nonfundamental investment
limitation  concerning  investment in securities having voting rights. The Funds
may not:

         (a       Purchase securities having voting rights except  securities of
                  other investment companies.

Maine  Municipal Bond Fund has adopted the following  nonfundamental  investment
limitation. The Fund may not:

         (a)      Invest in oil, gas or other mineral exploration or development
                  programs,  or  leases,  provided  that the Fund may  invest in
                  securities issued by companies engaged in such activities.

                                       17
<PAGE>

The New  Hampshire  Bond Fund has adopted the following  fundamental  investment
limitations that cannot be changed without the affirmative vote of a majority of
the Fund's outstanding voting securities. The Fund may not:

         (1)      With respect to 50% of its assets,  purchase a security  other
                  than a U.S.  Government  Security  of any one  issuer if, as a
                  result,  more  than 5% of the  Fund's  total  assets  would be
                  invested  in the  securities  of that issuer or the Fund would
                  own more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of that
                  issuer.

         (2)      Purchase  securities if, immediately after the purchase,  more
                  than 25% of the  value of the  Fund's  total  assets  would be
                  invested in the securities of issuers  having their  principal
                  business activities in the same industry, provided there is no
                  limit on investments in U.S. Government Securities,  municipal
                  securities  or  in  the   securities  of  domestic   financial
                  institutions (not including their foreign branches).  For this
                  purpose,   consumer  finance  companies,   industrial  finance
                  companies,  and gas,  electric,  water and  telephone  utility
                  companies are each considered to be separate industries.

         (3)      Underwrite  securities of other issuers,  except to the extent
                  that the Fund may be considered to be acting as an underwriter
                  in connection with the disposition of portfolio securities.

         (4)      Purchase or sell real estate or any interest  therein,  except
                  that the Fund may invest in debt  obligations  secured by real
                  estate or interests therein or issued by companies that invest
                  in real estate or interests therein.

         (5)      Invest in commodities or in commodity contracts,  except that,
                  to the extent the Fund is  otherwise  permitted,  the Fund may
                  enter into  financial  futures  contracts and options on those
                  futures   contracts   and  may   invest  in   currencies   and
                  currency-related contracts.

         (6)      Borrow  money,  except for  temporary  or  emergency  purposes
                  (including the meeting of redemption  requests) and except for
                  entering  into reverse  repurchase  agreements,  provided that
                  borrowings do not exceed 33 1/3% of the Fund's net assets.

         (7)      Issue  senior  securities  except as  appropriate  to evidence
                  indebtedness that the Fund is permitted to incur, and provided
                  that the Fund may issue shares of additional series or classes
                  that the Board may establish.

         (8)      Make loans except for loans of portfolio  securities,  through
                  the use of repurchase agreements,  and through the purchase of
                  debt securities that are otherwise permitted investments.

The New Hampshire Bond Fund has adopted the following nonfundamental  investment
limitations that may be changed by the Board without shareholder  approval.  The
Fund may not:

         (a)      Purchase   securities  for  investment   while  any  borrowing
                  equaling   10%  or  more  of  the  Fund's   total   assets  is
                  outstanding;  and if at any time the Fund's  borrowings exceed
                  the  Fund's  investment  limitations  due to a decline  in net
                  assets,  such borrowings will be promptly  (within three days)
                  reduced  to  the   extent   necessary   to  comply   with  the
                  limitations.

         (b)      Purchase  securities that have voting rights,  except the Fund
                  may invest in securities of other investment  companies to the
                  extent  permitted by the  Investment  Company Act of 1940 (the
                  "1940 Act").

         (c)      Purchase   securities  on  margin,  or  make  short  sales  of
                  securities,  except for the use of short-term credit necessary
                  for  the   clearance  of  purchases  and  sales  of  portfolio
                  securities.

                                       18
<PAGE>

         (d)      Invest in  securities  (other than  fully-collateralized  debt
                  obligations)   issued  by   companies   that  have   conducted
                  continuous operations for less than three years, including the
                  operations of predecessors  (unless guaranteed as to principal
                  and interest by an issuer in whose  securities  the Fund could
                  invest)  if as a  result,  more  than 5% of the  value  of the
                  Fund's total assets would be so invested.

         (e)      Invest in or hold securities of any issuer other than the Fund
                  if, to the Fund's  knowledge,  those directors and officers of
                  the  Trust  or the  Fund's  investment  adviser,  individually
                  owning  beneficially  more than 1/2 of 1% of the securities of
                  the issuer,  in the aggregate own more than 5% of the issuer's
                  securities.

         (f)      Invest in oil, gas or other mineral exploration or development
                  programs,  or  leases,  provided  that the Fund may  invest in
                  securities issued by companies engaged in such activities.

         (g)      Acquire  securities  or invest in repurchase  agreements  with
                  respect to any securities  if, as a result,  more than (i) 15%
                  of the  Fund's net assets  (taken at current  value)  would be
                  invested in repurchase  agreements not entitling the holder to
                  payment of principal within seven days and in securities which
                  are not  readily  marketable  or (ii) 10% of the Fund's  total
                  assets  would be invested in  securities  that are illiquid by
                  virtue of  restrictions  on the sale of such securities to the
                  public without registration under the Securities Act of 1933.

         (h)      Purchase or sell real property  (including limited partnership
                  interests,  but excluding readily marketable interests in real
                  estate investment trusts or readily  marketable  securities of
                  companies which invest in real estate.)

Except as required by the 1940 Act, if any percentage  restriction on investment
or  utilization  of assets is adhered to at the time an  investment  is made,  a
later change in percentage  resulting  from a change in the market values of the
Fund's  assets or purchases and  redemptions  of shares will not be considered a
violation of the limitation.

For purposes of the  limitation  set forth above with  respect to TaxSaver  Bond
Fund, which relates to the diversification of the Fund's assets, the District of
Columbia,  each state, each political subdivision,  agency,  instrumentality and
authority  thereof,  and each multi-state agency of which a state is a member is
deemed to be a separate  "issuer."  When the assets and  revenues  of an agency,
authority,  instrumentality or other political subdivision are separate from the
government  creating  the  subdivision  and the  security  is backed only by the
assets and revenues of the subdivision,  such subdivision  would be deemed to be
the sole issuer.  Similarly,  in the case of private activity bonds, if the bond
is backed only by the assets and revenues of the nongovernmental user, then such
nongovernmental  user  would be deemed  to be the sole  issuer.  However,  if in
either case, the creating government or some other agency guarantees a security,
that guarantee  would be considered a separate  security and would be treated as
an issue of such government or other agency.

No more than 25% of a Fund's total assets may be invested in the  securities  of
one issuer.  However,  this limitation does not apply to securities of an issuer
payable solely from the proceeds of U.S. Government Securities.

4. PERFORMANCE DATA

The Funds may quote  performance  in various ways. All  performance  information
supplied  by the Funds in  advertising  is  historical  and is not  intended  to
indicate  future  returns.  The Funds' net asset  value,  yield and total return
fluctuate in response to market  conditions and other factors,  and the value of
Fund shares when redeemed may be more or less than their original cost.


                                       19
<PAGE>


Standardized SEC yield and total return  information as of March 31, 1997 is set
forthin the following tables:
<TABLE>
<S>                     <C>             <C>                  <C>              <C>              <C>
                                       30 Day
                      30 Day           Annualized                                            Total Return
                      Annualized       Tax Equivalent     Total Return      Total Return     Since
                      Yield            Yield              1 Year            5 Year           Inception
                      -----            -----              ------            ------           ---------
INVESTORS BOND FUND
                       7.49%           N/A                7.18%             7.91%            8.92%

TAXSAVER BOND FUND
                       4.74%           7.85%              5.15%             7.02%            7.38%

MAINE MUNICIPAL
BOND FUND              4.19%           7.58%              4.98%             6.73%            6.64%

NEW  HAMPSHIRE
BOND FUND              4.34%           7.57%              4.56%             N/A              5.73%
</TABLE>

Tax-equivalent  yield for  TaxSaver  Bond Fund is based on a Federal  income tax
rate of 39.6%.  The tax equivalent  yield for Maine Municipal Bond Fund is based
on a combined  Federal and Maine state income tax rate of 48.1%  (Federal  39.6%
and State of Maine 8.5%).  The tax equivalent  yield for New Hampshire Bond Fund
is based on a combined  Federal and New Hampshire state income tax rate of 44.6%
(Federal 39.6% and State of New Hampshire 5.0%).

Investors  Bond Fund and TaxSaver Bond Fund  commenced  operations on October 2,
1989. Maine Municipal Bond Fund and New Hampshire Bond Fund commenced operations
on December 5, 1991 and December 31, 1992, respectively.

In  advertising  performance  each  Fund  may  compare  any of  its  performance
information  with data published by independent  evaluators such as Morningstar,
Lipper Analytical Services, Inc., IBC/Donoghue,  Inc., CDA/Wiesenberger or other
companies which track the investment  performance of investment companies ("Fund
Tracking  Companies").  Each  Fund  may  also  compare  any of  its  performance
information  with the performance of recognized  stock,  bond and other indices,
including  but not limited to the  Municipal  Bond Buyers  Indices,  the Salomon
Brothers Bond Index,  the Shearson Lehman Bond Index,  the Standard & Poor's 500
Composite Stock Price Index, the Dow Jones  Industrial  Average,  U.S.  Treasury
bonds,  bills or notes and changes in the  Consumer  Price Index as published by
the  U.S.  Department  of  Commerce.  The  Funds  may  refer to  general  market
performances  over  past  time  periods  such as  those  published  by  Ibbotson
Associates (for instance, its "Stocks, Bonds, Bills and Inflation Yearbook"). In
addition,  the Funds  may refer in such  materials  to mutual  fund  performance
rankings  and other  data  published  by Fund  Tracking  Companies.  Performance
advertising  may also refer to discussions of the Funds and  comparative  mutual
fund data and ratings  reported in independent  periodicals,  such as newspapers
and financial magazines.

For example, the Funds may advertise the historical advantages, based on assumed
investments made on particular dates, in long term corporate bonds or in the S&P
500  Composite  Stock Index  against U.S.  Treasury  bills,  as published by the
companies listed above.

YIELD CALCULATIONS

Yields  for a Fund used in  advertising  are  computed  by  dividing  the Fund's
interest income for a given 30 days or one-month period, net of expenses, by the
average number of shares  entitled to receive  distributions  during the period,
dividing  this  figure by the Fund's net asset value per share at the end of the
period and annualizing the result  (assuming  compounding of income) in order to
arrive at an annual percentage rate. In general, interest income is


                                       20
<PAGE>

reduced  with  respect to bonds  purchased  at a premium over their par value by
subtracting  a portion  of the  premium  from  income on a daily  basis,  and is
increased  with respect to bonds  purchased at a discount by adding a portion of
the discount to daily income.  Capital gain and loss generally are excluded from
these calculations.

Income  calculated for the purpose of determining  the Fund's yield differs from
income as determined  for other  accounting  purposes.  Because of the different
accounting  methods  used,  and  because  of the  compounding  assumed  in yield
calculations,  the  yield  quoted  for a  Fund  may  differ  from  the  rate  of
distribution  the Fund paid over the same period or the rate of income  reported
in the Fund's financial statements.

The tax  equivalent  yield for TaxSaver Bond Fund is the rate an investor  would
have to earn from a fully taxable  investment in order to equal the Fund's yield
after taxes.  Tax equivalent  yields are calculated by dividing the Fund's yield
by one minus the stated Federal or combined  Federal and state tax rate. If only
a portion of the Fund's  yield is  tax-exempt,  only that portion is adjusted in
the calculation.

Although  published  yield  information  is useful to  investors  in reviewing a
Fund's performance,  investors should be aware that a Fund's yield for any given
period is not an  indication or  representation  by the Fund of future yields or
rates of return on the Fund's shares. Also, Processing Organizations (as defined
in the  Prospectuses)  may charge their customers direct fees in connection with
an investment  in a Fund,  which will have the effect of reducing the Fund's net
yield  to  those  shareholders.  The  yields  of  each  Fund  are not  fixed  or
guaranteed,  and  an  investment  in  a  Fund  is  not  insured  or  guaranteed.
Accordingly,  yield information may not necessarily be used to compare shares of
a Fund with investment alternatives which, like money market instruments or bank
accounts, may provide a fixed rate of interest.  Also, it may not be appropriate
to compare a Fund's yield information directly to similar information  regarding
investment alternatives which are insured or guaranteed.

TOTAL RETURN CALCULATIONS

Each  of  the  Funds  may  advertise  total  return.  Total  returns  quoted  in
advertising  reflect all  aspects of a Fund's  return,  including  the effect of
reinvesting  dividends  and  capital  gain  distributions  and any change in the
Fund's net asset value per share over the  period.  Average  annual  returns are
calculated  by  determining  the growth or  decline  in value of a  hypothetical
historical  investment in a Fund over a stated period,  and then calculating the
annually compounded  percentage rate that would have produced the same result if
the rate of growth or decline in value had been constant over the period.  While
average  annual  returns  are  a  convenient   means  of  comparing   investment
alternatives, investors should realize that the performance is not constant over
time but changes from year to year, and that average  annual  returns  represent
averaged figures as opposed to the actual year-to-year performance of the Funds.

Average  annual  total  return is  calculated  by  finding  the  average  annual
compounded  rates of return of a  hypothetical  investment  over a given  period
according to the following formula:

                  P(1+T)n = ERV

         Where:

                  P = a  hypothetical  initial  payment of  $1,000;
                  T = average annual  total  return; 
                  n = number of years;  and
                  ERV = ending redeemable value.

ERV is the value, at the end of the applicable period, of a hypothetical  $1,000
payment made at the beginning of the applicable period.

In  addition  to  average  annual  returns,  each Fund may quote  unaveraged  or
cumulative total returns  reflecting the simple change in value of an investment
over a stated period.  Total returns may be broken down into their


                                       21
<PAGE>

components  of income and capital  (including  capital gain and changes in share
price)  in order to  illustrate  the  relationship  of these  factors  and their
contributions  to total  return.  Total  returns,  yields and other  performance
information  may  be  quoted  numerically  or  in  a  table,  graph  or  similar
illustration.

         Period total return is calculated according to the following formula:

                  PT = (ERV/P-1)

         Where:

                  PT = period total return.
                          The other definitions are the same as in
                          average annual total return above.

5. MANAGEMENT

The trustees and officers of the Trust and their  principal  occupations  during
the past five years are set forth  below.  Each  Trustee  who is an  "interested
person" (as defined by the 1940 Act) of the Trust is indicated by an asterisk.

John Y. Keffer,* Chairman and President (age 56)

     President  and  Director,  Forum  Financial  Services,  Inc. (a  registered
     broker-dealer),   Forum  Administrative   Services,   LLC  (a  mutual  fund
     administrator),  Forum  Financial  Corp. (a registered  transfer agent) and
     Forum Advisors,  Inc. (a registered  investment  adviser).  Mr. Keffer is a
     Trustee and/or officer of various registered investment companies for which
     Forum Administrative  Services,  LLC serves as manager or administrator and
     for which Forum Financial Services,  Inc. serves as manager,  administrator
     and/or  distributor.  His address is Two Portland Square,  Portland,  Maine
     04101.

Costas Azariadis, Trustee (age 53)

     Professor of Economics,  University of California,  Los Angeles, since July
     1992.  Prior  thereto,  Dr.  Azariadis  was  Professor  of Economics at the
     University  of  Pennsylvania.  His  address  is  Department  of  Economics,
     University of California,  Los Angeles,  405 Hilgard  Avenue,  Los Angeles,
     California 90024.

James C. Cheng, Trustee (age 54)

     President  of  Technology  Marketing  Associates  (a  marketing  consulting
     company) since September 1991.  Prior thereto,  Mr. Cheng was President and
     Chief  Executive  Officer of Network  Dynamics,  Incorporated  (a  software
     development   company).   His  address  is  27  Temple   Street,   Belmont,
     Massachusetts 02178.

J. Michael Parish, Trustee (age 53)

     Partner at the law firm of Reid and Priest, LLP, since 1995. Prior thereto,
     he was a partner at the law firm of Winthrop  Stimson Putnam & Roberts from
     1989 to 1995 and was a partner at LeBoeuf, Lamb, Leiby & MacRae, a law firm
     of which he was a member from 1974 to 1989.  His address is 40 Wall Street,
     New York, New York 10005.

Mark D. Kaplan, Vice President, Assistant Treasurer and Assistant Secretary (age
42)

     Managing Director at Forum Financial  Services,  Inc. since September 1995.
     Prior thereto, Mr. Kaplan was Managing Director and Director of Research at
     H.M.  Payson & Co. His  address is Two  Portland  Square,  Portland,  Maine
     04101.

                                       22
<PAGE>

David I. Goldstein, Secretary (age 36)

     Counsel, Forum Financial Services,  Inc., with which he has been associated
     since 1991.  Prior thereto,  Mr. Goldstein was associated with the law firm
     of  Kirkpatrick & Lockhart.  Mr.  Goldstein is also  Secretary or Assistant
     Secretary  of  various  registered  investment  companies  for which  Forum
     Administrative  Services,  LLC or Forum Financial Services,  Inc. serves as
     manager,  administrator  and/or  distributor.  His address is Two  Portland
     Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

Max Berueffy, Assistant Secretary (age 46)

     Counsel, Forum Financial Services,  Inc., with which he has been associated
     since  1994.  Prior  thereto,  Mr.  Berueffy  was on the  staff of the U.S.
     Securities and Exchange  Commission for seven years, first in the appellate
     branch  of  the  Office  of the  General  Counsel,  then  as a  counsel  to
     Commissioner  Grundfest  and  finally  as a senior  special  counsel in the
     Division  of  Investment  Management.  Mr.  Berueffy is also  Secretary  or
     Assistant  Secretary of various registered  investment  companies for which
     Forum Administrative Services, LLC or Forum Financial Services, Inc. serves
     as manager,  administrator and/or distributor.  His address is Two Portland
     Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

Cheryl O. Tumlin, Assistant Secretary (age 31)

     Assistant Counsel, Forum Financial Services,  Inc., with which she has been
     associated since July 1996.  Prior thereto,  Ms. Tumlin was on the staff of
     the U.S.  Securities and Exchange Commission as an attorney in the Division
     of Market Regulation and prior thereto Ms. Tumlin was an associate with the
     law firm of Robinson  Silverman  Pearce  Aronsohn & Berman in New York, New
     York.  Ms.  Tumlin  is  also  Assistant  Secretary  of  various  registered
     investment companies for which Forum Administrative  Services, LLC or Forum
     Financial   Services,   Inc.  serves  as  manager,   administrator   and/or
     distributor. Her address is Two Portland Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

TRUSTEE COMPENSATION.  Each Trustee of the Trust (other than John Y. Keffer, who
is an  interested  person of the Trust) is paid  $1,000  for each Board  meeting
attended (whether in person or by electronic  communication)  and is paid $1,000
for each committee  meeting attended on a date when a Board meeting is not held.
As of March 31,  1997,  in addition to $1,000 for each Board  meeting  attended,
each Trustee  receives $100 per active  portfolio of the Trust.  To the extent a
meeting relates to only certain  portfolios of the Trust,  Trustees are paid the
$100 fee only with respect to those portfolios. Trustees are also reimbursed for
travel and related  expenses  incurred in  attending  meetings of the Board.  No
officer of the Trust is compensated by the Trust.

The following  table provides the aggregate  compensation  paid to each Trustee.
The Trust has not  adopted  any form of  retirement  plan  covering  Trustees or
officers. Information is presented for the fiscal year ended March 31, 1997.
<TABLE>
           <S>                          <C>                 <C>              <C>             <C>
                                                           ACCRUED           ANNUAL
                                        AGGREGATE          PENSION        BENEFITS UPON       TOTAL
         TRUSTEE                      COMPENSATION        BENEFITS         RETIREMENT      COMPENSATION
         -------                      ------------        --------         ----------      ------------
         Mr. Keffer                       None              None              None             None
         Mr. Azariadis                   $4,000             None              None            $4,000
         Mr. Cheng                       $4,000             None              None            $4,000
         Mr. Parish                      $4,000             None              None            $4,000
</TABLE>


ADVISER

Pursuant  to an  Advisory  Agreement  with the Trust (the  "Investment  Advisory
Agreement"), the Funds' investment adviser, Forum Advisors, Inc. (the "Adviser")
furnishes at its own expense all services, facilities and personnel necessary in
connection  with  managing  each  Fund's  investments  and  effecting  portfolio
transactions for the


                                       23
<PAGE>

respective Fund. The Investment  Advisory Agreement provides for an initial term
of two  years  from  its  effective  date  with  respect  to a Fund  and for its
continuance in effect for successive  twelve-month periods thereafter,  provided
the agreement is specifically approved at least annually by the Board or by vote
of the  shareholders  of the  Fund,  and in  either  case by a  majority  of the
directors who are not parties to the Investment Advisory Agreement or interested
persons of any such party.

The Investment  Advisory  Agreement is terminable  without  penalty by the Trust
with respect to the Fund on 60 days' written  notice when  authorized  either by
vote of its  shareholders  or by a vote of a majority  of the  Board,  or by the
Adviser  on not more than 60 days' nor less than 30 days'  written  notice,  and
will  automatically  terminate in the event of its  assignment.  The  Investment
Advisory Agreement also provides that, with respect to a Fund, the Adviser shall
not be liable  for any error of  judgment  or  mistake  of law or for any act or
omission  in the  performance  of its  duties to the Fund,  except  for  willful
misfeasance,  bad faith or gross  negligence in the performance of the Adviser's
duties or by reason of reckless  disregard of its  obligations  and duties under
the Investment  Advisory  Agreement.  The Investment Advisory Agreement provides
that the Adviser may render services to others.

For its services under the Investment Advisory  Agreement,  the Advisor receives
with respect to each Fund a fee at an annual rate of 0.40% of the Fund's average
daily net assets.  Fees payable under the  Investment  Advisory  Agreement  with
respect to the each Fund are set forth in the following tables:
<TABLE>
<S>                           <C>                         <C>                        <C>
INVESTORS BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                     GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                     ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $100,163                    $0                          $100,163
1996                         $107,061                    $48,250                     $58,811
1995                         $100,098                    $9,407                      $90,691

TAXSAVER BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                     GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                     ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $70,634                     $0                          $70,634
1996                         $69,544                     $0                          $69,544
1995                         $65,238                     $59,238                     $6,000

MAINE MUNICIPAL BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                    GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                    ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $101,549                    $0                          $101,549
1996                         $105,104                    $0                          105,104
1995                         $105,063                    $91,930                     $13,133

NEW HAMPSHIRE BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                    GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                    ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $31,774                     $0                          $31,774
1996                         $23,870                     $0                          $23,870
1995                         $17,826                     $17,826                     $0
</TABLE>

                                       24
<PAGE>

In addition to receiving  its advisory fee from the Funds,  the Adviser may also
act and be  compensated  as  investment  manager for its clients with respect to
assets which are invested in the Funds.  In some instances the Adviser may elect
to credit  against any  investment  management fee received from a client who is
also a  shareholder  in the Fund an amount equal to all or a portion of the fees
received  by the  Adviser or any  affiliate  of the  Adviser  from the Fund with
respect to the client's assets invested in the Fund.

The  Adviser  has  agreed to  reimburse  the Trust for  certain  of each  Fund's
operating  expenses  (exclusive  of  interest,   taxes,   brokerage,   fees  and
organization  expenses,  all to the extent  permitted by applicable state law or
regulation) which in any year exceed the limits prescribed by any state in which
a Fund's shares are  qualified for sale.  The Trust may elect not to qualify its
shares  for sale in every  state.  The  manager  and  distributor  believe  that
currently the most restrictive  expense ratio limitation imposed by any state is
2-1/2% of the first $30  million of each Fund's  average  net assets,  2% of the
next $70  million of its average net assets and 1-1/2% of its average net assets
in excess of $100  million.  For the  purpose of this  obligation  to  reimburse
expenses,  the Fund's annual  expenses are estimated and accrued daily,  and any
appropriate  estimated  payments  will be made by the Adviser or the manager and
distributor monthly.

Subject to the above obligations to reimburse the Trust for its excess expenses,
the Trust has confirmed its obligation to pay all its other expenses, including:
interest  charges,  taxes,  brokerage fees and  commissions;  certain  insurance
premiums;  fees, interest charges and expenses of the custodian,  transfer agent
and dividend disbursing agent;  telecommunications expenses; auditing, legal and
compliance expenses;  costs of forming the corporation and maintaining corporate
existence; costs of preparing and printing the Trust's prospectuses,  statements
of additional information, account application forms and shareholder reports and
delivering them to existing and prospective  shareholders;  costs of maintaining
books of original  entry for portfolio and fund  accounting  and other  required
books and  accounts  and of  calculating  the net  asset  value of shares of the
Trust;  costs  of  reproduction,   stationery  and  supplies;   compensation  of
directors,  officers  and  employees  of the Trust and costs of other  personnel
performing  services  for the Trust who are not  officers  of the  Adviser,  the
manager and  distributor  or their  respective  affiliates;  costs of  corporate
meetings;  Securities  and  Exchange  Commission  registration  fees and related
expenses;  expenses incurred pursuant to state securities laws; and fees payable
to the Adviser under the Investment Advisory Agreement.

ADMINISTRATION

Pursuant  to an  Administration  Agreement  approved by the Board of Trustees on
June 19,  1997 (the  "Administration  Agreement"),  FAS  supervises  the overall
management  of  the  Trust  (which  includes,   among  other   responsibilities,
negotiation  of contracts  and fees with,  and  monitoring  of  performance  and
billing of, the transfer  agent and custodian and arranging for  maintenance  of
books and  records of the  Trust) and  provides  the Trust with  general  office
facilities.  The  Administration  Agreement  may be  terminated  by either party
without  penalty on 60 days' written notice and may not be assigned  except upon
written consent by both parties. The Administration Agreement also provides that
FAS shall not be liable for any error of  judgment  or mistake of law or for any
act or omission in the  administration  or management  of the Trust,  except for
willful  misfeasance,  bad faith or gross negligence in the performance of FAS's
duties or by reason of reckless  disregard of its  obligations  and duties under
the   Administration   Agreement.   Prior  to  June  19,  1997,   FFSI  provided
administration  and  distribution  services to the Trust pursuant to a Managment
Agreement (the "Management Agreement")

FAS  provides  persons  satisfactory  to the Board to serve as  officers  of the
Trust.  Those  officers,  as well as certain other employees and Trustees of the
Trust,  may be  directors,  officers  or  employees  of (and  persons  providing
services to the Trust may include) FAS, its affiliates or certain  affiliates of
the Adviser.

DISTRIBUTION

FFSI was  incorporated  under the laws of the State of  Delaware  on February 7,
1986 and  serves  as  distributor  of  shares  of the  Portfolio  pursuant  to a
Distribution   Agreement   between   FFSI  and  the  Trust  (the   "Distribution
Agreement"). The Distribution Agreement provides, with respect to each Fund, for
an initial term of one year from


                                       25
<PAGE>

its effective date and for its continuance in effect for successive twelve-month
periods  thereafter,  provided the agreement is  specifically  approved at least
annually by the Board or by the  shareholders of the Fund, and in either case by
a majority of the Trustees who are not parties to the Distribution  Agreement or
interested persons of any such party.

The Distribution Agreement terminates automatically if it is assigned and may be
terminated  without  penalty  with  respect  to each Fund by vote of the  Fund's
shareholders  or by either party on 60 days' written  notice.  The  Distribution
Agreement  also provides that FFSI shall not be liable for any error of judgment
or mistake of law or for any act or omission in the performances of its services
to the Trust, except for willful  misfeasance,  bad faith or gross negligence in
the  performance  of FFSI's  duties or by reason of  reckless  disregard  of its
obligations  and  duties  under  the  Distribution  Agreement.  Pursuant  to the
Distribution  Agreement,  FFSI  receives,  and may reallow to certain  financial
institutions, the sales charge paid by the purchasers of each Fund's shares. The
aggregate  sales charges  payable to FFSI with respect to each Fund are outlined
in the following tables:
<TABLE>
<S>                                <C>                         <C>                        <C>
INVESTORS BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED                  AGGREGATE
MARCH 31                         SALES CHARGE                AMOUNT RETAINED             AMOUNT REALLOWED
- --------                         ------------                ---------------             ----------------
           1997                        $1,951                       $274                       $1,677
           1996                        $6,252                       $829                       $5,423
           1995                        $1,706                       $243                       $1,463

TAXSAVER BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED                 AGGREGATE
MARCH 31                         SALES CHARGE                AMOUNT RETAINED             AMOUNT REALLOWED
- --------                         ------------                ---------------             ----------------
           1997                         $16                          $2                          $14
           1996                       $13,336                      $1,317                      $12,019
           1995                        $7,701                      $1,012                      $6,689

MAINE MUNICIPAL BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED                  AGGREGATE
MARCH 31                          SALES CHARGE                AMOUNT RETAINED             AMOUNT REALLOWED
- --------                          ------------                ---------------             ----------------
           1997                       $117,032                    $10,264                     $106,768
           1996                       $106,683                    $13,941                      $92,742
           1995                       $133,896                    $17,656                     $116,239

NEW HAMPSHIRE BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED                 AGGREGATE
MARCH 31                         SALES CHARGE                AMOUNT RETAINED             AMOUNT REALLOWED
- --------                         ------------                ---------------             ----------------
           1997                       $54,094                      $4,557                      $49,537
           1996                       $24,865                      $3,309                      $21,556
           1995                       $33,166                      $4,429                      $28,737
</TABLE>

For its services under the Management  Agreement,  FFSI received with respect to
each Fund a fee at an annual  rate of 0.30% of the  average  daily net assets of
each Fund. Fees payable under the Management Agreement with respect to each Fund
are outlined in the following tables:

                                       26
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                  <C>                         <C>                           <C>
INVESTORS BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                             GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                    NET FEE
- --------                             ---------                   ----------                    -------
           1997                       $75,122                     $75,122                        $0
           1996                       $80,296                     $80,296                        $0
           1995                       $75,074                     $75,074                        $0

TAXSAVER BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                             GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                    NET FEE
- --------                             ---------                   ----------                    -------
           1997                       $52,975                     $52,975                        $0
           1996                       $52,158                     $52,158                        $0
           1995                       $48,928                     $48,928                        $0

MAINE MUNICIPAL BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                             GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                    NET FEE
- --------                             ---------                   ----------                    -------
           1997                       $76,162                     $76,162                        $0
           1996                       $78,828                     $78,828                        $0
           1995                       $78,797                     $78,797                        $0

NEW HAMPSHIRE BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                             GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                    NET FEE
- --------                             ---------                   ----------                    -------
           1997                       $23,831                     $23,831                        $0
           1996                       $17,902                     $17,902                        $0
           1995                       $13,369                     $13,369                        $0
</TABLE>

TRANSFER AGENT

Forum Financial Corp. (the "Transfer Agent") acts as transfer agent of the Trust
pursuant to a transfer agency agreement (the "Transfer Agency  Agreement").  The
Transfer Agency  Agreement  provides,  with respect to each Fund, for an initial
term of two years from its effective date and for its  continuance in effect for
successive  twelve-month  periods  thereafter,  provided  that the  agreement is
specifically approved at least annually by the Board or, with respect to a Fund,
by a vote of the  shareholders of that Fund, and in either case by a majority of
the directors who are not parties to the Transfer Agency Agreement or interested
persons of any such party at a meeting  called for the  purpose of voting on the
Transfer Agency Agreement.

Among the responsibilities of the Transfer Agent as agent for the Trust are: (1)
answering customer inquiries regarding account status and history, the manner in
which  purchases  and  redemptions  of shares of the Funds may be  effected  and
certain other matters  pertaining to the Funds;  (2) assisting  shareholders  in
initiating  and changing  account  designations  and  addresses;  (3)  providing
necessary  personnel  and  facilities  to  establish  and  maintain  shareholder
accounts  and  records,   assisting  in  processing   purchase  and   redemption
transactions  and receiving wired funds; (4) transmitting and receiving funds in
connection  with  customer  orders to purchase or redeem  shares;  (5) verifying
shareholder  signatures  in  connection  with  changes  in the  registration  of
shareholder  accounts;  (6) furnishing  periodic statements and confirmations of
purchases  and  redemptions;   (7)  arranging  for  the  transmission  


                                       27
<PAGE>

of proxy statements,  annual reports, prospectuses and other communications from
the Trust to its  shareholders;  (8) arranging for the receipt,  tabulation  and
transmission to the Trust of proxies  executed by  shareholders  with respect to
meetings of  shareholders  of the Trust;  and (9)  providing  such other related
services as the Trust or a shareholder may reasonably request.

The Transfer Agent or any  sub-transfer  agent or processing  agent may also act
and receive  compensation as custodian,  investment manager,  nominee,  agent or
fiduciary  for its customers or clients who are  shareholders  of the Funds with
respect to assets invested in the Funds.  The Transfer Agent or any sub-transfer
agent or other  processing agent may elect to credit against the fees payable to
it by its clients or  customers  all or a portion of any fee  received  from the
Trust or from the Transfer  Agent with  respect to assets of those  customers or
clients  invested in the Fund. The Transfer  Agent,  the Manager or sub-transfer
agents or  processing  agents  retained by the Transfer  Agent may be Processing
Organizations  (as defined in the  Prospectus)  and, in the case of sub-transfer
agents or  processing  agents,  may also be  affiliated  persons of the Transfer
Agent or the Manager.

For its  services  under the  Transfer  Agency  Agreement,  the  Transfer  Agent
receives, with respect to each Fund: (i) a fee at an annual rate of 0.25 percent
of the  average  daily net assets of each Fund (ii) a fee of  $12,000  per year;
such amounts to be computed  and paid monthly in arrears by the Fund;  and (iii)
Annual Shareholder Account Fees of $18.00 per shareholder account;  such fees to
be computed as of the last  business day of the prior month.  Fees payable under
the  Transfer  Agency  Agreement  with respect to each Fund are set forth in the
following tables:
<TABLE>
<S>                           <C>                         <C>                        <C>
INVESTORS BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                    GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE

1997                         $76,562                     $58,271                     $18,291
1996                         $80,320                     $60,882                     $19,438
1995                         $62,562                     $49,813                     $12,749

TAXSAVER BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                    GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE

1997                         $57,010                     $40,248                     $16,762
1996                         $56,344                     $38,888                     $17,456
1995                         $40,794                     $28,091                     $12,703

MAINE MUNICIPAL BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                    GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE

1997                         $82,456                     $39,581                     $42,875
1996                         $84,962                     $41,754                     $43,208
1995                         $65,664                     $49,488                     $16,176

                                       28
<PAGE>

NEW HAMPSHIRE BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                    GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                    NET FEE
- --------                    ---------                   ----------                    --------
1997                         $33,317                      $6,539                      $26,778
1996                         $28,488                       $645                       $27,843
1995                         $11,141                      $8,715                      $2,426
</TABLE>

The Transfer Agent or any  sub-transfer  agent or processing  agent may also act
and receive compensation for acting as custodian,  investment manager,  nominee,
agent or fiduciary for its customers or clients who are shareholders of the Fund
with respect to assets invested in the Fund.

Pursuant to a Fund  Accounting  Agreement,  the Transfer Agent also provides the
Fund with  portfolio  accounting,  including the  calculation  of the Fund's net
asset  value.  For these  services,  the Transfer  Agent  receives an annual fee
ranging from $36,000 to $60,000 depending upon the amount and type of the Fund's
portfolio  transactions  and positions.  Fees payable under the Fund  Accounting
Agreement with respect to fund accounting services for the Fund are set forth in
the following table:
<TABLE>
<S>                           <C>                           <C>                      <C>
INVESTORS BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                     GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                     ---------                   ----------                  --------
1997                         $41,000                     $0                          $41,000
1996                         $38,000                     $0                          $38,000
1995                         $36,000                     $0                          $36,000

TAXSAVER BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                    GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                    ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $36,000                     $0                          $36,000
1996                         $39,000                     $0                          $39,000
1995                         $36,000                     $0                          $36,000

MAINE MUNICIPAL BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                    GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                    ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $48,000                     $0                          $48,000
1996                         $48,000                     $0                          $48,000
1995                         $48,000                     $0                          $48,000

NEW HAMPSHIRE BOND FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                    GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                    ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $37,000                     $0                          $37,000
1996                         $37,000                     $0                          $37,000
1995                         $36,000                     $0                          $36,000
</TABLE>

                                       29
<PAGE>

6. DETERMINATION OF NET ASSET VALUE

The Trust does not  determine  net asset value on the  following  holidays:  New
Year's Day, Dr.  Martin  Luther King,  Jr. Day,  Presidents'  Day,  Good Friday,
Memorial Day, Independence Day, Labor Day, Thanksgiving and Christmas. Purchases
and redemptions are effected at the time of the next  determination of net asset
value following the receipt of any purchase or redemption order.

7. PORTFOLIO TRANSACTIONS

Purchases and sales of portfolio  securities for the Funds usually are principal
transactions.  Portfolio  securities  for  these  Funds are  normally  purchased
directly  from  the  issuer  or from an  underwriter  or  market  maker  for the
securities.  There usually are no brokerage commissions paid for such purchases.
Purchases  from  underwriters  of portfolio  securities  include a commission or
concession  paid by the issuer to the  underwriter,  and purchases  from dealers
serving as market makers include the spread between the bid and asked prices.

The Funds may effect purchases and sales through brokers who charge commissions.
Allocations  of  transactions  to  brokers  and  dealers  and the  frequency  of
transactions  are determined by the Adviser in its best judgment and in a manner
deemed to be in the best  interest of  shareholders  of the Funds rather than by
any  formula.  The primary  consideration  is prompt  execution  of orders in an
effective manner and at the most favorable price available to the Funds. For the
fiscal years ended March 31,  1997,  1996,  and 1995,  the Funds did not pay any
brokerage commissions.

A Fund may not always pay the lowest commission or spread available.  Rather, in
determining the amount of commission,  including certain dealer spreads, paid in
connection with Fund  transactions,  the Adviser takes into account such factors
as size of the order,  difficulty  of  execution,  efficiency  of the  executing
broker's  facilities  (including  the  services  described  below)  and any risk
assumed by the executing broker. The Adviser may also take into account payments
made by  brokers  effecting  transactions  for a Fund (i) to the Fund or (ii) to
other  persons on behalf of the Fund for  services  provided  to it for which it
would be obligated to pay.

In  addition,  the Adviser may give  consideration  to research  and  investment
analysis services furnished by brokers or dealers to the Adviser for its use and
may cause a Fund to pay these brokers a higher amount of commission  than may be
charged by other brokers.  Such research and analysis is of the types  described
in Section 28(e)(3) of the Securities  Exchange Act of 1934, as amended,  and is
designed to augment the Adviser's own internal research and investment  strategy
capabilities.  The Adviser may use the research and analysis in connection  with
services to clients  other than a Fund,  and the Adviser's fee is not reduced by
reason of the Adviser's receipt of the research services.

Investment decisions for each Fund will be made independently from those for any
other account or investment  company that is or may in the future become managed
by the  Adviser or its  affiliates.  If,  however,  a Fund and other  investment
companies or accounts  managed by the Adviser are  contemporaneously  engaged in
the purchase or sale of the same security,  the  transactions may be averaged as
to price and  allocated  equitably to each account.  In some cases,  this policy
might  adversely  affect the price paid or received by a Fund or the size of the
position  obtainable  for the Fund. In addition,  when purchases or sales of the
same security for a Fund and for other investment companies and accounts managed
by the  Adviser  occur  contemporaneously,  the  purchase  or sale orders may be
aggregated  in  order  to  obtain  any  price  advantages   available  to  large
denomination purchases or sales.

No portfolio  transactions are executed with the Adviser,  the Manager or any of
their affiliates.

                                       30
<PAGE>

8. ADDITIONAL PURCHASE AND REDEMPTION INFORMATION

Shares of each Fund are sold on a continuous basis by the distributor.

Set forth below is an example of the method of computing  the offering  price of
each  Fund's  shares.  The example  assumes a purchase  of shares of  beneficial
interest aggregating less than $100,000 subject to the schedule of sales charges
set forth in the  Prospectuses at a price based on the net asset value per share
of each Fund on March 31, 1997.
<TABLE>
<S>                                          <C>               <C>              <C>                 <C>
                                             Investors        TaxSaver            Maine           New Hampshire
                                               Bond             Bond            Municipal             Bond
                                               Fund             Fund            Bond Fund             Fund
                                        --------------------------------------------------------------------------

Net Asset Value Per Share                    $ 10.19          $ 10.49             10.73               10.31

Sales Charge, 3.75% of offering
price (3.90% of net asset value
per share)                                   $  0.40          $  0.41              N/A                 N/A

Sales Charge, 2.50% of offering
price (2.56% of net asset value
per share)                                      N/A              N/A            $  0.27             $  0.26

Offering to Public                           $ 10.59          $ 10.90            $11.00              $10.57
</TABLE>

In addition to the situations  described in the Prospectus  under "Purchases and
Redemptions of Shares," the Trust may redeem shares involuntarily,  from time to
time, to reimburse a portfolio  for any loss  sustained by reason of the failure
of a shareholder to make full payment for shares purchased by the shareholder or
to collect any charge  relating to  transactions  effected  for the benefit of a
shareholder  which  is  applicable  to the  Fund's  shares  as  provided  in the
Prospectus.

The Trust has filed an election  with the  Securities  and  Exchange  Commission
pursuant to which a Fund will only effect a redemption  in portfolio  securities
if a shareholder  is redeeming  more than $250,000 or 1% of the Fund's total net
assets, whichever is less, during any 90-day period.

The Funds may wire proceeds of  redemptions  to  shareholders  that have elected
wire redemption  privileges only if the wired amount is greater than $5,000.  In
addition, the Funds will only wire redemption proceeds to financial institutions
located in the United States.

By  use  of  telephone  redemption  and  exchange  privileges,  the  shareholder
authorizes  the  Transfer  Agent  to act  upon  the  instruction  of any  person
representing himself either to be, or to have the authority to act on behalf of,
the investor and  believed by the Transfer  Agent to be genuine.  The records of
the Transfer  Agent of such  instructions  are binding.  Proceeds of an exchange
transaction may be invested in another  Participating Fund (as defined below) in
the name of the shareholder.

EXCHANGE PRIVILEGE

The  exchange  privilege  permits  shareholders  of the Funds to exchange  their
shares  for  shares of any other  fund of the Trust or shares of  certain  other
portfolios  of  investment  companies  which  retain  FAS or its  affiliates  as
investment  adviser or distributor and which participate in the Trust's exchange
privilege  program  ("Participating  Fund").  For Federal  income tax  purposes,
exchange  transactions  are treated as sales on which a purchaser will realize a
capital gain or loss  depending  on whether the value of the shares  redeemed is
more or less than his basis in such shares at the time of the transaction.

                                       31
<PAGE>

Exchange transactions will be made on the basis of relative net asset values per
share at the time of the exchange  transaction plus any sales charge  applicable
to the  Participating  Fund  whose  shares  are  being  acquired.  Shares of any
Participating Fund may be redeemed and the proceeds used to purchase,  without a
sales charge,  shares of any other Participating Fund that are offered without a
sales charge. Shares of any Participating Fund purchased with a sales charge may
be redeemed and the proceeds used to purchase, without a sales charge, shares of
any other  Participating  Fund  otherwise  sold with a lesser or the same  sales
charge. If the Participating Fund purchased in the exchange  transaction imposes
a higher sales charge than was paid  originally  on the  exchanged  shares,  the
shareholder  will  be  responsible  for the  difference  between  the two  sales
charges. Shares acquired through the reinvestment of dividends and distributions
are deemed to have been  acquired with a sales charge rate equal to that paid on
the shares on which the dividend or distribution was paid.

The terms of the exchange privilege are subject to change, and the privilege may
be  terminated  by any of the  Participating  Funds or the  Trust.  However  the
privilege  will not be  terminated,  and no material  change that  restricts the
availability  of the  privilege to  shareholders  will be  implemented,  without
reasonable advance notice to shareholders.

INDIVIDUAL RETIREMENT CUSTODIAL ACCOUNT

Investors  Bond  Fund and  Investors  High  Grade  Bond  Fund  offer  individual
retirement plans (the "IRA") for individuals who wish to use shares of the Funds
as  a  medium  for  funding  individual  retirement  savings.   Under  the  IRA,
distributions  of net investment  income and capital gain will be  automatically
reinvested  in the  IRA  established  for the  investor.  The  Fund's  custodian
furnishes custodial services to the IRAs for a service fee. Shareholders wishing
to establish an IRA to invest in the Fund should  contact the Transfer Agent for
further details and information.

9. TAXATION

Qualification as a regulated  investment company under the Internal Revenue Code
of 1986, as amended, does not involve governmental  supervision of management or
investment practices or policies. Investors should consult their own counsel for
a complete  understanding of the requirements the Funds must meet to qualify for
such  treatment.  The  information set forth in the Prospectus and the following
discussion  relate solely to Federal income taxes on dividends and distributions
by a Fund and assume that each Fund qualifies as a regulated investment company.
Investors  should  consult  their own counsel  for  further  details and for the
application of state and local tax laws to the investor's particular situation.

The Funds expect to derive substantially all of their gross income (exclusive of
capital gain) from sources  other than  dividends.  Accordingly,  it is expected
that most of the Funds'  dividends  or  distributions  will not  qualify for the
dividends-received deduction for corporations.

Certain listed options and regulated futures  contracts are considered  "section
1256 contracts" for Federal income tax purposes.  Section 1256 contracts held by
a Fund at the end of each  taxable  year will be "marked to market"  and treated
for Federal income tax purposes as though sold for fair market value on the last
business day of such taxable  year.  Gain or loss  realized by a Fund on section
1256  contracts  generally  will be considered  60% long-term and 40% short-term
capital  gain or loss.  A Fund can elect to exempt its  section  1256  contracts
which are part of a "mixed straddle" from the application of section 1256.

With respect to equity or  over-the-counter  put and call options,  gain or loss
realized by a Fund upon the lapse or sale of such  options held by the Fund will
be either  long-term  or  short-term  capital  gain or loss  depending  upon the
respective Fund's holding period with respect to such option.  However,  gain or
loss  realized upon the lapse or closing out of such options that are written by
a Fund will be treated as short-term capital gain or loss. In general, if a Fund
exercises an option, or if an option that a Fund has written is exercised,  gain
or loss on the option will not be separately recognized but the premium received
or paid will be included in the calculation of gain or loss upon  disposition of
the property underlying the option.

                                       32
<PAGE>

Under current  federal tax law, if a Fund invests in bonds issued with "original
issue  discount",  the Fund  generally  will be required to include in income as
interest each year,  in addition to stated  interest  received on such bonds,  a
portion of the excess of the face  value of the bonds  over their  issue  price,
even  though the Fund does not receive  payment  with  respect to such  discount
during the year. With respect to "market discount bonds" (i.e.,  bonds purchased
by a Fund at a price less than their issue  price plus the portion of  "original
issue  discount"  previously  accrued  thereon),  the Fund may likewise elect to
accrue and  include in income  each year a portion of the market  discount  with
respect to such bonds. As a result, in order to make the distributions necessary
for a Fund not to be subject to federal income or excise taxes,  the Fund may be
required to pay out as an income  distribution  each year an amount greater than
the total amount of cash which the Fund has actually received as interest during
the year.

10. OTHER INFORMATION

CUSTODIAN

Pursuant  to a  Custodian  Agreement,  The First  National  Bank of Boston,  100
Federal  Street,  Boston,  Massachusetts  02106,  acts as the  custodian of each
Fund's  assets.  The  custodian's   responsibilities  include  safeguarding  and
controlling  the Funds' cash and securities,  determining  income and collecting
interest on Fund investments.

COUNSEL

Legal matters in connection  with the issuance of shares of beneficial  interest
of the Trust are passed upon by the law firm of Seward & Kissel,  1200 G Street,
N.W., Washington, D.C. 20005

AUDITORS

Deloitte & Touche LLP, 125 Summer  Street,  Boston,  Massachusetts,  independent
auditors, act as auditors for the Trust.

THE TRUST AND ITS SHARES

The Trust was originally  incorporated in Maryland on March 24, 1980 and assumed
the name of Forum  Funds,  Inc.  on March 16,  1987.  On January 5, 1996,  Forum
Funds,  Inc. was  reorganized  as a Delaware  business  trust.  The Trust has an
unlimited  number of authorized  shares of beneficial  interest.  The Board may,
without  shareholder  approval,  divide the authorized  shares into an unlimited
number of  separate  portfolios  or series  (such as the  Funds)  and may in the
future  divide  portfolios or series into two or more classes of shares (such as
Investor and Institutional Shares). Currently the authorized shares of the Trust
are divided into 15 separate series.

Each  share of each  fund of the  Trust  and  each  class of  shares  has  equal
dividend,  distribution,  liquidation and voting rights,  and fractional  shares
have  those  rights  proportionately,   except  that  expenses  related  to  the
distribution  of the shares of each class (and certain  other  expenses  such as
transfer  agency and  administration  expenses) are borne solely by those shares
and each class votes separately with respect to the provisions of any Rule 12b-1
plan  which  pertain to the class and other  matters  for which  separate  class
voting is appropriate under applicable law.  Generally,  shares will be voted in
the aggregate  without reference to a particular  portfolio or class,  except if
the matter  affects only one  portfolio or class or voting by portfolio or class
is required by law, in which case shares will be voted  separately  by portfolio
or class, as appropriate. Delaware law does not require the Trust to hold annual
meetings of shareholders,  and it is anticipated that shareholder  meetings will
be held only when required by Federal or state law.  Shareholders (and Trustees)
have  available  certain  procedures  for the removal of Trustees.  There are no
conversion or  preemptive  rights in  connection  with shares of the Trust.  All
shares when issued in  accordance  with the terms of the offering  will be fully
paid and nonassessable.  Shares are redeemable at net asset value, at the option
of the  shareholders,  subject to any contingent  deferred sales charge that may
apply.  A shareholder in a portfolio is entitled to the  shareholder's  pro rata
share of all dividends and  distributions  arising from that portfolio's  assets
and, upon  redeeming  shares,  will receive the portion of the  portfolio's  net
assets represented by the redeemed shares.

                                       33
<PAGE>

As of December 31, 1997, the officers and Trustees of the Trust as a group owned
less than 1% of the  outstanding  shares of each Fund. Also as of that date, the
shareholders  listed below owned or owned of record more than 5% of either Fund.
From time to time, certain shareholders may own a large percentage of the shares
of a Fund. Accordingly, those shareholders may be able to greatly affect (if not
determine)  the  outcome  of a  shareholder  vote.  As noted,  certain  of these
shareholders are known to the Trust to hold their shares of record only and have
no beneficial interest, including the right to vote, in the shares.
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                        <C>
INVESTORS BOND FUND

                                                                           PERCENTAGE OF FUND
                                                                           SHARES OWNED
SHAREHOLDERS (OF RECORD)                                                   ------------
- ------------------------
SEI Trust Company
c/o Irwin Union Bank & Trust                                               58.95%
Attn: Mutual Fund Administrator
One Freedom Valley Drive
Oaks, Pennsylvania  19456

Firstrust Company National City Bank Trust Department
227 Main Street                                                            20.04%
Evansville, Indiana  47708

National Financial Services Corp.                                          5.39%
For the Exclusive Benefit of Custodian
PO Box 3908
Church Street Station
New York, NY  10008-3900

TAXSAVER BOND FUND

                                                                           PERCENTAGE OF FUND
                                                                           SHARES OWNED
SHAREHOLDER                                                                ------------
- ------------
SEI Trust Company
c/o Irwin Union Bank & Trust                                               46.73%
Attn: Mutual Fund Administrator
One Freedom Valley Drive
Oaks, Pennsylvania  19456

Leonore Zusman TTEE
Leonore Zusman Living Trust                                                10.71%
6439 Woodacre Ct.
Englewood, OH 45322


Firstrust Company National City Bank Trust Department
227 Main Street
Evansville, Indiana  47708                                                 9.79%%


Lawrence L. Zusman TTEE
Lawrence L. Zusman Living Trust                                            9.60%
6439 Woodacre Ct.
Englewood, OH 45322
</TABLE>

                                       34
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                        <C>
Mitchell Singer
5045 North Main Street
Suite 250                                                                  5.55%
Dayton, OH  45415-3637

MAINE MUNICIPAL BOND FUND

                                                                           PERCENTAGE OF FUND
                                                                           SHARES OWNED
SHAREHOLDER (OF RECORD)                                                    ------------
- -----------------------         
Administrative Data Management Corp.
Attn:  Sue Needell
581 Main Street                                                            40.79%
Woodbridge, NJ  07095-1198

NEW HAMPSHIRE BOND FUND

                                                                           PERCENTAGE OF FUND
                                                                           SHARES OWNED
SHAREHOLDERS (OF RECORD)                                                   ------------
- ------------------------
Independence Trust
Attn: Linda Feliciano                                                      44.22%
200 Bedford Street, 5th Floor
Manchester, NH  03105-0119

Administrative Data Management Corp.
Attn:  Sue Needell
581 Main Street                                                            33.88%
Woodbridge, NJ  07095-1198
</TABLE>

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

The  financial  statements of each Fund for the year ended March 31, 1997 (which
include a statement  of assets and  liabilities,  a statement of  operations,  a
statement  of changes in net assets,  notes to financial  statements,  financial
highlights,  a statement of investments  and the auditors'  report  thereon) are
included in the Annual Report to Shareholders  delivered along with this SAI and
are incorporated herein by reference.

The unaudited  financial  statements  for each Fund for the  semi-annual  period
ended September 30, 1997 (which include a statement of assets and liabilities, a
statement  of  operations,  a  statement  of  changes  in net  assets,  notes to
financial statements,  financial highlights,  a statement of investments and the
auditors'  report  thereon) are included in the Forum Funds  Semi-Annual  Report
delivered along with this SAI and are incorporated herein by reference.



                                       35
<PAGE>

INVESTORS HIGH GRADE BOND FUND
INVESTORS BOND FUND
TAXSAVER BOND FUND
MAINE MUNICIPAL BOND FUND
NEW HAMPSHIRE BOND FUND

APPENDIX A - DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES RATINGS

1.       CORPORATE AND MUNICIPAL BONDS (INCLUDING CONVERTIBLE BONDS)

MOODY'S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC. ("MOODY'S")

Moody's rates  corporate  bond issues,  including  convertible  debt issues,  as
follows:

Bonds which are rated Aaa are judged by Moody's to be of the best quality.  They
carry the smallest  degree of investment  risk and are generally  referred to as
"gilt edge." Interest  payments are protected by a large or by an  exceptionally
stable margin and principal is secure. While the various protective elements are
likely to change,  such changes as can be visualized are most unlikely to impair
the fundamentally strong position of such issues.

Bonds  which are rated Aa are  judged to be of high  quality  by all  standards.
Together  with  the Aaa  group,  they  comprise  what  are  generally  known  as
high-grade  bonds.  They are rated lower than the best bonds because  margins of
protection may not be as large as in Aaa securities or fluctuation of protective
elements  may be of greater  amplitude  or there may be other  elements  present
which make the long term risks appear somewhat larger than in Aaa securities.

Bonds which are rated A possess many favorable investment  attributes and are to
be  considered as upper medium grade  obligations.  Factors  giving  security to
principal and interest are considered adequate but elements may be present which
suggest a susceptibility to impairment some time in the future.

Bonds which are rated Baa are considered as medium grade obligations, i.e., they
are neither highly protected nor poorly secured.  Interest payment and principal
security appear adequate for the present but certain protective  elements may be
lacking or may be  characteristically  unreliable over any great length of time.
Such  bonds  lack  outstanding  investment  characteristics  and  in  fact  have
speculative characteristics as well.

Bonds which are rated Ba are judged to have speculative  elements;  their future
cannot be  considered  as well  assured.  Often the  protection  of interest and
principal  payments may be very moderate and thereby not well safeguarded during
both good and bad times over the future.  Uncertainty of position  characterizes
bonds in this class.

Bonds  which  are  rated  B  generally  lack  characteristics  of the  desirable
investment.  Assurance of interest and principal  payments or of  maintenance of
other terms of the contract over any long period of time may be small.

Bonds which are rated Caa are of poor standing. Such issues may be in default or
there may be present elements of danger with respect to principal or interest.

Bonds which are rated Ca represent  obligations  which are speculative in a high
degree. Such issues are often in default or have other marked shortcomings.

Bonds which are rated C are the lowest  rated class of bonds and issues so rated
can be regarded as having  extremely  poor  prospects of ever attaining any real
investment standing.

Note:  Those  bonds in the Aa, A, Baa,  Ba or B groups  which  Moody's  believes
possess the strongest  investment  attributes are designated by the symbols Aa1,
A1, Baa1, Ba1, and B1.

                                      A-1
<PAGE>

STANDARD AND POOR'S CORPORATION ("S&P")

S&P rates corporate bond issues, including convertible debt issues, as follows:

Bonds  rated  AAA have the  highest  rating  assigned  by S&P.  Capacity  to pay
interest and repay principal is extremely strong.

Bonds rated AA have a very strong  capacity to pay interest and repay  principal
and differ from the highest rated issues only in small degree.

Bonds  rated A have a strong  capacity  to pay  interest  and  repay  principal,
although they are somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in
circumstances   and  economic   conditions  than  debt  rated  in  higher  rated
categories.

Bonds rated BBB are regarded as having an adequate  capacity to pay interest and
repay principal.  Whereas they normally exhibit adequate protection  parameters,
adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are more likely to lead to
weakened  capacity to pay interest and repay principal for debt in this category
than in higher rated categories.

Bonds rated BB, B, CCC, CC and C are  regarded,  on  balance,  as  predominantly
speculative  with  respect to the  issuer's  capacity to pay  interest and repay
principal in  accordance  with the terms of the  obligation.  BB  indicates  the
lowest degree of speculation and C the highest degree of speculation. While such
bonds will likely have some quality and  protective  characteristics,  these are
outweighed by large uncertainties or major risk exposures to adverse conditions.
Bonds  rated  BB  have  less  near-term  vulnerability  to  default  than  other
speculative issues.  However,  they face major ongoing uncertainties or exposure
to adverse  business,  financial,  or  economic  conditions  which could lead to
inadequate capacity to meet timely interest and principal payments.

Bonds rated B have a greater  vulnerability  to default but  currently  have the
capacity to meet interest  payments and principal  payments.  Adverse  business,
financial,  or economic conditions will likely impair capacity or willingness to
pay interest and repay principal.

Bonds rated CCC have currently  identifiable  vulnerability to default,  and are
dependent upon favorable  business,  financial,  and economic conditions to meet
timely  payment of interest and repayment of principal.  In the event of adverse
business,  financial,  or economic  conditions,  they are not likely to have the
capacity to pay interest and repay principal.

Bonds rated C  typically  are  subordinated  to senior debt which as assigned an
actual or implied  CCC debt  rating.  This  rating may also be used to  indicate
imminent default.

The C rating may be used to cover a situation  where a  bankruptcy  petition has
been filed, but debt service  payments are continued.  The rating Cl is reserved
for income bonds on which no interest is being paid.

Bonds are rated D when the issue is in payment default, or the obligor has filed
for  bankruptcy.  The D  rating  category  is used  when  interest  payments  or
principal  payments are not made on the date due, even if the  applicable  grace
period has not expired,  unless S&P believes that such payments will made during
such grace period.

Note:  The ratings  from AA to CCC may be modified by the addition of a plus (+)
or minus (-) sign to show the relative standing within the rating category.

                                      A-2
<PAGE>

FITCH IBCA, INC.. ("FITCH")

Fitch rates  corporate  bond  issues,  including  convertible  debt  issues,  as
follows:

AAA Bonds are  considered  to be  investment  grade  and of the  highest  credit
quality.  The obligor has an  exceptionally  strong  ability to pay interest and
repay  principal,  which is unlikely to be  affected by  reasonably  foreseeable
events.

AA Bonds are considered to be investment  grade and of very high credit quality.
The  obligor's  ability to pay  interest  and repay  principal  is very  strong,
although not quite as strong as bonds rated AAA.  Because bonds rated in the AAA
and AA  categories  are  not  significantly  vulnerable  to  foreseeable  future
developments, shorter-term debt of these issuers is generally rate F-1+.

A Bonds are considered to be investment  grade and of high credit  quality.  The
obligor's  ability to pay  interest  and repay  principal  is  considered  to be
strong, but may be more vulnerable to adverse changes in economic conditions and
circumstances than bonds with higher ratings.

BBB Bonds are  considered  to be  investment  grade and of  satisfactory  credit
quality. The obligor's ability to pay interest and repay principal is considered
to be  adequate.  Adverse  changes in  economic  conditions  and  circumstances,
however,  are more likely to have adverse  impact on these bonds,  and therefore
impair timely payment.  The likelihood that the ratings of these bonds will fall
below investment grade is higher than for bonds with higher ratings.

BB Bonds are considered  speculative.  The obligor's ability to pay interest and
repay principal may be affected over time by adverse economic changes.  However,
business and financial  alternatives  can be  identified  which could assist the
obligor in satisfying its debt service requirements.

B Bonds  are  considered  highly  speculative.  While  bonds in this  class  are
currently meeting debt service requirements, the probability of continued timely
payment of principal  and  interest  reflects the  obligor's  limited  margin of
safety and the need for reasonable business and economic activity throughout the
life of the issue.

CCC Bonds have certain identifiable  characteristics which, if not remedied, may
lead to  default.  The  ability to meet  obligations  requires  an  advantageous
business and economic environment.

CC Bonds  are  minimally  protected.  Default  in  payment  of  interest  and/or
principal seems probable over time.

C Bonds are in imminent default in payment of interest or principal.

DDD, DD, and D Bonds are in default on interest and/or principal payments.  Such
bonds  are  extremely  speculative  and  should  be valued on the basis of their
ultimate  recovery value in liquidation or  reorganization  of the obligor.  DDD
represents the highest  potential for recovery on these bonds,  and D represents
the lowest potential for recovery.

Plus (+) and  minus (-) signs  are used  with a rating  symbol to  indicate  the
relative position of a credit within the rating category.  Plus and minus signs,
however, are not used in the AAA, DDD, DD, or D categories.

2.       PREFERRED STOCK

MOODY'S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC.

Moody's rates preferred stock as follows:

An issue rated aaa is  considered  to be a  top-quality  preferred  stock.  This
rating indicates good asset protection and the least risk of dividend impairment
among preferred stock issues.

                                      A-3
<PAGE>

An issue  rated aa is  considered  a  high-grade  preferred  stock.  This rating
indicates  that  there  is  a  reasonable  assurance  that  earnings  and  asset
protection will remain relatively well maintained in the foreseeable future.

An issue rated a is  considered to be an  upper-medium  grade  preferred  stock.
While  risks  are  judged  to be  somewhat  greater  than  in  the  aaa  and  aa
classification,  earnings and asset protection are, nevertheless, expected to be
maintained at adequate levels.

An issue rated baa is considered to be a medium-grade,  neither highly protected
nor poorly secured. Earnings and asset protection appear adequate at present but
may be questionable over any great length of time.

An issue rated ba is  considered  to have  speculative  elements  and its future
cannot be considered  well assured.  Earnings and asset  protection  may be very
moderate  and not  well  safeguarded  during  adverse  periods.  Uncertainty  of
position characterizes preferred stocks in this class.

An issue which is rated b  generally  lacks the  characteristics  of a desirable
investment. Assurance of dividend payments and maintenance of other terms of the
issue over any long period of time may be small.

An issue  which is rated caa is likely to be in  arrears on  dividend  payments.
This  rating  designation  does not  purport to  indicate  the future  status of
payments.

An issue which is rated ca is  speculative  in a high degree and is likely to be
in arrears on dividends with little likelihood of eventual payment.

An issue which is rated c can be regarded as having  extremely poor prospects of
ever attaining any real investment  standing.  This is the lowest rated class of
preferred or preference stock.

Note:   Moody's  applies  numerical   modifiers  1,  2  and  3  in  each  rating
classification  from aa through b in its  preferred  stock  rating  system.  The
modifier 1 indicates  that the  security  ranks in the higher end of its generic
rating category;  the modifier 2 indicates a mid-range ranking; and the modifier
3  indicates  that the  issuer  ranks in the  lower  end of its  generic  rating
category.

STANDARD & POOR'S CORPORATION

S&P rates preferred stock as follows:

AAA is the highest rating that is assigned by S&P to a preferred stock issue and
indicates an extremely strong capacity to pay the preferred stock obligations.

A preferred  stock issue rated AA also qualifies as a high-quality  fixed income
security.  The  capacity to pay  preferred  stock  obligations  is very  strong,
although not as overwhelming as for issues rated AAA.

An issue  rated A is  backed  by a sound  capacity  to pay the  preferred  stock
obligations,  although it is somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of
changes in circumstances and economic conditions.

An issue  rated BBB is  regarded  as backed by an  adequate  capacity to pay the
preferred stock  obligations.  Whereas it normally exhibits adequate  protection
parameters,  adverse  economic  conditions  or changing  circumstances  are more
likely to lead to a weakened  capacity to make payments for a preferred stock in
this category than for issues in the A category.

Preferred stock rated BB, B, and CCC are regarded,  on balance, as predominantly
speculative  with  respect  to the  issuer's  capacity  to pay  preferred  stock
obligations.  BB indicates the lowest degree of speculation  and CCC the highest
degree of  speculation.  While such issues  will  likely  have some  quality and
protective characteristics, these are outweighed by large uncertainties or major
risk exposures to adverse conditions.

                                      A-4
<PAGE>

The rating CC is reserved for a preferred stock issue in arrears on dividends or
sinking fund payments but that is currently paying.

A preferred stock rated C is a non-paying issue.

A preferred  stock rated D is a  non-paying  issue with the issuer in default on
debt instruments.

To provide more detailed  indications of preferred  stock  quality,  the ratings
from AA to CCC may be modified  by the  addition of a plus (+) or minus (-) sign
to show relative standing within the major rating categories.

3.       SHORT TERM MUNICIPAL LOANS

MOODY'S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC.

MIG-1/VMIG-1.  This  designation  denotes best quality.  There is present strong
protection by established cash flows, superior liquidity support or demonstrated
broadbased access to the market for refinancing.

MIG-2/VMIG-2.  This designation denotes high quality.  Margins of protection are
ample although not so large as in the MIG-1/VMIG-1 group.

MIG 3/VMIG 3. This designation denotes favorable quality.  All security elements
are accounted for but there is lacking the undeniable  strength of the preceding
grades.  Liquidity and cash flow  protection may be narrow and market access for
refinancing is likely to be less well established.

MIG 4/VMIG 4. This designation  denotes adequate  quality.  Protection  commonly
regarded as required of an  investment  security is present  and,  although  not
distinctly or predominantly speculative, there is specific risk.

STANDARD AND POOR'S CORPORATION

SP-1. Very strong or strong capacity to pay principal and interest. Those issues
which are  determined to possess  overwhelming  safety  characteristics  will be
given a plus (+) designation.

SP-2. Satisfactory capacity to pay principal and interest.

SP-3. Speculative capacity to pay principal and interest.

4.       OTHER MUNICIPAL SECURITIES AND COMMERCIAL PAPER

MOODY'S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC.

Moody's two highest ratings for short-term debt, including commercial paper, are
Prime-1 and Prime-2.  Both are judged investment grade, to indicate the relative
repayment ability of rated issuers.

Issuers rated Prime-1 have a superior ability for repayment of senior short-term
debt  obligations.  Prime-1 repayment ability will often be evidenced by many of
the following characteristics:

         --      Leading market positions in well-established industries.
         --      High rates of return on funds employed.
         --      Conservative capitalization structure with moderate reliance on
                 debt and ample asset protection.
         --      Broad margins in earnings coverage of fixed financial charges
                 and high internal cash generation.
         --      Well-established  access  to a range of financial markets  and
                 assured sources of alternate liquidity.

                                      A-5
<PAGE>

Issuers rated  Prime-2 by Moody's have a strong  ability for repayment of senior
short-term  debt  obligations.  This will  normally be  evidenced by many of the
characteristics of issuers rated Prime-1 but to a lesser degree. Earnings trends
and  coverage   ratios,   while  sound,   may  be  more  subject  to  variation.
Capitalization characteristics, while still appropriate, may be more affected by
external conditions. Ample alternate liquidity is maintained.

STANDARD AND POOR'S CORPORATION

S&P's two highest  commercial  paper  ratings are A and B. Issues  assigned an A
rating are regarded as having the greatest  capacity for timely payment.  Issues
in this  category  are  delineated  with the numbers 1, 2 and 3 to indicate  the
relative  degree of  safety.  An A-1  designation  indicates  that the degree of
safety  regarding  timely payment is either  overwhelming or very strong.  Those
issues determined to possess  overwhelming  safety  characteristics  are denoted
with a plus (+) sign designation. The capacity for timely payment on issues with
an A-2 designation is strong.  However,  the relative degree of safety is not as
high as for issues  designated A-1. A-3 issues have a satisfactory  capacity for
timely  payment.  They are,  however,  somewhat  more  vulnerable to the adverse
effects  of  changes  in  circumstances  than  obligations  carrying  the higher
designations.  Issues rated B are  regarded as having only an adequate  capacity
for timely payment. However, such capacity may be damaged by changing conditions
or short-term adversities.

FITCH IBCA, INC..

Fitch's  short-term ratings apply to debt obligations that are payable on demand
or have original maturities of generally up to three years, including commercial
paper, certificates of deposit,  medium-term notes, and municipal and investment
notes.

F-1+. Issues assigned this rating are regarded as having the strongest degree of
assurance for timely payment.

F-1.  Issues  assigned this rating  reflect an assurance of timely  payment only
slightly less in degree than issues rated F-1+.

F-2.  Issues  assigned this rating have a  satisfactory  degree of assurance for
timely payment,  but the margin of safety is not as great as for issues assigned
F-1+ or F-1 rating.

F-3. Issues assigned this rating have characteristics suggesting that the degree
of assurance for timely payment is adequate,  however, near-term adverse changes
could cause these securities to be rated below investment grade.

F-S.  Issues  assigned  this rating have  characteristics  suggesting  a minimal
degree of assurance for timely payment and are  vulnerable to near-term  adverse
changes in financial and economic conditions.

D.   Issues assigned this rating are in actual or imminent payment default.

5.  SHORT-TERM AND LONG-TERM DEBT RATINGS BY THOMSON BANKWATCH

         Thomson  BankWatch  short-term  ratings  assess  the  likelihood  of an
untimely or  incomplete  payment of  principal  or  interest  of  unsubordinated
instruments  having a  maturity  of one year or less  which is  issued by United
States  commercial banks,  thrifts and non-bank banks;  non-United States banks;
and  broker-dealers.  The  following  summarizes  the  ratings  used by  Thomson
BankWatch:

         "TBW-1"  - This  designation  represents  Thomson  BankWatch's  highest
rating  category and indicates a very high degree of likelihood  that  principal
and interest will be paid on a timely basis.

         "TBW-2" - This  designation  indicates  that while the degree of safety
regarding  timely  payment of  principal  and  interest is strong,  the relative
degree of safety is not as high as for issues rated "TBW-1."

                                      A-6
<PAGE>

         "TBW-3" - This  designation  represents  the  lowest  investment  grade
category  and  indicates  that  while the debt is more  susceptible  to  adverse
developments  (both internal and external) than obligations with higher ratings,
capacity to service  principal  and interest in a timely  fashion is  considered
adequate.

         "TBW-4"  - This  designation  indicates  that the debt is  regarded  as
non-investment grade and therefore speculative.

         Thomson BankWatch  assesses the likelihood of an untimely  repayment of
principal or interest  over the term to maturity of long term debt and preferred
stock which are issued by United States commercial  banks,  thrifts and non-bank
banks; non-United States banks; and broker-dealers. The following summarizes the
rating categories used by Thomson BankWatch for long-term debt ratings:

         "AAA" - This designation  represents the highest  category  assigned by
Thomson  BankWatch to  long-term  debt and  indicates  that the ability to repay
principal and interest on a timely basis is extremely high.

         "AA" - This  designation  indicates  a very  strong  ability  to  repay
principal and interest on a timely basis with limited  incremental risk compared
to issues rated in the highest category.

         "A" - This  designation  indicates that the ability to repay  principal
and  interest is strong.  Issues rated "A" could be more  vulnerable  to adverse
developments (both internal and external) than obligations with higher ratings.

         "BBB"  -  This  designation   represents  Thomson   BankWatch's  lowest
investment-grade   category  and  indicates  an  acceptable  capacity  to  repay
principal  and interest.  Issues rated "BBB" are,  however,  more  vulnerable to
adverse  developments  (both internal and external) than obligations with higher
ratings.

         "BB,"  "B,"  "CCC,"  and "CC," - These  designations  are  assigned  by
Thomson  BankWatch  to  non-investment  grade  long-term  debt.  Such issues are
regarded as having  speculative  characteristics  regarding  the  likelihood  of
timely  payment of principal and interest.  "BB"  indicates the lowest degree of
speculation and "CC" the highest degree of speculation.

         "D" - This designation indicates that the long-term debt is in default.

         PLUS (+) OR MINUS (-) - The ratings from "AAA" through "CC" may include
a plus or minus sign  designation  which  indicates  where within the respective
category the issue is placed.


                                      A-7
<PAGE>

INVESTORS HIGH GRADE BOND FUND
INVESTORS BOND FUND
TAXSAVER BOND FUND
MAINE MUNICIPAL BOND FUND
NEW HAMPSHIRE BOND FUND

APPENDIX B - DESCRIPTION OF MUNICIPAL SECURITIES

1.       MUNICIPAL BONDS

Municipal  Bonds  which  meet  longer  term  capital  needs and  generally  have
maturities   of  more  than  one  year  when   issued,   have  three   principal
classifications:

GENERAL  OBLIGATION  BONDS are  issued by such  entities  as  states,  counties,
cities,  towns, and regional  districts.  The proceeds of these  obligations are
used  to  fund a wide  range  of  public  projects,  including  construction  or
improvement of schools,  highways and roads,  and water and sewer  systems.  The
basic security  behind General  Obligation  Bonds is the issuer's  pledge of its
full  faith and  credit  and  taxing  power for the  payment  of  principal  and
interest.  The taxes that can be levied for the  payment of debt  service may be
limited or unlimited as to the rate or amount of special assessments.

REVENUE BONDS in recent years have come to include an increasingly  wide variety
of types of municipal obligations. As with other kinds of municipal obligations,
the issuers of revenue bonds may consist of virtually any form of state or local
governmental  entity,  including  states,  state  agencies,   cities,  counties,
authorities  of  various  kinds,   such  as  public  housing  or   redevelopment
authorities,  and special districts, such as water, sewer or sanitary districts.
Generally,  revenue  bonds are secured by the revenues or net  revenues  derived
from a particular facility, group of facilities, or, in some cases, the proceeds
of a special excise or other specific  revenue source.  Revenue bonds are issued
to finance a wide variety of capital projects including electric, gas, water and
sewer systems;  highways,  bridges,  and tunnels;  port and airport  facilities;
colleges and universities; and hospitals. Many of these bonds provide additional
security in the form of a debt service reserve fund to be used to make principal
and  interest  payments.  Various  forms of credit  enhancement,  such as a bank
letter of credit or municipal  bond  insurance,  may also be employed in revenue
bond  issues.  Housing  authorities  have a wide  range of  security,  including
partially or fully insured  mortgages,  rent  subsidized  and/or  collateralized
mortgages,  and/or the net revenues from housing or other public projects.  Some
authorities  provide further  security in the form of a state's ability (without
obligation) to make up deficiencies in the debt service reserve fund.

In recent  years,  revenue  bonds have been issued in large volumes for projects
that are privately owned and operated as described below.

PRIVATE  ACTIVITY  BONDS are  considered  municipal  bonds if the interest  paid
thereon  is exempt  from  Federal  income  tax and are issued by or on behalf of
public  authorities  to  raise  money  to  finance  various  privately  operated
facilities for business and manufacturing,  housing and health.  These bonds are
also used to finance public  facilities  such as airports,  mass transit systems
and ports.  The payment of the principal and interest on such bonds is dependent
solely on the ability of the facility's  user to meet its financial  obligations
and the pledge,  if any,  of real and  personal  property  as security  for such
payment.

While, at one time, the pertinent  provisions of the Internal  Revenue Code (the
"Code")  permitted  private  activity  bonds  to  bear  tax-exempt  interest  in
connection with virtually any type of commercial or industrial  project (subject
to various  restrictions as to authorized  costs,  size  limitations,  state per
capita volume restrictions, and other matters), the types of qualifying projects
under  the  Code  have  become  increasingly  limited,  particularly  since  the
enactment of the Tax Reform Act of 1986.  Under current  provisions of the Code,
tax-exempt  financing  remains  available,   under  prescribed  conditions,  for
owner-occupied housing, certain privately owned and operated rental multi-family
housing  facilities,  nonprofit  hospital  and nursing  home  projects,  certain
manufacturing or industrial projects,  and solid waste disposal projects,  among
others,  and for the refunding (that is, the tax-exempt  refinancing) of various

                                      B-1
<PAGE>

kinds of other private commercial  projects  originally financed with tax-exempt
bonds.  In future  years,  the types of projects  qualifying  under the Code for
tax-exempt financing are expected to become increasingly limited.

Because of terminology  formerly used in the Code, virtually any form of private
activity bond may still be referred to as an "industrial  development bond," but
more and more frequently  revenue bonds have become classified  according to the
particular  type of facility  being  financed,  such as hospital  revenue bonds,
nursing home revenue bonds,  multifamily  housing revenues bonds,  single family
housing  revenue  bonds,  industrial  development  revenue bonds and solid waste
resource recovery revenue bonds.

Tax-exempt bonds are also categorized according to whether the interest is or is
not  includible  in the  calculation  of  alternative  minimum  taxes imposed on
individuals,  according  to whether the costs of acquiring or carrying the bonds
are or are not deductible in part by banks and other financial institutions, and
according to other criteria relevant for Federal income tax purposes. Due to the
increasing complexity of Code and related requirements governing the issuance of
tax-exempt bonds,  industry practice has uniformly  required,  as a condition to
the issuance of such bonds,  but  particularly  for revenue bonds, an opinion of
nationally  recognized  bond counsel as to the tax-exempt  status of interest on
the bonds.

2.       MUNICIPAL NOTES

Municipal Notes  generally are used to provide for short-term  capital needs and
usually have maturities of one year or less. They include the following:

TAX  ANTICIPATION   NOTES  are  issued  to  finance  working  capital  needs  of
municipalities.  Generally,  they are issued in anticipation of various seasonal
tax revenues,  such as income,  sales,  use and business taxes,  and are payable
from these specific future taxes.

REVENUE  ANTICIPATION  NOTES are issued in expectation of receipt of other types
of  revenues,  such as Federal  revenues  available  under the  Federal  Revenue
Sharing Programs.

BOND ANTICIPATION  NOTES are issued to provide interim financing until long-term
financing can be arranged.  In most cases,  the long-term bonds then provide the
money for the repayment of the Notes.

CONSTRUCTION  LOAN  NOTES  are sold to  provide  construction  financing.  After
successful completion and acceptance,  many projects receive permanent financing
through the Federal Housing  Administration  under the Federal National Mortgage
Association or the Government National Mortgage Association.

TAX-EXEMPT COMMERCIAL PAPER is a short-term obligation with a stated maturity of
365 days or less.  It is issued by  agencies of state and local  governments  to
finance   seasonal   working  capital  needs  or  as  short-term   financing  in
anticipation of longer term financing.

3.       MUNICIPAL LEASES

Municipal Leases,  which may take the form of a lease or an installment purchase
or conditional  sale  contract,  are issued by state and local  governments  and
authorities to acquire a wide variety of equipment and  facilities  such as fire
and sanitation vehicles,  telecommunications equipment and other capital assets.
Municipal  leases  frequently  have special risks not normally  associated  with
general  obligation  or  revenue  bonds.  Leases  and  installment  purchase  or
conditional sale contracts (which normally provide for title to the leased asset
to pass  eventually  to the  government  issuer)  have  evolved  as a means  for
governmental  issuers to acquire  property  and  equipment  without  meeting the
constitutional  and  statutory  requirements  for  the  issuance  of  debt.  The
debt-issuance limitations of many state constitutions and statutes are deemed to
be  inapplicable  because  of the  inclusion  in many  leases  or  contracts  of
"non-appropriation"  clauses that provide  that the  governmental  issuer has no
obligation to make future  payments under the lease or contract  unless money is
appropriated for such purpose by the appropriate legislative body on a yearly or
other periodic basis. To reduce this risk, the Fund will only purchase municipal
leases subject to

                                      B-2
<PAGE>

a non-appropriation clause when the payment of principal and accrued interest is
backed by an unconditional  irrevocable  letter of credit or guarantee of a bank
or other entity that meets the criteria described in the Prospectus.


                                      B-3
<PAGE>




INVESTORS BOND FUND
TAXSAVER BOND FUND

APPENDIX C - HEDGING STRATEGIES

As discussed in the  Prospectus,  the Adviser to each Fund may engage in certain
options  and  futures  strategies  to attempt to hedge a Fund's  portfolio.  The
instruments  in which the Fund may invest  include (i) options on securities and
stock indexes,  (ii) stock index and interest rate futures  contracts  ("futures
contracts"), and (iii) options on futures contracts. Use of these instruments is
subject to regulation by the Securities  and Exchange  Commission  ("SEC"),  the
several options and futures exchanges upon which options and futures are traded,
and the Commodity Futures Trading Commission ("CFTC").

The various hedging and income strategies  referred to herein and in each Fund's
Prospectus are intended to illustrate the type of strategies  that are available
to, and may be used by, the Adviser in managing a Fund's portfolio. Depending on
prevailing market conditions,  use of these strategies may enable the Adviser to
reduce  investment  risks to which a Fund may be subject.  No  assurance  can be
given, however, that any strategies will succeed.

The Funds will not use  leverage  in their  hedging  strategies.  In the case of
transactions  entered  into as a hedge,  a Fund  will hold  securities  or other
options or futures  positions whose values are expected to offset  ("cover") its
obligations  thereunder.  A Fund will not enter  into a  hedging  strategy  that
exposes the Fund to an  obligation to another party unless it owns either (1) an
offsetting ("covered") position or (2) cash, U.S. government securities or other
liquid  assets  with a value  sufficient  at all  times to cover  its  potential
obligations.  Each Fund will comply with guidelines  established by the SEC with
respect to coverage and, if the guidelines so require, will set aside cash, U.S.
government  securities or other liquid  assets in a segregated  account with its
custodian in the prescribed  amount.  Securities,  options or futures  positions
used for cover and assets held in a segregated  account cannot be sold or closed
out while the hedging  strategy is  outstanding,  unless they are replaced  with
similar  assets.  As a result,  there is a possibility  that the use of cover or
segregation  involving  a large  percentage  of a  Fund's  assets  could  impede
portfolio  management or the Fund's ability to meet redemption requests or other
current obligations.

OPTIONS  STRATEGIES.  The Funds may  purchase  put and call  options  written by
others and write (sell) put and call options  covering  specified  securities or
stock  index-related   amounts.  A  put  option  (sometimes  called  a  "standby
commitment")  gives the buyer of such  option,  upon  payment of a premium,  the
right to deliver a specified  amount of a security or  specified  amount of cash
(on  stock-index  options) to the writer of the option on or before a fixed date
at a predetermined  price. A call option  (sometimes  called a "reverse  standby
commitment") gives the purchaser of the option,  upon payment of a premium,  the
right to call upon the writer to  deliver a  specified  amount of a security  or
specified  amount of cash (on stock-index  options) or before a fixed date, at a
predetermined  price. The  predetermined  prices may be higher or lower than the
market value of the underlying currency or security. A Fund may buy or sell both
exchange-traded  and  over-the-counter  ("OTC") options. A Fund will purchase or
write an option  only if that  option is traded  on a  recognized  U.S.  options
exchange  or if the  Adviser  believes  that a liquid  secondary  market for the
option exists. When a Fund purchases an OTC option, it relies on the dealer from
which it has purchased the OTC option to make or take delivery of the securities
or currency  underlying the option.  Failure by the dealer to do so would result
in the loss of the premium  paid by the Fund as well as the loss of the expected
benefit of the  transaction.  OTC options and the  securities  underlying  these
options are currently treated as illiquid securities.

A Fund may purchase call options on equity  securities  that the Adviser intends
to  include  in the  Fund's  portfolio  in  order  to fix the  cost of a  future
purchase.  Call options may also be purchased as a means of  participating in an
anticipated price increase of a security on a more limited risk basis than would
be possible if the security itself were purchased.  In the event of a decline in
the price of the underlying security,  use of this strategy would serve to limit
the potential  loss to the Fund to the option premium paid;  conversely,  if the
market price of the underlying  security  increases above the exercise price and
the Fund either sells or exercises the option,  any profit  eventually  realized
will be  reduced by the  premium  paid.  The Funds may  similarly  purchase  put
options in order to hedge against a decline in market value of  securities  held
in its portfolio.  The put enables a Fund to sell the underlying security at 

                                      C-1
<PAGE>

the  predetermined  exercise  price;  thus the potential for loss to the Fund is
limited to the  option  premium  paid.  If the  market  price of the  underlying
security  is higher  than the  exercise  price of the put,  any  profit the Fund
realizes on the sale of the  security  would be reduced by the premium  paid for
the put option less any amount for which the put may be sold.

A Fund may write covered call options when the Adviser  believes that the market
value of the  underlying  security  will not  rise to a value  greater  than the
exercise  price plus the premium  received.  Call options may also be written to
provide limited protection against a decrease in the market price of a security,
in an amount equal to the call premium received less any transaction  costs. The
Fund may write covered put options only to effect closing transactions.

A Fund may purchase and write put and call options on stock  indices in much the
same manner as the equity and debt security options discussed above, except that
stock index options may serve as a hedge  against  overall  fluctuations  in the
securities  markets  (or market  sectors) or as a means of  participating  in an
anticipated  price  increase  in those  markets.  The  effectiveness  of hedging
techniques  using stock index  options  will depend on the extent to which price
movements  in the stock index  selected  correlate  with price  movements of the
securities which are being hedged.  Stock index options are settled  exclusively
in cash.

SPECIAL  CHARACTERISTICS AND RISKS OF OPTIONS TRADING. The Funds may effectively
terminate their right or obligation  under an option contract by entering into a
closing transaction.  For instance,  if a Fund wished to terminate its potential
obligation to sell securities under a call option it had written,  a call option
of the same series (an  identical  call option)  would be purchased by the Fund.
Closing  transactions  essentially  permit the Funds to realize profits or limit
losses on its  options  positions  prior to the  exercise or  expiration  of the
option. In addition:

(1) The  successful  use of  options  as a  hedging  strategy  depends  upon the
Adviser's  ability  to  forecast  the  direction  of price  fluctuations  in the
underlying  securities  markets,  or  in  the  case  of a  stock  index  option,
fluctuations in the market sector represented by the index.

(2) Options  normally have expiration  dates of up to nine months.  Options that
expire  unexercised  have no  value.  Unless an  option  purchased  by a Fund is
exercised  or unless a closing  transaction  is  effected  with  respect to that
position, a loss will be realized in the amount of the premium paid.

(3) A  position  in an  exchange  listed  option  may be  closed  out only on an
exchange which  provides a market for identical  options.  Most exchange  listed
options  relate to equity  securities.  Exchange  markets  for  options  on debt
securities  are  relatively  new and the  ability  to  establish  and  close out
positions on the exchanges is subject to the  maintenance of a liquid  secondary
market.  Closing  transactions may be effected with respect to options traded in
the over-the-counter  markets (currently the primary markets for options on debt
securities)  only by  negotiating  directly  with the other  party to the option
contract or in a secondary market for the option if such market exists. There is
no assurance that a liquid secondary market will exist for any particular option
at any specific time. If it is not possible to effect a closing  transaction,  a
Fund would have to exercise  the option  which it  purchased in order to realize
any profit.  The inability to effect a closing  transaction on an option written
by a Fund may result in material losses to that Fund.

(4) The  Funds'  activities  in the  options  markets  may  result  in a  higher
portfolio turnover rate and additional brokerage costs.

FUTURES  STRATEGIES.  Several  interest  rate futures  contracts  currently  are
traded;  these include  various futures  contracts on Treasury bonds,  notes and
bills on the Chicago  Board of Trade as well as a 30 Interest Rate contract also
traded on the Chicago  Board of Trade.  Futures  contracts  on a municipal  bond
index are traded on the  Chicago  Board of Trade.  This index  assigns  relative
values,  which  fluctuate in accordance with current market  conditions,  to the
municipal  bonds  comprising  the index.  Options  on  various of these  futures
contracts are also traded.

A futures contract is a bilateral  agreement wherein one party agrees to accept,
and the other party agrees to make, delivery of cash or securities as called for
in the contract at a specified  future date and at a specified  price. For stock

                                      C-2
<PAGE>

index futures  contracts,  delivery is of an amount of cash equal to a specified
dollar amount times the difference  between the stock index value at the time of
the contract and the close of trading of the contract. For interest rate futures
contracts, delivery is of the underlying debt securities.

A Fund may use interest rate futures  contracts and options thereon to hedge its
portfolio  against  changes in the general level of interest  rates.  A Fund may
purchase an interest  rate  futures  contract  when it intends to purchase  debt
securities but has not yet done so. This strategy may minimize the effect of all
or part of an increase in the market price of the debt  security  which the Fund
intended to purchase in the  future.  A Fund may sell an interest  rate  futures
contract in order to continue to receive the income from a debt security,  while
endeavoring to avoid part or all of the decline in market value of that security
which would accompany an increase in interest rates.

A Fund may purchase a call option on an interest rate futures  contract to hedge
against a market advance in debt securities which the Fund planned to acquire at
a future  date.  The  purchase  of a call  option on an  interest  rate  futures
contracts is analogous  to the purchase of a call option on an  individual  debt
security  which can be used as a  temporary  substitute  for a  position  in the
security  itself.  A Fund may also write  covered call options on interest  rate
futures  contracts  as a partial  hedge  against a decline  in the price of debt
securities held in the Fund's portfolio or purchase put options on interest rate
futures  contracts  in order to hedge  against  a  decline  in the value of debt
securities held in the Fund's portfolio.

SPECIAL  CHARACTERISTICS  AND RISKS OF FUTURES AND RELATED OPTIONS TRADING.  The
following relate to each Fund's use of futures  contracts and options on futures
contracts  and, to the extent in the future they were to be  permitted,  foreign
currency  and other  options  traded on a  commodities  exchange  (collectively,
"futures contracts and related options").

No price is paid upon entering into futures  contracts.  Instead,  upon entering
into a futures contract,  a Fund would be required to deposit with its custodian
in a segregated  account in the name of the futures  broker an amount of cash or
U.S. government  securities generally equal to 5% or less of the contract value.
This amount is known as "initial margin." Subsequent payments, called "variation
margin," to and from the broker,  would be made on a daily basis as the value of
the futures  position  varies,  a process known as "marking to the market." When
writing a call option on a futures contract,  variation margin must be deposited
in accordance  with  applicable  exchange  rules.  The initial margin in futures
transactions is in the nature of a performance bond or good-faith deposit on the
contract that is returned to the Fund upon termination of the contract, assuming
all contractual obligations have been satisfied.

Holders and writers of futures  and  related  options can enter into  offsetting
closing transactions,  similar to closing transactions on options, by selling or
purchasing,  respectively,  a futures  contract or related  option with the same
terms as the position  held or written.  Positions in futures  contracts  may be
closed  only on an  exchange  providing  a  secondary  market  for  the  futures
contracts.

Under certain circumstances, futures exchanges may establish daily limits in the
amount that the price of a futures contract or related option may vary either up
or down from the previous day's settlement  price. Once the daily limit has been
reached  in a  particular  contract,  no trades  may be made that day at a price
beyond that limit.  Futures or options  contract  prices could move to the daily
limit for several consecutive trading days with little or no trading and thereby
prevent prompt  liquidation of positions.  In such event, it may not be possible
for a Fund to close a position,  and in the event of adverse price movements,  a
Fund would have to make daily cash payments of variation  margin  (except in the
case of purchased options). In addition:

(1)  Successful  use by a Fund of futures  contracts  and related  options  will
depend  upon the  Adviser's  ability  to  predict  accurately  movements  in the
direction of the overall  securities  and interest rate markets,  which requires
different  skills  and  techniques  than  predicting  changes  in the  prices of
individual  securities.  Moreover,  futures  contracts relate not to the current
level of the underlying  instrument but to the anticipated  levels at some point
in the future;  thus, for example,  trading of index futures may not reflect the
trading of the  securities  which are used to  formulate an index or even actual
fluctuations in the relevant index itself.

                                      C-3
<PAGE>

(2) The price of futures contracts may not correlate  perfectly with movement in
the price of the  hedged  securities  due to price  distortions  in the  futures
market.  There may be several  reasons  unrelated to the value of the underlying
securities  which cause this situation to occur. As a result, a correct forecast
of general market trends may still not result in successful  hedging through the
use of futures  contracts  over the short term.  Activities  of large traders in
both the futures and securities markets involving arbitrage and other investment
strategies may result in temporary price distortions.

(3)  Although  the Funds intend to purchase or sell futures only on exchanges or
boards of trade where there appears to be an active secondary  market,  there is
no  assurance  that a liquid  secondary  market  will  exist for any  particular
contract at any particular  time. In such event, it may not be possible to close
a futures position, and in the event of adverse price movements, the Funds would
continue to be required to make daily cash payments of variation margin.

(4) Like other  options,  options on futures  contracts have a limited life. The
Funds  will not trade  options  on futures  contracts  unless and until,  in the
Adviser's opinion,  the market for such options has developed  sufficiently that
the  risks  in  connection  with  options  are not  greater  than  the  risks in
connection with futures transactions.

(5) Purchasers of options on futures contracts pay a premium in cash at the time
of  purchase.  This  amount  and the  transaction  costs is all that is at risk.
Sellers of options on futures  contracts,  however,  must post an initial margin
and are subject to  additional  margin calls which could be  substantial  in the
event of adverse price movements.

(6) Each  Fund's  activities  in the  futures  markets  may  result  in a higher
portfolio  turnover rate and additional  transaction  costs in the form of added
brokerage commissions.


                                      C-4
<PAGE>

MAINE MUNICIPAL BOND FUND

APPENDIX D - HEDGING STRATEGIES

1.       BOND INDEX FUTURES

Futures  contracts  on a municipal  bond index (the  "Index")  are traded on the
Chicago  Board of Trade.  Maine  Municipal  Bond  Fund may seek to hedge  itself
against changes in interest rates by purchasing and selling futures contracts on
the Index or any  municipal  bond index  hereafter  approved  for trading by the
Commodity Futures Trading Commission.  The Index assigns numerical values to the
municipal securities comprising the Index and, based on those values, fluctuates
in accordance with market movements of the municipal bonds comprising the Index.
The  purchaser  or seller of a futures  contract on the Index  agrees to take or
make delivery of an amount of cash equal to the  difference  between a specified
dollar  multiple  of the  value  of the  Index  on the  expiration  date  of the
contract,  "current  contract  value," and the price at which the  contract  was
originally purchased or sold.
No physical delivery of the municipal bonds underlying the Index is made.

BOND INDEX  FUTURES  CHARACTERISTICS.  Unlike the purchase or sale of a specific
security by the Fund, no price is paid or received by the Fund upon the purchase
or sale of an index futures  contract.  Initially,  the Fund will be required to
deposit  with the broker  through  which such  transaction  is  effected or in a
segregated  account with the Fund's custodian an amount of cash or U.S. Treasury
bills equal to a specified  dollar  amount per contract as of the date  thereof.
This amount is known as initial margin.  The nature of initial margin in futures
transactions  is different from that of margin in security  transactions in that
futures  contract  margin  does not involve  the  borrowing  of funds to finance
transactions.  Rather, the initial margin is in the nature of a performance bond
or good  faith  deposit  on the  contract  which is  returned  to the Fund  upon
termination of the futures contract,  assuming all contractual  obligations have
been satisfied.  Subsequent  payments,  called variation margin, to and from the
broker  will be made on a daily  basis  as the  price  of the  underlying  index
fluctuates,  a process  known as "marking to the market." For example,  when the
Fund has  purchased  an index  futures  contract  and the  price of the  futures
contract has risen in response to a rise in the Index,  that  position will have
increased in value and the Fund will receive from the broker a variation  margin
payment  equal  to that  increase  in  value.  Conversely,  where  the  Fund has
purchased an index  futures  contract and the price of the futures  contract has
declined  in response to a decrease  in the Index,  the  position  would be less
valuable  and the Fund would be required to make a variation  margin  payment to
the broker. At any time prior to expiration of the futures contract, the Adviser
may  elect to close the  position  by taking an  opposite  position  which  will
operate to  terminate  the Fund's  position  in the  futures  contract.  A final
determination of variation  margin is then made,  additional cash is required to
be paid by or released to the Fund, and the Fund realizes a loss or gain.

RISKS OF  TRANSACTIONS  IN INDEX FUTURES.  There are several risks in connection
with the use of index futures by the Fund as a hedging  device.  One risk arises
because of the imperfect correlation between movements in the price of the index
futures and the hedge. The price of the index futures may move more than or less
than the price of the securities being hedged. If the price of the index futures
moves less than the price of the securities  which are the subject of the hedge,
the hedge will not be fully effective but, if the price of the securities  being
hedged  has moved in an  unfavorable  direction,  the Fund  would be in a better
position than if it had not hedged at all. If the price of the securities  being
hedged has moved in a favorable  direction,  this  advantage  will be  partially
offset by the loss on the index  future.  If the price of the future  moves more
than the price of the underlying  securities,  the Fund will experience either a
loss or gain on the future which will not be  completely  offset by movements in
the price of the  securities  which are the subject of the hedge.  To compensate
for the  imperfect  correlation  of movements in the price of  securities  being
hedged and movements in the price of the index futures, the Fund may buy or sell
index futures of a greater  contract  value than the dollar amount of securities
being hedged if the  volatility  over a particular  time period of the prices of
such  securities has been greater than the  volatility  over such time period of
the Index, or if otherwise deemed to be appropriate by the Adviser.  Conversely,
the Fund may buy or sell fewer index futures if the volatility over a particular
time  period  of the  prices  of the  securities  being  hedged is less than the
volatility over such time period of the Index,  or it is otherwise  deemed to be
appropriate by the Adviser.  It is also possible  that,  where the Fund has sold
index futures to hedge its portfolio against a decline in the market, the market
may advance and the value of  securities  held in the Fund may decline.  If this
occurred,  the Fund would lose money on the future and also experience a decline
in the  value of its  portfolio  securities.  However,  over time the value of a
diversified 

                                      D-1
<PAGE>

portfolio should tend to move in the same direction as the Index, although there
may be deviations arising from differences between the composition of the Fund's
portfolios and the securities comprising the Index.

When index  futures are  purchased to hedge  against  possible  increases in the
price of  municipal  bonds  before  the Fund is able to invest its cash (or cash
equivalents) in municipal bonds in an orderly  fashion,  it is possible that the
market  may  decline  instead.  If the Fund  then  determines  not to  invest in
municipal  bonds at that time because of concern as to possible  further  market
decline or for other reasons,  the Fund will realize a loss on the index futures
that is not offset by a reduction in the price of securities purchased.

In addition to the possibility that there may be an imperfect correlation, or no
correlation  at all,  between  movements in the index futures and the portion of
the  portfolio  being  hedged,  the  price of index  futures  may not  correlate
perfectly with movement in the Index due to certain market  distortions.  Rather
than meeting additional margin deposit requirements, investors may close futures
contracts  through  offsetting  transactions  which  could  distort  the  normal
relationship between the Index and the index futures markets. Secondly, from the
point of view of  speculators,  deposit  requirements  in the futures market are
less onerous  than margin  requirements  in the  securities  market.  Therefore,
increased  participation  by  speculators  in the index futures  market may also
cause temporary price distortions. Due to the possibility of price distortion in
the index futures market, and because of the imperfect  correlation  between the
movements in the Index and  movements in the price of index  futures,  a correct
forecast  of  general  market  trends by the  Adviser  may still not result in a
successful hedging transaction over a short time frame.

Positions in futures on the Index may be closed out only on the Chicago Board of
Trade which  provides a secondary  market for such  futures.  Although  the Fund
intends to purchase or sell index  futures  only on exchanges or boards of trade
where there appear to be active secondary markets,  there is no assurance that a
liquid  secondary  market on any  exchange  or board of trade will exist for any
particular  contract or at any  particular  time.  In such event,  it may not be
possible  to close an index  futures  investment  position,  and in the event of
adverse price  movements,  the Fund would  continue to be required to make daily
cash payments of variation margin. However, in the event index futures have been
used to hedge portfolio  securities,  such securities will not be sold until the
futures contract can be terminated.  In such  circumstances,  an increase in the
price of the  securities,  if any, may partially or completely  offset losses on
the index futures.  However,  as described above, there is no guarantee that the
price of the securities  will in fact correlate with the price  movements in the
futures markets and thus provide an offset on index futures.

Successful  use of index  futures by the Fund is also  subject to the  Adviser's
ability to predict  correctly  movements in the direction of the municipal  bond
markets.  For  example,  if the Fund has hedged  against  the  possibility  of a
decline in the municipal bond market and bond prices increase instead,  the Fund
will lose part or all of the  benefit of the  increased  value of the  portfolio
securities  which it has hedged  because it will have  offsetting  losses in its
futures positions. In addition, in such situations, if the Fund has insufficient
cash, it may have to sell portfolio  securities to meet daily  variation  margin
requirements.  Such sales of  securities  may, but will not  necessarily,  be at
increased  prices  which  reflect the rising  market.  The Fund may have to sell
portfolio securities at a time when it may be disadvantageous to do so.

2.       OTHER FUTURES CONTRACTS AND OPTIONS ON FUTURES

The Fund may invest in  certain  other  financial  futures  contracts  ("futures
contracts") and options thereon.  The Fund may sell a futures contract or a call
option thereon or purchase a futures contract or a put option thereon as a hedge
against a decrease  in the value of the Fund's  securities.  A futures  contract
sale creates an obligation by the Fund, as seller,  to deliver the specific type
of  instrument  called for in the  contract  at a  specified  future  time for a
specified price. A futures contract  purchase creates an obligation by the Fund,
as purchaser, to take delivery of the specific type of financial instrument at a
specified  future  time at a specified  price.  The Fund is required to maintain
margin deposits with brokerage firms through which it effects futures  contracts
as described under "Bond Index Futures Characteristics."

Although the terms of futures  contracts  specify actual  delivery or receipt of
securities, in most instances the contracts are closed out before the settlement
date without the making or taking of delivery of the securities.  Closing out of
a futures  contract is effected by entering into an offsetting  purchase or sale
transaction.  An offsetting 

                                      D-2
<PAGE>

transaction  for a futures  contract sale is effected by entering into a futures
contract  purchase  for  the  same  aggregate  amount  of the  specific  type of
financial  instrument  and same delivery  date. If the price in the sale exceeds
the  price  in the  offsetting  purchase,  the  Fund  is  immediately  paid  the
difference  and thus  realizes a gain. If the purchase  price of the  offsetting
transaction  exceeds the sale price, the Fund pays the difference and realizes a
loss.  Similarly,  the closing out of a futures contract purchase is effected by
the Fund entering into a futures  contract  sale. If the  offsetting  sale price
exceeds the purchase price, the Fund realizes a gain, and if the offsetting sale
price is less than the purchase price, the Fund realizes a loss.

Unlike a futures contract, which requires the parties to buy and sell a security
on a set date, an option on a futures contract  entitles its holder to decide on
or before a future  date  whether to enter into such a  contract.  If the holder
decides not to enter into the contract, the premium paid for the option is lost.
Since the value of the  option is fixed at the point of sale,  the holder is not
required  to make daily  payments  of cash to reflect the change in the value of
the  underlying  contract  as would be the case for a  purchaser  or seller of a
futures  contract.  The value of the option does change and is  reflected in the
net asset value of the Fund.

Currently,  futures contracts can be purchased on certain debt securities issued
by  the  U.S.  Treasury,   certificates  of  the  Government  National  Mortgage
Association  and bank  certificates  of deposit.  The Fund may invest in futures
contracts covering these types of financial  instruments as well as in new types
of such contracts that become available in the future.

Financial futures  contracts are traded in an auction  environment on the floors
of several  exchanges  --principally,  the Chicago  Board of Trade,  the Chicago
Mercantile Exchange and the New York Futures Exchange.  Each exchange guarantees
performance  under  contract  provisions  through  a  clearing  corporation,   a
nonprofit  organization  managed  by  the  exchange  membership  which  is  also
responsible for handling daily account of deposit or withdrawals of margin.

Investing in futures  contracts  involves  the risks of imperfect  correlations,
secondary market illiquidity and the Adviser's  incorrect  predictions of market
movements, as described under "Bond Index Futures Characteristics."

Put and call options on financial futures have characteristics  similar to those
of other  options.  For a  further  description  of  options,  see "Put and Call
Options" below.

In addition to the risks  associated  with  investing in options on  securities,
there are particular risks  associated with investing in options on futures.  In
particular,  the ability to  establish  and close out  positions on such options
will be subject to the development and maintenance of a liquid secondary market.
It is not certain that this market will develop.

The Fund may not enter into  futures  contracts  or related  options  thereon if
immediately  thereafter (i) the amount  committed to margin plus the amount paid
for option  premiums  exceeds 5% of the value of the Fund's total assets or (ii)
the sum of the current contract values of open futures  contracts  purchased and
sold by the Fund would  exceed 30% of the value of the Fund's total  assets.  In
instances  involving  the purchase of futures  contracts by the Fund,  an amount
equal to the  market  value  of the  futures  contract  will be  deposited  in a
segregated  account of cash and cash equivalents to  collateralize  the position
and thereby insure that the use of such futures contract is unleveraged.

3.       PUT AND CALL OPTIONS

The Fund may purchase  put and call options  written by others and write put and
call options  covering the types of securities  in which the Fund may invest.  A
put option  (sometimes  called a "standby  commitment")  gives the buyer of such
option, upon payment of a premium,  the right to deliver a specified amount of a
security  to  the  writer  of  the  option  on  or  before  a  fixed  date  at a
predetermined  price.  A  call  option  (sometimes  called  a  "reverse  standby
commitment") gives the purchaser of the option,  upon payment of a premium,  the
right to call upon the writer to deliver a specified  amount of a security on or
before a fixed date, at a  predetermined  price.  The Fund will not purchase any
option if, immediately thereafter, the aggregate cost of all outstanding options
purchased by the Fund would exceed 5% of the value of its total  assets;  a Fund
will not  write any  option  (other  than  options  on  futures 

                                      D-3
<PAGE>

contracts)  if,  immediately  thereafter,  the aggregate  value of its portfolio
securities subject to outstanding options would exceed 30% of its total assets.

When the Fund writes a put option it maintains  in a segregated  account cash or
U.S.  Government  securities  in an amount  adequate to purchase the  underlying
security should the put be exercised. When the Fund writes a call option it must
own at all times during the option period either the underlying securities or an
offsetting  call option on the same  securities.  If a put option written by the
Fund were  exercised,  the Fund would be obligated  to purchase  the  underlying
security  at the  exercise  price.  If a call  option  written  by the Fund were
exercised,  the Fund would be obligated to sell the  underlying  security at the
exercise price.

The risk  involved  in writing a put option is that there could be a decrease in
the market value of the underlying  security  caused by rising interest rates or
other  factors.  If  this  occurred,  the  option  could  be  exercised  and the
underlying  security  would then be sold to the Fund at a higher  price than its
current  market value.  The risk involved in writing a call option is that there
could be an increase in the market value of the  underlying  security  caused by
declining interest rates or other factors. If this occurred, the option could be
exercised and the underlying  security would then be sold by the Fund at a lower
price than its current  market  value.  These risks could be reduced by entering
into a closing  transaction  as  described  below.  The Fund retains the premium
received  from  writing  a put or  call  option  whether  or not the  option  is
exercised.

The Fund may dispose of an option  which it has  purchased  by  entering  into a
"closing  sale  transaction"  with the  writer of the  option.  A  closing  sale
transaction  terminates  the obligation of the writer of the option and does not
result in the ownership of an option.  The Fund realizes a profit or loss from a
closing sale  transaction if the premium  received from the  transaction is more
than or less than the cost of the option.

The Fund may terminate its  obligation to the holder of an option written by the
Fund through a "closing purchase transaction." The Fund may not, however, effect
a closing purchase  transaction with respect to such an option after it has been
notified of the exercise of such option. The Fund realizes a profit or loss from
a closing  purchase  transaction if the cost of the  transaction is more or less
than the premium received by the Fund from writing the option.

                                      D-4
<PAGE>

APPENDIX E - TEXT OF FORUM BROCHURE

In connection with its  advertisements,  a Fund may provide a description of the
Fund's investment adviser and its affiliates, which are service providers to the
Fund. Text which is currently in use is set forth below.

"FORUM FINANCIAL GROUP OF COMPANIES

Forum Financial  Group of Companies  represent more than a decade of diversified
experience  with every  aspect of mutual  funds.  The Forum  Family of Funds has
benefited from the informed,  sharply  focused  perspective on mutual funds that
experience makes possible.

The Forum Family of Funds has been created and managed by  affiliated  companies
of Portland-based  Forum Financial Group, among the nation's largest mutual fund
administrators  providing clients with a full line of services for every type of
mutual fund.

The Forum  Family of Funds is designed to give  investment  representatives  and
investors a broad choice of carefully  structured  and  diversified  portfolios,
portfolios  that can satisfy a wide  variety of  immediate  as well as long-term
investment goals.

Forum  Financial Group has developed its "brand name" family of mutual funds and
has made them available to the investment public and to institutions on both the
national and regional levels.

For more than a decade Forum has had direct  experience with mutual funds from a
different  perspective,  a perspective  made  possible by Forum's  position as a
leading designer and full-service  administrator  and manager of mutual funds of
all types.

Today Forum  Financial  Group  administers  and  provides  services for over 120
mutual  funds for 17  different  fund  managers,  with more than $30  billion in
client assets. Forum has its headquarters in Portland, Maine, and has offices in
Seattle, Bermuda, and Warsaw, Poland. In a joint venture with Bank Handlowy, the
largest  and  oldest  commercial  bank  in  Poland,   Forum  operates  the  only
independent  transfer agent and mutual fund accounting business in Poland. Forum
directs an off-shore and hedge fund administration  business through its Bermuda
office. It employs more than 230 professionals worldwide.

From the  beginning,  Forum  developed a plan of action that was effective  with
both start- up funds, and funds that needed  restructuring and improved services
in order to live up to their potential.  The success of its innovative  approach
is  evident  in  Forum's  growth  rate over the  years,  a growth  rate that has
consistently outstripped that of the mutual fund industry as a whole, as well as
that of the fund service outsource industry.

Forum has worked with both  domestic  and  international  mutual fund  sponsors,
designing  unique  mutual  fund  structures,  positioning  new funds  within the
sponsors' own corporate planning and targeted markets.

Forum's staff of experienced lawyers, many of whom have been associated with the
Securities  and  Exchange  Commission,  have  been  available  to work with fund
sponsors to customize  fund  components and to evaluate the potential of various
fund structures.

Forum has introduced fund sponsors to its unique proprietary Core and Gateway(R)
partnership,  helping them to take advantage of this full-service  master/feeder
structure.

Fund sponsors  understand that even the most efficiently and creatively designed
fund can disappoint  shareholders  if it is inadequately  serviced.  That is the
reason why fund  sponsors  have relied on Forum to meet all of a fund's  complex
compliance, regulatory, and filing needs.

                                      E-1
<PAGE>

Forum's full service commitment  includes providing state-of- the-art accounting
support (Forum has 8 CPAs on staff, as well as senior  accountants who have been
associated with Big 6 accounting firms).  Forum's proprietary  accounting system
is continually upgraded and can provide custom-built modules to satisfy a fund's
specific  requirements.   This  service  is  joined  with  transfer  agency  and
shareholder  service  groups that draw their strength both from the high caliber
of the people staffing each unit and from Forum's  advanced  technology  support
system.

More than a decade of  experience  with mutual  funds has given Forum  practical
hands-on  experience and knowledge of how mutual funds function "from the inside
out."

Forum has put that  experience to work by creating the Forum Family of Funds,  a
family where each member is designed  and  positioned  for your best  investment
advantage,  and where each fund is  serviced  with the utmost  attention  to the
delivery of timely, accurate, and comprehensive shareholder information.

INVESTMENT ADVISERS

Forum Investment  Advisors,  LLC offers the services of portfolio  managers with
the highest  qualifications--because without such direction, a comprehensive and
goal-oriented  investment  program  and  ongoing  investment  strategy  are  not
possible.  Serving  as  portfolio  managers  for the  Forum  Family of Funds are
individuals  with  decades  of  experience  with  some  of the  country's  major
financial institutions.

Individual  funds in the Forum Family of Funds invest in portfolios that have as
their investment adviser nationally recognized institutions,  including Schroder
Capital Management International, Inc., a major figure in worldwide mutual funds
that, with its affiliates, managed over $175 billion as of September 30, 1997.

Forum Funds are also  managed by the  portfolio  managers of H.M.  Payson & Co.,
founded in Portland, Maine in 1854 and one of the oldest investment firms in the
country.  Payson has approximately $1 billion in assets under  management,  with
clients that include  pension plans,  endowment  funds,  and  institutional  and
individual accounts.

FORUM INVESTMENT ADVISORS, LLC

Forum Investment  Advisors,  LLC is the largest Maine based  investment  adviser
with  approximately  $1.4  billion in assets  under  management.  The  portfolio
managers have decades of combined experience in a cross section of the country's
financial  markets.  The managers have  specific,  day-to-day  experience in the
asset class  portfolios  they manage,  bringing  critical  focus to meeting each
fund's explicit investment objectives. The portfolio managers have been involved
in investing the assets of large  insurance  companies,  banks,  pension  plans,
individuals,  and of course mutual funds. Forum Investment  Advisors,  LLC has a
staff of analysts and investment  administrators  to meet the demands of serving
shareholders in our funds.

FORUM FAMILY OF FUNDS

It has been said that  mutual  fund  investment  offerings--of  which  there are
nearly  10,000,  with assets spread across stock,  bond,  and money market funds
worth  more  than  $4  trillion--come  in  a  rainbow  of  varieties.  A  better
description  would be a "spectrum" of varieties,  the spectrum graded from green
through  amber  and on to red.  In  simpler  terms,  from low risk  investments,
through moderate to high risk. The lower the risk, the lower the possible reward
- -- the higher the risk, the higher the potential reward.

The Forum Family of Funds provides  conservative  investment  opportunities that
reduce the risk of loss of capital,  using underlying  money market  investments
U.S. Government  securities  (although the shares of the Forum Funds are neither
insured nor guaranteed by the U.S. Government or its agencies),  thus 

                                      E-2
<PAGE>

cushioning the investment against market  volatility.  These funds offer regular
income, ready access to your money, and flexibility to buy or sell at any time.

In the less  conservative  but still not  aggressive  category  are funds in the
Forum Family that seek to provide steady income and, in certain cases,  tax-free
earnings.  Such investments  provide important  diversification to an investment
portfolio.

Growth funds in the Forum Family more  aggressively  pursue a high return at the
risk of market volatility.  These funds include domestic and international stock
mutual funds."


                                      E-3
<PAGE>

APPENDIX F - TEXT OF PEOPLES HERITAGE NEWS RELEASE

Peoples Heritage Financial Group, Inc. (NASDAQ:PHBK) announced today that it has
formed an alliance with a major mutual fund provider and an investment  advisory
firm to expand its mutual fund  offerings.  The  alliance  with Forum  Financial
Group and H.M.  Payson & Company will result in 18 funds,  including  the unique
Maine Municipal Bond Fund and New Hampshire Bond Fund, being offered through the
branches  of Peoples'  affiliate  banks in Maine,  New  Hampshire  and  northern
Massachusetts and the Company's trust and investment subsidiaries

'There is no secret to where  financial  services  are moving,  under one roof,"
said William J. Ryan, Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer of Peoples
Heritage.   "One  only  has  to  watch  the  virtually  daily  announcements  of
consolidations  in  the  financial  sector  to  understand  that  customers  are
demanding and receiving 'one-stop' financial services.

"We think we are adding the additional  competitive  advantage of funds that are
managed and administered close to home."

Eighteen  Forum funds will be offered  including two Payson funds.  The tax-free
Maine and New Hampshire  state bond funds are the only two such funds  available
and usually  invest 80% of total  assets in  municipal  securities.  Other funds
being  provided by the alliance  include money  market,  fixed income and equity
funds.

Forum Financial, based in Portland, Maine since 1987, administers 146 funds with
more than $36 billion in assets.  Forum  manages  mutual  funds for  independent
investment advisors such as Payson and for banks. Forum Investment Advisors, LLC
an affiliate,  is the largest Maine-based  investment advisor with approximately
$1.7 billion in fund assets under management.

"We are providing a great product set to the customers served by Peoples' nearly
200 branches in northern New  England,"  said John Y.  Keffer,  Forum  Financial
president,  "The key today is to link a wide variety of investment  options with
convergent, easy access for customers. I believe this alliance does just that."

H.M.  Payson & Co.,  founded in 1854, is one of the nation's  oldest  investment
firms with  nearly $1 billion in assets  under  management  and $300  million in
non-managed  custodial accounts.  The Payson value Fund and Payson Balanced Fund
are among the 18 offerings.

"I believe we have all the  ingredients  of a  tremendous  alliance,"  said John
Walker,  Payson president and managing  director.  "We have the region's premier
community banking company,  a community-based  investment  advisor,  and a local
mutual fund company that operates  nationally  and  specializes  in working with
banks. We are poised to provide solid investment performance and service."

Peoples Heritage Financial Group is a $10 billion multi-state bank and financial
services  holding company  headquartered  in Portland,  Maine. Its Maine banking
affiliate,  Peoples Heritage Bank, has the state's leading deposit market share.
Its New Hampshire  banking  affiliate,  Bank of New  Hampshire,  has the state's
leading deposit market share. Family Bank, the Company's  Massachusetts  banking
subsidiary,  has the state's tenth largest  deposit market share and the leading
market  share  in many of the  northern  Massachusetts  communities  it  serves.
Peoples  affiliate  banks  also  operate  subsidiaries  in  leasing,  trust  and
investment services and insurance.

                                      F-1
<PAGE>


FORUM FINANCIAL GROUP:

Headquarters:  Two Portland Square, Portland, Maine 04101
President:  John Y. Keffer
Offices:  Portland, Seattle, Warsaw, Bermuda
*Established  in 1986 to  administer  mutual  funds for  independent  investment
advisors and banks 
*Among the nation's largest  third-party fund  administrators
*Uses proprietary in-house systems and custom programming capabilities
         *ADMINISTRATION  AND  DISTRIBUTION SERVICES: Regulatory, compliance,
          expense  accounting, budgeting for all funds
         *FUND  ACCOUNTING  SERVICES: Portfolio valuation, accounting, dividend
          declaration,  and tax advice
         *SHAREHOLDER SERVICES: Preparation of statements, distribution support,
          inquiries and processing of trades
*CLIENT ASSETS UNDER ADMINISTRATION AND DISTRIBUTION:  $36.9 billion
*CLIENT ASSETS PROCESSED BY FUND ACCOUNTING:  $47.6 billion
*CLIENT FUNDS UNDER ADMINISTRATION AND DISTRIBUTION:  146 mutual funds with 219
 share classes
*INTERNATIONAL VENTURES:
         Joint  venture  with Bank  Handlowy in Warsaw,  Poland,  using  Forum's
         proprietary   transfer  agency  and  distribution   systems   Off-shore
         investment  fund  administration,  using  Bermuda as Forum's  center of
         operations
*FORUM EMPLOYEES:  United States -198, Poland - 61, Bermuda - 3

FORUM CONTACTS:
Mark Kaplan, Managing Director and Portfolio Manager, Forum Investment Advisors,
LLC,
(207) 879-1900 X 6123
Tony Santaniello, Director of Marketing, (207) 879-1900 X 6175

                                      F-2
<PAGE>


H.M. PAYSON & CO.:

Headquarters:  One Portland Square, Portland, Maine
President and Managing Director: John Walker
Quality investment services and conservative wealth management since 1854
*Assets under Management: $1 Billion
*Custody Income Assets: $300 Million
*Client Base: 85% individuals; 15% institutional
*Owned by 11 shareholders; 11 managing directors
*Payson Balanced Fund and Payson Value Fund  (administrative and shareholder
 services  provided by Forum Financial Group)
*Employees: 45

H.M. PAYSON & CO. CONTACT:
Joel Harris, Portfolio/Marketing Coordinator, (207) 772-3761

                                      F-3
<PAGE>

FORUM FUNDS

DAILY ASSETS TREASURY FUND
DAILY ASSETS TREASURY OBLIGATIONS FUND
DAILY ASSETS GOVERNMENT FUND
DAILY ASSETS CASH FUND
DAILY ASSETS MUNICIPAL FUND

Account Information and
Shareholder Servicing:                   Distributor:
         Forum Financial Corp.                    Forum Financial Services, Inc.
         P.O. Box 446                             Two Portland Square
         Portland, Maine  04112                   Portland, Maine  04101
         (207) 879-0001                           (207) 879-1900
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
January 1, 1998 as amended April 15, 1998

This Statement of Additional  Information  supplements  the  Prospectuses  dated
January 1, 1998,  offering  Investor  Shares,  Institutional  Service Shares and
Institutional  Shares of Daily  Assets  Treasury  Fund,  Daily  Assets  Treasury
Obligations Fund, Daily Assets Government Fund, Daily Assets Cash Fund and Daily
Assets  Municipal Fund, five portfolios of the Trust, and should be read only in
conjunction with the applicable  Prospectus,  a copy of which may be obtained by
an investor without charge by contacting the Trust's  Distributor at the address
listed above.

TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                          PAGE

  1.       General                                                          2
  2.       Investment Policies                                              3
  3.       Investment Limitations                                           7
  4.       Investment by Financial Institutions                            10
  5.       Performance Data                                                12
  6.       Management                                                      13
  7.       Determination of Net Asset Value                                21
  8.       Portfolio Transactions                                          22
  9.       Additional Purchase and Redemption Information                  22
  10.      Taxation                                                        24
  11.      Other Information                                               24
  12.      Financial Statements                                            26

           Appendix A - Description of Securities Ratings
           Appendix B - Performance Information
           Appendix C - Miscellaneous Tables
           Appendix D - Text of Peoples Heritage News Release


THIS  STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL  INFORMATION IS NOT A PROSPECTUS AND IS AUTHORIZED
FOR DISTRIBUTION TO PROSPECTIVE  INVESTORS ONLY IF PRECEDED OR ACCOMPANIED BY AN
EFFECTIVE PROSPECTUS.


<PAGE>


1.  GENERAL

THE TRUST

The  Trust is  registered  with the SEC as an  open-end,  management  investment
company  and was  organized  as a business  trust under the laws of the State of
Delaware  on August 29,  1995.  On January  5, 1996 the Trust  succeeded  to the
assets and liabilities of Forum Funds,  Inc. Forum Funds,  Inc. was incorporated
on March 24, 1980 and assumed the name of Forum  Funds,  Inc. on March 16, 1987.
The Board has the authority to issue an unlimited number of shares of beneficial
interest of separate  series with no par value per share and to create  separate
classes of shares  within each  series.  The Trust  currently  offers  shares of
eighteen series and has three series that have not commenced operation as of the
date of this SAI. The series of the Trust are as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>          <C>                                                   <C>
          Daily Assets Treasury Fund                            Austin Global Equity Fund
          Daily Assets Treasury Obligations Fund                Oak Hall Equity Fund
          Daily Assets Government Fund
          Daily Assets Cash Fund                                Quadra Limited Maturity Treasury Fund
          Daily Assets Municipal Fund                           Quadra Value Equity Fund
                                                                Quadra Growth Fund
          Investors Bond Fund                                   Quadra International Equity Fund
          TaxSaver Bond Fund                                    Quadra Opportunistic Bond Fund
          Maine Municipal Bond Fund
          New Hampshire Bond Fund

          Payson Value Fund
          Payson Balanced Fund.
</TABLE>

DEFINITIONS

As used in this Statement of Additional  Information,  the following terms shall
have the meanings listed:

"Adviser" means Forum Investment Advisors, LLC.

"Board" means the Board of Trustees of Forum Funds.

"Core Trust" means Core Trust (Delaware), a Delaware business trust.

"Core Trust Board" means the Board of Trustees of Core Trust (Delaware).

"FAS" means Forum Administrative Services, LLC

"FFC" means Forum Financial Corp.

"FFSI" means Forum Financial Services, Inc.

"Fund" means Daily Assets Treasury Fund, Daily Assets Treasury Obligations Fund,
Daily Assets  Government  Fund, Daily Assets Cash Fund or Daily Assets Municipal
Fund.

"Fund Business Day" has the meaning ascribed  thereto in the current  Prospectus
of the Funds.

"NRSRO" means a nationally recognized statistical rating organization.

"Portfolio" means Treasury Portfolio,  Treasury Cash Portfolio,  Government Cash
Portfolio,  Cash Portfolio or Municipal Cash Portfolio, each a portfolio of Core
Trust.

                                       2
<PAGE>

"SAI" means this Statement of Additional Information.

"SEC" means the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.

"Treasury Securities" has the meaning ascribed thereto by the current Prospectus
of the Funds.

"Trust" means Forum Funds, a Delaware business trust.

"U.S.  Government  Securities" has the meaning  ascribed  thereto by the current
Prospectus of the Funds.

"1940 Act" means the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.

2.  INVESTMENT POLICIES

Each Fund currently  seeks to achieve its investment  objective by investing all
of its  investable  assets in its  corresponding  Portfolio.  The  corresponding
Portfolios of Daily Assets  Treasury  Fund,  Daily Assets  Treasury  Obligations
Fund,  Daily  Assets  Government  Fund,  Daily Assets Cash Fund and Daily Assets
Municipal Fund, respectively,  are Treasury Portfolio,  Treasury Cash Portfolio,
Government  Cash  Portfolio,   Cash  Portfolio  and  Municipal  Cash  Portfolio.
Following  is  information   pertaining  to  the  investment   policies  of  the
Portfolios, which supplements the investment policy information contained in the
Funds' Prospectuses.

Each  Fund  has  an  investment  policy  that  allows  it to  invest  all of its
investable assets in its corresponding  Portfolio. All other investment policies
of each Fund and its corresponding Portfolio are identical.  Therefore, although
this and the following sections provide supplemental  information  regarding the
investment  policies of the  Portfolios  (and the  responsibilities  of the Core
Trust Board),  they apply equally to the  investment  policies of the Funds (and
the  responsibilities  of the Board).  Information  with respect to Daily Assets
Treasury  Fund for periods prior to December 5, 1995 (for  instance,  investment
advisory fees paid),  the date that Fund began investing in Treasury  Portfolio,
reflects  information with respect to the Fund and the Fund's direct  investment
in securities.

Debt  securities  with longer  maturities  tend to produce higher yields and are
generally  subject to greater  price  movements  than  obligations  with shorter
maturities. An increase in interest rates will generally reduce the market value
of  portfolio  investments,  and a decline  in  interest  rates  will  generally
increase the value of portfolio investments.

Each  Portfolio  invests at least 95% of its total assets in  securities  in the
highest  rating  category  (as  determined  pursuant to Rule 2a-7 under the 1940
Act).

Government  Cash  Portfolio and Cash  Portfolio  currently are  prohibited  from
purchasing  any security  issued by the Federal Home Loan Mortgage  Corporation.
This does not prohibit the Portfolios from entering into  repurchase  agreements
collateralized  with  securities  issued  by  the  Federal  Home  Loan  Mortgage
Corporation.

Except  for U.S.  Government  Securities  and to the  limited  extent  otherwise
permitted  by Rule 2a-7 under the 1940 Act, the  Portfolios  may not invest more
than five percent of their total assets in (i) the  securities of any one issuer
or (ii)  securities  that are rated (or are issued by an issuer with  comparable
outstanding short-term debt that is rated) in the second highest rating category
or are unrated and determined by an Adviser to be of comparable quality.

RATINGS AS INVESTMENT CRITERIA

Moody's  Investors  Service,  Inc.  ("Moody's"),  Standard & Poor's  Corporation
("S&P") and other NRSROs are private services that provide ratings of the credit
quality  of debt  obligations.  A  description  of the  higher  quality  ratings
assigned to debt  securities by several NRSROs is included in Appendix A to this
SAI. The Portfolios use these ratings in determining  whether to purchase,  sell
or hold a security.  It should be emphasized,  however, that ratings are general
and are not absolute  standards of quality.  Consequently,  securities  with the
same  maturity,  interest  rate and rating  may have  different  market  prices.
Subsequent to its purchase by a Portfolio,  an issue of


                                       3
<PAGE>

securities  may cease to be rated or its rating may be  reduced.  A  Portfolio's
Adviser,  and in certain cases the Core Trust Board, will consider such an event
in determining  whether the Portfolio  should  continue to hold the  obligation.
Credit ratings attempt to evaluate the safety of principal and interest payments
and do not evaluate the risks of  fluctuations  in market  value.  Also,  rating
agencies  may fail to make  timely  changes  in credit  ratings in  response  to
developments and events, so that an issuer's current financial  condition may be
better or worse than the rating indicates.

SMALL BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION SECURITIES

Each Portfolio  (other than Municipal  Cash  Portfolio) may purchase  securities
issued by the Small Business Administration ("SBA"). SBA securities are variable
rate  securities  that  carry the full  faith and  credit of the  United  States
Government, and generally have an interest rate that resets monthly or quarterly
based on a spread to the Prime rate. SBA securities generally have maturities at
issue  of up to 25  years.  No  Portfolio  may  purchase  an  SBA  security  if,
immediately  after the purchase,  (i) the Portfolio  would have more than 15% of
its net assets invested in SBA securities or (ii) either the unamortized premium
or unaccreted  discount on SBA securities  held by the Portfolio  divided by the
sum of the  premium or discount  securities'  par  amount,  respectively,  would
exceed 2.5% (0.025).

ADJUSTABLE RATE MORTGAGE BACKED SECURITIES

The  Portfolios  (other than Treasury  Portfolio) may purchase  adjustable  rate
mortgage backed or other asset backed  securities  (such as SBA securities) that
are U.S.  Government  Securities.  Treasury Cash Portfolio may purchase mortgage
backed or asset backed securities that are U.S. Treasury Securities. These types
of  securities  directly  or  indirectly  represent a  participation  in, or are
secured by and payable from,  adjustable rate mortgages or other loans which may
be secured by real estate or other assets.  Unlike traditional debt instruments,
payments on these  securities  include both  interest  and a partial  payment of
principal.  Prepayments  of the  principal of  underlying  loans may shorten the
effective  maturities of these  securities.  Some adjustable rate securities (or
the  underlying  loans)  are  subject to caps or floors  that limit the  maximum
change  in  interest  rate  during a  specified  period  or over the life of the
security.

Adjustable  rate mortgage  backed  securities  ("MBSs") are securities that have
interest  rates that are reset at periodic  intervals,  usually by  reference to
some interest rate index or market  interest rate.  MBSs represent  interests in
pools  of  mortgages  made  by  lenders  such  as  commercial   banks,   savings
associations,  mortgage  bankers  and  mortgage  brokers  and may be  issued  by
governmental or government-related entities or by non-governmental entities such
as commercial banks, savings associations,  mortgage bankers and other secondary
market issuers.

MBSs differ  from other forms of debt  securities,  which  normally  provide for
periodic  payment of  interest  in fixed  amounts  with  principal  payments  at
maturity or specified  call dates in that MBSs provide  periodic  payments which
consist of interest and, in most cases, principal. In effect, these payments are
a "pass-through" of the periodic  payments and optional  prepayments made by the
individual borrowers on their mortgage loans, net of any fees paid to the issuer
or  guarantor  of such  securities.  Additional  payments to holders of MBSs are
caused by prepayments  resulting from the sale of the underlying property or the
refinancing or foreclosure of the underlying  mortgage loans.  Such  prepayments
may significantly shorten the effective maturities of MBSs, and occur more often
during periods of declining interest rates.

Although the rate adjustment feature of MBSs may act as a buffer to reduce sharp
changes in the value of MBSs,  these  securities are still subject to changes in
value  based on changes  in market  interest  rates or  changes in the  issuer's
creditworthiness.  Because the interest rate is reset only periodically, changes
in the  interest  rate on MBSs  may lag  behind  changes  in  prevailing  market
interest  rates.  Also,  some MBSs (or the underlying  mortgages) are subject to
caps or floors that limit the maximum change in interest rate during a specified
period or over the life of the security.

During periods of declining  interest  rates,  income to the Portfolios  derived
from  mortgages  which are not prepaid  will  decrease as the coupon rate resets
along with the decline in interest rates in contrast to the income on fixed-rate

                                       4
<PAGE>

mortgages,  which will remain constant.  At times, some of the MBSs in which the
Portfolios will invest will have  higher-than-market  interest  rates,  and will
therefore  be  purchased  at  a  premium  above  their  par  value.  Unscheduled
prepayments,  which are made at par, will cause the  Portfolios to suffer a loss
equal to the unamortized premium, if any.

During  periods of rising  interest  rates,  changes in the coupon  rates of the
mortgages  underlying  the  Portfolios'  investments  may lag behind  changes in
market  interest  rates.  This may result in a slightly  lower  value  until the
coupons reset to market rates. Many MBSs in the Portfolios' portfolios will have
"caps"  that limit the  maximum  amount by which the  interest  rate paid by the
borrower  may  change  at each  reset  date or over  the  life of the  loan  and
fluctuation in interest rates above these levels could cause these securities to
"cap out" and to behave more like fixed-rate debt securities.

The Portfolios may purchase collateralized mortgage obligations ("CMOs"),  which
are  collateralized  by MBSs or by pools  of  conventional  mortgages.  CMOs are
typically  structured  with a number of  classes or series  that have  different
maturities and are generally  retired in sequence.  Each class of bonds receives
periodic interest payments  according to the coupon rate on the bonds.  However,
all monthly principal  payments and any prepayments from the collateral pool are
paid first to the "Class 1"  bondholders.  The principal  payments are such that
the Class 1 bonds will be  completely  repaid no later than,  for example,  five
years  after the  offering  date.  Thereafter,  all  payments of  principal  are
allocated  to the next most senior  class of bonds until that class of bonds has
been fully repaid.  Although full payoff of each class of bonds is contractually
required by a certain  date,  any or all classes of bonds may be paid off sooner
than expected  because of an  acceleration  in  pre-payments  of the obligations
comprising the collateral pool.

Since the inception of the mortgage-related  pass-through  security in 1970, the
market for these securities has expanded  considerably.  The size of the primary
issuance market and active  participation  in the secondary market by securities
dealers  and many types of  investors  make  government  and  government-related
pass-through pools highly liquid.

Governmental  or private  entities  may create new types of MBSs in  response to
changes in the market or changes in government regulation of such securities. As
new types of these  securities  are  developed  and  offered to  investors,  the
Adviser  may,  consistent  with  the  investment  objective  and  policies  of a
Portfolio, consider making investments in such new types of securities.

WHEN-ISSUED SECURITIES AND DELAYED DELIVERY SECURITIES

Each  Portfolio may purchase  securities on a  when-issued  or delayed  delivery
basis.  In those cases,  the purchase price and the interest rate payable on the
securities are fixed on the  transaction  date and delivery and payment may take
place a month or more after the date of the transaction. At the time a Portfolio
makes the commitment to purchase securities on a when-issued or delayed delivery
basis,  the Portfolio will record the  transactions as a purchase and thereafter
reflect  the value  each day of such  securities  in  determining  its net asset
value.  If a Portfolio  chooses to dispose of the right to acquire a when-issued
security  prior to its  acquisition,  it could,  as with the  disposition of any
other  portfolio  obligation,  incur a gain or loss due to  market  fluctuation.
Failure  of an  issuer to  deliver  the  security  may  result in the  Portfolio
incurring a loss or missing an opportunity  to make an  alternative  investment.
When a  Portfolio  agrees to  purchase a security  on a  when-issued  or delayed
delivery  basis,  its  custodian  will set aside and  maintain  in a  segregated
account cash,  U.S.  Government  Securities or other liquid assets with a market
value at all times at least equal to the amount of its commitment.

Core Trust's custodian will set aside and maintain in a segregated  account cash
and  securities  with a market  value at all times  equal to the  amount of each
Portfolio's forward commitment obligations.

ILLIQUID SECURITIES

Each  Portfolio  may invest up to 10% of its net assets in illiquid  securities.
The term "illiquid  securities" for this purpose means repurchase agreements not
entitling  the holder to payment of principal  within seven days and 


                                       5
<PAGE>

securities  that are illiquid by virtue of legal or contractual  restrictions on
resale or the absence of a readily available market.

The Core  Trust  Board  has  ultimate  responsibility  for  determining  whether
specific  securities are liquid or illiquid.  The Core Trust Board has delegated
the function of making  day-to-day  determinations  of liquidity to the Advisers
and, with respect to certain types of restricted  securities which may be deemed
to be liquid,  has  adopted  guidelines  to be  followed  by the  Advisers.  The
Advisers take into account a number of factors in reaching liquidity  decisions,
including but not limited to (1) the frequency of trades and  quotations for the
security; (2) the number of dealers willing to purchase or sell the security and
the  number  of other  potential  buyers;  (3) the  willingness  of  dealers  to
undertake to make a market in the  security;  (4) the nature of the  marketplace
trades,  including  the time  needed to dispose of the  security,  the method of
soliciting offers and the mechanics of the transfer; (5) whether the security is
registered;  and (6) if the security is not traded in the United States, whether
it can be freely  traded in a liquid  foreign  securities  market.  The Advisers
monitor the liquidity of the securities in each Portfolio's portfolio and report
periodically to the Core Trust Board.

Certificates  of  deposit  and other  fixed  time  deposits  that carry an early
withdrawal  penalty  or mature in greater  than  seven  days are  treated by the
Portfolio as illiquid securities if there is no readily available market for the
instrument.

REPURCHASE AGREEMENTS AND SECURITIES LENDING

In order to obtain additional  income, the Portfolios may from time to time lend
securities from their portfolio to brokers,  dealers and financial institutions.
Securities  loans must be callable at any time and must be continuously  secured
by  collateral  from  the  borrower  in the  form of  cash  or  U.S.  Government
Securities.  The Portfolios receive fees in respect of securities loans from the
borrower or interest from investing the cash collateral.  The Portfolios may pay
fees to arrange the loans. As a fundamental policy, Treasury Portfolio, and as a
nonfundamental  policy, the other Portfolios,  may not lend portfolio securities
in an amount greater than 33 1/3% of the value of their total assets.

In connection with entering into repurchase agreements and securities loans, the
Portfolios require continual maintenance by Core Trust's custodian of the market
value of the  underlying  collateral  in amounts  equal to, or in excess of, the
repurchase  price plus the transaction  costs  (including loss of interest) that
the Portfolios  could expect to incur upon  liquidation of the collateral if the
counterparty defaults. The Portfolios' use of securities lending entails certain
risks not associated with direct investments in securities. For instance, in the
event  that  bankruptcy  or  similar   proceedings  were  commenced   against  a
counterparty  in  these   transactions  or  a  counterparty   defaulted  on  its
obligations,  a  Portfolio  might  suffer a loss.  Failure by the other party to
deliver a security  purchased by a Portfolio may result in a missed  opportunity
to make an alternative investment.  The Adviser monitors the creditworthiness of
counterparties  to these  transactions  under  the Core  Trust  Board's  general
supervision  and pursuant to specific  Core Trust Board adopted  procedures  and
intend  to  enter  into  these   transactions   only  when  they   believe   the
counterparties present minimal credit risks and the income to be earned from the
transaction justifies the attendant risks.

VARIABLE AND FLOATING RATE SECURITIES

The yield of variable and floating rate securities varies in relation to changes
in specific  money market rates,  such as the Prime Rate. A "variable"  interest
rate adjusts at predetermined intervals (for example, daily, weekly or monthly),
while a "floating"  interest rate adjusts  whenever a specified  benchmark  rate
(such as the bank prime  lending rate)  changes.  These changes are reflected in
adjustments  to the yields of the  variable and floating  rate  securities,  and
different  securities  may have  different  adjustment  rates.  Accordingly,  as
interest rates increase or decrease,  the capital  appreciation  or depreciation
may be less on these obligations than for fixed rate obligations.  To the extent
that the Portfolios  invest in long-term  variable or floating rate  securities,
the Adviser  believes that the  Portfolios  may be able to take advantage of the
higher yield that is usually paid on long-term securities.

Cash  Portfolio  also may purchase  variable  and floating  rate master notes of
corporations, which are unsecured obligations redeemable upon notice that permit
investment  of  fluctuating  amounts at varying  rates of  interest  pursuant to
direct arrangement with the issuer of the instrument.  These obligations include
master  demand notes


                                       6
<PAGE>

that  permit  investment  of  fluctuating  amounts at varying  rates of interest
pursuant to direct arrangement with the issuer of the instrument.  The issuer of
these  obligations  often has the right,  after a given period,  to prepay their
outstanding principal amount of the obligations upon a specified number of days'
notice.  These obligations  generally are not traded,  nor generally is there an
established secondary market for these obligations.  To the extent a demand note
does not have a seven day or  shorter  demand  feature  and there is no  readily
available market for the obligation, it is treated as an illiquid security.

INVESTMENT COMPANY SECURITIES

In connection with managing their cash  positions,  the Portfolios may invest in
the securities of other investment  companies that are money market funds within
the  limits  proscribed  by the  1940  Act.  Under  normal  circumstances,  each
Portfolio  only  intends  to invest  in funds  when it has  excess  cash and the
Adviser  believes that the  investment is in the best interest of the Portfolio.
In  addition to a  Portfolio's  expenses  (including  the  various  fees),  as a
shareholder in another  investment  company, a Portfolio would bear its pro rata
portion of the other investment company's expenses (including fees).

ZERO-COUPON SECURITIES.

Treasury  Portfolio may invest in zero-coupon  securities such as Treasury bills
and separately traded principal and interest  components of Treasury  Securities
issued or guaranteed  under the U.S.  Treasury's  Separate Trading of Registered
Interest and Principal of Securities  ("STRIPS")  program.  These securities are
sold at  original  issue  discount  and pay no  interest  to  holders  prior  to
maturity.  Because  of this,  zero-coupon  securities  may be subject to greater
fluctuation  of market value than the other  securities in which the  Portfolios
may invest. All zero-coupon  securities in which the Portfolio invests will have
a maturity of less than 13 months.

3.  INVESTMENT LIMITATIONS

Fundamental investment limitations of a Fund or of a Portfolio cannot be changed
without  the  affirmative  vote  of the  lesser  of  (i)  more  than  50% of the
outstanding  interests  of the  respective  Fund or Portfolio or (ii) 67% of the
shares of the Fund or Portfolio  present or  represented  at a  shareholders  or
interestholders meeting at which the holders of more than 50% of the outstanding
interests of the Fund or Portfolio are present or represented.

Except as required by the 1940 Act, if a percentage restriction on investment or
utilization  of assets is adhered to at the time an  investment is made, a later
change  in  percentage  resulting  from a  change  in  the  market  values  of a
Portfolio's  assets,  the  change in  status  of a  security  or  purchases  and
redemptions of shares will not be considered a violation of the limitation.

Each  Fund  has  adopted  the same  fundamental  and  nonfundamental  investment
limitations as its corresponding  Portfolio. In addition, the Portfolios and the
Funds have adopted a fundamental policy which provides that, notwithstanding any
other investment policy or restriction (whether  fundamental),  the Portfolio or
Fund, as applicable,  may invest all of its assets in the securities of a single
pooled  investment fund having  substantially  the same  investment  objectives,
policies and restrictions as the Fund or Portfolio, as applicable.

TREASURY PORTFOLIO has adopted the following fundamental  investment limitations
which are in addition to those  contained  in the  Prospectuses  of Daily Assets
Treasury Fund and which may not be changed  without  shareholder  approval.  The
Portfolio may not:

(1)      With respect to 75% of its assets, purchase securities, other than U.S.
         Government  Securities,  of any one issuer if more than 5% of the value
         of the  Portfolio's  total  assets  would  at the time of  purchase  be
         invested in any one issuer.

(2)      Purchase  securities,  other than U.S. Government  Securities,  if more
         than 25% of the value of the Portfolio's total assets would be invested
         in securities of issuers  conducting their principal  business activity
         in the same  industry,  provided  that consumer  finance  companies and
         industrial  finance companies are 


                                       7
<PAGE>

          considered to be separate industries and that there is no limit on the
          purchase of the securities of domestic commercial banks.

(3)      Act as an  underwriter  of securities of other  issuers,  except to the
         extent  that,  in  connection   with  the   disposition   of  portfolio
         securities,  the  Portfolio  may be  deemed  to be an  underwriter  for
         purposes of the Securities Act of 1933.

(4)      Purchase or sell real estate or any interest  therein,  except that the
         Portfolio  may invest in debt  obligations  secured  by real  estate or
         interests  therein or issued by companies that invest in real estate or
         interests therein.

(5)      Purchase or sell physical commodities or contracts relating to physical
         commodities,  provided that currencies and  currency-related  contracts
         will not be deemed to be physical commodities.

(6)      Borrow money, except for temporary or emergency purposes (including the
         meeting of redemption  requests).  Total  borrowings  may not exceed 33
         1/3% of the  Portfolio's  total assets and borrowing for purposes other
         than  meeting  redemptions  may not  exceed 5% of the value of each the
         Portfolio's total assets. Outstanding borrowings in excess of 5% of the
         value  of the  Portfolio's  total  assets  must be  repaid  before  any
         subsequent investments are made by the Portfolio.

(7)      Issue senior  securities  except pursuant to Section 18 of the 1940 Act
         and except that the  Portfolio  may borrow money  subject to investment
         limitations specified in the Portfolio's Prospectus.

(8)      Make loans,  except that the Portfolio may (i) purchase debt securities
         which are otherwise permissible investments, (ii) enter into repurchase
         agreements and (iii) lend portfolio securities.

(9)      Purchase  or  sell  real  property   (including   limited   partnership
         interests,  but excluding readily  marketable  interests in real estate
         investment trusts or readily  marketable  securities of companies which
         invest in real estate.)

(10)     Pledge,  mortgage or hypothecate its assets, except to secure permitted
         indebtedness.  Collateralized  loans of securities are not deemed to be
         pledges or hypothecations for this purpose.

(11)     Write put and call options.

(12)     Invest for the purpose of exercising control over any person.

(13)     Purchase restricted securities.

TREASURY   PORTFOLIO  has  adopted  the  following   nonfundamental   investment
limitations  that may be  changed by the Core Trust  Board  without  shareholder
approval. The Portfolio may not:

(a)      Purchase  securities  having  voting  rights,  except the Portfolio may
         invest  in  securities  of other  investment  companies  to the  extent
         permitted by the 1940 Act.

(b)      Purchase  securities  on  margin,  or make short  sales of  securities,
         except for the use of short-term  credit necessary for the clearance of
         purchases and sales of portfolio securities.

(c)      Invest in securities (other than fully-collateralized debt obligations)
         issued by companies that have conducted continuous  operations for less
         than three years,  including  the  operations of  predecessors,  unless
         guaranteed  as  to  principal  and  interest  by  an  issuer  in  whose
         securities the Portfolio could invest.

                                       8
<PAGE>

(d)      Invest in or hold  securities of any issuer if officers and Trustees of
         the Trust or the Adviser,  individually  owning  beneficially more than
         1/2 of 1% of the  securities  of the issuer,  in the aggregate own more
         than 5% of the issuer's securities.

(e)      Invest in  interests  in oil or gas or  interests in other  mineral 
         exploration  or  development programs.

TREASURY CASH PORTFOLIO, GOVERNMENT CASH PORTFOLIO, CASH PORTFOLIO AND MUNICIPAL
CASH PORTFOLIO  have adopted the following  fundamental  investment  limitations
which are in addition to those  contained  in the  Prospectuses  offering  Daily
Assets Treasury  Obligations  Fund,  Daily Assets  Government Fund, Daily Assets
Cash Fund and Daily Assets  Municipal Fund and which may not be changed  without
shareholder approval. No Portfolio may:

(1)      With  respect to 75% of its  assets,  purchase a security  other than a
         U.S.  Government Security (or, in the case of Municipal cash Portfolio,
         other than a security of an investment  company) if, as a result,  more
         than 5% of the  Portfolio's  total  assets  would  be  invested  in the
         securities of a single issuer.

(2)      Purchase  securities if, immediately after the purchase,  more than 25%
         of the value of the  Portfolio's  total assets would be invested in the
         securities of issuers having their principal business activities in the
         same industry; provided, however, that there is no limit on investments
         in U.S. Government Securities.

(3)      Underwrite  securities of other issuers,  except to the extent that the
         Portfolio  may  be  considered  to  be  acting  as  an  underwriter  in
         connection with the disposition of portfolio securities.

(4)      Purchase or sell real estate or any interest  therein,  except that the
         Portfolio  may invest in debt  obligations  secured  by real  estate or
         interests  therein or issued by companies that invest in real estate or
         interests therein.

(5)      Purchase or sell physical commodities or contracts relating to physical
         commodities,  provided that currencies and  currency-related  contracts
         will not be deemed to be physical commodities.

(6)      Borrow money, except for temporary or emergency purposes (including the
         meeting of  redemption  requests)  and except for entering into reverse
         repurchase  agreements,  provided that borrowings do not exceed 33 1/3%
         of the value of the Portfolio's total assets.

(7)      Issue senior securities except as appropriate to evidence  indebtedness
         that the  Portfolio  is  permitted  to  incur,  and  provided  that the
         Portfolio  may issue  shares of  additional  series or classes that the
         Trustees may establish.

(8)      Make loans except for loans of portfolio securities, through the use of
         repurchase agreements, and through the purchase of debt securities that
         are otherwise permitted investments.

(9)      With  respect  to  Government  Cash  Portfolio,  purchase  or hold  any
         security that (i) a Federally  chartered  savings  association  may not
         invest in,  sell,  redeem,  hold or otherwise  deal  pursuant to law or
         regulation,  without limit as to percentage of the association's assets
         and (ii) pursuant to 12 C.F.R.  Section 566.1 would cause shares of the
         Portfolio not to be deemed to be short term liquid assets when owned by
         Federally chartered savings associations.

For purposes of limitation  (2): (i) loan  participations  are  considered to be
issued by both the issuing  bank and the  underlying  corporate  borrower;  (ii)
utility companies are divided according to their services (for example, gas, gas
transmission,  electric  and  telephone  will  each  be  considered  a  separate
industry); and (iii) financial service companies will be classified according to
the end users of their services,  for example,  automobile finance, bank finance
and diversified finance will each be considered a separate industry.

                                       9
<PAGE>

TREASURY CASH PORTFOLIO, GOVERNMENT CASH PORTFOLIO, CASH PORTFOLIO AND MUNICIPAL
CASH PORTFOLIO have adopted the following nonfundamental  investment limitations
that may be changed by the Core Trust Board without shareholder  approval.  Each
Portfolio may not:

(a)      With  respect to 100% of its assets,  purchase a security  other than a
         U.S.  Government  Security  if,  as a  result,  more  than  5%  of  the
         Portfolio's  total  assets  would be  invested in the  securities  of a
         single  issuer,  unless the  investment is permitted by Rule 2a-7 under
         the 1940 Act.

(b)      Purchase  securities for investment while any borrowing  equaling 5% or
         more of the Portfolio's total assets is outstanding; and if at any time
         the   Portfolio's   borrowings   exceed  the   Portfolio's   investment
         limitations  due to a decline in net assets,  such  borrowings  will be
         promptly  (within three days) reduced to the extent necessary to comply
         with  the  limitations.  Borrowing  for  purposes  other  than  meeting
         redemption  requests will not exceed 5% of the value of the Portfolio's
         total assets.

(c)      Purchase  securities that have voting rights,  except the Portfolio may
         invest  in  securities  of other  investment  companies  to the  extent
         permitted by the 1940 Act.

(d)      Purchase  securities  on  margin,  or make short  sales of  securities,
         except for the use of short-term  credit necessary for the clearance of
         purchases and sales of portfolio securities.

(e)      Invest in securities (other than fully-collateralized debt obligations)
         issued by companies that have conducted continuous  operations for less
         than three years,  including  the  operations of  predecessors  (unless
         guaranteed  as  to  principal  and  interest  by  an  issuer  in  whose
         securities the Portfolio could invest), if as a result, more than 5% of
         the value of the Portfolio's total assets would be so invested.

(f)      Invest  in  oil,  gas  or  other  mineral  exploration  or  development
         programs, or leases, or in real estate limited  partnerships;  provided
         that the Portfolio may invest in securities issued by companies engaged
         in such activities.

(g)      Acquire  securities or invest in repurchase  agreements with respect to
         any securities if, as a result,  more than 10% of the  Portfolio's  net
         assets  (taken  at  current  value)  would be  invested  in  repurchase
         agreements  not  entitling  the holder to payment of  principal  within
         seven days and in  securities  that are  illiquid by virtue of legal or
         contractual  restrictions  on  resale  or  the  absence  of  a  readily
         available market.

4.  INVESTMENTS BY FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS

INVESTMENT BY SHAREHOLDERS THAT ARE BANKS - DAILY ASSETS GOVERNMENT FUND

Government Cash Portfolio invests only in instruments which, if held directly by
a bank or bank holding company  organized under the laws of the United States or
any state thereof,  would be assigned to a risk-weight  category of no more than
20% under the current risk based capital  guidelines adopted by the Federal bank
regulators (the "Guidelines"). In the event that the Guidelines are revised, the
Portfolio's  portfolio will be modified  accordingly,  including by disposing of
portfolio  securities  or other  instruments  that no longer  qualify  under the
Guidelines.  In addition, the Portfolio does not intend to hold in its portfolio
any securities or instruments  that would be subject to restriction as to amount
held by a National  bank under  Title 12,  Section  24  (Seventh)  of the United
States Code. If the Portfolio's portfolio includes any instruments that would be
subject to a restriction as to amount held by a National bank, investment in the
Portfolio may be limited.

The Guidelines  provide that shares of an investment fund are generally assigned
to the risk-weight category applicable to the highest risk-weighted  security or
instrument  that the fund is permitted to hold.  Accordingly,  Portfolio  shares
should qualify for a 20% risk  weighting  under the  Guidelines.  The Guidelines
also provide that, in the case of an investment fund whose shares should qualify
for a risk  weighting  below 100% due to  limitations  on the assets which it is
permitted  to hold,  bank  examiners  may review the  treatment of the shares to
ensure  that  they  have  been  assigned  an  appropriate  risk-weight.  In this
connection,  the Guidelines  provide that,  regardless of the  


                                       10
<PAGE>

composition of an investment fund's assets,  shares of a fund may be assigned to
the 100%  risk-weight  category  if it is  determined  that the fund  engages in
activities   that  appear  to  be   speculative  in  nature  or  has  any  other
characteristics  that are inconsistent with a lower risk weighting.  The Adviser
has no reason to believe that such a determination would be made with respect to
the  Portfolio.   Their  are  various   subjective   criteria  for  making  this
determination and, therefore,  it is not possible to provide any assurance as to
how Portfolio shares will be evaluated by bank examiners.

Before  acquiring  Fund  shares,  prospective  investors  that are banks or bank
holding  companies,  particularly those that are organized under the laws of any
country  other  than the  United  States  or of any  state,  territory  or other
political  subdivision of the United States, and prospective  investors that are
U.S. branches and agencies of foreign banks or Edge Corporations, should consult
all applicable laws, regulations and policies, as well as appropriate regulatory
bodies,  to confirm  that an  investment  in Fund Shares is  permissible  and in
compliance with any applicable investment or other limits.

Fund  Shares  held by  National  banks are  generally  required  to be  revalued
periodically and reported at the lower of cost or market value.  Such shares may
also be subject to special regulatory  reporting,  accounting and tax treatment.
In addition,  a bank may be required to obtain specific  approval from its board
of directors  before  acquiring  Fund shares,  and thereafter may be required to
review its  investment  in a Fund for the purpose of verifying  compliance  with
applicable Federal banking laws, regulations and policies.

National banks generally must review their holdings of shares of a Fund at least
quarterly  to  ensure  compliance  with  established  bank  policies  and  legal
requirements.  Upon request,  the  Portfolios  will make  available to the Funds
investors  information  relating to the size and  composition of their portfolio
for the purpose of providing Fund shareholders with this information.

INVESTMENT BY SHAREHOLDERS THAT ARE CREDIT UNIONS - DAILY ASSETS GOVERNMENT FUND
AND DAILY ASSETS TREASURY OBLIGATIONS FUND

Treasury Cash Portfolio and Government Cash Portfolio limit their investments to
investments that are legally  permissible for Federally  chartered credit unions
under applicable provisions of the Federal Credit Union Act (including 12 U.S.C.
Section  1757(7),  (8) and (15)) and the applicable rules and regulations of the
National Credit Union  Administration  (including 12 C.F.R. Part 703, Investment
and Deposit  Activities),  as such  statutes  and rules and  regulations  may be
amended.  The Portfolios limit their investments to U.S.  Government  Securities
(including  Treasury STRIPS) and repurchase  agreements fully  collateralized by
U.S.  Government  Securities.  Certain  U.S.  Government  Securities  owned by a
Portfolio may be mortgage or asset backed,  but,  except to reduce interest rate
risk, no such security will be (i) a stripped mortgage backed security ("SMBS"),
(ii) a  collateralized  mortgage  obligation  ("CMO")  or real  estate  mortgage
investment  conduit  ("REMIC") that meets any of the tests outlined in 12 C.F.R.
Section  703.5(g) or (iii) a residual  interest  in a CMO or REMIC.  In order to
reduce  interest rate risk, the  Portfolios  may purchase a SMBS,  CMO, REMIC or
residual  interest  in a CMO or REMIC  but  only in  accordance  with 12  C.F.R.
Section 703.5(i).  Treasury Cash Portfolio and Government Cash Portfolio have no
current intention to make any such investment. The Portfolios also may invest in
reverse  repurchase  agreements  in  accordance  with 12 C.F.R.  703.4(e) to the
extent otherwise permitted hereunder and in the Prospectus.

INVESTMENTS  BY  SHAREHOLDERS  THAT  ARE  SAVINGS  ASSOCIATIONS  - DAILY  ASSETS
TREASURY OBLIGATIONS FUND AND DAILY ASSETS GOVERNMENT PORTFOLIO

Treasury Cash Portfolio and Government Cash Portfolio limit their investments to
investments  that  are  legally  permissible  for  Federally  chartered  savings
associations  without limit as to percentage under applicable  provisions of the
Home Owners' Loan Act  (including  12 U.S.C.  Section  1464) and the  applicable
rules and regulations of the Office of Thrift Supervision,  as such statutes and
rules and regulations may be amended.  In addition,  the Portfolios  limit their
investments  to  investments  that are  permissible  for an open-end  investment
company to hold and would permit shares of the investment  company to qualify as
liquid assets under 12 C.F.R.  Section 566.1(g) and as short-term  liquid assets
under 12 C.F.R. Section 566.1(h). These policies may be amended only by approval
of a Portfolio's or Fund's shareholders, as applicable.

                                       11
<PAGE>

5.  PERFORMANCE DATA

For a listing of certain performance data as of August 31, 1997, see Appendix B.

YIELD INFORMATION

Each  Fund  may  provide  current  annualized  and  effective  annualized  yield
quotations  for each class based on its daily  dividends.  These  quotations may
from  time  to time be used in  advertisements,  shareholder  reports  or  other
communications to shareholders.  All performance  information supplied by a Fund
is historical and is not intended to indicate future returns.

In  performance  advertising  the Funds  may  compare  any of their  performance
information  with data published by independent  evaluators such as Morningstar,
Lipper Analytical  Services,  Inc.,  IBC/Donoghue,  Inc. or  CDA/Wiesenberger or
other companies which track the investment  performance of investment  companies
("Fund Tracking Companies"). The Funds may also compare any of their performance
information  with the performance of recognized  stock,  bond and other indices.
The Funds may also refer in such materials to mutual fund  performance  rankings
and other data published by Fund Tracking Companies. Performance advertising may
also refer to discussions of a Fund and comparative mutual fund data and ratings
reported in independent periodicals, such as newspapers and financial magazines.

Any current yield  quotation of a class of a Fund which is used in such a manner
as to be subject to the  provisions of Rule 482(d) under the  Securities  Act of
1933, as amended,  shall consist of an annualized  historical yield,  carried at
least  to  the  nearest   hundredth  of  one   percent,   based  on  a  specific
seven-calendar-day  period and shall be  calculated  by dividing  the net change
during the seven-day  period in the value of an account  having a balance of one
share  at the  beginning  of the  period  by the  value  of the  account  at the
beginning  of the  period,  and  multiplying  the  quotient  by 365/7.  For this
purpose,  the net change in account  value would reflect the value of additional
shares  purchased  with  dividends  declared on the original share and dividends
declared on both the original share and any such  additional  shares,  but would
not reflect any  realized  gains or losses  from the sale of  securities  or any
unrealized  appreciation or depreciation on portfolio  securities.  In addition,
any effective  annualized  yield quotation used by a Fund shall be calculated by
compounding  the  current  yield  quotation  for such  period by adding 1 to the
product,  raising the sum to a power equal to 365/7,  and subtracting 1 from the
result.

Although  published  yield  information  is useful to  investors  in reviewing a
class' performance,  investors should be aware that each Fund's yield fluctuates
from  day to day and  that the  class'  yield  for any  given  period  is not an
indication or  representation by the Fund of future yields or rates of return on
the Fund's shares.  Also,  Participating  Organizations (as that term is used in
the  Prospectus)  may charge their  customers  direct fees in connection with an
investment  in a Fund,  which  will have the effect of  reducing  the class' net
yield to those shareholders.  The yields of a class are not fixed or guaranteed,
and an investment in the Fund is not insured or guaranteed.  Accordingly,  yield
information  may not  necessarily  be used to  compare  shares  of the Fund with
investment  alternatives  which, like money market instruments or bank accounts,
may provide a fixed rate of interest.  Also, it may not be appropriate  directly
to compare a Fund's  yield  information  to similar  information  of  investment
alternatives which are insured or guaranteed.

Income  calculated  for the purpose of  determining  a class' yield differs from
income as determined  for other  accounting  purposes.  Because of the different
accounting  methods  used,  and  because  of the  compounding  assumed  in yield
calculations,  the  yield  quoted  for a  class  may  differ  from  the  rate of
distribution  the class paid over the same period or the rate of income reported
in the Fund's financial statements.

OTHER PERFORMANCE AND SALES LITERATURE MATTERS

Total returns quoted in sales literature reflect all aspects of a Fund's return,
including the effect of  reinvesting  dividends and capital gain  distributions.
Average  annual returns  generally are  calculated by determining  the growth or
decline in value of a hypothetical historical investment in a Fund over a stated
period, and then calculating the 


                                       12
<PAGE>

annually compounded  percentage rate that would have produced the same result if
the rate of growth or decline in value had been constant over the period.  While
average  annual  returns  are  a  convenient   means  of  comparing   investment
alternatives, investors should realize that the performance is not constant over
time but changes from year to year, and that average  annual  returns  represent
averaged figures as opposed to the actual year-to-year performance of the Funds.

Average  annual  total  return is  calculated  by  finding  the  average  annual
compounded  rates of  return of a  hypothetical  investment  over  such  periods
according to the following formula:

         P(1+T)n = ERV

         Where:
                  P = a  hypothetical  initial  payment  of  $1,000
                  T = average annual total return 
                  n = number of years
                  ERV = ending redeemable value: ERV is the value, at the end of
                  the applicable  period, of a hypothetical  $1,000 payment made
                  at the beginning of the applicable period.

OTHER ADVERTISING MATTERS

The Funds may advertise other forms of performance.  For example, average annual
and  cumulative  total  returns  may be  quoted as a  percentage  or as a dollar
amount, and may be calculated for a single investment,  a series of investments,
and/or a series of redemptions over any time period. Total returns may be broken
down into their  components of income and capital  (including  capital gains and
changes  in share  price)  in order to  illustrate  the  relationship  of the se
factors and their contributions to total return. Any performance information may
be presented numerically or in a table, graph or similar illustration.

A Fund may also include various information in its  advertisements.  Information
included in the Fund's  advertisements  may include,  but is not limited to: (i)
the Fund's (or the  Fund's  corresponding  Portfolios)  portfolio  holdings  and
portfolio  allocation as of certain dates, such as portfolio  diversification by
instrument  type,  by  instrument  or by  maturity,  (ii)  descriptions  of  the
portfolio  managers of the Fund or the Fund's  corresponding  Portfolio  and the
portfolio  management  staff of the  Adviser  or  summaries  of the views of the
portfolio managers with respect to the financial markets, (iii) the results of a
hypothetical  investment  in a Fund over a given number of years,  including the
amount that the investment  would be at the end of the period,  (iv) the effects
of earning  Federally and, if applicable,  state tax-exempt income from the Fund
or investing in a tax-deferred account, such as an individual retirement account
and (v) the net asset value,  net assets or number of  shareholders of a Fund as
of one or more dates.

In connection with its advertisements a Fund may provide "shareholders' letters"
which  serve to provide  shareholders  or  investors  an  introduction  into the
Fund's, the Portfolio's,  the Trust's, the Core Trust's or any of the Trust's or
the Core Trust's service providers' policies or business practices.

6.  MANAGEMENT

TRUSTEES AND OFFICERS OF THE TRUST

The trustees and officers of the Trust and their  principal  occupations  during
the past five years are set forth  below.  Each  Trustee  who is an  "interested
person" (as defined by the 1940 Act) of the Trust is indicated by an asterisk.

John Y. Keffer,* Chairman and President (age 56)

     President  and  Director,  Forum  Financial  Services,  Inc. (a  registered
     broker-dealer),   Forum  Administrative   Services,   LLC  (a  mutual  fund
     administrator),  Forum  Financial  Corp. (a registered  transfer agent) and
     Forum Advisors,  Inc. (a registered  investment  adviser).  Mr. Keffer is a
     Trustee and/or officer of various 


                                       13
<PAGE>

     registered  investment companies for which Forum  Administrative  Services,
     LLC  serves as  manager  or  administrator  and for which  Forum  Financial
     Services,  Inc. serves as manager,  administrator  and/or distributor.  His
     address is Two Portland Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

Costas Azariadis, Trustee (age 53)

     Professor of Economics,  University of California,  Los Angeles, since July
     1992.  Prior  thereto,  Dr.  Azariadis  was  Professor  of Economics at the
     University  of  Pennsylvania.  His  address  is  Department  of  Economics,
     University of California,  Los Angeles,  405 Hilgard  Avenue,  Los Angeles,
     California 90024.

James C. Cheng, Trustee (age 54)

     President  of  Technology  Marketing  Associates  (a  marketing  consulting
     company) since September 1991.  Prior thereto,  Mr. Cheng was President and
     Chief  Executive  Officer of Network  Dynamics,  Incorporated  (a  software
     development   company).   His  address  is  27  Temple   Street,   Belmont,
     Massachusetts 02178.

J. Michael Parish, Trustee (age 53)

     Partner at the law firm of Reid and Priest, LLP, since 1995. Prior thereto,
     he was a partner at the law firm of Winthrop  Stimson Putnam & Roberts from
     1989 to 1995 and was a partner at LeBoeuf, Lamb, Leiby & MacRae, a law firm
     of which he was a member from 1974 to 1989.  His address is 40 Wall Street,
     New York, New York 10005.

Mark D. Kaplan, Vice President, Assistant Treasurer and Assistant Secretary (age
42)

     Managing Director at Forum Financial  Services,  Inc. since September 1995.
     Prior thereto, Mr. Kaplan was Managing Director and Director of Research at
     H.M.  Payson & Co. His  address is Two  Portland  Square,  Portland,  Maine
     04101.

David I. Goldstein, Secretary (age 36)

     Counsel, Forum Financial Services,  Inc., with which he has been associated
     since 1991.  Prior thereto,  Mr. Goldstein was associated with the law firm
     of  Kirkpatrick & Lockhart.  Mr.  Goldstein is also  Secretary or Assistant
     Secretary  of  various  registered  investment  companies  for which  Forum
     Administrative  Services,  LLC or Forum Financial Services,  Inc. serves as
     manager,  administrator  and/or  distributor.  His address is Two  Portland
     Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

Max Berueffy, Assistant Secretary (age 46)

     Counsel, Forum Financial Services,  Inc., with which he has been associated
     since  1994.  Prior  thereto,  Mr.  Berueffy  was on the  staff of the U.S.
     Securities and Exchange  Commission for seven years, first in the appellate
     branch  of  the  Office  of the  General  Counsel,  then  as a  counsel  to
     Commissioner  Grundfest  and  finally  as a senior  special  counsel in the
     Division  of  Investment  Management.  Mr.  Berueffy is also  Secretary  or
     Assistant  Secretary of various registered  investment  companies for which
     Forum Administrative Services, LLC or Forum Financial Services, Inc. serves
     as manager,  administrator and/or distributor.  His address is Two Portland
     Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

Cheryl O. Tumlin, Assistant Secretary (age 31)

     Assistant Counsel, Forum Financial Services,  Inc., with which she has been
     associated since July 1996.  Prior thereto,  Ms. Tumlin was on the staff of
     the U.S.  Securities and Exchange Commission as an attorney in the Division
     of Market Regulation and prior thereto Ms. Tumlin was an associate with the
     law firm of Robinson  Silverman  Pearce  Aronsohn & Berman in New York, New
     York.  Ms.  Tumlin  is  also  Assistant  Secretary  of  various  registered
     investment companies for which Forum Administrative  Services, LLC or



                                       14
<PAGE>

     Forum  Financial  Services,  Inc. serves as manager,  administrator  and/or
     distributor. Her address is Two Portland Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

TRUSTEES AND OFFICERS OF CORE TRUST

The Trustees and officers of Core Trust and their principal  occupations  during
the past five years are set forth  below.  Each of the  Trustees of the Trust is
also a Trustee of Core Trust and several officers of the Trust serve as officers
of Core Trust . Each  Trustee who is an  "interested  person" (as defined by the
1940 Act) of Core Trust is indicated by an asterisk. Accordingly, for background
information  pertaining  to the Trustees and these  officers,  see "Trustees and
Officers of the Trust" above.

John Y. Keffer,* Chairman and President.

Costas Azariadis, Trustee.

James C. Cheng, Trustee.

J. Michael Parish, Trustee.

David I. Goldstein, Secretary

Thomas G. Sheehan, Vice President and Assistant Secretary (age 42)

     Counsel, Forum Financial Services, Inc. since October, 1993. Prior thereto,
     Mr. Sheehan was a Special Counsel in the Division of Investment  Management
     of the U.S.  Securities  and Exchange  Commission in  Washington,  D.C. His
     address is Two Portland Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

Sara M. Clark, Vice President, Assistant Secretary and Treasurer (age 33).

     Managing Director,  Forum Financial Services, Inc., with which she has been
     associated  since  1994.  Prior  thereto,  from 1991 to 1994 Ms.  Clark was
     Controller of Wright Express  Corporation (a national  credit card company)
     and for six years prior thereto was employed at Deloitte & Touche LLP as an
     accountant.  Ms. Clark is also an officer of various registered  investment
     companies  for which  Forum  Financial  Services,  Inc.  serves as manager,
     administrator  and/or  distributor.  Her  address is Two  Portland  Square,
     Portland, Maine 04101.

TRUSTEE COMPENSATION

THE TRUST.  Each  Trustee of the Trust  (other  than John Y.  Keffer,  who is an
interested  person of the Trust) is paid $1,000 for each Board meeting  attended
(whether in person or by electronic communication) and $1,000 for each committee
meeting  attended  on a date when a Board  meeting is not held.  As of March 31,
1997, in addition to the $1,000 for each Board meeting attended, each Trustee is
paid $100 per active  portfolio of the Trust. To the extent a meeting relates to
only certain  portfolios of the Trust,  Trustees are paid the $100 fee only with
respect to those portfolios. Trustees are also reimbursed for travel and related
expenses incurred in attending meetings of the Board. No officer of the Trust is
compensated by the Trust.

The following  table provides the aggregate  compensation  paid to each Trustee.
The Trust has not  adopted  any form of  retirement  plan  covering  Trustees or
officers.  Information  is presented for the period April 1, 1997 through August
31, 1997.



                                       15
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
         <S>                            <C>                 <C>              <C>               <C>
                                                           ACCRUED           ANNUAL
                                        AGGREGATE          PENSION        BENEFITS UPON        TOTAL
         TRUSTEE                      COMPENSATION        BENEFITS         RETIREMENT      COMPENSATION
         -------                      ------------        --------         ----------      ------------
         Mr. Keffer                       None              None              None             None
         Mr. Azariadis                   $1,000             None              None            $1,000
         Mr. Cheng                       $1,000             None              None            $1,000
         Mr. Parish                      $1,000             None              None            $1,000
</TABLE>

CORE TRUST.  Each of the  Trustees of the Trust is also a Trustee of Core Trust.
Each  Trustee of Core Trust  (other than John Y.  Keffer,  who is an  interested
person of Core Trust) is paid $1,000 for each Core Trust Board meeting  attended
(whether  in  person  or by  electronic  communication)  plus  $100  per  active
portfolio of Core Trust and is paid $1,000 for each committee  meeting  attended
on a date when a Core Trust Board  meeting is not held.  To the extent a meeting
relates to only certain portfolios of Core Trust, trustees are paid the $100 fee
only with respect to those  portfolios.  Core Trust trustees are also reimbursed
for travel and related expenses incurred in attending meetings of the Core Trust
Board.  For the fiscal year of the Portfolios  ended August 31, 1997,  each Core
Trust trustee received fees totalling $2,238.

INVESTMENT ADVISERS

Forum  Investment  Advisors,  LLC,  the  investment  adviser to each  Portfolio,
furnishes to the  Portfolios  at its own expense all  services,  facilities  and
personnel necessary in connection with managing the Portfolios'  investments and
effecting portfolio  transactions for the Portfolios,  pursuant to an investment
advisory agreement between the Adviser and Core Trust (an "Advisory Agreement").
The Advisory Agreement provides, with respect to each Portfolio,  for an initial
term of one year from its effective  date and for its  continuance in effect for
successive  twelve-month periods thereafter,  provided the Advisory Agreement is
specifically  approved  at least  annually by the Core Trust Board or by vote of
the  shareholders  of the  Portfolios,  and in either  case by a majority of the
Trustees who are not parties to the Advisory  Agreement or interested persons of
any such party.

Prior to January 2, 1998,  Linden Asset  Management,  Inc.  ("Linden") served as
investment  adviser to Treasury Cash  Portfolio,  Government  Cash Portfolio and
Cash  Portfolio,  and Forum  Advisors,  Inc.  served as  investment  adviser  to
Treasury Portfolio and Municipal Cash Portfolio. Linden and Forum Advisors, Inc.
also acted as investment  subadvisors to each Portfolio that they did not manage
on a daily basis. On January 2, 1998, Forum Advisors,  Inc.  acquired Linden and
reorganized  into a new company  named Forum  Investment  Advisors,  LLC.  These
transactions have not effected any change in advisory staff, portfolio managers,
or advisory fees, or any other material change.

Table 1 in Appendix C shows the dollar amount of fees paid under the invesmtment
advisory  agreements  between  Core Trust and Linden and between  Core Trust and
Forum Advisors, Inc., as applicable, with respect to each Portfolio or, prior to
Daily Assets Treasury Fund investing in Treasury Portfolio, the dollar amount of
fees paid under the Investment  Advisory  Agreement  between the Trust and Forum
Advisors,  Inc. with respect to the Fund.  This  information is provided for the
past three years (or shorter time a Portfolio has been operational).

The Advisory  Agreement is terminable without penalty by Core Trust with respect
to the Portfolio on 60 days' written  notice when  authorized  either by vote of
the Portfolio's shareholders or by a vote of a majority of the Core Trust Board,
or by the  Adviser  on not more  than 60 days'  nor less  than 30 days'  written
notice,  and will  automatically  terminate in the event of its assignment.  The
Advisory  Agreement  also  provides  that,  with respect to the  Portfolio,  the
Adviser  shall not be liable for any error of  judgment or mistake of law or for
any act or omission in the  performance of its duties to the  Portfolio,  except
for willful misfeasance, bad faith or gross negligence in the performance of the
Adviser's  duties or by reason of  reckless  disregard  of its  obligations  and
duties under the Advisory  Agreement.  The Advisory  Agreement provides that the
Adviser may render services to others.

For its  services,  the Adviser  receives  an advisory  fee at an annual rate of
0.05% of Treasury  Portfolio's and Municipal Cash Portfolio's  average daily net
assets For  services  provided  to  Treasury  Cash  Portfolio,  Government  Cash
Portfolio and Cash  Portfolio,  the Adviser  receives an advisory fee based upon
the  total  average  daily  net  assets of those  Portfolios 


                                       16
<PAGE>

("Total Portfolio Assets"). The Adviser's fee is calculated at an annual rate on
a  cumulative  basis  as  follows:  0.06% of the  first  $200  million  of Total
Portfolio Assets,  0.04% of the next $300 million of Total Portfolio Assets, and
0.03% of the remaining Total  Portfolio  Assets.  A Fund's expenses  include the
Fund's pro rata portion of the advisory fee paid by the corresponding Portfolio.

In  addition to  receiving  an advisory  fee from a  Portfolio  it advises,  the
Adviser may also act and be  compensated  as investment  manager for its clients
with respect to assets which are invested in the  Portfolio.  In some  instances
the Adviser may elect to credit against any  investment  management fee received
from a client who is also a shareholder  in the Portfolio an amount equal to all
or a portion of the fees received by the Adviser or any affiliate of the Adviser
from  the  Portfolio  with  respect  to  the  client's  assets  invested  in the
Portfolio.

The Adviser has agreed, with respect to each portfolio,  to reimburse Core Trust
for certain of the Portfolios' operating expenses (exclusive of interest, taxes,
brokerage,  fees and  organization  expenses,  all to the  extent  permitted  by
applicable  state  law or  regulation)  which  in any  year  exceed  the  limits
prescribed by any state in which the Portfolios' shares are qualified for sale.

Subject  to the  above  obligations  to  reimburse  Core  Trust  for its  excess
expenses,  Core Trust and the Trust have confirmed their respective  obligations
to pay all their other expenses,  including:  interest charges, taxes, brokerage
fees and commissions;  certain insurance  premiums;  fees,  interest charges and
expenses  of the  custodian,  transfer  agent  and  dividend  disbursing  agent;
telecommunications  expenses;  auditing, legal and compliance expenses; costs of
forming the corporation and maintaining corporate existence;  costs of preparing
and printing the Trust's  prospectuses,  statements of  additional  information,
account  application  forms  and  shareholder  reports  and  delivering  them to
existing and prospective  shareholders;  costs of maintaining  books of original
entry for portfolio and fund  accounting  and other  required books and accounts
and of  calculating  the net asset  value of shares of Core Trust and the Trust;
costs of  reproduction,  stationery  and  supplies;  compensation  of  Trustees,
officers and employees of Core and costs of other personnel  performing services
for Core Trust and the Trust who are not officers of an Adviser, the manager and
distributor or their respective  affiliates;  costs of corporate  meetings;  SEC
registration fees and related expenses;  state securities laws registration fees
and  related  expenses;  and fees  payable  to the  Adviser  under the  Advisory
Agreement.

Anthony R. Fischer, Jr.,is primarily responsible for the day-to-day managment of
the Portfolios.  Mr. Fischer was the sole  stockholder,  director and officer of
Linden from 1992 until its  acquisition  by the Adviser.  He has been  primarily
responsible for the day-to-day managment of Treasury Cash Portfolio,  Government
Cash Portfolio and Cash Portfolio  since their  inception.  Mr. Fischer has over
twenty-five  years  experience in the money market  industry.  From 1984 through
1989,  Mr.  Fischer  served as Senior Vice  President  and  Treasurer  of United
California Savings Bank, Santa Ana, California,  and prior thereto, as a Manager
for five years at PaineWebber Jackson & Curtis, New York, New York.

ADMINISTRATION

Table 2 in  Appendix C shows the dollar  amount of fees paid for  administrative
services by the Funds and the Portfolios.  This  information is provided for the
past three years (or shorter time a Portfolio has been operational).

THE TRUST.  Pursuant to an administration  agreement (the "Trust  Administration
Agreement"), FAS supervises the overall management of the Trust (which includes,
among  other  responsibilities,  negotiation  of  contracts  and fees with,  and
monitoring of  performance  and billing of, the transfer agent and custodian and
arranging  for  maintenance  of books and records of the Trust) and provides the
Trust with general office facilities.  The Trust Administration Agreement may be
terminated  by either party without  penalty on 60 days' written  notice and may
not be  assigned  except  upon  written  consent  by  both  parties.  The  Trust
Administration  Agreement  also  provides  that FAS shall not be liable  for any
error  of  judgment  or  mistake  of law  or for  any  act  or  omission  in the
administration or management of the Trust, except for willful  misfeasance,  bad
faith or gross  negligence  in the  performance  of FAS's duties or by reason of
reckless disregard of its obligations and duties under the Trust  Administration
Agreement.  Prior to June 19, 1997, FFSI provided administration services to the
Trust.

                                       17
<PAGE>

FAS  provides  persons  satisfactory  to the Board to serve as  officers  of the
Trust.  Those  officers,  as well as certain other employees and Trustees of the
Trust, may be Trustees, officers or employees of (and persons providing services
to the Trust may include)  FAS,  FFSI,  their  affiliates  or  affiliates of the
Adviser.

CORE TRUST.  Pursuant to a management agreement with Core Trust (the "Core Trust
Management  Agreement"),  FAS  supervises  the overall  management of Core Trust
(which includes, among other responsibilities, negotiation of contracts and fees
with, and monitoring of performance  and billing of, the custodian and arranging
for maintenance of books and records of Core Trust) and provides Core Trust with
general office facilities.  The Core Trust Management  Agreement provides,  with
respect to the  Portfolios,  for an initial term of one year from its  effective
date and for its  continuance  in effect  for  successive  twelve-month  periods
thereafter, provided the agreement is specifically approved at least annually by
the Core Trust Board or by the  shareholders  of the  Portfolios,  and in either
case by a  majority  of the  Trustees  who are not  parties  to the  Core  Trust
Management  Agreement or interested persons of any such party. Prior to November
15, 1997, FFSI provided administration services to Core Trust.

The Core Trust Management Agreement  terminates  automatically if it is assigned
and may be terminated without penalty with respect to the Portfolio by vote of a
Portfolio's shareholders or by either party on 60 days' written notice. The Core
Trust  Management  Agreement also provides that FFSI shall not be liable for any
error  of  judgment  or  mistake  of law  or for  any  act  or  omission  in the
administration or management of Core Trust, except for willful misfeasance,  bad
faith or gross  negligence in the  performance of Forum's duties or by reason of
reckless disregard of its obligations and duties under the Core Trust Management
Agreement.

Athe request of the Core Trust Board, FAS provides  persons  satisfactory to the
Core Trust Board to serve as officers of Core Trust.

DISTRIBUTION

FFSI was  incorporated  under the laws of the State of  Delaware  on February 7,
1986 and  serves  as  distributor  of  shares  of the  Portfolio  pursuant  to a
Distribution  Agreement  between  FFSI and the Trust  (the  "Trust  Distribution
Agreement").  The Trust Distribution  Agreement  provides,  with respect to each
Fund,  for an  initial  term of one  year  from its  effective  date and for its
continuance in effect for successive  twelve-month periods thereafter,  provided
the Trust Distribution  Agreement is specifically  approved at least annually by
the Board or by the  shareholders  of the Fund, and in either case by a majority
of the  Trustees  who are not  parties to the Trust  Distribution  Agreement  or
interested persons of any such party.

The Trust Distribution Agreement terminates  automatically if it is assigned and
may be  terminated  without  penalty  with  respect  to each Fund by vote of the
Fund's  shareholders  or by either party on 60 days' written  notice.  The Trust
Distribution Agreement also provides that FFSI shall not be liable for any error
of judgment or mistake of law or for any act or omission in the  performance  of
services  to the  Trust,  except  for  willful  misfeasance,  bad faith or gross
negligence  in the  performance  of  FFSI's  duties  or by  reason  of  reckless
disregard of its obligations and duties under the Trust Distribution Agreement.

With  respect  to any class  that has  adopted a  distribution  plan,  the Trust
Distribution  Agreement is also  terminable upon similar notice by a majority of
the  Trustees who (i) are not  interested  persons of the Trust and (ii) have no
direct or indirect financial interest in the operation of that distribution plan
or in the Trust Distribution Agreement ("Qualified Trustees").

FFSI acts as sole  placement  agent for interests in the Portfolios and receives
no compensation for those services from the portfolios.

INVESTOR CLASS  DISTRIBUTION  PLAN. In accordance with Rule 12b-1 under the 1940
Act,  with  respect  to the  Investor  Class of each Fund,  the Trust  adopted a
distribution  plan (the "Investor Class Plan") which provides for the payment to
Forum of a Rule 12b-1 fee at the annual rate of 0.15% of the  average  daily net
assets of the Investor class of each Fund as compensation  for Forum's  services
as distributor.

                                       18
<PAGE>

The Investor  Class Plan provides that all written  agreements  relating to that
plan must be  approved  by the  Board,  including  a majority  of the  Qualified
Trustees.  In  addition,  the Investor  Class Plan (as well as the  Distribution
Agreement)  requires the Trust and Forum to prepare and submit to the Board,  at
least  quarterly,  and the Board will review,  written reports setting forth all
amounts  expended under the Investor Class Plan and  identifying  the activities
for which those expenditures were made.

The Investor Class Plan provides that it will remain in effect for one year from
the date of its adoption and thereafter  shall continue in effect provided it is
approved at least  annually  by the  shareholders  or by the Board,  including a
majority of the Qualified  Trustees.  The Investor  Class Plan further  provides
that it may not be amended to increase  materially  the costs which may be borne
by the Trust for  distribution  pursuant  to the  Investor  Class  Plan  without
shareholder  approval and that other  material  amendments of the Investor Class
Plan must be approved by the Qualified Trustees.  The Investor Class Plan may be
terminated at any time by the Board, by a majority of the Qualified Trustees, or
by a Fund's Investor class shareholders.

Table 3 in Appendix C shows the dollar amount of fees payable under the Investor
Class Plan with respect to each Fund. This  information is provided for the past
three years (or shorter time a Fund has been operational).

TRANSFER AGENT

Forum Financial Corp.  ("FFC") acts as transfer agent of the Trust pursuant to a
transfer agency agreement with the Trust (the "Transfer Agency Agreement").  The
Transfer Agency  Agreement  provides,  with respect to the Funds, for an initial
term of one year from its effective  date and for its  continuance in effect for
successive  twelve-month  periods thereafter,  provided that the Transfer Agency
Agreement is  specifically  approved at least annually by the Board or by a vote
of the  shareholders  of each  Fund,  and in either  case by a  majority  of the
Trustees who are not parties to the  Transfer  Agency  Agreement  or  interested
persons of any such party at a meeting  called for the  purpose of voting on the
Transfer Agency Agreement.

Among the  responsibilities  of FFC as  transfer  agent for the Trust  are:  (1)
answering customer inquiries regarding account status and history, the manner in
which  purchases  and  redemptions  of shares of each Fund may be  effected  and
certain other matters  pertaining to each Fund;  (2) assisting  shareholders  in
initiating  and changing  account  designations  and  addresses;  (3)  providing
necessary  personnel  and  facilities  to  establish  and  maintain  shareholder
accounts  and  records,   assisting  in  processing   purchase  and   redemption
transactions  and receiving wired funds; (4) transmitting and receiving funds in
connection  with  customer  orders to purchase or redeem  shares;  (5) verifying
shareholder  signatures  in  connection  with  changes  in the  registration  of
shareholder  accounts;  (6) furnishing  periodic statements and confirmations of
purchases  and  redemptions;   (7)  arranging  for  the  transmission  of  proxy
statements, annual reports, prospectuses and other communications from the Trust
to its shareholders;  (8) arranging for the receipt, tabulation and transmission
to the Trust of proxies  executed by  shareholders  with  respect to meetings of
shareholders of the Trust;  and (9) providing such other related services as the
Trust or a shareholder may reasonably request.

FFC or any  sub-transfer  agent or  processing  agent  may also act and  receive
compensation as custodian,  investment manager,  nominee, agent or fiduciary for
its customers or clients who are  shareholders  of a Fund with respect to assets
invested in that Fund. FFC or any  sub-transfer  agent or other processing agent
may elect to credit  against the fees  payable to it by its clients or customers
all or a portion of any fee received  from the Trust or from the Transfer  Agent
with respect to assets of those customers or clients  invested in the Portfolio.
FFC, FAS or sub-transfer  agents or processing agents retained by the FFC may be
Processing  Organizations  (as  defined in the  Prospectus)  and, in the case of
sub-transfer  agents or processing agents, may also be affiliated persons of FFC
or FAS.

For its services under the Transfer Agency Agreement, FFC receives an annual fee
from each Fund of (i) 0.02% of each Fund's average daily net assets attributable
to  institutional  Shares  and 0.25% of each  Fund's  average  daily net  assets
attributable to  Institutional  Service Shares and Investor Shares (computed and
paid monthly in arrears by the Fund),  (ii) $12,000 per year  (computed and paid
monthly in arrears by the Fund) and (iii)  Annual  Shareholder  Account  Fees of
$125 per shareholder account in Institutional  Shares and $18.00 per shareholder
account in Institutional  Service Shares and Investor Shares (computed as of the
last business day of the prior month).

                                       19
<PAGE>

Table 4 in Appendix C shows the dollar  amount of fees paid for transfer  agency
services by the Funds. This information is provided for the past three years (or
shorter time a Fund has been operational).

SHAREHOLDER SERVICE PLAN AND AGREEMENTS

The Trust has adopted a shareholder  service plan  ("Shareholder  Service Plan")
with respect to the  Institutional  Service class and the Investor class of each
Fund which provides that Forum may obtain the services of financial institutions
to act as shareholder  servicing  agents for their  customers  invested in those
classes. The Shareholder Service Plan was effective on November 15, 1997 for the
Institutional Service class of those Funds then operating.

The Shareholder  Service Plan provides that all written  agreements  relating to
that plan must be approved by the Board,  including a majority of the  Qualified
Trustees.  In  addition,  the  Shareholder  Service Plan (as well as the various
shareholder  service  agreements)  requires  the Trust and Forum to prepare  and
submit to the  Board,  at least  quarterly,  and the Board will  review  written
reports  setting forth all amounts  expended under the plan and  identifying the
activities for which those expenditures were made.

The Shareholder Service Plan provides that it will remain in effect for one year
from the date of its adoption and thereafter  shall continue in effect  provided
it is  approved  at least  annually  by the  shareholders  or by the Board.  The
Shareholder  Service Plan further provides material  amendments of the plan must
be approved by the  Qualified  Trustees.  The  Shareholder  Service  Plan may be
terminated at any time by the Board or by a majority of the Qualified Trustees.

The  Trust  may  enter  into  shareholder   servicing  agreements  with  various
Shareholder  Servicing Agents pursuant to which those agents, as agent for their
customers,  may agree among other  things to: (i) answer  shareholder  inquiries
regarding the manner in which purchases,  exchanges and redemptions of shares of
the Trust may be effected and other matters  pertaining to the Trust's services;
(ii) provide  necessary  personnel  and  facilities  to  establish  and maintain
shareholder  accounts and records;  (iii) assist  shareholders  in arranging for
processing purchase, exchange and redemption transactions;  (iv) arrange for the
wiring of  funds;  (v)  guarantee  shareholder  signatures  in  connection  with
redemption orders and transfers and changes in shareholder-designated  accounts;
(vi) integrate  periodic  statements with other  shareholder  transactions;  and
(vii) provide such other related services as the shareholder may request.

As  Participating  Organizations,  some  Shareholder  Servicing  Agents also may
impose  certain  conditions  on their  customers,  subject  to the  terms of the
Trust's Prospectus, in addition to or different from those imposed by the Trust,
such as requiring a minimum initial  investment or by charging their customers a
direct fee for their services.  Some  Shareholder  Servicing Agents may also act
and receive compensation for acting as custodian,  investment manager,  nominee,
agent or  fiduciary  for its  customers or clients who are  shareholders  of the
Funds with respect to assets invested in the Funds. These Shareholder  Servicing
Agents may elect to credit  against  the fees  payable  to it by its  clients or
customers  all or a portion of any fee  received  from the Trust with respect to
assets of those customers or clients invested in the Funds.

Table 4 in  Appendix  C shows  the  dollar  amount  of fees  payable  under  the
Shareholder  Service  Plan with  respect  to  Institutional  Service  Shares and
Investor Shares of each Fund.

FUND ACCOUNTING

Pursuant  to a  Fund  Accounting  Agreement,  Forum  Accounting  Services,  LLC.
provides the Funds with  accounting  services,  including the calculation of the
Fund's net asset value.  For these services,  Forum  Accounting  Services,  LLC.
receives an annual fee ranging from $12,000 to $36,000 depending upon the number
of  securities  in which the Fund invests and the number of classes in the Fund.
Pursuant  to a Fund  Accounting  Agreement  with Core  Trust,  Forum  Accounting
Services,  LLC. also provides portfolio  accounting  services to each Portfolio,
including  the  calculation  of each  Portfolio's  net  asset  value.  For these
services,  Forum Accounting Services, LLC. receives an annual fee of $48,000 per
year plus surcharges  depending upon the amount and type of the Fund's portfolio

                                       20
<PAGE>

transactions and positions. The Fee for Treasury Cash Portfolio, Government Cash
Portfolo  and Cash  Portfolio  is the lesser of 0.05% of the  average  daily net
assets of the Portfolios or $48,000 plus, for each investor in a Portfolio above
one (excluding FFSI and its affiliates), $6,000 per year.

Forum Accounting Services,  LLC is required to use its best judgment and efforts
in rendering fund accounting services and is not be liable to Core Trust for any
action or  inaction  in the absence of bad faith,  willful  misconduct  or gross
negligence.  Forum Accounting Services, LLC is not responsible or liable for any
failure or delay in performance of its fund accounting  obligations  arising out
of or caused,  directly or indirectly,  by  circumstances  beyond its reasonable
control  and  Core  Trust  has  agreed  to  indemnify  and hold  harmless  Forum
Accounting Services, LLC , its employees, agents, officers and directors against
and from any and all claims, demands,  actions,  suits, judgments,  liabilities,
losses, damages, costs, charges, counsel fees and other expenses of every nature
and character arising out of or in any way related to Forum Accounting Services,
LLC 's actions taken or failures to act with respect to a Portfolio or based, if
applicable,  upon  information,  instructions  or  requests  with  respect  to a
Portfolio given or made to Forum Accounting  Services,  LLC by an officer of the
Trust duly authorized.  This  indemnification does not apply to Forum Accounting
Services,  LLC's actions  taken or failures to act in cases of Forum  Accounting
Services, LLC 's own bad faith, willful misconduct or gross negligence.

Table 6 in  Appendix  C shows the  dollar  amount  of fees  paid for  accounting
services by the Funds and the Portfolios.  This  information is provided for the
past three years (or shorter time a Fund or Portfolio has been operational).

7.  DETERMINATION OF NET ASSET VALUE

The Funds do not determine net asset value on the following holidays: New Year's
Day, Martin Luther King, Jr. Day,  Presidents'  Day, Good Friday,  Memorial Day,
Independence  Day,  Labor Day,  Columbus Day,  Veterans' Day,  Thanksgiving  and
Christmas.  Purchases  and  redemptions  are  effected  at the  time of the next
determination  of net asset  value  following  the  receipt of any  purchase  or
redemption order.

Pursuant  to the rules of the SEC,  both the Board and the Core Trust Board have
established  procedures  to  stabilize  each  Fund's  and each  Portfolio's,  as
applicable,  net asset  value at $1.00 per  share.  These  procedures  include a
review of the extent of any  deviation  of net asset value per share as a result
of fluctuating interest rates, based on available market rates, from each Fund's
and  Portfolio's,  as applicable,  $1.00 amortized cost price per share.  Should
that  deviation  exceed  1/2  of  1%,  the  Board  and  the  Core  Trust  Board,
respectively,  will consider whether any action should be initiated to eliminate
or reduce material dilution or other unfair results to shareholders. Such action
may include redemption of shares in kind, selling portfolio  securities prior to
maturity,  reducing or withholding dividends and utilizing a net asset value per
share as determined by using available market quotations.

In  determining  the  approximate  market  value of portfolio  investments,  the
Portfolios may employ outside  organizations,  which may use a matrix or formula
method that takes into consideration market indices,  matrices, yield curves and
other specific adjustments.  This may result in the securities being valued at a
price different from the price that would have been determined had the matrix or
formula method not been used.  All cash,  receivables  and current  payables are
carried at their face value.

Each  investor in a  Portfolio,  including  the Funds,  may add to or reduce its
investment  in that  Portfolio  on each  business day of the  Portfolios  (which
corresponds to Fund Business  Days).  The Portfolios  maintain the same Business
Days as do the Funds.  As of the close of regular  trading on any Fund  Business
Day, the value of a Fund's  beneficial  interest in a Portfolio is determined by
multiplying  the net asset value of the Portfolio by the  percentage,  effective
for that day,  which  represents  the Fund's share of the  aggregate  beneficial
interests  in the  Portfolio.  Any  additions  or  reductions,  which  are to be
effected as of the close of the Fund Business Day, are then effected. The Fund's
percentage  of the  aggregate  beneficial  interests in the  Portfolio  are then
recomputed as the percentage equal to the fraction (i) the numerator of which is
the value of the Fund's  investment in the Portfolio as of the close of the Fund
Business Day plus or minus,  as the case may be, the amount of net  additions to
or reductions  from the Fund's  investment in the Portfolio  effected as of that
time, and (ii) the  denominator of which is the aggregate net asset value of the
Portfolio as of the close of the Fund  Business  Day plus or minus,  as the case
may be,  the  amount  of net


                                       21
<PAGE>

additions to or reductions  from the aggregate  investments  in the Portfolio by
all investors in the  Portfolio.  The  percentage  determined is then applied to
determine  the value of the Fund's  interest in the Portfolio as of the close of
the next Fund Business Day.

8.  PORTFOLIO TRANSACTIONS

Purchases  and sales of  portfolio  securities  for the  Portfolio  usually  are
principal  transactions.  Portfolio  securities are normally  purchased directly
from the issuer or from an underwriter or market maker for the securities. There
usually are no brokerage  commissions  paid for such  purchases.  Although  Core
Trust does not anticipate that the Portfolio will pay any amounts of commission,
in   the   event   the   Portfolio   pays   brokerage   commissions   or   other
transaction-related compensation, the payments may be made to broker-dealers who
pay  expenses of the  Portfolio  that it would  otherwise  be  obligated  to pay
itself.  Any  transaction  for  which  the  Portfolio  pays  transaction-related
compensation will be effected at the best price and execution available,  taking
into account the amount of any payments  made on behalf of the  Portfolio by the
broker-dealer   effecting  the  transaction.   Purchases  from  underwriters  of
portfolio  securities  include a commission or concession  paid by the issuer to
the underwriter, and purchases from dealers serving as market makers include the
spread between the bid and asked prices.

Since each Fund's and Portfolio's inception,  no brokerage fees were paid by any
Fund (during those periods of the Funds invested  directly in  securities),  nor
any Portfolio.

Allocations of  transactions  to dealers and the frequency of  transactions  are
determined  for each  Portfolio by the Advisers in their best  judgment and in a
manner  deemed to be in the best  interest  of  shareholders  of that  Portfolio
rather than by any formula.  The primary  consideration  is prompt  execution of
orders in an effective  manner and at the most favorable  price available to the
Portfolio.

Investment  decisions for the Portfolios will be made  independently  from those
for any other account or investment  company that is or may in the future become
managed by an Adviser or their respective  affiliates.  If, however, a Portfolio
and  other   investment   companies  or  accounts  managed  by  an  Adviser  are
contemporaneously  engaged in the  purchase  or sale of the same  security,  the
transactions  may be  averaged  as to  price  and  allocated  equitably  to each
account.  In some cases,  this policy might  adversely  affect the price paid or
received  by a  Portfolio  or  the  size  of the  position  obtainable  for  the
Portfolio.  In  addition,  when  purchases  or sales of the same  security for a
Portfolio  and for  other  investment  companies  managed  by an  Adviser  occur
contemporaneously,  the  purchase or sale orders may be  aggregated  in order to
obtain any price advantages available to large denomination purchases or sales.

No  portfolio  transactions  are  executed  with  the  Adviser  or  any  of  its
affiliates.

9.  ADDITIONAL PURCHASE AND REDEMPTION INFORMATION

Shares of the Funds are sold on a continuous  basis by the  distributor  without
any sales charge.

In addition to the situations  described in the Prospectus  under "Purchases and
Redemptions of Shares," the Trust may redeem shares involuntarily to reimburse a
Fund for any loss  sustained by reason of the failure of a  shareholder  to make
full payment for shares  purchased by the  shareholder  or to collect any charge
relating to  transactions  effected  for the benefit of a  shareholder  which is
applicable to a Fund's shares as provided in the Prospectus from time to time.

The Trust has filed a formal  election  with the SEC pursuant to which the Funds
will only effect a redemption  in portfolio  securities in kind if a shareholder
is redeeming more than $250,000 or 1% of the Fund's total net assets,  whichever
is less, during any 90-day period.

The Funds may wire proceeds of  redemptions  to  shareholders  that have elected
wire redemption  privileges only if the wired amount is greater than $5,000.  In
addition, the Funds will only wire redemption proceeds to financial institutions
located in the United States.

                                       22
<PAGE>

By use of the  telephone  redemption  or  exchange  privilege,  the  shareholder
authorizes  the  Transfer  Agent  to act  upon  the  instruction  of any  person
representing himself to either be, or to have the authority to act on behalf of,
the investor and  believed by the Transfer  Agent to be genuine.  The records of
the Transfer Agent of such instructions are binding.

The Transfer Agent will deem a shareholder's account "lost" if correspondence to
the  shareholder's  address of record is  returned  for six  months,  unless the
Transfer Agent  determines  the  shareholder's  new address.  When an account is
deemed lost all  distributions  on the account will be  reinvested in additional
shares of the Fund. In addition,  the amount of any outstanding  (unpaid for six
months or more) checks for distributions that have been returned to the Transfer
Agent will be reinvested and the checks will be canceled.

EXCHANGE PRIVILEGE

The  exchange  privilege  permits  shareholders  of the Funds to exchange  their
shares for shares of any Participating  Fund, which includes (i) the other Funds
and  (ii) any  other  mutual  fund for  which  Forum  or its  affiliates  act as
investment adviser, manager or distributor and which participates in the Trust's
exchange privilege program.

Exchange  transactions  are made on the basis of relative  net asset  values per
share at the time of the exchange  transaction  plus any applicable sales charge
of the Participating Fund whose shares are acquired.  Exchanges are accomplished
by  (i)  a  redemption  of  the  shares  of  the  Fund  exchanged  at  the  next
determination  of that Fund's net asset value after the exchange order in proper
form (including any necessary  supporting  documents  required by the Fund whose
shares  are  being  exchanged)  is  accepted  by the  Transfer  Agent and (ii) a
purchase of the shares of the fund  acquired at the next  determination  of that
fund's net asset  value  after (or  occurring  simultaneously  with) the time of
redemption.

Shares of any  Participating  Fund may be  exchanged  without a sales charge for
shares of any Participating Fund that are offered without a sales charge. If the
Participating  Fund  whose  shares are  purchased  in the  exchange  transaction
imposes a higher sales charge the shareholder  will be required to pay the sales
charge on the purchased  shares.  Shareholders are entitled to any reduced sales
charges of the  Participating  Fund into which they are exchanging to the extent
those reduced sales charges would be applicable to that  shareholder's  purchase
of shares.

The Funds do not charge for the  exchange  privilege  and there is  currently no
limit on the number of exchanges a shareholder  may make, but each Fund reserves
the right to limit excessive exchanges by any shareholder. A pattern of frequent
exchanges  may be  deemed  by the  Transfer  Agent  to be  contrary  to the best
interests  of the  Fund's  other  shareholders  and,  at the  discretion  of the
Transfer  Agent,  may be limited  by that  Fund's  refusal to accept  additional
exchanges from the investor.

The terms of the exchange privilege are subject to change, and the privilege may
be terminated by any Participating Fund or the Trust. However the privilege will
not be terminated, and no material change that restricts the availability of the
privilege to shareholders  will be implemented,  without 60 days' advance notice
to  shareholders.  No notice need be given of an amendment  whose only  material
effect is to reduce  amount of sales charge  required to be paid on the exchange
and no notice need be given if  redemptions of shares of a Fund are suspended or
a Fund temporarily delays or ceases the sale of its shares.

INDIVIDUAL RETIREMENT CUSTODIAL ACCOUNT

The  Funds  (other  than  Daily  Assets  Municipal  Fund)  offer  an  individual
retirement  plan (the "IRA") for individuals who wish to use shares of a Fund as
a medium for funding individual retirement savings. Under the IRA, distributions
of net investment  income and capital gain will be  automatically  reinvested in
the IRA established for the investor.  The Funds' custodian  furnishes custodial
services to the IRAs for a service fee. Shareholders wishing to invest in a Fund
through an IRA should contact the Transfer Agent for further information.


                                       23
<PAGE>

10.      TAXATION

Qualification as a regulated  investment company under the Internal Revenue Code
of 1986 does not involve  governmental  supervision  of management or investment
practices or policies. Investors should consult their own counsel for a complete
understanding  of the  requirements  the  Funds  must meet to  qualify  for such
treatment.  The  information  set  forth  in the  Prospectus  and the  following
discussion  relate solely to Federal income taxes on dividends and distributions
by each  Fund  and  assume  that  the  Funds  qualify  as  regulated  investment
companies.  Investors  should consult their own counsel for further  details and
for the  application  of state and local tax laws to the  investor's  particular
situation.

The Funds expect to derive substantially all of their gross income (exclusive of
capital gain) from sources  other than  dividends.  Accordingly,  it is expected
that  none  of the  Funds'  dividends  or  distributions  will  qualify  for the
dividends-received deduction for corporations.

If Fund shares are sold at a loss after  being held for six months or less,  the
loss will be treated as long-term  capital  loss to the extent of any  long-term
capital gain distribution received on those shares.

Any capital gain  distribution  received by a shareholder  reduces the net asset
value of his  shares  by the  amount of the  distribution.  To the  extent  that
capital gain was accrued by a Fund before the shareholder  purchased his shares,
the distribution would be in effect a return of capital to that shareholder. All
capital gain distributions, including those that operate as a return of capital,
are taxable to the shareholder  receiving them as described above  regardless of
the length of time he may have held his shares prior to the distribution.

11.      OTHER INFORMATION

CUSTODIAN

Pursuant to a Custodian  Agreement  with Core Trust,  The First National Bank of
Boston, 100 Federal Street,  Boston,  Massachusetts 02106, acts as the custodian
of Treasury  Portfoio's and Municipal  Cash  Portfolio's  assets.  Pursuant to a
Custodian Agreement with Core Trust,  Imperial Trust Company, 201 North Figueroa
Street, Suite 610, Los Angeles,  California 90012, acts as the custodian of each
other Portfolio's assets. The custodians'  responsibilities include safeguarding
and  controlling  the  Portfolios  cash and securities  and  determining  income
payable on and collecting interest on Portfolio investments.

COUNSEL

Legal  matters in  connection  with the issuance of  beneficial  interest of the
Trust are passed upon by Seward & Kissel, 1200 G Street, N.W., Washington,  D.C.
20005.

AUDITORS

KPMG Peat Marwick LLP, 99 High Street, Boston,  Massachusetts 02110, independent
auditors, acts as auditors for the Funds and as auditors for the Portfolios.

THE TRUST AND ITS SHARES

The Trust is a  business  trust  organized  under  Delaware  law.  Delaware  law
provides that shareholders shall be entitled to the same limitations of personal
liability  extended to  stockholders  of private  corporations  for profit.  The
securities regulators of some states,  however, have indicated that they and the
courts in their state may decline to apply Delaware law on this point.

The Trust Instrument contains an express disclaimer of shareholder liability for
the debts, liabilities, obligations, and expenses of the Trust and requires that
a disclaimer be given in each contract  entered into or executed by the Trust 


                                       24
<PAGE>

or the Trustees.  The Trust Instrument  provides for indemnification out of each
series' property of any shareholder or former shareholder held personally liable
for the obligations of the series.  The Trust Instrument also provides that each
series  shall,  upon  request,  assume the defense of any claim made against any
shareholder  for any act or  obligation  of the series and satisfy any  judgment
thereon.  Thus, the risk of a shareholder incurring financial loss on account of
shareholder liability is limited to circumstances in which Delaware law does not
apply, no contractual limitation of liability was in effect and the portfolio is
unable to meet its obligations. (FAS) believes that, in view of the above, there
is no risk of personal liability to shareholders.

The Trust  Instrument  further provides that the Trustees shall not be liable to
any person  other than the Trust or its  shareholders;  moreover,  the  Trustees
shall not be liable for any conduct  whatsoever,  provided that a Trustee is not
protected against any liability to which he would otherwise by subject by reason
of willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of the
duties involved in the conduct of his office.

The Board is  required  to call a meeting  of  shareholders  for the  purpose of
voting  upon the  removal of any  trustee  when so  requested  in writing by the
shareholders of record holding at least 10% of the Trust's outstanding shares.

Each series' capital consists of shares of beneficial interest. Shares are fully
paid and  nonassessable,  except as set forth above with  respect to Trustee and
shareholder liability.  Shareholders  representing 10% or more of the Trust or a
series may, as set forth in the Trust Instrument,  call meetings of the Trust or
series  for any  purpose  related  to the Trust or  series,  as the case may be,
including,  in the case of a meeting of the entire Trust,  the purpose of voting
on removal of one or more  Trustees.  The Trust or any series may be  terminated
upon the sale of its  assets to, or merger  with,  another  open-end  management
investment  company or series thereof,  or upon  liquidation and distribution of
its  assets.  Generally  such  terminations  must be approved by the vote of the
holders  of a majority  of the  outstanding  shares of the Trust or the  series;
however, the Trustees may, without prior shareholder  approval,  change the form
of organization of the Trust by merger,  consolidation or incorporation.  If not
so  terminated  or   reorganized,   the  Trust  and  its  series  will  continue
indefinitely.  Under the Trust Instrument, the Trustees may, without shareholder
vote,  cause  the  Trust  to  merge  or  consolidate  into  one or more  trusts,
partnerships or corporations or cause the Trust to merge or consolidate into one
or  more  trusts,  partnerships  or  corporations  or  cause  the  Trust  to  be
incorporated  under Delaware law, so long as the surviving entity is an open-end
management  investment  company  that  will  succeed  to or assume  the  Trust's
registration statement.

FUND STRUCTURE

CORE AND GATEWAY.  The Funds seek to achieve their objective by investing all of
their  investable  assets in a  separate  portfolio  of a  registered,  open-end
management  investment company with substantially the same investment  objective
and  policies  as the  Fund.  This  "Core  and  Gateway"  fund  structure  is an
arrangement  whereby  one or  more  investment  companies  or  other  collective
investment  vehicles that share investment  objectives -- but offer their shares
through  distinct  distribution  channels -- pool their assets by investing in a
single investment company having substantially the same investment objective and
policies (a "Core  Portfolio").  This means that the only investment  securities
that will be held by a Fund will be the Fund's  interest in the Core  Portfolio.
This  structure   permits  other  collective   investment   vehicles  to  invest
collectively  in a Core  Portfolio,  allowing for greater  economies of scale in
managing operations of the single Core Portfolio. The Board retains the right to
withdraw a Fund's  investments from a Core Portfolio at any time; the Fund would
then resume  investing  directly in  individual  securities  of other issuers or
could re-invest all of its assets in another Core Portfolio.

FUND  SHAREHOLDERS'  VOTING  RIGHTS.  A Core  Portfolio  normally  will not hold
meetings  of  its  investors  except  as  required  under  the  1940  Act.  As a
shareholder in a Core Portfolio, a Fund is entitled to vote in proportion to its
relative  interest  in the Core  Portfolio.  On any issue,  a Fund will vote its
shares in a Core Portfolio in proportion to the votes cast by its  shareholders.
If there are other investors in a Core Portfolio, there can be no assurance that
any issue that receives a majority of the votes cast by the Fund's  shareholders
will  receive  a  majority  of votes  cast by all Core  Portfolio  shareholders.
Generally, a Fund will hold a meeting of its shareholders to obtain instructions
on how to vote its  interest  in a Core  Portfolio  when the Core  Portfolio  is
conducting  a  meeting  of its  shareholders.  However,  subject  to  applicable
statutory and regulatory  requirements,  a Fund will not seek  instructions from
its shareholders  with respect to (i) any proposal  relating to a Core Portfolio
that,  if made with  respect  to the Fund, 


                                       25
<PAGE>

would not require the vote of Fund  shareholders,  or (ii) any proposal relating
to the Core Portfolio that is identical to a proposal previously approved by the
Fund's shareholders.

In  addition  to a vote to remove a  trustee  or  change a  fundamental  policy,
examples  of  matters  that will  require  approval  of  shareholders  of a Core
Portfolio include,  subject to applicable statutory and regulatory requirements:
the election of  trustees;  approval of an  investment  advisory  contract;  the
dissolution  of a Core  Portfolio;  certain  amendments  of  the  organizational
documents  for  the  Core  Portfolio;   a  merger,   consolidation  or  sale  of
substantially  all of a Core  Portfolio's  assets;  or  any  additional  matters
required or authorized by the charter or trust  instrument and by-laws of a Core
Portfolio or any registration statement of a Core Portfolio, or as the directors
or trustees of the Core Portfolio may consider desirable.  The board of trustees
of a Core Portfolio will  typically  reserve the power to change  nonfundamental
policies without prior shareholder approval.

CONSIDERATIONS  OF  INVESTING  IN A  PORTFOLIO.  A Fund's  investment  in a Core
Portfolio  may be affected by the actions of other large  investors  in the Core
Portfolio, if any. For example, if the Core Portfolio had a large investor other
than the Fund  that  redeemed  its  interest  in the  Core  Portfolio,  the Core
Portfolio's  remaining  investors  (including  the  Fund)  might,  as a  result,
experience higher pro rata operating expenses,  thereby producing lower returns.
A Fund may withdraw its entire  investment  from the Core Portfolio at any time,
if the Board  determines  that it is in the best  interests  of the Fund and its
shareholders to do so. A Fund might withdraw, for example, if other investors in
the Core Portfolio, by a vote of shareholders,  changed the investment objective
or policies of the Core  Portfolio in a manner not  acceptable  to the Board.  A
withdrawal  could result in a distribution  in kind of portfolio  securities (as
opposed to a cash  distribution) by the Core Portfolio.  That distribution could
result in a less  diversified  portfolio of  investments  for the Fund and could
affect adversely the liquidity of the Fund's  portfolio.  If the Fund decided to
convert those securities to cash, it normally would incur transaction  costs. If
a Fund withdrew its investment from the Core Portfolio, the Board would consider
what action might be taken,  including  the  management  of the Fund's assets in
accordance  with its  investment  objective  and  policies by the Adviser or the
investment of all of the Fund's  investable  assets in another pooled investment
entity having substantially the same investment objective as the Fund.

12.  FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

The Statements of Assets and Liabilities,  Statements of Operations,  Statements
of Changes in Net Assets, notes thereto and Financial Highlights of Daily Assets
Treasury  Fund and Daily  Assets Cash Fund for the fiscal year ended  August 31,
1997 and the Independent Auditors' Report thereon (included in the Annual Report
to  Shareholders),  which are  delivered  along with this SAI, are  incorporated
herein  by  reference.  Also  incorporated  by  reference  into this SAI are the
Schedules of Investments,  Statements of Assets and  Liabilities,  Statements of
Operations,  Statements of Changes in Net Assets, and notes thereto, of Treasury
Portfolio  and Cash  Portfolio for the fiscal year ended August 31, 1997 and the
Independent Auditors' Report thereon.

As Daily Assets Treasury  Obligations  Fund, Daily Assets Government Fund, Daily
Assets Municipal Fund and Municipal Cash Portfolio had not as of the date hereof
commenced operations, no financial statements are available.




                                       26
<PAGE>

APPENDIX A - DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES RATINGS

1.  CORPORATE BONDS

         MOODY'S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC. ("MOODY'S")

Bonds which are rated Aaa are judged by Moody's to be of the best quality.  They
carry the smallest  degree of investment  risk and are generally  referred to as
"gilt edge." Interest  payments are protected by a large or by an  exceptionally
stable margin and principal is secure. While the various protective elements are
likely to change,  such changes as can be visualized are most unlikely to impair
the fundamentally strong position of such issues.

Bonds  which are rated Aa are  judged to be of high  quality  by all  standards.
Together  with  the Aaa  group,  they  comprise  what  are  generally  known  as
high-grade  bonds.  They are rated lower than the best bonds because  margins of
protection may not be as large as in Aaa securities or fluctuation of protective
elements  may be of greater  amplitude  or there may be other  elements  present
which make the long-term risks appear somewhat larger than in Aaa securities.

Bonds which are rated A possess many favorable investment  attributes and are to
be  considered as upper medium grade  obligations.  Factors  giving  security to
principal and interest are considered adequate but elements may be present which
suggest a susceptibility to impairment some time in the future.

Note:  Those bonds in the Aa and A groups  which  Moody's  believes  possess the
strongest investment
attributes are designated by the symbols Aa1 and A1.

         STANDARD AND POOR'S CORPORATION ("S&P")

Bonds  rated  AAA have the  highest  rating  assigned  by S&P.  Capacity  to pay
interest and repay principal is extremely strong.

Bonds rated AA have a very strong  capacity to pay interest and repay  principal
and differ from the highest rated issues only in small degree.

Bonds  rated A have a strong  capacity  to pay  interest  and  repay  principal,
although they are somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in
circumstances   and  economic   conditions  than  debt  rated  in  higher  rated
categories.

Note:  The ratings for AA and A may be modified by the addition of a plus (+) or
minus (-) sign to show the relative standing within the rating category.

         FITCH IBCA, INC.. ("FITCH")

AAA Bonds are  considered  to be  investment  grade  and of the  highest  credit
quality.  The obligor has an  exceptionally  strong  ability to pay interest and
repay  principal,  which is unlikely to be  affected by  reasonably  foreseeable
events.

AA Bonds are considered to be investment  grade and of very high credit quality.
The  obligor's  ability to pay  interest  and repay  principal  is very  strong,
although not quite as strong as bonds rated AAA.  Because bonds rated in the AAA
and AA  categories  are  not  significantly  vulnerable  to  foreseeable  future
developments, shorter-term debt of these issuers is generally rate F-1+.

A Bonds are considered to be investment  grade and of high credit  quality.  The
obligor's  ability to pay  interest  and repay  principal  is  considered  to be
strong, but may be more vulnerable to adverse changes in economic conditions and
circumstances than bonds with higher ratings.

                                      A-1
<PAGE>

Plus (+) and  minus (-) signs  are used  with a rating  symbol to  indicate  the
relative position of a credit within the rating category.  Plus and minus signs,
however, are not used in the AAA categories.

2.  COMMERCIAL PAPER

         MOODY'S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC.

Moody's two highest ratings for short-term debt, including commercial paper, are
Prime-1 and Prime-2.  Both are judged investment grade, to indicate the relative
repayment ability of rated issuers.

Issuers rated Prime-1 have a superior ability for repayment of senior short-term
debt  obligations.  Prime-1 repayment ability will often be evidenced by many of
the following characteristics:

          --    Leading market positions in well-established industries.
          --    High rates of return on funds employed.
          --    Conservative  capitalization  structure  with moderate  reliance
                on debt and ample asset protection.
          --    Broad margins in earnings coverage of fixed financial charges
                and high internal cash generation.
          --    Well-established  access  to a  range  of  financial  markets
                and  assured  sources  of alternate liquidity.

Issuers rated  Prime-2 by Moody's have a strong  ability for repayment of senior
short-term  debt  obligations.  This will  normally be  evidenced by many of the
characteristics of issuers rated Prime-1 but to a lesser degree. Earnings trends
and  coverage   ratios,   while  sound,   may  be  more  subject  to  variation.
Capitalization characteristics, while still appropriate, may be more affected by
external conditions. Ample alternate liquidity is maintained.

         STANDARD AND POOR'S CORPORATION

S&P's two highest  commercial  paper  ratings are A and B. Issues  assigned an A
rating are regarded as having the greatest  capacity for timely payment.  Issues
in this  category  are  delineated  with the numbers 1, 2 and 3 to indicate  the
relative  degree of  safety.  An A-1  designation  indicates  that the degree of
safety  regarding  timely payment is either  overwhelming or very strong.  Those
issues determined to possess  overwhelming  safety  characteristics  are denoted
with a plus (+) sign designation. The capacity for timely payment on issues with
an A-2 designation is strong.  However,  the relative degree of safety is not as
high as for issues  designated A-1. A-3 issues have a satisfactory  capacity for
timely  payment.  They are,  however,  somewhat  more  vulnerable to the adverse
effects  of  changes  in  circumstances  than  obligations  carrying  the higher
designations.  Issues rated B are  regarded as having only an adequate  capacity
for timely payment. However, such capacity may be damaged by changing conditions
or short-term adversities.

         FITCH IBCA, INC..

Fitch's  short-term ratings apply to debt obligations that are payable on demand
or have original maturities of generally up to three years, including commercial
paper, certificates of deposit,  medium-term notes, and municipal and investment
notes.

F-1+. Issues assigned this rating are regarded as having the strongest degree of
assurance for timely payment.

F-1.  Issues  assigned this rating  reflect an assurance of timely  payment only
slightly less in degree than issues rated F-1+.

F-2.  Issues  assigned this rating have a  satisfactory  degree of assurance for
timely payment,  but the margin of safety is not as great as for issues assigned
F-1+ or F-1 ratings.

                                      A-2
<PAGE>


APPENDIX B - PERFORMANCE INFORMATION

For the seven day period ended August 31, 1997, the annualized yields of each of
the classes of the Funds that were then operating were as follows:
<TABLE>
<S>                                     <C>                 <C>                  <C>                <C>
                                                                                TAX EQUIVALENT      TAX EQUIVALENT
                                        CURRENT YIELD      EFFECTIVE YIELD      CURRENT YIELD      EFFECTIVE YIELD
DAILY ASSETS TREASURY FUND
    Investor Shares                           --                  --                  --                  --
    Institutional Service Shares            4.76%               4.87%                 --                  --
    Institutional Shares                      --                  --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS TREASURY
OBLIGATIONS FUND
    Investor Shares                           --                  --                  --                  --
    Institutional Service Shares              --                  --                  --                  --
    Institutional Shares                      --                  --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS GOVERNMENT FUND
    Investor Shares                           --                  --                  --                  --
    Institutional Service Shares              --                  --                  --                  --
    Institutional Shares                      --                  --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS CASH FUND
    Investor Shares                           --                  --                  --                  --
    Institutional Service Shares            5.19%               5.33%                 --                  --
    Institutional Shares                      --                  --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS MUNICIPALFUND
    Investor Shares                           --                  --                  --                  --
    Institutional Service Shares              --                  --                  --                  --
    Institutional Shares                      --                  --                  --                  --
</TABLE>

As of August 31, 1997, there were no outstanding  Institutional Shares, Investor
Shares or  Institutional  Service  Shares of each Fund other  than Daily  Assets
Treasury Fund and Daily Assets Cash Fund.

                                      B-1
<PAGE>

APPENDIX C- MISCELLANEOUS TABLES
<TABLE>
<S>                                                            <C>                 <C>                <C>
                                    TABLE 1 - INVESTMENT ADVISORY FEES

                                                              GROSS FEE           FEE WAIVED         NET FEE PAID
TREASURY PORTFOLIO
Period ended August 31, 1997                                    $9,064                $0                $9,064
Year ended March 31, 1997                                      $20,637                $0               $20,637
Year ended March 31, 1996(1)                                   $69,466                $0               $69,466
Year ended March 31, 1995(1)                                   $59,382             $53,382              $6,000
TREASURY CASH PORTFOLIO
Year ended August 31, 1997                                                            $0
Year ended August 31, 1996                                     $12,930                $0               $12,930
GOVERNMENT CASH PORTFOLIO
Year ended August 31, 1997                                     $196,857               $0               $196,857
Year ended August 31, 1996                                     $156,552               $0               $156,552
CASH PORTFOLIO
Year ended August 31, 1997                                     $72,872                $0               $72,872
Year ended August 31, 1996                                     $38,083                $0               $38,083
MUNICIPAL CASH PORTFOLIO
Year ended August 31, 1997                                        --                  --                  --
</TABLE>

(1) Prior to January  15,  1996,  Forum  Advisors,  Inc.  acted as Daily  Assets
Treasury Fund's investment  adviser under an investment  advisory agreement with
Forum Funds, Inc. Under this investment advisory agreement, Forum received a fee
at an annual rate of 0.20% of the average daily net assets of the Fund.


                                      C-1
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                                           <C>                 <C>                 <C>
                                      TABLE 2 - ADMINISTRATION FEES

                                                              GROSS FEE           FEE WAIVED         NET FEE PAID
TREASURY PORTFOLIO
Period ended August 31, 1997                                   $18,128             $18,128                $0
Year ended March 31, 1997                                       41,274             $41,274                $0
Year ended March 31, 1996(1)
TREASURY CASH PORTFOLIO
Year ended August 31, 1997                                     $24,287             $14,346              9,941
Year ended August 31, 1996                                     $19,198              $9,307              $9,891
GOVERNMENT CASH PORTFOLIO
Year ended August 31, 1997                                     $252,821               $0               $252,821
Year ended August 31, 1996                                     $230,547            $104,558            $125,989
CASH PORTFOLIO
Year ended August 31, 1997                                     $92,652              $7,621             $85,031
Year ended August 31, 1996                                     $56,125              $3,719             $52,406
MUNICIPAL CASH PORTFOLIO
Year ended August 31, 1997                                        --                  --                  --

DAILY ASSETS TREASURY FUND
Period ended August 31, 1997                                   $18,123                $0               $18,123
Year ended March 31, 1997                                      $41,232              $7,453             $33,779
Year ended March 31, 1996
DAILY ASSETS TREASURY OBLIGATIONS FUND
Year ended August 31, 1997                                        --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS GOVERNMENT FUND
Year ended August 31, 1997                                        --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS CASH FUND
Year ended August 31, 1997                                      $7,453              $7,453                $0
DAILY ASSETS MUNICIPAL FUND
Year ended August 31, 1997                                        --                  --                  --

</TABLE>

                                      C-2
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                                            <C>               <C>                  <C>
                                TABLE 3 - INVESTOR SHARES RULE 12B-1 FEES

                                                              GROSS FEE           FEE WAIVED         NET FEE PAID
DAILY ASSETS TREASURY FUND
Period ended August 31, 1997                                      --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS TREASURY OBLIGATIONS FUND
Year ended August 31, 1997                                        --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS GOVERNMENT FUND
Year ended August 31, 1997                                        --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS CASH FUND
Period ended August 31, 1997                                      --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS MUNICIPAL FUND
Year ended August 31, 1997                                        --                  --                  --
</TABLE>

For the fiscal year ended August 31, 1997, no Investor  Shares were  outstanding
and, accordingly, no fees were payable under the Investor Class Plan.

                                      C-3
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                                             <C>                 <C>                <C>
                                      TABLE 4 - TRANSFER AGENCY FEES

                                                              GROSS FEE           FEE WAIVED         NET FEE PAID
DAILY ASSETS TREASURY FUND
Institutional Service Shares
     Period ended August 31, 1997                              $50,810             $44,054              $6,756
     Year ended March 31, 1997                                 $116,051            $101,485            $14,566
     Year ended March 31, 1996                                 $110,792            $96,881              13,911
DAILY ASSETS TREASURY OBLIGATIONS FUND
Institutional Service Shares
     Year ended August 31, 1997                                   --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS GOVERNMENT FUND
Institutional Service Shares
     Year ended August 31, 1997                                   --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS CASH FUND
Institutional Service Shares
     Period ended August 31, 1997                              $29,772             $17,766              12,006
DAILY ASSETS MUNICIPAL FUND
Institutional Service Shares
     Year ended August 31, 1997                                   --                  --                  --
</TABLE>

As of August 31, 1997, there were no outstanding  Institutional Shares, Investor
Shares or  Institutional  Service  Shares of each Fund other  than Daily  Assets
Treasury Fund and Daily Assets Cash Fund.

                                      C-4
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                                          <C>                    <C>                <C>
                                    TABLE 5 - SHAREHOLDER SERVICE FEES

                                                              GROSS FEE           FEE WAIVED         NET FEE PAID
DAILY ASSETS TREASURY FUND
Institutional Service Shares
     Period ended August 31, 1997                                 --                  --                  --
Investor Shares
     Period ended August 31, 1997                                 --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS TREASURY OBLIGATIONS FUND
Institutional Service Shares
     Year ended August 31, 1997                                   --                  --                  --
Investor Shares
     Period ended August 31, 1997                                 --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS GOVERNMENT FUND
Institutional Service Shares
     Year ended August 31, 1997                                   --                  --                  --
Investor Shares
     Period ended August 31, 1997                                 --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS CASH FUND
Institutional Service Shares
     Year ended August 31, 1997                                   --                  --                  --
Investor Shares
     Period ended August 31, 1997                                 --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS MUNICIPAL FUND
Institutional Service Shares
     Year ended August 31, 1997                                   --                  --                  --
Investor Shares
     Period ended August 31, 1997                                 --                  --                  --
</TABLE>

As of  August  31,  1997,  there  were no  outstanding  Investor  Shares  and no
effective  Shareholder Plan with respect to Institutional  Service Shares of any
Fund.

                                      C-5
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                                              <C>                 <C>                 <C>
                                      TABLE 6 - FUND ACCOUNTING FEES

                                                              GROSS FEE           FEE WAIVED         NET FEE PAID
TREASURY PORTFOLIO
Period ended August 31, 1997                                   $20,000                $0               $20,000
Year ended March 31, 1997                                      $48,000                $0               $48,000
Year ended March 31, 1996(1)
TREASURY CASH PORTFOLIO
Year ended August 31, 1997                                     $24,279                $0               $24,279
Year ended August 31, 1996                                     $28,518             $19,955              $8,563
GOVERNMENT CASH PORTFOLIO
Year ended August 31, 1997                                     $48,000                $0               $48,000
Year ended August 31, 1996                                     $42,000                $0               $42,000
CASH PORTFOLIO
Year ended August 31, 1997                                     $48,000                $0               $48,000
Year ended August 31, 1996                                     $42,000             $14,957             $27,043
MUNICIPAL CASH PORTFOLIO
Year ended August 31, 1997                                        --                  --                  --

DAILY ASSETS TREASURY FUND
Period ended August 31, 1997                                    $5,000                $0                $5,000
Year ended March 31, 1997                                      $12,000                $0               $12,000
Year ended March 31, 1996
DAILY ASSETS TREASURY OBLIGATIONS FUND
Year ended August 31, 1997                                        --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS GOVERNMENT FUND
Year ended August 31, 1997                                        --                  --                  --
DAILY ASSETS CASH FUND
Year ended August 31, 1997
DAILY ASSETS MUNICIPAL FUND
Year ended August 31, 1997                                        --                  --                  --


</TABLE>

                                      C-6
<PAGE>


                                        TABLE 7 - 5% SHAREHOLDERS

As of October 31, 1997,  the officers and Trustees of the Trust as a group owned
less than 1% of the  outstanding  shares of each Fund. Also as of that date, the
shareholders  listed below owned more than 5% of each Fund.  Shareholders owning
25% or more of the  shares of a Fund or of the Trust as a whole may be deemed to
be controlling persons. By reason of their substantial holdings of shares, these
persons may be able to require the Trust to hold a  shareholder  meeting to vote
on certain  issues and may be able to determine  the outcome of any  shareholder
vote.  As noted,  certain of these  shareholders  are known to the Trust to hold
their shares of record only and have no beneficial interest, including the right
to vote, in the shares.
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                        <C>                      <C>
                                                                       PERCENTAGE OF        PERCENTAGE OF SHARES OF
                                                                       SHARES OWNED                FUND OWNED
DAILY ASSETS TREASURY FUND
INSTITUTIONAL SERVICE SHARES
H.M. Payson & Co. Custody Account                                       41.1141.11%              15,437,654.710
P.O. Box 31, Portland, ME 04112
H.M. Payson & Co. Custody Account                                         33.77%                 12,681,768.470
P.O. Box 31, Portland, ME 04112
DAILY ASSETS CASH FUND
INSTITUTIONAL SERVICE SHARES
H.M. Payson & Co. Custody Account                                         50.63%                 5,274,716.100
P.O. Box 31, Portland, ME 04112
 H.M. Payson & Co. Custody Account                                        44.39%                 4,624,133.160
P.O. Box 31, Portland, ME 04112
</TABLE>

                                      C-7
<PAGE>

APPENDIX D - PEOPLES HERITAGE NEWS RELEASE

Peoples Heritage Financial Group, Inc. (NASDAQ:PHBK) announced today that it has
formed an alliance with a major mutual fund provider and an investment  advisory
firm to expand its mutual fund  offerings.  The  alliance  with Forum  Financial
Group and H.M.  Payson & Company will result in 18 funds,  including  the unique
Maine Municipal Bond Fund and New Hampshire Bond Fund, being offered through the
branches  of Peoples'  affiliate  banks in Maine,  New  Hampshire  and  northern
Massachusetts and the Company's trust and investment subsidiaries

'There is no secret to where  financial  services  are moving,  under one roof,"
said William J. Ryan, Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer of Peoples
Heritage.   "One  only  has  to  watch  the  virtually  daily  announcements  of
consolidations  in  the  financial  sector  to  understand  that  customers  are
demanding and receiving 'one-stop' financial services.

"We think we are adding the additional  competitive  advantage of funds that are
managed and administered close to home."

Eighteen  Forum funds will be offered  including two Payson funds.  The tax-free
Maine and New Hampshire  state bond funds are the only two such funds  available
and usually  invest 80% of total  assets in  municipal  securities.  Other funds
being  provided by the alliance  include money  market,  fixed income and equity
funds.

Forum Financial, based in Portland, Maine since 1987, administers 146 funds with
more than $36 billion in assets.  Forum  manages  mutual  funds for  independent
investment advisors such as Payson and for banks. Forum Investment Advisors, LLC
an affiliate,  is the largest Maine-based  investment advisor with approximately
$1.7 billion in fund assets under management.

"We are providing a great product set to the customers served by Peoples' nearly
200 branches in northern New  England,"  said John Y.  Keffer,  Forum  Financial
president,  "The key today is to link a wide variety of investment  options with
convergent, easy access for customers. I believe this alliance does just that."

H.M.  Payson & Co.,  founded in 1854, is one of the nation's  oldest  investment
firms with  nearly $1 billion in assets  under  management  and $300  million in
non-managed  custodial accounts.  The Payson value Fund and Payson Balanced Fund
are among the 18 offerings.

"I believe we have all the  ingredients  of a  tremendous  alliance,"  said John
Walker,  Payson president and managing  director.  "We have the region's premier
community banking company,  a community-based  investment  advisor,  and a local
mutual fund company that operates  nationally  and  specializes  in working with
banks. We are poised to provide solid investment performance and service."

Peoples Heritage Financial Group is a $10 billion multi-state bank and financial
services  holding company  headquartered  in Portland,  Maine. Its Maine banking
affiliate,  Peoples Heritage Bank, has the state's leading deposit market share.
Its New Hampshire  banking  affiliate,  Bank of New  Hampshire,  has the state's
leading deposit market share. Family Bank, the Company's  Massachusetts  banking
subsidiary,  has the state's tenth largest  deposit market share and the leading
market  share  in many of the  northern  Massachusetts  communities  it  serves.
Peoples  affiliate  banks  also  operate  subsidiaries  in  leasing,  trust  and
investment services and insurance.

                                      D-1
<PAGE>

FORUM FINANCIAL GROUP:

Headquarters:  Two Portland Square, Portland, Maine 04101
President:  John Y. Keffer
Offices:  Portland, Seattle, Warsaw, Bermuda
*Established  in 1986 to  administer  mutual  funds for  independent  investment
advisors and banks *Among the nation's largest  third-party fund  administrators
*Uses proprietary in-house systems and custom programming capabilities
         *ADMINISTRATION  AND  DISTRIBUTION  SERVICES: Regulatory, compliance,
          expense  accounting, budgeting for all funds
         *FUND  ACCOUNTING SERVICES: Portfolio valuation, accounting, dividend
          declaration,  and tax advice
         *SHAREHOLDER SERVICES: Preparation of statements, distribution support,
          inquiries  and processing of trades
*CLIENT ASSETS UNDER ADMINISTRATION AND DISTRIBUTION:  $36.9 billion
*CLIENT ASSETS PROCESSED BY FUND ACCOUNTING:  $47.6 billion
*CLIENT FUNDS UNDER ADMINISTRATION AND DISTRIBUTION:  146 mutual funds with 219
share classes
*INTERNATIONAL VENTURES:
         Joint  venture  with Bank  Handlowy in Warsaw,  Poland,  using  Forum's
         proprietary   transfer  agency  and  distribution   systems   Off-shore
         investment  fund  administration,  using  Bermuda as Forum's  center of
         operations
*FORUM EMPLOYEES:  United States -198, Poland - 61, Bermuda - 3

FORUM CONTACTS:
Mark Kaplan, Managing Director and Portfolio Manager, Forum Investment Advisors,
LLC,
(207) 879-1900 X 6123
Tony Santaniello, Director of Marketing, (207) 879-1900 X 6175



                                      D-2
<PAGE>


H.M. PAYSON & CO.:

Headquarters:  One Portland Square, Portland, Maine
President and Managing Director: John Walker
Quality investment services and conservative wealth management since 1854
*Assets under Management: $1 Billion
*Custody Income Assets: $300 Million
*Client Base: 85% individuals; 15% institutional
*Owned by 11 shareholders; 11 managing directors
*Payson Balanced Fund and Payson Value Fund  (administrative  and shareholder
services  provided by Forum Financial Group)
*Employees: 45


H.M. PAYSON & CO. CONTACT:
Joel Harris, Portfolio/Marketing Coordinator, (207) 772-3761



                                      D-3
<PAGE>



                                EQUITY INDEX FUND
                              INVESTORS EQUITY FUND
                        SMALL COMPANY OPPORTUNITIES FUND
                            INTERNATIONAL EQUITY FUND
                              EMERGING MARKETS FUND

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Account Information and
Shareholder Servicing:                 Distributor:
         Forum Financial Corp.                  Forum Financial Services, Inc.
         P.O. Box 446                           Two Portland Square
         Portland, Maine 04112                  Portland, Maine  04101
         207-879-0001                           207-879-1900
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                       STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
                    MARCH 30, 1998 AS AMENDED APRIL 15, 1998

Forum Funds (the  "Trust") is a registered  open-end  investment  company.  This
Statement of Additional  Information  supplements the Prospectus dated March 30,
1998,  as  amended  from time to time,  offering  shares of Equity  Index  Fund,
Investors Equity Fund, Small Company  Opportunities Fund,  International  Equity
Fund and Emerging Markets Fund (each, a Fund and collectively,  the "Funds") and
should be read only in conjunction  with the Prospectus,  a copy of which may be
obtained by an investor without charge by contacting the Trust's  Distributor at
the address listed above.

Each Fund,  except for  Investors  Equity Fund,  currently  seeks to achieve its
investment  objective  by  holding  the  securities  of  one  or  more  separate
portfolios of registered open-end management investment company.

THIS  STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL  INFORMATION IS NOT A PROSPECTUS AND IS AUTHORIZED
FOR DISTRIBUTION TO PROSPECTIVE  INVESTORS ONLY IF PRECEDED OR ACCOMPANIED BY AN
EFFECTIVE PROSPECTUS.

                                        TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                      PAGE
 1.       General...................................................... 2
 2.       Investment Policies.......................................... 4
 3.       Investment Limitations.......................................18
 4.       Performance Data.............................................22
 5.       Management...................................................23
 6.       Determination of Net Asset Value.............................32
 7.       Portfolio Transactions.......................................32
 8.       Additional Purchase and
             Redemption Information....................................33
 9.       Taxation.....................................................35
 10.      Other Information............................................37

          Appendix A - Description of Securities Ratings..............A-1
          Appendix B - Text of Forum Brochure.........................B-1
          Appendix C - Text of Peoples Heritage News Release..........C-1


<PAGE>

1.  GENERAL

THE  TRUST.  The Trust is  registered  with the SEC as an  open-end,  management
investment  company and was organized as a business  trust under the laws of the
State of Delaware on August 29, 1995. On January 5, 1996 the Trust  succeeded to
the  assets  and  liabilities  of  Forum  Funds,  Inc.  Forum  Funds,  Inc.  was
incorporated  on March 24,  1980 and assumed  the name of Forum  Funds,  Inc. on
March 16, 1987.  The Board has the  authority  to issue an  unlimited  number of
shares of beneficial interest of separate series with no par value per share and
to create separate classes of shares within each series. The Trust currently has
authorized  shares  of  twenty-four  series,  including  series  that  have  not
commenced  operation  as of the date of this SAI. The series of the Trust are as
follows:

                  Investors  High Grade Bond Fund 
                  Investors  Bond Fund 
                  TaxSaver Bond Fund 
                  Daily  Assets Cash Fund 
                  Daily Assets  Treasury  Fund
                  Daily Assets Government Fund 
                  Daily Assets Municipal Fund
                  Daily Assets Treasury Obligations Fund 
                  Payson  Value Fund
                  Payson Balanced Fund
                  Maine  Municipal  Bond Fund
                  New  Hampshire  Bond Fund
                  Austin  Global  Equity  Fund 
                  Oak Hall Equity Fund 
                  Quadra Limited Maturity Treasury Fund 
                  Quadra Value Equity Fund 
                  Quadra Growth Fund  
                  Quadra International Equity Fund  
                  Quadra Opportunistic  Bond Fund 
                  Equity  Index Fund  
                  Investors  Equity Fund 
                  Investors  Growth Fund
                  Small Company  Opportunities Fund
                  International Equity Fund 
                  Emerging Markets Fund

DEFINITIONS. As used in this Statement of Additional Information,  the following
terms shall have the
meanings listed:

"Board" means the Board of Trustees of Forum Funds.

"Core Trust" means Core Trust (Delaware), a Delaware business trust.

"Core Trust Board" means the Board of Trustees of Core Trust (Delaware).

"Core Trust Portfolio" means Index Portfolio,  Small Cap Index Portfolio,  Small
Company  Stock  Portfolio,  Small  Company  Value  Portfolio and Small Cap Value
Portfolio, each, a series of Core Trust.

"FAdS" means Forum Administrative Services, LLC.

"FAcS" means Forum Accounting Services, LLC.

"FSS" means Forum Shareholder Services, LLC.

"FFSI" means Forum Financial Services, Inc.

                                       2
<PAGE>

"Forum Advisors" means Forum Investment Advisors, LLC.

"Fund"  means  Equity  Index  Fund,   Investors   Equity  Fund,   Small  Company
Opportunities Fund, International Equity Fund or Emerging Markets Fund.

"Fund  Business  Day" has the  meaning  ascribed  thereto in the Funds'  current
Prospectus.

"NRSRO" means a nationally recognized statistical rating organization.

"Norwest" means Norwest Investment Management, Inc.

"Portfolio" means Index Portfolio,  Schroder U.S. Smaller  Companies  Portfolio,
International Portfolio,  Schroder EM Core Portfolio, Small Cap Index Portfolio,
Small Company Stock Portfolio,  Small Company Value Portfolio or Small Cap Value
Portfolio.

"SAI" means this Statement of Additional Information.

"SCMI" means Schroder Capital Management International, Inc.

"SEC" means the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.

"Schroder Core" means Schroder Capital Funds, a Delaware business trust.

"Schroder Core Board" means the Board of Trustees of Schroder Core.

"Schroder Core  Portfolio"  means  International  Portfolio and Schroder EM Core
Portfolio.

"Trust" means Forum Funds, a Delaware business trust.

"U.S.  Government  Securities" has the meaning  ascribed  thereto by the current
Prospectus of the Funds.

"1940 Act" means the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.



                                       3
<PAGE>

2. INVESTMENT POLICIES

INTRODUCTION

The following  information  supplements the discussion  found under  "Investment
Objective  and  Policies"  in  the  Prospectus.   Each  of  Equity  Index  Fund,
International  Equity Fund and Emerging  Markets Fund currently seeks to achieve
its  investment  objective  by  investing  all of  its  investment  assets  in a
Portfolio,  that has substantially  the same investment  objective and policies.
Because  each  Fund  has  substantially  the  same  investment  policies  as the
Portfolio  in which it invests and  currently  invests all of its assets in that
Portfolio,  investment policies for these Funds and the Portfolios in which they
invest  are  generally  discussed  in  reference  to  the  Fund.  Small  Company
Opportunities  Fund  currently  seeks to achieve  its  investment  objective  by
investing its assets in two or more Portfolios. Accordingly, the Fund may invest
in certain of the instruments described below through the Portfolios in which it
invests.

Each of  International  Fund and Emerging Markets Fund normally invests at least
65% of its total assets in equity securities of companies  domiciled outside the
United States,  including  common and preferred stock,  convertible  securities,
depository receipts,  and warrants or rights to purchase such equity securities.
Investments  also  may be made  in  debt  obligations  of  foreign  governments,
corporations  and  international  or  supranational   organizations  (and  their
agencies or instrumentalities).

For temporary defensive purposes, to accumulate cash for investments, or to meet
anticipated  redemptions,  each Fund may  invest in (or  enter  into  repurchase
agreements  with banks and broker  dealers  with  respect  to)  short-term  debt
securities,  including Treasury bills and other U.S. Government securities,  and
certificates of deposit and bankers'  acceptances of U.S.  banks.  Each Fund may
also hold cash and time  deposits  in foreign  banks,  denominated  in any major
foreign currency.  In anticipation of foreign exchange requirements and to avoid
losses  due  to  adverse   movements  in  foreign   currency   exchange   rates,
International  Equity Fund and Emerging Markets Fund also may enter into forward
contracts to purchase and sell foreign currencies. See "Forward Foreign Currency
Exchange Contracts" below.

ILLIQUID AND RESTRICTED SECURITIES

"Illiquid  and  Restricted   Securities"  under  "Investment  Policies"  in  the
Prospectus  sets  forth  the  circumstances  in  which  a  Fund  may  invest  in
"restricted  securities".  In connection  with the Funds'  original  purchase of
restricted  securities,  it may  negotiate  rights  with the issuer to have such
securities  registered  for  sale at a later  time.  Further,  the  registration
expenses of illiquid  restricted  securities  may also be negotiated by the Fund
with the issuer at the time such  securities  are  purchased  by the Fund.  When
registration is required,  however, a considerable period may elapse between the
decision to sell the securities and the time the Fund would be permitted to sell
such securities. A similar delay might be experienced in attempting to sell such
securities  pursuant to an exemption from registration.  Thus, a Fund may not be
able to  obtain  as  favorable  a price  as that  prevailing  at the time of the
decision to sell.

LOANS OF PORTFOLIO SECURITIES

Each Fund may lend its portfolio  securities subject to the restrictions  stated
in the Prospectus.  Under applicable regulatory  requirements (which are subject
to change),  the loan collateral  must: (1) on each business day, at least equal
the market value of the loaned  securities;  and (2) must consist of cash,  bank
letters of credit,  U.S.  Government  securities,  or other cash  equivalents in
which the Fund is permitted to invest.  To be acceptable as collateral,  letters
of credit must obligate a bank to pay amounts demanded by the Fund if the demand
meets  the  terms  of the  letter.  Such  terms  and the  issuing  bank  must be
satisfactory  to  the  Fund's   investment   advisor.   When  lending  portfolio
securities,  a Fund  receives  from the borrower an amount equal to the interest
paid or the dividends  declared on the loaned  securities during the term of the
loan plus the  interest  on the  collateral  securities  (less any  finders'  or
administrative  fees the Fund pays in arranging the loan).  A Fund may share the
interest it receives on the collateral  securities  with the borrower as long as
it  realizes  at least a minimum  amount of  interest  required  by the  lending
guidelines  established  by the  Board.  A Fund  will  not  lend  its  portfolio
securities  to any officer,  director,  employee


                                       4
<PAGE>

or affiliate of the Fund or the  investment  adviser to the Fund. The terms of a
Fund's loans must meet certain tests under the Internal  Revenue Code and permit
the Fund to reacquire loaned securities on five business days' notice or in time
to vote on any important matter.

U.S. GOVERNMENT SECURITIES

Each Fund may invest in obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S.  Government
or its agencies, instrumentalities or government-sponsored enterprises that have
remaining maturities not exceeding one year. Agencies and instrumentalities that
issue or guarantee debt  securities and that have been  established or sponsored
by the U.S.  Government  include the Bank for  Cooperatives,  the  Export-Import
Bank, the Federal Farm Credit System,  the Federal Home Loan Banks,  the Federal
Home Loan Mortgage  Corporation,  the Federal  Intermediate  Credit  Banks,  the
Federal Land Banks, the Federal National  Mortgage  Association,  the Government
National Mortgage Association and the Student Loan Marketing Association. Except
for obligations issued by the U.S. Treasury and the Government National Mortgage
Association,  none of the obligations of the other agencies or instrumentalities
referred  to  above  are  backed  by the  full  faith  and  credit  of the  U.S.
Government.

BANK OBLIGATIONS

Each Fund may invest in  obligations of U.S. banks  (including  certificates  of
deposit and bankers' acceptances) having total assets at the time of purchase in
excess  of $1  billion.  Such  banks  must be  members  of the  Federal  Deposit
Insurance Corporation or the Federal Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation.

Each Fund also may invest in  certificates  of deposit  issued by foreign banks,
denominated in any major foreign currency.  Each Fund will invest in instruments
issued by foreign  banks which,  in the view of its  investment  adviser and the
Trustees of the Trust, Core Trust or Schroder Core, are of credit-worthiness and
financial stature in their respective countries comparable to U.S. banks used by
the Fund.

A certificate of deposit is an interest-bearing negotiable certificate issued by
a bank  against  funds  deposited  in  the  bank.  A  bankers'  acceptance  is a
short-term draft drawn on a commercial bank by a borrower, usually in connection
with an international  commercial  transaction.  Although the borrower is liable
for payment of the draft, the bank  unconditionally  guarantees to pay the draft
at its face value on the maturity date.

SHORT-TERM DEBT SECURITIES

The  Funds  may  invest  in  commercial  paper,  that is,  short-term  unsecured
promissory notes issued in bearer form by bank holding  companies,  corporations
and finance  companies.  The commercial  paper purchased by a Fund for temporary
defensive  purposes consists of direct obligations of domestic issuers which, at
the time of  investment,  are rated  "P-1" by Moody's  Investors  Service,  Inc.
("Moody's")  or "A-1" by Standard & Poor's  Corporation  ("S&P"),  or securities
that, if not rated,  are issued by companies  having an  outstanding  debt issue
currently rated "Aa" by Moody's or "AAA" or "AA" by S&P. The rating "P-1" is the
highest commercial paper rating assigned by Moody's, and the rating "A-1" is the
highest commercial paper ratings assigned by S&P.

REPURCHASE AGREEMENTS

Each Fund may invest in securities subject to repurchase  agreements maturing in
seven days or less with U.S. banks or  broker-dealers.  In a typical  repurchase
agreement,  the seller of a security  commits  itself at the time of the sale to
repurchase  that  security  from the buyer at a  mutually  agreed-upon  time and
price.  The repurchase  price exceeds the sale price,  reflecting an agreed-upon
interest rate  effective  for the period the buyer owns the security  subject to
repurchase.  The  agreed-upon  rate is unrelated  to the  interest  rate on that
security.  Each  Fund's  investment  adviser  will  monitor  the  value  of  the
underlying security at the time the transaction is entered into and at all times
during  the term of the  repurchase  agreement  to insure  that the value of the
security always equals or exceeds the repurchase  price. In the event of default
by the seller under the repurchase  agreement,  a Fund may have  difficulties in
exercising  its  rights to the  underlying  securities  and may incur  costs and
experience time delays in connection with


                                       5
<PAGE>

the disposition of such securities.  To evaluate potential risks, the investment
adviser reviews the  credit-worthiness of those banks and dealers with which the
Fund enters into repurchase agreements.

CONVERTIBLE SECURITIES

The Funds may  invest in  convertible  preferred  stocks  and  convertible  debt
securities.  A convertible security is a bond, debenture,  note, preferred stock
or other  security  that may be  converted  into or  exchanged  for a prescribed
amount of common  stock of the same or a different  issuer  within a  particular
period of time at a specified  price or  formula.  Convertible  securities  rank
senior to common stocks in a  corporation's  capital  structure and,  therefore,
carry less risk than the corporation's  common stock. The value of a convertible
security  is a function  of its  "investment  value" (its value as if it did not
have a conversion  privilege),  and its "conversion value" (the security's worth
if it were to be  exchanged  for  the  underlying  security,  at  market  value,
pursuant to its conversion privilege).

DEBT-TO-EQUITY CONVERSIONS

Emerging  Markets  Fund may invest up to 5% of its net assets in  debt-to-equity
conversions  incident to corporate  reorganizations.  Debt-to-equity  conversion
programs are sponsored in varying degrees by certain emerging market  countries,
particularly  in Latin America,  and permit  investors to use external debt of a
country to make equity investments in local companies.  Many conversion programs
relate primarily to investments in transportation,  communication, utilities and
similar  infrastructure-related  areas.  The  terms of the  programs  vary  from
country to country,  but include significant  restrictions on the application of
proceeds  received  in the  conversion  and on the  repatriation  of  investment
profits  and  capital.  When  inviting  conversion  applications  by  holders of
eligible  debt, a government  usually  specifies  the minimum  discount from par
value that it will accept for  conversion.  SCMI  believes  that  debt-to-equity
conversion  programs may offer  investors  opportunities  to invest in otherwise
restricted  equity  securities  that have a potential  for  significant  capital
appreciation  and intends to invest assets of the Portfolio to a limited  extent
in such programs under appropriate circumstances. There can be no assurance that
debt-to-equity  conversion  programs  will continue or be successful or that the
Portfolio  will  be able  to  convert  all or any of its  emerging  market  debt
portfolio into equity investments.

FORWARD FOREIGN CURRENCY EXCHANGE CONTRACTS

To hedge against adverse price movements in the securities held in its portfolio
and the currencies in which they are  denominated  (as well as in the securities
it might  wish to  purchase  and their  denominated  currencies),  International
Equity Fund and  Emerging  Markets  Fund may engage in  transactions  in forward
foreign currency contracts.

A  forward  foreign  currency  exchange  contract  ("forward  contract")  is  an
obligation  to  purchase  or sell a currency  at a future date (which may be any
fixed number of days from the date of the  contract  agreed upon by the parties)
at a price  set at the  time of the  contract.  International  Equity  Fund  and
Emerging  Markets Fund may each enter into forward  contracts as a hedge against
fluctuations in future foreign exchange rates.

Currently,  only a limited  market,  if any,  exists  for  hedging  transactions
relating to  currencies in many  emerging  market  countries or to securities of
issuers  domiciled  or  principally  engaged  in  business  in  emerging  market
countries.  This may limit a Fund's ability to effectively hedge its investments
in those emerging markets.  Hedging against a decline in the value of a currency
does not eliminate fluctuations in the prices of portfolio securities or prevent
losses if the prices of such securities  decline.  Such  transactions also limit
the opportunity for gain if the value of the hedged  currencies  should rise. In
addition,  it may not be possible for a Fund to hedge against a devaluation that
is so  generally  anticipated  that the Fund is not able to contract to sell the
currency at a price above the devaluation level it anticipates.

A Fund will enter into forward  contracts under certain  instances.  When a Fund
enters into a contract for the purchase or sale of a security  denominated  in a
foreign currency,  it may, for example, wish to secure the price of the security
in  U.S.  dollars  or  some  other  foreign  currency  which  the  Portfolio  is
temporarily  holding in its portfolio.  By entering into a forward  contract for
the  purchase or sale (for a fixed  amount of dollars or other  currency) of the
amount of foreign currency involved in the underlying security  transactions,  a
Fund will be able to  protect  itself 


                                       6
<PAGE>

against  possible  loss  (resulting  from  adverse  changes in the  relationship
between the U.S.  dollar or other currency being used for the security  purchase
and the foreign currency in which the security is denominated) during the period
between  the date on which the  security  is  purchased  or sold and the date on
which payment is made or received.

In addition,  when a Fund anticipates purchasing securities at some future date,
and wishes to secure the current  exchange  rate of the  currency in which those
securities  are  denominated  against  the U.S.  dollar  or some  other  foreign
currency, it may enter into a forward contract to purchase an amount of currency
equal  to part or all of the  value  of the  anticipated  purchase,  for a fixed
amount of U.S. dollars or other currency.

In all of the  above  instances,  if the  currency  in which a Fund's  portfolio
securities (or anticipated  portfolio securities) are denominated rises in value
with respect to the currency which is being  purchased,  then the Fund will have
realized  fewer  gains  than  if the  Fund  had not  entered  into  the  forward
contracts. Furthermore, the precise matching of the forward contract amounts and
the value of the securities  involved will not generally be possible,  since the
future  value  of  such  securities  in  foreign  currencies  will  change  as a
consequence  of market  movements in the value of those  securities  between the
date the forward contract is entered into and the date it matures.

To the extent that a Fund enters into  forward  foreign  currency  contracts  to
hedge  against a decline in the value of  portfolio  holdings  denominated  in a
particular  foreign currency  resulting from currency  fluctuations,  there is a
risk  that the  Fund  may  nevertheless  realize  a gain or loss as a result  of
currency  fluctuations after such portfolio holdings are sold should the Fund be
unable to enter into an "offsetting"  forward foreign currency contract with the
same party or another  party. A Fund may be limited in its ability to enter into
hedging  transactions  involving  forward contracts by the Internal Revenue Code
requirements  relating to qualifications as a regulated  investment company (see
"Taxation").

A Fund is not  required  to enter  into  such  transactions  with  regard to its
foreign  currency-denominated  securities  and  will  not  do so  unless  deemed
appropriate by SCMI.  Generally,  a Fund will not enter into a forward  contract
with a term of greater than one year.

OPTIONS AND HEDGING

As discussed in the Prospectus, certain Funds (and Portfolios) may write covered
call options against securities held in its portfolio and covered put options on
eligible  portfolio  securities  and may purchase  options of the same series to
effect  closing  transactions;  and may hedge against  potential  changes in the
market value of its investments  (or anticipated  investments) by purchasing put
and call  options on  portfolio  (or  eligible  portfolio)  securities  (and the
currencies in which they are denominated) and engaging in transactions involving
futures contracts and options on such contracts.

Call and put  options  on U.S.  Treasury  notes,  bonds and bills and on various
foreign currencies are listed on several U.S. and foreign  securities  exchanges
and are written in over-the-counter transactions ("OTC Options"). Listed options
are issued or  guaranteed  by the  exchange on which they trade or by a clearing
corporation such as the Options  Clearing  Corporation  ("OCC").  Ownership of a
listed call  option  gives a Fund the right to buy from the OCC (in the U.S.) or
other  clearing  corporation or exchange,  the  underlying  security or currency
covered by the option at the  stated  exercise  price (the price per unit of the
underlying  security  or  currency)  by filing an exercise  notice  prior to the
expiration date of the option. The writer (seller) of the option would then have
the obligation to sell, to the OCC (in the U.S.) or other  clearing  corporation
or exchange, the underlying security or currency at that exercise price prior to
the expiration date of the option,  regardless of its then current market price.
Ownership  of a  listed  put  option  would  give a Fund  the  right to sell the
underlying  security  or  currency  to the OCC (in the  U.S.) or other  clearing
corporation or exchange at the stated exercise price. Upon notice of exercise of
the put option,  the writer of the option would have the  obligation to purchase
the underlying security or currency from the OCC (in the U.S.) or other clearing
corporation or exchange at the exercise price.

The OCC or other  clearing  corporation  or exchange that issues listed  options
ensures that all transactions in such options are properly executed. OTC options
are purchased from or sold (written) to dealers or financial  institutions


                                       7
<PAGE>

which  have  entered  into  direct  agreements  with a Fund.  With OTC  options,
variables  such as expiration  date,  exercise  price and premium will be agreed
between a Fund and the transacting  dealer.  If the transacting  dealer fails to
make or take delivery of the securities or amount of foreign currency underlying
an option it has  written,  a Fund would lose the premium paid for the option as
well as any anticipated  benefit of the  transaction.  A Fund will engage in OTC
option  transactions  only with member  banks of the Federal  Reserve  System or
primary dealers in U.S.  Government  securities or with affiliates of such banks
or dealers which have capital of at least $50 million or whose  obligations  are
guaranteed by an entity having capital of at least $50 million.

OPTIONS ON FOREIGN  CURRENCIES.  International  Equity Fund and Emerging Markets
Fund may purchase and write options on foreign  currencies for purposes  similar
to those involved with investing in forward foreign currency exchange contracts.
For  example,  in order to  protect  against  declines  in the  dollar  value of
portfolio  securities  which are denominated in a foreign  currency,  a Fund may
purchase put options on an amount of such  foreign  currency  equivalent  to the
current value of the portfolio securities involved. As a result, a Fund would be
able to sell the foreign  currency for a fixed amount of U.S.  dollars,  thereby
securing the dollar value of the  portfolio  securities  (less the amount of the
premiums paid for the options).  Conversely, a Fund may purchase call options on
foreign currencies in which securities it anticipates purchasing are denominated
to secure a set U.S.  dollar  price for such  securities  and protect  against a
decline in the value of the U.S.  dollar against such foreign  currency.  A Fund
may also purchase call and put options to close out written option positions.

A Fund may also  write  covered  call  options on  foreign  currency  to protect
against potential declines in its portfolio  securities which are denominated in
foreign currencies.  If the U.S. dollar value of the portfolio  securities falls
as a result of a decline in the exchange  rate  between the foreign  currency in
which it is denominated and the U.S. dollar, then a loss to a Fund occasioned by
such value decline would be  ameliorated by receipt of the premium on the option
sold.  At the same time,  however,  a Fund  gives up the  benefit of any rise in
value of the  relevant  portfolio  securities  above the  exercise  price of the
option and, in fact,  only  receives a benefit from the writing of the option to
the extent that the value of the portfolio  securities  falls below the price of
the  premium  received.  A Fund may also  write  options  to close out long call
option positions. A covered put option on a foreign currency would be written by
the Fund for the same reason it would purchase a call option,  namely,  to hedge
against an increase in the U.S.  dollar  value of a foreign  security  which the
Fund anticipates  purchasing.  Here, the receipt of the premium would offset, to
the extent of the size of the premium,  any increased  cost to a Fund  resulting
from an increase in the U.S. dollar value of the foreign  security.  However,  a
Fund could not  benefit  from any  decline in the cost of the  foreign  security
which is greater than the price of the premium  received.  A Fund may also write
options to close out long put option positions.

Markets in foreign  currency  options are relatively new and a Fund's ability to
establish and close out positions on such options is subject to the  maintenance
of a liquid  secondary  market.  Although a Fund will not purchase or write such
options  unless and until,  in the opinion of the SCMI,  the market for them has
developed sufficiently to ensure that their risks are not greater than the risks
in connection  with the  underlying  currency,  there can be no assurance that a
liquid secondary market will exist for a particular option at any specific time.
In addition,  options on foreign currencies are affected by all of those factors
that influence foreign exchange rates and investments generally.

The value of a foreign  currency option depends upon the value of the underlying
currency  relative  to the U.S.  dollar:  as a result,  the price of the  option
position may vary with changes in the value of either or both currencies and may
have no relationship to the investment merits of a foreign  security,  including
foreign  securities  held in a "hedged"  investment  portfolio.  Because foreign
currency  transactions  occurring in the interbank market involve  substantially
larger  amounts  than those that may be involved in the use of foreign  currency
options,  investors may be  disadvantaged by having to deal in an odd lot market
(generally  consisting  of  transactions  of  less  than  $1  million)  for  the
underlying  foreign  currencies at prices that are less favorable than for round
lots.

There is no systematic reporting of last sale information for foreign currencies
or any regulatory requirement that quotations available through dealers or other
market  sources  be firm or  revised on a timely  basis.  Quotation  information
available  is  generally  representative  of  very  large  transactions  in  the
interbank market and thus may not reflect relatively smaller transactions (i.e.,
less than $1 million) where rates may be less favorable. The interbank market in
foreign currencies is a global,  around-the-clock market. To the extent that the
U.S. options markets are 


                                       8
<PAGE>

closed while the markets for the underlying currencies remain open,  significant
price and rate movements may take place in the  underlying  markets that are not
reflected in the options market.

COVERED CALL WRITING.  Emerging  Markets Fund is permitted to write covered call
options on portfolio securities and on the U.S. dollar and foreign currencies in
which they are  denominated,  without  limit.  Equity  Index Fund and  Investors
Equity Fund may write  covered  calls on up to 100% of their total assets if the
calls are listed on a domestic securities or commodities exchange.  Generally, a
call  option is  "covered"  if a Fund owns (or has the right to acquire  without
additional cash consideration (or for additional cash consideration held for the
Fund  by  its  Custodian  in  a  segregated  account)  the  underlying  security
(currency)  subject to the option.  In the case of call options on U.S. Treasury
Bills,  however,  the Fund might own U.S.  Treasury Bills of a different  series
from those  underlying  the call option,  but with a principal  amount and value
corresponding  to the exercise  price and a maturity  date no later than that of
the security (currency) deliverable under the call option. A call option is also
covered if a Fund holds a call on the same security as the  underlying  security
(currency) of the written option,  where the exercise price of the call used for
coverage is equal to or less than the exercise price of the call or greater than
the  exercise  price of the call  written  if the mark to market  difference  is
maintained  by a Fund in cash,  U.S.  Government  securities or other high grade
debt obligations  which the Portfolio holds in a segregated  account  maintained
with its custodian.

A Fund will  receive a premium  from the  purchaser  in return for a call it has
written.  Receipt of such  premiums  may enable a Fund to earn a higher level of
current  income  than it would  earn  from  holding  the  underlying  securities
(currencies) alone.  Moreover, the premium received will offset a portion of the
potential loss incurred by a Fund if the securities  (currencies) underlying the
option are ultimately  sold  (exchanged) by the Fund at a loss.  Furthermore,  a
premium  received on a call written on a foreign  currency will  ameliorate  any
potential loss of value on the portfolio  security due to a decline in the value
of the currency. However, during the option period, the covered call writer has,
in return for the premium,  given up the  opportunity  for capital  appreciation
above the exercise price should the market price of the underlying  security (or
the exchange rate of the currency in which it is denominated)  increase, but has
retained  the risk of loss should the price of the  underlying  security (or the
exchange rate of the currency in which it is denominated)  decline.  The premium
received will fluctuate with varying economic market  conditions.  If the market
value  of the  portfolio  securities  (or  the  currencies  in  which  they  are
denominated)  upon which call options have been  written  increases,  a Fund may
receive a lower total return from the portion of its portfolio  upon which calls
have been written than it would have had such calls not been written.

With respect to listed options and certain OTC options, during the option period
a Fund  may be  required,  at any  time,  to  deliver  the  underlying  security
(currency)  against  payment of the  exercise  price on any calls it has written
(exercise  of  certain  listed  and  OTC  options  may be  limited  to  specific
expiration  dates).  This  obligation is terminated  upon the  expiration of the
option period or at such earlier time when the writer effects a closing purchase
transaction.  A closing  purchase  transaction is  accomplished by purchasing an
option of the same series as the option previously written. However, once a Fund
has been  assigned  an  exercise  notice,  the Fund  will be  unable to effect a
closing purchase transaction.

Closing purchase  transactions are ordinarily effected to realize a profit on an
outstanding call option, to prevent an underlying security (currency) from being
called,  to permit the sale of an  underlying  security  (or the exchange of the
underlying  currency)  or to enable a Fund to write  another  call option on the
underlying  security  (currency)  with  either  a  different  exercise  price or
expiration  date or both.  A Fund may  realize a net gain or loss from a closing
purchase  transaction  depending upon whether the amount of the premium received
on the  call  option  is more or less  than the cost of  effecting  the  closing
purchase transaction. Any loss incurred in a closing purchase transaction may be
wholly or partially offset by unrealized appreciation in the market value of the
underlying  security  (currency).  Conversely,  a gain  resulting from a closing
purchase  transaction  could be  offset  in whole  or in part or  exceeded  by a
decline in the market value of the underlying security (currency).

If a call option  expires  unexercised,  a Fund realizes a gain in the amount of
the premium on the option less the commission paid. Such a gain, however, may be
offset by depreciation in the market value of the underlying security (currency)
during the option period. If a call option is exercised,  a Fund realizes a gain
or loss  from  the  sale of the  underlying  security 


                                       9
<PAGE>

(currency) equal to the difference  between the purchase price of the underlying
security (currency) and the proceeds of the sale of the security (currency) plus
the premium received on the option less the commission paid.

Options written by a Fund will normally have expiration  dates of up to eighteen
months from the date written. The exercised price of a call option may be below,
equal to or above the current  market  value of the  underlying  security at the
time the option is written.

COVERED PUT WRITING.  As a writer of a covered put option, a Fund would incur an
obligation to buy the security  underlying  the option from the purchaser of the
put, at the option's exercise price at any time during the option period, at the
purchaser's  election (certain listed and OTC put options written by a Fund will
be exercisable by the purchaser only on a specific  date). A put is "covered" if
at all times a Fund maintains with its custodian (in a segregated account) cash,
U.S. Government securities or other high grade obligations in an amount equal to
at least the exercise price of the option. Similarly, a short put position could
be  covered  by a Fund by its  purchase  of a put  option  on the same  security
(currency) as the underlying security of the written option,  where the exercise
price of the purchased option is equal to or more than the exercise price of the
put written or less than the exercise  price of the put written if the marked to
market difference is maintained by a Fund in cash, U.S. Government securities or
other high grade debt obligations  which the Fund holds in a segregated  account
maintained  at its  custodian.  In writing puts, a Fund assumes the risk of loss
should the market value of the underlying  security (currency) decline below the
exercise  price of the option  (any loss being  decreased  by the receipt of the
premium on the option written). In the case of listed options, during the option
period a Fund may be  required,  at any time,  to make  payment of the  exercise
price against delivery of the underlying security  (currency).  The operation of
and  limitations  on covered put  options in other  respects  are  substantially
identical to those of call options.

A Fund will write put  options  for three  purposes:  (1) to receive  the income
derived from the premiums paid by purchasers;  (2) when the  investment  adviser
wishes to purchase  the  security  (or a security  denominated  in the  currency
underlying  the option)  underlying the option at a price lower than its current
market  price (in which case it will write the covered put at an exercise  price
reflecting the lower  purchase  price  sought);  and (3) to close out a long put
option  position.  The potential  gain on a covered put option is limited to the
premium  received on the option (less the commissions  paid on the  transaction)
while the potential  loss equals the  differences  between the exercise price of
the  option  and  the  current  market  price  of  the   underlying   securities
(currencies) when the put is exercised, offset by the premium received (less the
commissions paid on the transaction).

PURCHASING CALL AND PUT OPTIONS. Equity Index Fund and Investors Equity Fund may
purchase put options ("puts") that relate to: (1) securities it holds; (2) Stock
Index  Futures  (whether  or  not it  holds  such  Stock  Index  Futures  in its
portfolio); or (3) broadly-based stock indices. The Fund may not sell puts other
than those it previously purchased,  nor purchase puts on securities it does not
hold. The fund may purchase  calls:  (a) as to securities,  broadly-based  stock
indices  or  Stock  Index  Futures,   or  (b)  to  effect  a  "closing  purchase
transaction" to terminate its obligation on a call it has previously  written. A
call or put may be purchased only if, after such purchase,  the value of all put
and call  options  held by the Fund  would  not  exceed 5% of the  Fund's  total
assets.  Emerging  Markets Fund may purchase listed and OTC call and put options
in amounts  equaling up to 5u of its total  assets.  A Fund may  purchase a call
option in order to close out a covered call position (see "Covered Call Writing"
above),  to protect  against an increase  in price of a security it  anticipates
purchasing  or,  in the case of a call  option  on  foreign  currency,  to hedge
against an adverse  exchange  rate move of the currency in which the security it
anticipates  purchasing  is  denominated  vis-a-vis  the  currency  in which the
exercise  price is  denominated.  The  purchase  of the call  option to effect a
closing transaction on a call written over-the-counter may be a listed or an OTC
option.  In  either  case,  the  call  purchased  is  likely  to be on the  same
securities  (currencies)  and have the same  terms  as the  written  option.  If
purchased  over-the-counter,  the option would  generally  be acquired  from the
dealer or financial institution which purchased the call written by a Fund.

A Fund may purchase put options on securities (currencies) which it holds in its
portfolio to protect  itself  against a decline in the value of the security and
to close out  written  put  option  positions.  If the  value of the  underlying
security  (currency)  were to fall below the exercise price of the put purchased
in an amount greater then the premium paid for the option, a Fund would incur no
additional  loss.  In addition,  a Fund may sell a put option it has  previously
purchased  prior  to the sale of the  securities  (currencies)  underlying  such
option.  Such a sale would result


                                       10
<PAGE>

in a net gain or loss depending upon whether the amount  received on the sale is
more or less than the premium and other transaction costs paid on the put option
that is sold.  Any such  gain or loss  could be  offset in whole or in part by a
change in the  market  value of the  underlying  security  (currency).  If a put
option purchased by a Fund expired without being sold or exercised,  the premium
would be lost.

RISKS OF OPTIONS TRANSACTIONS. During the option period, the covered call writer
has,  in return for the  premium on the  option,  given up the  opportunity  for
capital  appreciation  above  the  exercise  price  if the  market  price of the
underlying security (or the value of its denominated  currency)  increases,  but
has  retained the risk of loss if the price of the  underlying  security (or the
value of its denominated currency) declines.  The writer has no control over the
time  when it may be  required  to  fulfill  its  obligation  as a writer of the
option.  Once an option writer has received an exercise notice, it cannot effect
a closing  purchase  transaction in order to terminate its obligation  under the
option and must  deliver or receive the  underlying  securities  at the exercise
price.

Prior to exercise or  expiration,  an option  position can only be terminated by
entering into a closing purchase or sale  transaction.  If a covered call option
writer is unable to effect a closing  purchase  transaction  or to  purchase  an
offsetting OTC option,  it cannot sell the underlying  security until the option
expires or the option is  exercised.  Accordingly,  a covered call option writer
may not be able to sell an underlying security at a time when it might otherwise
be  advantageous to do so. A covered put option writer who is unable to effect a
closing  purchase  transaction  or to purchase an  offsetting  OTC option  would
continue  to bear the risk of  decline  in the  market  price of the  underlying
security  until the option expires or is exercised.  In addition,  a covered put
writer would be unable to utilize the amount held in cash or U.S.  Government or
other high grade short-term obligations as security for the put option for other
investment purposes until the exercise or expiration of the option.

A Fund's ability to close out its position as a writer of an option is dependent
upon the existence of a liquid secondary market on option exchanges. There is no
assurance  that  such a  market  will  exist,  particularly  in the  case of OTC
options, since such options will generally only be closed out by entering into a
closing purchase transaction with the purchasing dealer.  However, a Fund may be
able to purchase an offsetting  option that does not close out its position as a
writer  but  constitutes  an asset of equal  value to the  obligation  under the
option  written.  If a Fund is not able to either enter into a closing  purchase
transaction or purchase an offsetting position,  it will be required to maintain
the securities  subject to the call, or the collateral  underlying the put, even
though it might not be advantageous to do so, until a closing transaction can be
entered into (or the option is exercised or expires).

Among the possible  reasons for the absence of a liquid  secondary  market on an
exchange  are:  (1)  insufficient  trading  interest  in  certain  options;  (2)
restrictions  on  transactions  imposed  by  an  exchange;  (3)  trading  halts,
suspensions or other restrictions  imposed with respect to particular classes or
series of options  or  underlying  securities;  (4)  interruption  of the normal
operations on an exchange;  (5)  inadequacy of the  facilities of an exchange or
the OCC to handle  current  trading  volume;  or (6) a  decision  by one or more
exchanges to discontinue the trading of options (or a particular class or series
of options),  in which event the  secondary  market on that exchange (or in that
class or series of options) would cease to exist.

In the event of the  bankruptcy  of a broker  through  which a Fund  engages  in
transactions  in options,  the Fund could  experience  delays  and/or  losses in
liquidating  open positions  purchased or sold through the broker and/or incur a
loss of all or part of its margin  deposits with the broker.  Similarly,  in the
event of the bankruptcy of the writer of an OTC option  purchased by a Fund, the
Fund  could  experience  a loss  of all or  part  of the  value  of the  option.
Transactions  will be  entered  into by a Fund only with  brokers  or  financial
institutions deemed creditworthy by its investment adviser or subadviser.

Exchanges have established  limitations  governing the maximum number of options
on the same  underlying  security or futures  contract  (whether or not covered)
that may be written by a single  investor,  whether  acting  alone or in concert
with  others  (regardless  of whether  such  options  are written on the same or
different  exchanges  or are held or written on one or more  accounts or through
one or more brokers).  An exchange may order the  liquidation of positions found
to be in  violation  of  these  limits  and it may  impose  other  sanctions  or
restrictions.  These  position  limits may restrict the number of listed options
which a Fund may write.

                                       11
<PAGE>

The hours of trading for options may not conform to the hours  during  which the
underlying securities are traded. If the option markets close before the markets
for the  underlying  securities,  significant  price and rate movements can take
place in the underlying markets that cannot be reflected in the option markets.

The extent to which a Fund may enter into transactions  involving options may be
limited by the Internal  Revenue  Code's  requirements  for  qualification  as a
regulated  investment  company  and a Fund's  intention  to qualify as such (see
"Taxation").

FUTURES CONTRACTS.  Certain Funds may purchase and sell interest rate, currency,
and index futures  contracts  ("futures  contracts") that are traded on U.S. and
foreign  commodity  exchanges,  on such underlying  securities as U.S.  Treasury
bonds,  notes and bills,  and/or any foreign  government  fixed-income  security
("interest rate" futures),  on various  currencies  ("currency  futures") and on
such  indices of U.S.  and  foreign  securities  as may exist or come into being
("index futures").

A Fund will purchase or sell interest rate futures  contracts for the purpose of
hedging some or all of the value of its  portfolio  securities  (or  anticipated
portfolio  securities)  against  changes in prevailing  interest  rates.  If the
investment adviser anticipates that interest rates may rise and,  concomitantly,
the  price of  certain  of its  portfolio  securities  fall,  a Fund may sell an
interest rate futures contract.  If declining interest rates are anticipated,  a
Fund may  purchase  an  interest  rate  futures  contract  to protect  against a
potential  increase in the price of  securities  the Fund  intends to  purchase.
Subsequently,  appropriate  securities  may be purchased by a Fund in an orderly
fashion; as securities are purchased,  corresponding  futures positions would be
terminated by offsetting sales of contracts.

A Fund will purchase or sell index futures  contracts for the purpose of hedging
some or all of its  portfolio  (or  anticipated  portfolio)  securities  against
changes in their  prices.  If it  anticipates  that the prices of  securities it
holds may fall, a Fund may sell an index futures contract. Conversely, if a Fund
wishes to hedge against  anticipated  price rises in those  securities  which it
intends to purchase, the Fund may purchase an index futures contract.

A Fund  will  purchase  or sell  currency  futures  on  currencies  in which its
portfolio securities (or anticipated  portfolio  securities) are denominated for
the purposes of hedging against  anticipated changes in currency exchange rates.
A Fund will enter into  currency  futures  contracts for the same reasons as set
forth above for  entering  into forward  foreign  currency  exchange  contracts;
namely, to secure the value of a security  purchased or sold in a given currency
vis-a-vis a different  currency or to hedge against an adverse currency exchange
rate movement of a portfolio  security's (or anticipated  portfolio  security's)
denominated currency vis-a-vis a different currency.

In addition to the above,  interest  rate,  index and  currency  futures will be
bought  or sold in order to close out short or long  positions  maintained  by a
Fund in corresponding futures contracts.

Although  most  interest  rate  futures  contracts  call for actual  delivery or
acceptance  of  securities,  the  contracts  usually  are  closed out before the
settlement date without making or taking  delivery.  A futures  contract sale is
closed out by  effecting  a futures  contract  purchase  for the same  aggregate
amount of the specific type of security  (currency)  and the same delivery date.
If the sale price exceeds the  offsetting  purchase  price,  the seller would be
paid the difference  and would realize a gain. If the offsetting  purchase price
exceeds the sale price,  the seller would pay the difference and would realize a
loss.  Similarly,  a futures  contract  purchase  is closed out by  effecting  a
futures  contract  sale for the same  aggregate  amount of the specific  type of
security  (currency) and the same delivery  date. If the  offsetting  sale price
exceeds the purchase price,  the purchaser would realize a gain,  whereas if the
purchase price exceeds the offsetting sale price,  the purchaser would realize a
loss.  There is no  assurance  that a Fund will be able to enter  into a closing
transaction.

INTEREST  RATE  FUTURES  CONTRACTS.  When a Fund enters  into an  interest  rate
futures contract,  it is initially  required to deposit with its custodian (in a
segregated  account in the name of the broker  performing  the  transaction)  an
"initial  margin"  of cash or U.S.  Government  securities  or other  high grade
short-term obligations equal to approximately 2% of the contract amount. Initial
margin  requirements are established by the exchanges on which futures contracts
trade  and may  change.  In  addition,  brokers  may  establish  margin  deposit
requirements in excess of those required by the exchanges.

                                       12
<PAGE>

Initial  margin in futures  transactions  is different from margin in securities
transactions in that initial margin does not involve the borrowing of money by a
brokers'  client but is,  rather,  a good faith deposit on the futures  contract
that will be  returned  to a Fund upon the  proper  termination  of the  futures
contract.  The margin deposits made are marked to market daily and a Fund may be
required  to make  subsequent  deposits  of cash or U.S.  Government  securities
(called  "variation  margin") with the Fund's futures contract  clearing broker,
which are reflective of price fluctuations in the futures contract.

CURRENCY FUTURES.  Generally,  foreign currency futures provide for the delivery
of a specified  amount of a given  currency,  on the  exercise  date,  for a set
exercise price  denominated in U.S. dollars or other currency.  Foreign currency
futures  contracts  would be entered into for the same reason and under the same
circumstances as forward foreign currency exchange  contracts.  SCMI will assess
such factors as cost spreads,  liquidity and  transaction  costs in  determining
whether to use futures  contracts or forward  contracts in its foreign  currency
transactions and hedging strategy.

Purchasers and sellers of foreign currency futures  contracts are subject to the
same risks that  apply  generally  to the  buying  and  selling of  futures.  In
addition, there are risks associated with foreign currency futures contracts and
their use as a hedging  device  similar  to those  associated  with  options  on
foreign currencies  described above.  Further,  settlement of a foreign currency
futures contract must occur within the country issuing the underlying  currency.
Thus, a Fund must accept or make delivery of the underlying  foreign currency in
accordance with any U.S. or foreign  restrictions  or regulations  regarding the
maintenance  of  foreign  banking  arrangements  by  U.S.  residents  and may be
required to pay any fees,  taxes or charges  associated with such delivery which
are assessed in the issuing country.

INDEX FUTURES CONTRACTS. Each Fund, except International Equity Fund, may invest
in index futures contracts. An index futures contract sale creates an obligation
by a Fund,  as seller,  to deliver  cash at a specified  future  time.  An index
futures contract purchase would create an obligation by a Fund, as purchaser, to
take delivery of cash at a specified future time.  Futures  contracts on indices
do not require the physical delivery of securities, but provide for a final cash
settlement on the expiration date that reflects  accumulated  profits and losses
credited or debited to each party's account.

A Fund is required to maintain  margin  deposits  with  brokerage  firms through
which it effects index futures  contracts in a manner  similar to that described
above for interest rate futures contracts.  In addition, due to current industry
practice, daily variations in gains and losses on open contracts are required to
be  reflected in cash in the form of variation  margin  payments.  A Fund may be
required to make additional margin payments during the term of the contract.

At any time prior to  expiration  of the futures  contract,  a Fund may elect to
close the  position  by taking an  opposite  position,  which  will  operate  to
terminate the Fund's position in the futures contract.  A final determination of
variation  margin is then made,  additional  cash is  required  to be paid by or
released to a Fund and the Fund realizes a loss or gain.

OPTIONS ON FUTURES CONTRACTS. A Fund may purchase and write call and put options
on  futures  contracts  traded  on  an  exchange  and  may  enter  into  closing
transactions with respect to such options to terminate an existing position.  An
option on a futures  contract  gives the  purchaser the right (in return for the
premium paid) to assume a position in a futures contract (a long position if the
option is a call and a short  position  if the  option is a put) at a  specified
exercise  price at any time during the term of the option.  Upon exercise of the
option,  the delivery of the futures position by the writer of the option to the
holder of the option is  accompanied by delivery of the  accumulated  balance in
the writer's  futures margin account,  which  represents the amount by which the
market price of the futures contract at the time of exercise exceeds, in case of
a call, or is less than, in the case of a put, the exercise  price of the option
on the futures contract.

A Fund will  purchase  and write  options  on  futures  contracts  for  purposes
identical  to those  set  forth  above for the  purchase  of a futures  contract

                                       13
<PAGE>

(purchase  of a call  option or sale of a put  option) and the sale of a futures
contract (purchase of a put option or sale of a call option),  or to close out a
long or short  position in futures  contracts.  If, for example,  the investment
adviser  wished  to  protect  against  an  increase  in  interest  rates and the
resulting  negative  impact  on the  value  of a  portion  of  its  fixed-income
portfolio,  it might write a call option on an interest  rate futures  contract,
the underlying  security of which  correlates  with the portion of the portfolio
the Adviser seeks to hedge.  Any premiums  received in the writing of options on
futures  contracts  may provide a further hedge against  losses  resulting  from
price declines in portions of a Fund's investment portfolio.

Options on foreign  currency  futures  contracts may involve certain  additional
risks.  Trading options on foreign currency futures contracts is relatively new.
The ability to establish  and close out  positions on such options is subject to
the maintenance of a liquid secondary  market.  To reduce this risk, a Fund will
not purchase or write options on foreign currency  futures  contracts unless and
until, in SCMI's opinion, the market for such options has developed sufficiently
that the  risks  in  connection  with  them are not  greater  than the  risks in
connection  with  transactions  in  the  underlying   foreign  currency  futures
contracts.

LIMITATIONS  ON FUTURES  CONTRACTS AND OPTIONS ON FUTURES.  A Fund may not enter
into  futures  contracts or purchase  related  options  thereon if,  immediately
thereafter, the amount committed to margin plus the amount paid for premiums for
unexpired options on futures contracts exceeds 5% of the value of a Fund's total
assets, after taking into account unrealized gains and unrealized losses on such
contracts it has entered into, provided,  however, that in the case of an option
that is in-the-money (the exercise price of the call (put) option is less (more)
than the market price of the underlying  security) at the time of purchase,  the
in-the-money amount may be excluded in calculating the 5%. However,  there is no
overall  limitation on the percentage of a Fund's assets which may be subject to
a hedge  position.  In  addition,  in  accordance  with the  regulations  of the
Commodity  Futures  Trading  Commission  ("CFTC") under which a Fund is exempted
from  registration  as a commodity pool  operator,  the Fund may only enter into
futures contracts and options on futures contracts  transactions for purposes of
hedging a part or all of its portfolio.  Except as described above, there are no
other limitations on the use of futures and options thereon by a Fund.

The writer of an option on a futures contract is required to deposit initial and
variation margin pursuant to requirements similar to those applicable to futures
contracts. Premiums received from the writing of an option on a futures contract
are included in initial margin deposits.

RISKS OF TRANSACTIONS IN FUTURES CONTRACTS AND RELATED OPTIONS.  A Fund may sell
a futures contract to protect against the decline in the value of securities (or
the  currency  in which they are  denominated)  held by a Fund.  However,  it is
possible  that  the  futures  market  may  advance  and the  value  of a  Fund's
securities (or the currency in which they are denominated) may decline.  If this
occurs,  a Fund will lose money on the futures  contract  and also  experience a
decline in value of its portfolio securities.  While this might occur for only a
very  brief  period  or to a  very  small  degree,  over  time  the  value  of a
diversified  portfolio  will tend to move in the same  direction  as the futures
contracts.

If a Fund purchases a futures contract to hedge against the increase in value of
securities  it intends to buy (or the  currency in which they are  denominated),
and the  value  of  such  securities  (currencies)  decreases,  then a Fund  may
determine not to invest in the  securities as planned and will realize a loss on
the  futures  contract  that is not  offset by a  reduction  in the price of the
securities.

If a Fund has sold a call  option  on a futures  contract,  it will  cover  this
position by holding (in a segregated  account maintained at its Custodian) cash,
U.S.  Government  Securities or other high grade debt obligations equal in value
(when added to any initial or  variation  margin on deposit) to the market value
of the securities  (currencies)  underlying the futures contract or the exercise
price  of the  option.  Such a  position  may  also be  covered  by  owning  the
securities  (currencies)  underlying the futures contract,  or by holding a call
option permitting a Fund to purchase the same contract at a price no higher than
the price at which the short position was established.

In addition,  if a Fund holds a long position in a futures contract it will hold
cash, U.S.  Government  Securities or other high grade debt obligations equal to
the  purchase  price of the  contract  (less the amount of initial or  variation
margin  on  deposit)  in a  segregated  account  maintained  for a  Fund  by its
Custodian.  Alternatively,  a Fund could 


                                       14
<PAGE>

cover its long position by purchasing a put option on the same futures  contract
with an exercise  price as high or higher than the price of the contract held by
the Fund.

Exchanges limit the amount by which the price of a futures  contract may move on
any day. If the price moves equal the daily limit on  successive  days,  then it
may prove impossible to liquidate a futures position until the daily limit moves
have ceased.  In the event of adverse price movements,  a Fund would continue to
be required  to make daily cash  payments of  variation  margin on open  futures
positions.  In such situations,  if a Fund has insufficient cash, it may have to
sell portfolio  securities to meet daily variation margin requirements at a time
when it may be disadvantageous to do so. In addition,  a Fund may be required to
take or make  delivery  of the  instruments  underlying  interest  rate  futures
contracts it holds at a time when it is  disadvantageous to do so. The inability
to close out options and futures  positions could also have an adverse impact on
a Fund's ability to effectively hedge its portfolio.

Futures  contracts  and options  thereon  that are  purchased or sold on foreign
commodities  exchanges  may  have  greater  price  volatility  than  their  U.S.
counterparts.  Furthermore,  foreign commodities exchanges may be less regulated
and  under  less  governmental   scrutiny  than  U.S.  exchanges  and  brokerage
commissions,  clearing costs and other transaction costs may be higher.  Greater
margin  requirements may limit a Fund's ability to enter into certain  commodity
transactions  on foreign  exchanges.  Moreover,  differences  in  clearance  and
delivery requirements on foreign exchanges may cause delays in the settlement of
a Fund's foreign exchange transactions.

In the event of the  bankruptcy  of a broker  through  which a Fund  engages  in
transactions in futures or options  thereon,  the Fund could  experience  delays
and/or losses in liquidating open positions purchased or sold through the broker
and/or  incur a loss of all or part of its  margin  deposits  with  the  broker.
Similarly,  in the  event  of the  bankruptcy  of the  writer  of an OTC  option
purchased  by a Fund,  the Fund  could  experience  a loss of all or part of the
value of the option.  Transactions  are entered into by a Fund only with brokers
or financial institutions deemed creditworthy by the Fund's investment adviser.

While the futures contracts and options  transactions to be engaged in by a Fund
for the purpose of hedging  its  portfolio  securities  are not  speculative  in
nature,  there are risks inherent in the use of such instruments.  One such risk
which may arise in  employing  futures  contracts  to protect  against the price
volatility  of  portfolio  securities  (and the  currencies  in  which  they are
denominated)  is that the prices of  securities  and indices  subject to futures
contracts (and thereby the futures  contract  prices) may correlate  imperfectly
with the behavior of the cash prices of a Fund's  portfolio  securities (and the
currencies in which they are  denominated).  Another such risk is that prices of
interest  rate  futures  contracts  may not move in tandem  with the  changes in
prevailing  interest rates against which a Fund seeks a hedge. A correlation may
also be distorted by the fact that the futures market is dominated by short-term
traders  seeking to profit  from the  difference  between a contract or security
price objective and their cost of borrowed funds. Such distortions are generally
minor and would diminish as the contract approached maturity.

There may exist an imperfect  correlation between the price movements of futures
contracts  purchased by a Fund and the movements in the prices of the securities
(currencies)  which are the subject of the hedge. If participants in the futures
market elect to close out their contracts through offsetting transactions rather
than meet margin deposit  requirements,  distortions in the normal  relationship
between the debt  securities  or currency  markets  and  futures  markets  could
result.  Price  distortions  could also result if investors in futures contracts
choose to make or take delivery of underlying  securities  rather than engage in
closing  transactions  due to the  resultant  reduction in the  liquidity of the
futures  market.  In addition,  because the deposit  requirements in the futures
markets are less onerous than margin requirements in the cash market,  increased
participation  by speculators in the futures market can be anticipated  with the
resulting   speculation   causing  temporary  price  distortions.   Due  to  the
possibility  of price  distortions  in the  futures  market  and  because of the
imperfect  correlation  between  movements  in  the  prices  of  securities  and
movements  in the prices of futures  contracts,  a correct  forecast of interest
rate trends may still not result in a successful hedging transaction.

There is no  assurance  that a liquid  secondary  market  will exist for futures
contracts and related options in which a Fund may invest.  In the event a liquid
market does not exist,  it may not be possible to close out a futures  position,
and in the  event of  adverse  price  movements,  a Fund  would  continue  to be
required  to  make  daily  cash  payments  of


                                       15
<PAGE>

variation  margin. In addition,  limitations  imposed by an exchange or board of
trade on which  futures  contracts  are traded may compel or prevent a Fund from
closing out a contract,  which may result in reduced gain or  increased  loss to
the Fund. The absence of a liquid market in futures contracts might cause a Fund
to make or take delivery of the  underlying  securities  (currencies)  at a time
when it may be disadvantageous to do so.

The  extent  to which a Fund  may  enter  into  transactions  involving  futures
contracts  and options  thereon may be limited by the  Internal  Revenue  Code's
requirements for qualification as a regulated  investment company and the Fund's
intention to qualify as such.

TAX ASPECTS OF HEDGING INSTRUMENTS.  The Fund intends to qualify as a "regulated
investment company" under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 (the "Code"). One of
the tests for such  qualification is that less than 30% of its gross income must
be derived  from gains  realized  on the sale of  securities  held for less than
three months. Due to this limitation, the Fund will limit the extent to which it
engages in the following  activities,  but will not be precluded  from them: (1)
selling  investments,  including  Stock Index Futures,  held for less than three
months, whether or not they were purchased on the exercise of a call held by the
Fund;  (2) purchasing  calls or puts that expire in less than three months;  (3)
effecting closing transactions with respect to calls or puts purchased less than
three  months  previously;  (4)  exercising  puts held by the Fund for less than
three  months;  and (5) writing  calls on  investments  held for less than three
months.

WARRANTS AND STOCK RIGHTS.  A Fund may invest in warrants,  which are options to
purchase an equity security at a specified price (usually representing a premium
over the applicable  market value of the underlying  equity security at the time
of the warrant's issuance). A Fund may not invest more than 5% of its net assets
(at the time of  investment)  in  warrants  (other  than  those  that  have been
acquired in units or attached to other securities).  No more than 2% of a Fund's
net assets (at the time of investment)  may be invested in warrants that are not
listed on the New York or  American  Stock  Exchanges.  Investments  in warrants
involve  certain  risks,  including the possible lack of a liquid market for the
resale of the warrants,  potential price fluctuations as a result of speculation
or other factors and failure of the price of the underlying  security to reach a
level at which the warrant can be prudently exercised (in which case the warrant
may expire  without  being  exercised,  resulting in the loss of a Fund's entire
investment therein).  The prices of warrants do not necessarily move parallel to
the prices of the underlying securities. Warrants have no voting rights, receive
no dividends and have no rights with respect to the assets of the issuer.

In  addition,  a Fund  may  invest  up to 5% of  its  assets  (at  the  time  of
investment)  in stock rights.  A stock right is an option given to a shareholder
to buy  additional  shares at a  predetermined  price  during a  specified  time
period.

FOREIGN SECURITIES

Investment in the securities of foreign issuers may involve risks in addition to
those normally  associated with  investments in the securities of U.S.  issuers.
There may be less publicly  available  information about foreign issuers than is
available  for U.S.  issuers,  and foreign  auditing,  accounting  and financial
reporting practices may differ from U.S.  practices.  Foreign securities markets
may be less  active  than U.S.  markets,  trading  may be thin and  consequently
securities prices may be more volatile.  The Funds' investment adviser, will, in
general,  invest only in securities of companies  and  governments  of countries
which,  in  its  judgment,   are  both  politically  and  economically   stable.
Nevertheless,  all foreign investments are subject to risks of foreign political
and economic  instability,  adverse  movements in foreign  exchange  rates,  the
imposition  or  tightening  of  exchange  controls or other  limitations  on the
repatriation  of foreign capital and changes in foreign  governmental  attitudes
toward  private  investment,  possibly  leading  to  nationalization,  increased
taxation, or confiscation of Portfolio assets.

DEPOSITORY RECEIPTS

Investments  in securities of foreign  issuers may on occasion be in the form of
sponsored  or  unsponsored  American  Depository  Receipts  ("ADRs") or European
Depository  Receipts  ("EDRs"),  or other similar  securities  convertible  into
securities  of  foreign  issuers.   These  securities  may  not  necessarily  be
denominated  in the same  currency  as the  securities  into  which  they may be
converted.  ADRs are receipts typically issued in the United States by a bank or
trust  company,  evidencing  ownership of the  underlying  securities.  EDRs are
typically  issued in Europe under a 


                                       16
<PAGE>

similar arrangement.  Generally,  ADRs, in registered form, are designed for use
in the U.S. securities markets and EDRs, in bearer form, are designed for use in
European  securities  markets.  Unsponsored  ADRs  may be  created  without  the
participation  of the foreign  issuer.  Holders of these ADRs generally bear all
the costs of the ADR facility,  whereas foreign  issuers  typically bear certain
costs in a sponsored ADR. The bank or trust company depository of an unsponsored
ADR may be under no obligation to distribute shareholder communications received
from the foreign issuer or to pass through voting rights.

USE OF FORWARD CONTRACTS IN FOREIGN EXCHANGE TRANSACTIONS

To protect or "hedge" against  adverse  movements in foreign  currency  exchange
rates, International Equity Fund and Emerging Markets Fund may invest in forward
contracts to purchase or sell an agreed-upon amount of a specified currency at a
future date, which may be any fixed number of days from the date of the contract
agreed upon by the  parties,  at a price set at the time of the  contract.  Such
contracts are traded in the interbank market conducted directly between currency
traders (usually large commercial banks) and their customers. A forward contract
generally  has no deposit  requirement,  and no  commissions  are charged at any
stage for trades.  Although such contracts tend to minimize the risk of loss due
to a decline in the value of the currency  which is sold,  they expose a Fund to
the risk  that the  counterparty  is unable  to  perform  and they tend to limit
commensurately  any  potential  gain which might result should the value of such
currency increase during the contract period.

HIGH YIELD/JUNK BONDS

International Equity Fund may invest up to 5% of its assets in bonds rated below
"Baa" by  Moody's  or  "BBB" by S&P  (commonly  known as "high  yield/high  risk
securities" or "junk bonds").  Emerging Markets Fund may invest up to 35% of its
assets in such high  yield/high  risk  securities.  Securities  rated lower than
"Baa"  by  Moody's  or  "BBB"  by S&P are  classified  as  non-investment  grade
securities  and are  considered  speculative.  Junk  bonds  may be  issued  as a
consequence of corporate  restructurings  (such as leveraged  buyouts,  mergers,
acquisitions, debt recapitalizations, or similar events) or by smaller or highly
leveraged companies.  Although the growth of the high yield securities market in
the 1980's paralleled a long economic expansion, recently many issuers have been
affected by adverse economic and market conditions. It should be recognized that
an economic  downturn or increase in interest rates is likely to have a negative
effect  on:  (1) the  high  yield  bond  market;  (2) the  value  of high  yield
securities;  and (3) the  ability of the  securities'  issuers to service  their
principal and interest  payment  obligations,  to meet their projected  business
goal, or to obtain additional financing.  In addition, the market for high yield
securities, which is concentrated in relatively few market makers, may not be as
liquid as the market for investment  grade  securities.  Under adverse market or
economic  conditions,  the  market  for high  yield  securities  could  contract
further,  independent  of any  specific  adverse  changes in the  condition of a
particular  issuer.  As a result,  the Fund could find it more difficult to sell
these securities or may be able to sell the securities only at prices lower than
if such  securities  were widely traded.  Prices  realized upon the sale of such
lower rated or unrated securities,  under these circumstances,  may be less than
the prices used in calculating the Fund's net asset value.

In  periods of  reduced  market  liquidity,  junk bond  prices  may become  more
volatile and may experience sudden and substantial  price declines.  Also, there
may be  significant  disparities  in the prices quoted for junk bonds by various
dealers.  Under such conditions,  a Fund may have to use subjective  rather than
objective  criteria to value its junk bond investments  accurately and rely more
heavily on the judgment of the Fund's investment adviser.

Prices  for junk  bonds  also may be  affected  by  legislative  and  regulatory
developments. For example, new federal laws require the divestiture by federally
insured savings and loans associations of their investments in high yield bonds.
Also,  from time to time,  Congress has  considered  legislation  to restrict or
eliminate  the  corporate  tax  deduction  for interest  payments or to regulate
corporate restructurings such as takeovers,  mergers or leveraged buyouts. These
laws could adversely affect the Fund's net asset value and investment practices,
the market for high yield  securities,  the  financial  condition  of issuers of
these securities, and the value of outstanding high yield securities.

Lower rated or unrated  debt  obligations  also  present  risks based on payment
expectations.  If an issuer calls the  obligation for  redemption,  the Fund may
have to replace the  security  with a lower  yielding  security,  resulting in a

                                       17
<PAGE>

decreased  return  for  investors.   If  the  Fund  experiences  unexpected  net
redemptions, it may be forced to sell its higher rated securities,  resulting in
a decline in the overall credit  quality of the Fund's  portfolio and increasing
the exposure of the Fund to the risks of high yield securities.

SHORT SALES AGAINST-THE-BOX

After the Fund makes a short sale  against-the-box,  while the short position is
open,  the Fund must own an equal  amount of the  securities  sold short;  or by
virtue of ownership of  securities  have the right,  without  payment of further
consideration,  to obtain an equal amount of the  securities  sold short.  Short
sales  against-the-box  may be made to defer,  for Federal  income tax purposes,
recognition  of gain or loss on the sale of  securities  "in the box"  until the
short position is closed out.

3.  INVESTMENT LIMITATIONS

The  following  investment  limitations  restate  or are in  addition  to  those
described under "Investment  Objective and Policies" and "Additional  Investment
Policies and Risk  Considerations" in the Prospectus.  Each Fund has adopted the
following  investment  limitations,  which are fundamental policies of the Funds
unless otherwise stated. Each Fund that invests in a Portfolio has substantially
the same fundamental  investment  policies as the Portfolio in which it invests.
Thus, reference to any Fund that invests in a Portfolio generally refers also to
the Portfolio in which that Fund invests:

(a)      Diversification:

No Fund (other than Emerging Markets Fund,  which as a nonfundamental  policy is
non-diversified) may, with respect to 75% of its assets,  purchase a security if
as a result:  (1) more than 5% of its assets would be invested in the securities
of any single issuer or (2) the Fund would own more than 10% of the  outstanding
voting  securities  of any single  issuer.  This  restriction  does not apply to
securities issued by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities.

(b)      Illiquid Securities

No Fund (except for Emerging Markets Fund and Small Company  Opportunities Fund)
will  invest  more than 10% of its assets in  "illiquid  securities",  which are
securities  that cannot be disposed of within  seven days at their then  current
value. For purposes of this limitation,  "illiquid securities" includes,  except
in those circumstances described below: (1) "restricted  securities",  which are
securities  that cannot be resold to the public without  registration  under the
Federal  securities laws and (2) securities of issuers having a record (together
with all predecessors) of less than three years of continuous operation.

As  a   nonfundamental   policy,   Emerging   Markets  Fund  and  Small  Company
Opportunities Fund may not acquire securities or invest in repurchase agreements
with respect to any securities if, as a result,  more than 15% of the Fund's net
assets (taken at current  value) would be invested in repurchase  agreements not
entitling the holder to payment of principal within seven days and in securities
which are not  readily  marketable,  including  securities  that are not readily
marketable  by  virtue of  restrictions  on the sale of such  securities  to the
public  without  registration  under  the  1993  Act,  as  amended  ("Restricted
Securities").

(c)      Concentration

Investors Equity Fund may not purchase a security if, as a result, more than 25%
of the Fund's total assets would be invested in securities of issuers conducting
their principal  business  activities in the same industry;  provided,  however,
that there is no limit on investments in U.S. Government securities,  repurchase
agreements covering U.S. Government securities, municipal securities and issuers
domiciled in a single country;  that financial  service companies are classified
according to the end users of their services (for example,  automobile  finance,
bank finance and diversified finance); and that utility companies are classified
according to their services (for example,  gas, gas  transmission,  electric and
gas, electric and telephone.  Notwithstanding  anything to the contrary,  to the
extent 


                                       18
<PAGE>

permitted  by the  1940  Act,  the  Fund may  invest  in one or more  investment
companies;  provided  that,  except  to the  extent  the Fund  invests  in other
investment  companies pursuant to Section  12(d)(1)(A) of the 1940 Act, the Fund
treats the assets of the investment companies in which it invests as its own for
purposes of this policy.

Small  Company  Opportunities  Fund may not purchase a security if, as a result,
more than 25% of the Fund's  total  assets  would be invested in  securities  of
issuers  conducting  their principal  business  activities in the same industry;
provided,  however,  that there is no limit on  investments  in U.S.  government
securities. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary, to the extent permitted by
the 1940 Act, the Fund may invest in one or more investment companies;  provided
that,  except to the  extent  the Fund  invests  in other  investment  companies
pursuant to Section  12(d)(1)(A)  of the 1940 Act, the Fund treats the assets of
the  investment  companies  in which it invests as its own for  purposes of this
policy.

Neither Equity Index Fund nor International  Equity Fund may purchase securities
if,  immediately  after  the  purchase,  more  than  25%  of  the  value  of the
Portfolio's  total  assets  would  be  invested  in the  securities  of  issuers
conducting their principal business  activities in the same industry;  provided,
however that there is no limit on  investments  in U.S.  Government  securities,
repurchase agreements covering U.S. Government securities, and issuers domiciled
in a single country;  that financial service companies are classified  according
to the end  users of their  services  (for  example,  automobile  finance,  bank
finance and  diversified  finance);  and that utility  companies are  classified
according to their services (for example,  gas, gas  transmission,  electric and
gas, electric and telephone).  Notwithstanding  anything to the contrary, to the
extent  permitted  by the 1940 Act, a Fund may invest in one or more  investment
companies;  provided  that,  except  to the  extent  the Fund  invests  in other
investment  companies pursuant to Section  12(d)(1)(A) of the 1940 Act, the Fund
treats the assets of the investment companies in which it invests as its own for
purposes of this policy.

Emerging  Markets Fund will not  purchase a security if, as a result,  more than
25% of the Fund's  total  assets  would be  invested  in  securities  of issuers
conducting  their  principal  business  activities  in the  same  industry.  For
purposes  of this  limitation,  there is no limit on:  (1)  investments  in U.S.
government  securities,   in  repurchase  agreements  covering  U.S.  government
securities,  in securities  issued by the states,  territories or possessions of
the United States ("municipal  securities") or in foreign government securities;
or (2) investment in issuers domiciled in a single jurisdiction. Notwithstanding
anything to the contrary,  to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the Fund may
invest in one or more investment companies;  provided that, except to the extent
the it invests in other investment  companies pursuant to Section 12(d)(1)(A) of
the 1940 Act, the Fund treats the assets of the investment companies in which it
invests as its own for purposes of this policy.

(d)      Underwriting Activities

No Fund (except Emerging Markets Fund and Small Company Opportunities Fund) will
underwrite  securities  issued by other  persons  except to the extent that,  in
connection with the disposition of its portfolio  investments,  it may be deemed
to be an underwriter under U.S. securities laws.

Neither  Emerging  Markets  Fund  nor  Small  Company   Opportunities  Fund  may
underwrite securities of other issuers,  except to the extent that a Fund may be
considered to be acting as an underwriter in connection  with the disposition of
its portfolio securities.

(e)      Borrowing

Equity Index Fund,  Investors Equity Fund, Small Company  Opportunities Fund and
International  Equity Fund may borrow money for temporary or emergency purposes,
including  the meeting of redemption  requests,  but not in excess of 33 1/3% of
the  value of the  Fund's  total  assets  (as  computed  immediately  after  the
borrowing).

Emerging  Markets  Fund will not  borrow  money  if,  as a  result,  outstanding
borrowings would exceed an amount equal to one third of the Fund's total assets.

                                       19
<PAGE>

As  a  non-fundamental   policy,  Equity  Index  Fund,  EMERGING  MARKETS  FUND,
International Equity Fund, Investors Equity Fund and Small Company Opportunities
Fund's  borrowings  for other than  temporary or  emergency  purposes or meeting
redemption  requests  may not  exceed an amount  equal to 5% of the  Fund's  net
assets.

(f)      Pledging

International  Fund may not  pledge,  mortgage or  hypothecate  its assets to an
extent greater than 10% of the value of the total assets of the Fund.

As a non-fundamental policy, Emerging Markets Fund, Equity Index Fund, Investors
Equity  Fund and Small  Company  Opportunities  Fund may not  pledge,  mortgage,
hypothecate or encumber any of its assets except to secure permitted  borrowings
or to secure other permitted transactions.

(g)      Margin and Short Sales

Emerging Markets Fund may not sell securities  short,  unless it owns or has the
right to obtain securities  equivalent in kind and amount to the securities sold
short (short sales "against-the-box"), and provided that transactions in futures
contracts and options are not deemed to constitute selling short.

International Equity Fund may not purchase securities on margin or sell short.

No Fund (other than Emerging Markets Fund,  International  Equity Fund and Small
Company Opportunities Fund) may: (1) purchase securities on margin; however, the
Fund may make margin deposits in connection with any Hedging Instruments,  which
it may use as  permitted  by any of its other  fundamental  policies or (2) sell
securities short.

As non-fundamental  policies,  Small Company Opportunities Fund may not purchase
securities on margin, or make short sales of any securities  (except short sales
against the box),  except for the use of  short-term  credit  necessary  for the
clearance  of  purchases  and  sales  of  portfolio  securities.  Small  Company
Opportunities  Fund  may make  margin  deposits  in  connection  with  permitted
transactions in options, futures contracts and options on futures contracts.

(h)      Investing for Control

No Fund (except for Small Company  Opportunities  Fund) may make investments for
the purpose of exercising  control or management;  provided that  investments by
Emerging  Markets Fund in entities  created  under the law of a foreign  country
solely to  facilitate  investment  in that  country are not deemed to be for the
purpose of exercising control or management under this limitation.

(i)      Real Estate

No Fund (except for Emerging Markets Fund and Small Company  Opportunities Fund)
may  purchase  or sell  real  estate,  provided  that the a Fund may  invest  in
securities issued by companies which invest in real estate or interests therein.

Small  Company  Opportunities  Fund may not  purchase or sell real estate or any
interest therein,  except that it may invest in debt obligations secured by real
estate or interests  therein or  securities  issued by companies  that invest in
real estate or interests  therein.  As a non-fundamental  policy,  Small Company
Opportunities Fund may not invest in real estate limited partnerships.

Emerging  Markets Fund may not purchase or sell real estate unless acquired as a
result of  ownership  of  securities  or other  instruments  (but this shall not
prevent the Fund from  investing in  securities or other  instruments  backed by
real estate or securities of companies engaged in the real estate business).


                                       20
<PAGE>

(j)      Lending

International  Fund  will not make  loans to other  persons,  provided  that for
purposes of this  restriction,  entering into repurchase  agreements,  acquiring
corporate  debt  securities  and  investing  in  U.S.  Government   obligations,
short-term  commercial paper,  certificates of deposit and bankers'  acceptances
shall not be deemed to be the making of a loan.

Equity  Index  Fund and  Investors  Equity  Fund will not lend  money  except in
connection  with the  acquisition of that portion of  publicly-distributed  debt
securities which the Fund's  investment  policies and restrictions  permit it to
purchase  (see   "Investment   Objective"  and  "Investment   Policies"  in  the
Prospectus);  the Funds may also make loans of portfolio  securities (see "Loans
of Portfolio  Securities") and enter into repurchase agreements (see "Repurchase
Agreements");

Neither  Emerging  Markets Fund nor Small  Company  Opportunities  Fund may make
loans,  except  a Fund may  enter  into  repurchase  agreements,  purchase  debt
securities  that  are  otherwise   permitted   investments  and  lend  portfolio
securities.

Emerging  Markets  Fund  will not  lend  money  except  in  connection  with the
acquisition  of  debt  securities  which  the  Fund's  investment  policies  and
restrictions  permit it to purchase (see "Investment  Objective" and "Investment
Policies" in the  Prospectus);  the  Portfolio  may also make loans of portfolio
securities  (see  "Loans of  Portfolio  Securities")  and enter into  repurchase
agreements (see "Repurchase Agreements");

(k)      Purchases and Sales of Commodities

International Equity Fund will invest in commodities;  commodity contracts other
than foreign currency forward contracts; or oil, gas and other mineral resource,
lease, or arbitrage transactions.

Neither Emerging Markets Fund nor Small Company  Opportunities Fund may purchase
or sell physical commodities unless acquired as a result of owning securities or
other  instruments,  but Emerging  Markets Fund may purchase or sell options and
futures  contracts  or  invest  in  securities  or other  instruments  backed by
physical commodities, and Small Company Opportunities Fund may purchase, sell or
enter into  financial  options and futures and forward  currency  contracts  and
other financial contracts or derivative instruments.

No Fund (other than Emerging Markets Fund,  International  Equity Fund and Small
Company  Opportunities  Fund) will invest in commodities or commodity  contracts
(other than  Hedging  Instruments  which it may use as  permitted  by any of its
other  fundamental  policies,  whether  or not any such  Hedging  Instrument  is
considered to be a commodity or a commodity contract);

(l)      Options and Futures Contracts

International  Equity  Fund may not  write,  purchase  or sell  options or puts,
calls, straddles, spreads, or combinations thereof.

No Fund (other than Emerging Markets Fund,  International  Equity Fund and Small
Company  Opportunities  Fund)  may  purchase  or write  puts or calls  except as
permitted by any of its other fundamental investment policies.

(m)      Warrants

No Fund (except for Emerging Markets Fund and Small Company  Opportunities Fund)
may invest in warrants,  valued at the lower of cost or market,  more than 5% of
the value of the Fund's net assets  (included  within  that  amount,  but not to
exceed 2% of the value of the Fund's net assets,  may be warrants  which are not
listed on the New York or American Stock Exchange. Warrants acquired by the Fund
in units or  attached to  securities  may be deemed 


                                       21
<PAGE>

to be without  value.) This policy is  non-fundamental  with respect to Emerging
Markets Fund, Equity Index Fund and Small Company Opportunities Fund.

(n)      Other Investment Companies

As  a   non-fundamental   policy,   Emerging  Markets  Fund  and  Small  Company
Opportunities Fund may not invest in securities of another  investment  company,
except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act.

(o)      Issuance of Senior Securities

Emerging Markets Fund and Small Company  Opportunities Fund may not issue senior
securities except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act.

(p)      Lending of Portfolio Securities

As a  non-fundamental  policy,  neither  Emerging Markets Fund nor Small Company
Opportunities  Fund may lend  portfolio  securities  if the  total  value of all
loaned  securities  would exceed one-third or 25%,  respectively,  of the Fund's
total assets.

4.  PERFORMANCE DATA

The Funds may, from time to time, include quotations of its average annual total
return in advertisements or reports to shareholders or prospective investors.

Quotations  of average  annual  total  return will be  expressed in terms of the
average annual compounded rate of return of a hypothetical  investment in a Fund
over  periods  of 1, 5 and 10  years  (up to the life of the  Fund),  calculated
pursuant to the following formula:

         P (1+T)n = ERV

(where P = a  hypothetical  initial  payment of $1,000,  T = the average  annual
total return, n = the number of years, and ERV = the ending  redeemable value of
a hypothetical  $1,000  payment made at the beginning of the period).  All total
return  figures will  reflect the  deduction  of Fund  expenses  (net of certain
reimbursed  expenses) on an annual basis, and will assume that all dividends and
distributions are reinvested when paid.

Quotations of total return will reflect only the  performance  of a hypothetical
investment in a Fund during the particular time period shown. Total return for a
Fund will vary based on changes in market conditions and the level of the Fund's
expenses,  and no reported performance figure should be considered an indication
of performance which may be expected in the future.

In  connection  with  communicating  total  return  to  current  or  prospective
investors,  a Fund also may compare  these figures to the  performance  of other
mutual  funds  tracked by mutual  fund  rating  services  or to other  unmanaged
indexes which may assume  reinvestment of dividends but generally do not reflect
deductions for administrative and management costs.

Investors  who purchase and redeem  shares of a Fund through a customer  account
maintained at a Service Organization may be charged one or more of the following
types of fees as agreed upon by the Service Organization and the investor,  with
respect to the customer services provided by the Service  Organization:  account
fees (a fixed  amount per month or per year);  transaction  fees (a fixed amount
per transaction processed);  compensating balance requirements (a minimum dollar
amount a customer  must  maintain in order to obtain the services  offered);  or
account  maintenance  fees (a periodic  charge  based upon a  percentage  of the
assets in the account or of the dividends paid on these assets).  Such fees will
have the effect of reducing  the  average  annual  total  return of the Fund for
those investors.

                                       22
<PAGE>

5.  MANAGEMENT

TRUSTEES AND OFFICERS

THE TRUST

The trustees and officers of the Trust and their  principal  occupations  during
the past five years are set forth  below.  Each  Trustee  who is an  "interested
person" (as defined by the 1940 Act) of the Trust is indicated by an asterisk.

John Y. Keffer,* Chairman and President (age 56)

     President  and  Director,  Forum  Financial  Services,  Inc. (a  registered
     broker-dealer),   Forum  Administrative   Services,   LLC  (a  mutual  fund
     administrator),  Forum  Financial  Corp. (a registered  transfer agent) and
     Forum Advisors,  Inc. (a registered  investment  adviser).  Mr. Keffer is a
     Trustee and/or officer of various registered investment companies for which
     Forum Administrative  Services,  LLC serves as manager or administrator and
     for which Forum Financial Services,  Inc. serves as manager,  administrator
     and/or  distributor.  His address is Two Portland Square,  Portland,  Maine
     04101.

Costas Azariadis, Trustee (age 53)

     Professor of Economics,  University of California,  Los Angeles, since July
     1992.  Prior  thereto,  Dr.  Azariadis  was  Professor  of Economics at the
     University  of  Pennsylvania.  His  address  is  Department  of  Economics,
     University of California,  Los Angeles,  405 Hilgard  Avenue,  Los Angeles,
     California 90024.

James C. Cheng, Trustee (age 54)

     President  of  Technology  Marketing  Associates  (a  marketing  consulting
     company) since September 1991.  Prior thereto,  Mr. Cheng was President and
     Chief  Executive  Officer of Network  Dynamics,  Incorporated  (a  software
     development   company).   His  address  is  27  Temple   Street,   Belmont,
     Massachusetts 02178.

J. Michael Parish, Trustee (age 53)

     Partner at the law firm of Reid and Priest, LLP, since 1995. Prior thereto,
     he was a partner at the law firm of Winthrop  Stimson Putnam & Roberts from
     1989 to 1995 and was a partner at LeBoeuf, Lamb, Leiby & MacRae, a law firm
     of which he was a member from 1974 to 1989.  His address is 40 Wall Street,
     New York, New York 10005.

Mark D. Kaplan, Vice President, Assistant Treasurer and Assistant Secretary (age
42)

     Managing Director at Forum Financial  Services,  Inc. since September 1995.
     Prior thereto, Mr. Kaplan was Managing Director and Director of Research at
     H.M.  Payson & Co. His  address is Two  Portland  Square,  Portland,  Maine
     04101.

David I. Goldstein, Secretary (age 36)

     Counsel, Forum Financial Services,  Inc., with which he has been associated
     since 1991.  Prior thereto,  Mr. Goldstein was associated with the law firm
     of  Kirkpatrick & Lockhart.  Mr.  Goldstein is also  Secretary or Assistant
     Secretary  of  various  registered  investment  companies  for which  Forum
     Administrative  Services,  LLC or Forum Financial Services,  Inc. serves as
     manager,  administrator  and/or  distributor.  His address is Two  Portland
     Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

                                       23
<PAGE>

Max Berueffy, Assistant Secretary (age 46)

     Counsel, Forum Financial Services,  Inc., with which he has been associated
     since  1994.  Prior  thereto,  Mr.  Berueffy  was on the  staff of the U.S.
     Securities and Exchange  Commission for seven years, first in the appellate
     branch  of  the  Office  of the  General  Counsel,  then  as a  counsel  to
     Commissioner  Grundfest  and  finally  as a senior  special  counsel in the
     Division  of  Investment  Management.  Mr.  Berueffy is also  Secretary  or
     Assistant  Secretary of various registered  investment  companies for which
     Forum Administrative Services, LLC or Forum Financial Services, Inc. serves
     as manager,  administrator and/or distributor.  His address is Two Portland
     Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

Cheryl O. Tumlin, Assistant Secretary (age 31)

     Assistant Counsel, Forum Financial Services,  Inc., with which she has been
     associated since July 1996.  Prior thereto,  Ms. Tumlin was on the staff of
     the U.S.  Securities and Exchange Commission as an attorney in the Division
     of Market Regulation and prior thereto Ms. Tumlin was an associate with the
     law firm of Robinson  Silverman  Pearce  Aronsohn & Berman in New York, New
     York.  Ms.  Tumlin  is  also  Assistant  Secretary  of  various  registered
     investment companies for which Forum Administrative  Services, LLC or Forum
     Financial   Services,   Inc.  serves  as  manager,   administrator   and/or
     distributor. Her address is Two Portland Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

TRUSTEE COMPENSATION.  Each Trustee of the Trust (other than John Y. Keffer, who
is an  interested  person of the Trust) is paid  $1,000  for each Board  meeting
attended (whether in person or by electronic  communication)  and is paid $1,000
for each committee  meeting attended on a date when a Board meeting is not held.
As of March 31,  1997,  in addition to $1,000 for each Board  meeting  attended,
each Trustee  receives $100 per active  portfolio of the Trust.  To the extent a
meeting relates to only certain  portfolios of the Trust,  Trustees are paid the
$100 fee only with respect to those portfolios. Trustees are also reimbursed for
travel and related  expenses  incurred in  attending  meetings of the Board.  No
officer of the Trust is compensated by the Trust.

The following table provides the aggregate compensation paid to each independent
Trustee. The Trust has not adopted any form of retirement plan covering Trustees
or officers. Information is presented for the fiscal year ended March 31, 1997.

<TABLE>
          <S>                           <C>                <C>               <C>               <C>
                                                           ACCRUED           ANNUAL
                                        AGGREGATE          PENSION        BENEFITS UPON       TOTAL
         TRUSTEE                      COMPENSATION        BENEFITS         RETIREMENT      COMPENSATION
         -------                      ------------        --------         ----------      ------------
         Mr. Keffer                       None              None              None             None
         Mr. Azariadis                   $4,000             None              None            $4,000
         Mr. Cheng                       $4,000             None              None            $4,000
         Mr. Parish                      $4,000             None              None            $4,000
</TABLE>


THE PORTFOLIOS

TRUSTEES AND OFFICERS OF CORE TRUST. The Trustees and officers of Core Trust and
their  principal  occupations  during the past five years and ages are set forth
below.  Each Trustee who is an "interested  person" (as defined by the 1940 Act)
of Core Trust is indicated by an asterisk.  Messrs. Keffer, Azariadis, Cheng and
Parish, Trustees of Core Trust, and Mr. Goldstein,  Secretary of Core Trust, all
currently  serve as  Trustees  and/or  officers of the Trust.  Accordingly,  for
background  information pertaining to these Trustees, see "Management - Trustees
and Officers -The Trust."

John Y. Keffer,* Chairman and President, Age 56.

Costas Azariadis, Trustee, Age 53.

                                       24
<PAGE>

James C. Cheng, Trustee, Age 54.

J. Michael Parish, Trustee, Age 53.

David I. Goldstein, Secretary (age 36)

Sara M. Clark, Vice President, Assistant Secretary and Treasurer, Age 33.

Managing  Director,  Forum  Financial  Services,  Inc.,  with which she has been
associated  since  1994.  Prior  thereto,  from  1991 to  1994,  Ms.  Clark  was
Controller of Wright Express  Corporation  (a national  credit card company) and
for six  years  prior  thereto  was  employed  at  Deloitte  & Touche  LLP as an
accountant.  Ms.  Clark is also an  officer  of  various  registered  investment
companies  for  which  Forum  Financial   Services,   Inc.  serves  as  manager,
administrator and/or distributor.  Her address is Two Portland Square, Portland,
Maine 04101.

The following  information relates to the principal  occupations during the past
five years of each trustee and executive  officer of Schroder Core and shows the
nature of any affiliation with SCMI.  Except as noted, each of these individuals
currently  serves in the same capacity for Schroder  Capital  Funds  (Delaware),
Schroder Capital Funds II and Schroder Series Trust, other registered investment
companies in the Schroder family of funds. If no address is shown,  the person's
address is that of the Trust, Two Portland Square. Portland, Maine 04101.

         PETER E. GUERNSEY,  75 - Trustee of Schroder Core; Insurance Consultant
         since  August  1986;  prior  thereto  Senior  Vice  President,  Marsh &
         McLennan, Inc., insurance brokers.

         JOHN I. HOWELL, 80 - Trustee of Schroder Core; Private Consultant since
         February 1987; Honorary Director,  American  International Group, Inc.;
         Director, American International Life Assurance Company of New York.

         CLARENCE F. MICHALIS, 75 - Trustee of Schroder Core;  Chairman  of  the
         Board   of   Directors,    Josiah   Macy,  Jr.  Foundation  (charitable
         foundation).

         HERMANN C. SCHWAB, 77 - Trustee of Schroder Core;  retired since March,
         1988; prior thereto, consultant to SCMI since February 1, 1984.

         HON.  DAVID N.  DINKINS,  69 - Trustee  of  Schroder  Core;  Professor,
         Columbia   University  School  of  International  and  Public  Affairs;
         Director,   American  Stock  Exchange,  Carver  Federal  Savings  Bank,
         Transderm  Laboratory  Corporation,  and  The  Cosmetic  Center,  Inc.;
         formerly, Mayor, The City of New York.

         PETER S.  KNIGHT,  46 - Trustee  of  Schroder  Core;  Partner,  Wunder,
         Knight,  Levine,  Thelen &  Forcey;  Director,  Comsat  Corp.,  Medicis
         Pharmaceutical  Corp.,  and Whitman  Education  Group  Inc.,  Formerly,
         Campaign Manager, Clinton/Gore `96.

         SHARON L. HAUGH*, 51, 787 Seventh Avenue, New York,  New York - Trustee
         of Schroder Core;  Chairman, Schroder Capital Management Inc.  ("SCM"),
         Executive Vice President and Director,  SCMI;  Chairman  and  Director,
         Schroder Advisors.

         MARK J. SMITH*,  35, 33 Gutter Lane,  London,  England - President  and
         Trustee of Schroder  Core;  Senior Vice  President and Director of SCMI
         since  April  1990;  Director  and  Senior  Vice  President,   Schroder
         Advisors.

         MARK  ASTLEY,  33,  787  Seventh  Avenue,  New  York,  New  York - Vice
         President  of  Schroder  Core;  First  Vice  President  of SCMI,  prior
         thereto, employed by various affiliates of SCMI in various positions in
         the investment research and portfolio management areas since 1987.

                                       25
<PAGE>

         ROBERT G.  DAVY,  36, 787  Seventh  Avenue,  New York,  New York - Vice
         President  of  Schroder  Core;  Director of SCMI and  Schroder  Capital
         Management  International Ltd. since 1994; First Vice President of SCMI
         since July, 1992; prior thereto, employed by various affiliates of SCMI
         in  various   positions  in  the  investment   research  and  portfolio
         management areas since 1986.

         MARGARET H.  DOUGLAS-HAMILTON,  55, 787 Seventh  Avenue,  New York, New
         York - Vice  President  of Schroder  Core;  Secretary of SCM since July
         1995;  Senior Vice President  (since April 1997) and General Counsel of
         Schroders U.S. Holdings Inc. since May 1987; prior thereto,  partner of
         Sullivan & Worcester, a law firm.

         RICHARD R. FOULKES,  51, 787 Seventh Avenue,  New York, New York - Vice
         President of Schroder Core; Deputy Chairman of SCMI since October 1995;
         Director and Executive  Vice President of Schroder  Capital  Management
         International Ltd. since 1989.

         FERGAL CASSIDY,  28, 787 Seventh Avenue, New York, New York - Treasurer
         of Schroder Core.

         JOHN Y.  KEFFER,  54 - Vice  President of Schroder  Core;  President of
         Forum Financial Group, LLC, parent Forum Accounting  Services,  LLC and
         Forum Administrative Services, LLC.

         JANE P.  LUCAS,  35,  787  Seventh  Avenue,  New York,  New York - Vice
         President of Schroder Core;  Director and Senior Vice  President  SCMI;
         Director of SCM since  September  1995;  Director of Schroder  Advisors
         since September 1996; Assistant Director Schroder Investment Management
         Ltd.
         since June 1991.

         CATHERINE A. MAZZA,  37, 787 Seventh Avenue,  New York, New York - Vice
         President of Schroder Core;  President of Schroder Advisors since 1997;
         First Vice President of SCMI and SCM since 1996;  prior  thereto,  held
         various marketing positions at Alliance Capital, an investment adviser,
         since July 1985.

         MICHAEL  PERELSTEIN,  41, 787 Seventh Avenue, New York, New York - Vice
         President  of Schroder  Core;  Director  since May 1997 and Senior Vice
         President of SCMI since January 1997; prior thereto,  Managing Director
         of MacKay - Shields Financial Corp.

         ALEXANDRA POE, 37, 787 Seventh  Avenue,  New York, New York - Secretary
         and Vice  President  of Schroder  Core;  Vice  President  of SCMI since
         August  1996;  Fund  Counsel  and Senior  Vice  President  of  Schroder
         Advisors  since August  1996;  Secretary  of Schroder  Advisors;  prior
         thereto, an investment  management attorney with Gordon Altman Butowsky
         Weitzen Shalov & Wein since July 1994;  prior thereto  counsel and Vice
         President of Citibank, N.A. since 1989.

         FARIBA  TALEBI,  36,  787  Seventh  Avenue,  New York,  New York - Vice
         President of the Trust;  Group Vice President of SCMI since April 1993,
         employed in various positions in the investment  research and portfolio
         management areas since 1987; Director of SCM since April 1997.

         JOHN A.  TROIANO,  38, 787 Seventh  Avenue,  New York,  New York - Vice
         President  of Schroder  Core;  Director of SCM since April 1997;  Chief
         Executive  Officer,  since July 1, 1997, of SCMI and Managing  Director
         and Senior Vice  President of SCMI since October 1995;  prior  thereto,
         employed  by various  affiliates  of SCMI in various  positions  in the
         investment research and portfolio management areas since 1981.

         IRA L.  UNSCHULD,  31, 787 Seventh  Avenue,  New York,  New York - Vice
         President of Schroder Core;  Vice  President of SCMI since April,  1993
         and an Associate from July, 1990 to April, 1993.



                                       26
<PAGE>

INVESTMENT ADVISERS

H.M. Payson,  Inc.  ("Payson") serves as investment  adviser to Investors Equity
Fund pursuant to an investment advisory agreement with the Trust. Subject to the
general  control of the Board,  Payson is  responsible  for among other  things,
developing  a  continuing  investment  program  for  Investors  Equity  Fund  in
accordance with its investment objective and reviewing the investment strategies
and policies of Investors Equity Fund. Payson was incorporated under the laws of
Delaware in 1987 and is registered  under the  Investment  Advisers Act of 1940.
For its services,  Payson receives an advisory fee at an annual rate of 0.65% of
Investor Equity Fund's average daily net assets.

Payson entered into an investment  sub-advisory  agreement with Peoples Heritage
to  exercise  certain  investment  discretion  over the  assets (or a portion of
assets) of Investors  Equity  Fund.  Subject to the general  supervision  of the
Board,  Peoples is responsible for, among other things,  developing a continuing
investment  program for Investors  Equity Fund in accordance with its investment
objective  and  reviewing the  investment  strategies  and policies of Investors
Equity Fund. Peoples Heritage,  located at One Portland Square,  Portland, Maine
04101, is a subsidiary of Peoples Heritage Financial Group, a multi-bank holding
company.  As of December 1, 1997, Peoples Heritage Financial Group had assets of
$6.5 billion and Peoples Heritage and its affiliates managed assets with a value
of approximately  $932 million.  Payson pays a fee to Peoples for its subadviser
services of 0.25% of Investors Equity Fund's average daily net assets.  This fee
is borne solely by Payson and does not increase the fee paid by  shareholders of
Investors Equity Fund.

Forum Advisors serves as investment adviser to Small Company  Opportunities Fund
pursuant to an  investment  advisory  agreement  with the Trust.  Subject to the
general  control of the Board,  Forum Advisors is  responsible  for, among other
things,   developing  a  continuing   investment   program  for  Small   Company
Opportunities Fund in accordance with its investment objective and reviewing the
investment  strategies and policies of Small Company  Opportunities  Fund. Forum
Advisors  was  organized  under the laws of Delaware  in 1997 and is  registered
under the  Investment  Advisory Act of 1940.  For its services,  Forum  Advisors
receives  an  advisory  fee  at  an  annual  rate  of  0.65%  of  Small  Company
Opportunities Fund's average daily net assets.

Subject to the general  supervision  of the Core Trust Board,  Norwest  provides
investment  advisory  services to Index  Portfolio,  Small Cap Index  Portfolio,
Small Company Stock Portfolio, Small Company Value Portfolio and Small Cap Value
Portfolio  pursuant to an  investment  advisory  agreement  with the Core Trust.
Norwest manages the investment and reinvestment of the assets of Index Portfolio
and  Small  Cap  Index  Portfolio  and  continuously  reviews,   supervises  and
administers   those  Portfolios'   investments.   In  this  regard,  it  is  the
responsibility  of Norwest to make decisions  relating to Index  Portfolio's and
Small Cap Index  Portfolio's  investments  and to place purchase and sale orders
regarding  investments with brokers or dealers selected by it in its discretion.
For its services  with  respect to the  Portfolios,  Norwest  receives a monthly
advisory fee equal on an annual basis to 0.15% of Index Portfolio's and 0.25% of
Small Cap Index Portfolio's average daily net assets, which Index Fund and Small
Company  Opportunities  Fund bear  indirectly . Norwest  oversees the investment
decisions of the  investment  subadvisers  employed by Norwest and Core Trust to
subadvise Small Company Stock Portfolio, Small Company Value Portfolio and Small
Cap Value Portfolio of Core Trust.  For its services,  Norwest  receives fees of
0.90%,  0.90% and 0.95% of the average  daily net assets of Small  Company Stock
Portfolio,  Small  Company  Value  Portfolio  and  Small  Cap  Value  Portfolio,
respectively.  Norwest,  which is located at Norwest  Center,  Sixth  Street and
Marquette,  Minneapolis,  Minnesota 55479, is an indirect  subsidiary of Norwest
Corporation,  a multi-bank  holding company that was incorporated under the laws
of Delaware in 1929. As of December 31, 1997, Norwest  Corporation had assets of
$88.5 billion, which made it the 11th largest bank holding company in the United
States. As of December 31, 1997,  Norwest and its affiliates managed assets with
a value of approximately $51.7 billion.

To assist Norwest in carrying out its  obligations,  Core Trust and Norwest have
retained  the  services of the  investment  subadvisers  described  below.  Each
investment  subadviser makes investment  decisions for the Portfolio to which it
serves  as  investment  subadviser  and  continually  reviews,   supervises  and
administers the Portfolio's  investment program with respect to that portion, if
any, of the  Portfolio's  assets that Norwest  believes should be managed by the
investment subadviser.  Currently, each investment subadviser manages all of the
assets of the


                                       27
<PAGE>

Portfolio  that it  subadvises.  Norwest  (and  not  the  Portfolios)  pay  each
investment  subadviser  a fee  for its  investment  subadvisory  services.  This
compensation  does not increase the amount paid by the Portfolios to Norwest for
investment advisory services.

Crestone,  which is located at 7720 East Belleview Avenue, Suite 220, Englewood,
Colorado  80111,  serves  as  investment   subadviser  to  Small  Company  Stock
Portfolio.  Crestone,  an indirect investment subsidiary of Norwest Corporation,
provides investment advice regarding companies with small market  capitalization
to various  clients,  including  institutional  investors.  As of June 30, 1997,
Crestone managed assets with a value of approximately $534 million.

Peregrine,  which is located at LaSalle Plaza,  800 LaSalle Avenue,  Suite 1850,
Minneapolis,  Minnesota 55402, serves as investment  subadviser to Small Company
Value  Portfolio.  Peregrine,  an indirect  investment  advisory  subsidiary  of
Norwest  Corporation,  provides  investment  advisory  services to corporate and
public pension plans, profit-sharing plans,  savings-investment plans and 401(k)
plans.  As of June 30, 1997,  Peregrine  managed  approximately  $5.0 billion in
assets.

Smith, which is located at 500 Crescent Court,  Suite 250, Dallas,  Texas 75201,
is  a  registered  investment  adviser.  Smith  provides  investment  management
services to company retirement plans, foundations,  endowments,  trust companies
and high net worth individuals using a disciplined  equity style. As of June 13,
1997, Smith managed over $200 million in assets.

Schroder Capital  Management  International  Inc., the investment adviser to the
Schroder  Core  Portfolios,  is a wholly owned U.S.  subsidiary of Schroder U.S.
Holdings  Inc.,  which engages  through its  subsidiary  firms in the investment
banking, asset management,  and securities  businesses.  Affiliates of Schroders
U.S. Holdings Inc. (or their  predecessors) have been investment  managers since
1927.  SCMI  and its  United  Kingdom  affiliate,  Schroder  Capital  Management
International,   Ltd.,   have  served   together  as   investment   manager  for
approximately $28 billion as of September 30, 1997. Schroders U.S. Holdings Inc.
is an indirect,  wholly owned U.S. subsidiary of Schroders plc, a publicly owned
holding  company  organized  under the laws of  England.  Schroders  plc and its
affiliates  engage in international  merchant banking and investment  management
businesses,  and as of September 30, 1997, had under  management  assets of over
$175 billion. Schroder Advisors is a wholly owned subsidiary of Schroder Capital
Management International Inc. As investment adviser, SCMI is entitled to monthly
advisory fees at the annual rates of 1.00% and 0.45%, respectively,  of Schroder
EM Core Portfolio's and International Portfolio's average daily net assets.

Each investment  advisory or subadvisory  agreement continues in effect provided
such continuance is approved  annually:  (1) by the holders of a majority of the
outstanding voting securities of the respective Fund or Portfolio (as defined by
the 1940 Act) or by the Board or Core Trust Board,  as applicable;  and (2) by a
majority of the  Trustees or Core Trust  Trustees,  as  applicable,  who are not
parties to such agreement or  "interested  persons" (as defined in the 1940 Act)
of any such party.  Each  investment  advisory or  subadvisory  agreement may be
terminated  without  penalty by vote of the Trustees of the Trust or Core Trust,
as  applicable,  or the  interestholders  of the Fund or  Portfolio  on 60 days'
written  notice to the adviser,  or by the adviser on 60 days' written notice to
the Trust or Core Trust and it will  terminate  automatically  if assigned.  The
investment advisory or subadvisory agreements also provide that, with respect to
each Fund or Portfolio,  neither the  investment  adviser or subadviser  nor its
personnel shall be liable for any error of judgment or mistake of law or for any
act or  omission  in the  performance  of its  duties to the Fund or  Portfolio,
except for lack of good faith,  provided  that nothing in the  agreements  shall
protect,  or purport to protect,  the adviser or subadviser against liability by
reason of willful misfeasance,  bad faith or gross negligence in the performance
of the its duties or by reason of  reckless  disregard  of its  obligations  and
duties under the investment advisory or subadvisory agreement.

ADMINISTRATIVE SERVICES

THE FUNDS. Forum Administrative  Services, LLC ("FAdS") acts as administrator to
the Trust on behalf of the Fund pursuant to an Administration Agreement with the
Trust. As administrator,  FAdS provides  management and administrative  services
necessary  to  the   operation  of  the  Trust  (which   include,   among  other
responsibilities, 


                                       28
<PAGE>

negotiation  of contracts  and fees with,  and  monitoring  of  performance  and
billing of, the transfer  agent and custodian and arranging for  maintenance  of
books and records of the Trust),  and  provides  the Trust with  general  office
facilities.  The Administration  Agreement will remain in effect for a period of
twelve months with respect to the Fund and thereafter is  automatically  renewed
each year for an additional  term of one year,  subject to approval by the Board
or the Shareholders,  and, in either case, by a majority of the Trustees who are
not interested persons of any party to the Administration Agreement.

The Administration  Agreement terminates automatically if it is assigned and may
be  terminated  without  penalty  with respect to the Fund by vote of the Fund's
shareholders  or by either party on not more than 60 days' written  notice.  The
Administration  Agreement  also  provides  that FAdS shall not be liable for any
error  of  judgment  or  mistake  of law  or for  any  act  or  omission  in the
administration or management of the Trust, except for willful  misfeasance,  bad
faith or gross  negligence in the  performance of Forum's duties or by reason of
reckless  disregard  of its  obligations  and  duties  under the  Administration
Agreement.

At the request of the Board, FAdS provides persons  satisfactory to the Board to
serve as  officers  of the  Trust.  Those  officers,  as well as  certain  other
employees and Trustees of the Trust, may be directors,  officers or employees of
FAdS, Forum Advisors, Norwest, SCMI, Payson, Smith or their affiliates.

THE PORTFOLIOS.  On behalf of the Core Trust Portfolios,  Core Trust has entered
into an  administration  agreement with Forum Financial  Services,  Inc. For its
administrative services, FFSI is entitled to receive from each portfolio fees at
the annual rates of 0.15% and 0.10%,  respectively,  of International  Portfolio
and Index Portfolio's average daily net assets.

On behalf of the  Schroder  Core  Portfolio,  Schroder  Core has entered into an
administration agreement with Schroder Fund Advisors Inc. ("Schroder Advisors"),
787 Seventh  Avenue,  New York,  New York 10019.  Schroder Core also has entered
into a  subadministration  agreement  with FAdS.  Pursuant to their  agreements,
Schroder  Advisors  and FAdS  have  agreed to  provide  certain  management  and
administrative services necessary for the Portfolio's operations, other than the
investment  management and administrative  services provided to the Portfolio by
SCMI  pursuant  to the  investment  advisory  agreement,  including  among other
things:  (1)  preparation  of  shareholder  reports  and   communications;   (2)
regulatory  compliance,  such as reports to and filings with the  Securities and
Exchange   Commission  and  state  securities   commissions;   and  (3)  general
supervision of the operation of the  Portfolio,  including  coordination  of the
services  performed  by the  Portfolio's  investment  adviser,  transfer  agent,
custodian,  independent accountants, legal counsel and others. Schroder Advisors
is a wholly-owned subsidiary of SCMI and is a registered broker-dealer organized
to act as administrator and distributor of mutual funds.

For these services, Schroder Advisors and FAdS are each entitled to receive from
Schroder Core fees at the annual rates of 0.10% and 0.075%, respectively, of the
Portfolio's average daily net assets

The administration agreement and subadministration agreement are terminable with
respect to the Schroder Core Portfolio  without  penalty by either party upon 60
days' notice to other party.

CUSTODIAN

Pursuant  to a  Custodian  Agreement  (the  "Custodian  Agreement"),  The  First
National Bank of Boston, P.O. Box 1959, Boston, Massachusetts 02105, acts as the
custodian  of  the  Funds'  assets.  The  custodian's  responsibilities  include
safeguarding and controlling the Fund's cash and securities,  determining income
and  collecting  interest  on Fund  investments.  The Fund's  custodian  employs
foreign  subcustodians  to  provide  custody  of the  Fund's  foreign  assets in
accordance with applicable regulations. The custodian is paid a fee at an annual
rate of 0.02% of the first $100  million of the average  daily net assets of the
Fund,  0.015% on the next $100  million of the  average  daily net assets of the
Fund and 0.0001% of the average daily net assets over $200 million,  and certain
transaction fees.

The Chase  Manhattan  Bank  ("Chase"),  through its Global  Securities  Services
division  located  in  London,  England,  acts as  custodian  of  Schroder  Core
Portfolio's  assets,  but  Chase  plays no role in  making  decisions  as to the
purchase


                                       29
<PAGE>

or sale of portfolio  securities  for the  Portfolio.  Pursuant to rules adopted
under the 1940 Act,  the  Schroder  Core  Portfolio  may  maintain  its  foreign
securities  and cash in the  custody  of  certain  eligible  foreign  banks  and
securities  depositories.  Selection of these foreign custodial  institutions is
made by the  Schroder  Core  Board  following  a  consideration  of a number  of
factors,  including (but not limited to) the reliability and financial stability
of the institution;  the ability of the institution to perform capably custodial
services for the Portfolio;  the  reputation of the  institution in its national
market;  the  political  and  economic  stability  of the  country  in which the
institution  is  located;  and further  risks of  potential  nationalization  or
expropriation of portfolio assets.

DISTRIBUTOR

Forum Financial Services,  Inc. ("Forum"),  an affiliate of FAdS, is the Trust's
distributor  and acts as the agent of the Trust in connection  with the offering
of shares of the Fund pursuant to a  Distribution  Agreement.  The  Distribution
Agreement  will continue in effect for twelve months and will continue in effect
thereafter only if its continuance is specifically approved at least annually by
the Board or by vote of the shareholders entitled to vote thereon, and in either
case, by a majority of the Trustees who: (1) are not parties to the Distribution
Agreement;  (2) are not interested persons of any such party or of the Trust and
(3) with  respect  to any class for which the Trust has  adopted a  distribution
plan,  have no direct or indirect  financial  interest in the  operation of that
distribution plan or in the Distribution  Agreement, at a meeting called for the
purpose of voting on the Distribution  Agreement.  All  subscriptions for shares
obtained by Forum are directed to the Trust for  acceptance  and are not binding
on  the  Trust  until  accepted  by  it.  Forum  receives  no   compensation  or
reimbursement of expenses for the distribution services provided pursuant to the
Distribution Agreement and is under no obligation to sell any specific amount of
Fund shares.

The Distribution Agreement provides that Forum shall not be liable for any error
of  judgment  or mistake of law or in any event  whatsoever,  except for willful
misfeasance,  bad faith or gross negligence in the performance of Forum's duties
or by reason of  reckless  disregard  of its  obligations  and duties  under the
Distribution Agreement.

The  Distribution  Agreement  is  terminable  with  respect to the Fund  without
penalty by the Trust on 60 days' written notice when  authorized  either by vote
of the Fund's  shareholders or by a vote of a majority of the Board, or by Forum
on 60 days'  written  notice.  The  Distribution  Agreement  will  automatically
terminate in the event of its assignment.

Forum may enter into  agreements with selected  broker-dealers,  banks, or other
financial  institutions  for distribution of shares of the Fund. These financial
institutions  may charge a fee for their  services and may receive  shareholders
service fees even though  shares of the Fund are sold without  sales  charges or
distribution fees. These financial  institutions may otherwise act as processing
agents, and will be responsible for promptly transmitting  purchase,  redemption
and other requests to the Fund.

Investors who purchase  shares in this manner will be subject to the  procedures
of the institution through whom they purchase shares, which may include charges,
investment  minimums,  cutoff  times and other  restrictions  in addition to, or
different  from,  those listed  herein.  Information  concerning  any charges or
services will be provided to customers by the financial  institution.  Investors
purchasing  shares of the Fund in this manner should  acquaint  themselves  with
their  institution's  procedures and should read this  Prospectus in conjunction
with any materials and information provided by their institution.  The financial
institution  and not its customers will be the  shareholder of record,  although
customers  may have the right to vote shares  depending  upon their  arrangement
with the institution.

TRANSFER AGENT

Forum  Shareholder  Services,  LLC ("FSS")  acts as transfer  agent of the Trust
pursuant to a transfer agency agreement (the "Transfer Agency  Agreement").  The
Transfer Agency  Agreement  provided,  with respect to each Fund, for an initial
term of one year from its effective  date and for its  continuance in effect for
successive  twelve-month  periods  thereafter,  provided  that the  agreement is
specifically  approved at least annually by the Board or, with respect to either
Fund,  by a vote of the  shareholders  of that  Fund,  and in  either  case by a
majority of the 


                                       30
<PAGE>

directors  who are not parties to the Transfer  Agency  Agreement or  interested
persons of any such party at a meeting  called for the  purpose of voting on the
Transfer Agency Agreement.

Among the  responsibilities  of FSS as agent for the Trust  are:  (1)  answering
customer  inquiries  regarding  account status and history,  the manner in which
purchases  and  redemptions  of shares of the Fund may be  effected  and certain
other matters  pertaining to the Fund; (2) assisting  shareholders in initiating
and  changing  account  designations  and  addresses;  (3)  providing  necessary
personnel  and  facilities to establish  and maintain  shareholder  accounts and
records,  assisting in  processing  purchase  and  redemption  transactions  and
receiving wired funds;  (4)  transmitting and receiving funds in connection with
customer  orders  to  purchase  or  redeem  shares;  (5)  verifying  shareholder
signatures  in  connection  with  changes  in the  registration  of  shareholder
accounts;  (6) furnishing periodic statements and confirmations of purchases and
redemptions;  (7) arranging for the  transmission  of proxy  statements,  annual
reports,   prospectuses  and  other   communications   from  the  Trust  to  its
shareholders;  (8) arranging for the receipt, tabulation and transmission to the
Trust  of  proxies  executed  by  shareholders   with  respect  to  meetings  of
shareholders of the Trust;  and (9) providing such other related services as the
Trust or a shareholder may reasonably request.

FSS or any  sub-transfer  agent or  processing  agent  may also act and  receive
compensation as custodian,  investment manager,  nominee, agent or fiduciary for
its customers or clients who are shareholders of the Fund with respect to assets
invested in the Fund. FSS or any  sub-transfer  agent or other  processing agent
may elect to credit  against the fees  payable to it by its clients or customers
all or a portion of any fee received  from the Trust or from FSS with respect to
assets  of those  customers  or  clients  invested  in the  Fund.  FSS,  FAdS or
sub-transfer  agents or  processing  agents  retained  by FSS may be  Processing
Organizations  (as defined in the Prospectus)  and, in the case of sub- transfer
agents or processing agents, may also be affiliated persons of FSS or Forum.

For its services under the Transfer Agency Agreement, FSS receives: (1) a fee at
an annual rate of 0.25 percent of the average daily net assets of the Fund;  (2)
a fee of $24,000  per year;  such  amounts to be  computed  and paid  monthly in
arrears by the Fund;  and (3) Annual  Shareholder  Account  Fees of $25.00 for a
retail and $125.00 for an  institutional  shareholder  account;  such fees to be
computed as of the last business day of the prior month.

FSS or any  sub-transfer  agent or  processing  agent  may also act and  receive
compensation  for acting as custodian,  investment  manager,  nominee,  agent or
fiduciary  for its  customers or clients who are  shareholders  of the Fund with
respect to assets invested in the Fund.

FSS also is the Schroder Core Portfolio's  transfer agent pursuant to a Transfer
Agency  Agreement  between  Schroder Core and FSS. FSS is compensated  for those
services in the amount of $12,000 per year plus certain  interestholder  account
fees.

FUND ACCOUNTING

FAcS performs  portfolio  accounting  services for the Funds  pursuant to a Fund
Accounting Agreement with the Trust. The Fund Accounting Agreement will continue
in effect only if such continuance is specifically approved at least annually by
the  Board of  Trustees  or by a vote of the  shareholders  of the  Trust and in
either  case by a  majority  of the  Trustees  who are not  parties  to the Fund
Accounting  Agreement  or  interested  persons of any such  party,  at a meeting
called for the  purpose of voting on the Fund  Accounting  Agreement.  Under its
agreement,  FAcS prepares and maintains books and records prepares and maintains
books and records of the Fund on behalf of the Trust as required  under the 1940
Act,  calculates  the net asset value per share of each Fund and  dividends  and
capital gain distributions and prepares periodic reports to shareholders and the
Securities  and Exchange  Commission.  For its services,  FAcS receives from the
Trust with respect to the Fund a fee of $12,000.

FAcS also performs portfolio  accounting  services for the Core Trust Portfolios
pursuant to a Fund  Accounting  Agreement  between Core Trust and FAcS.  For its
services,  FAcS receives a fee of $60,000 per year, plus  additional  surcharges
based upon total assets or security positions.

                                       31
<PAGE>

FSS performs transfer agency and portfolio  accounting services for the Schroder
Core  Portfolio  pursuant  to a Transfer  Agency and Fund  Accounting  Agreement
between  Schroder Core and FSS. For its portfolio  accounting  services,  FSS is
entitled to receive a fee of $60,000 per year, plus additional  surcharges based
upon total assets or security positions.  For its transfer agency services,  FSS
is entitled to receive a fee of $12,000 per year, plus per account charges.

6.  DETERMINATION OF NET ASSET VALUE

The Trust determines the net asset value per share of each Fund as of 4:00 p.m.,
Eastern  time, on each Fund Business Day by dividing the value of the Fund's net
assets (I.E.,  the value of its portfolio  securities  and other assets less its
liabilities)  by the number of that Fund's  shares  outstanding  at the time the
determination  is made.  Securities  owned by a Fund or Portfolio  listed on the
recognized stock exchanges are valued at the last reported trade price, prior to
the time when the assets are valued, on the exchange on which the securities are
principally traded. Listed securities traded on recognized stock exchanges where
last trade prices are not available are valued at mid-market prices.  Securities
traded in  over-the-counter  markets, or listed securities for which no trade is
reported  on the  valuation  date,  are  valued  at  the  most  recent  reported
mid-market  price.  Other securities and assets for which market  quotations are
not readily available are valued at fair value as determined in good faith using
methods approved by the Board.

Trading in  securities  on European  and Far Eastern  Securities  exchanges  and
over-the-counter markets may not take place on every day that the New York Stock
Exchange  is open for  trading.  Furthermore,  trading  takes  place in  various
foreign markets on days on which a Portfolio's NAV is not calculated.  If events
materially affecting the value of foreign securities occur between the time when
their price is determined and the time when net asset value is calculated,  such
securities  will be  valued at fair  value as  determined  in good  faith by the
Schroder Core Board or the Board.

All  assets  and  liabilities  of a  Portfolio  or Fund  denominated  in foreign
currencies  are  converted to U.S.  dollars at the mid price of such  currencies
against  U.S.  dollars last quoted by a major bank prior to the time when NAV of
the Fund or Portfolio is calculated.

7.  PORTFOLIO TRANSACTIONS

INVESTMENT DECISIONS

Investment  decisions for each  Portfolio and Fund and for the other  investment
advisory  clients of the  investment  advisers are made with a view to achieving
their respective investment objectives.  Investment decisions are the product of
many  factors  in  addition  to  basic  suitability  for the  particular  client
involved.  Thus, a particular security may be bought or sold for certain clients
even  though it could  have been  bought or sold for other  clients  at the same
time. Likewise, a particular security may be bought for one or more clients when
one or more clients are selling the security. In some instances,  one client may
sell a particular security to another client. It also sometimes happens that two
or more  clients  simultaneously  purchase or sell the same  security,  in which
event each day's  transactions  in such  security  are,  insofar as is possible,
averaged as to price and allocated between such clients in a manner which in the
investment  adviser's  opinion is equitable to each and in  accordance  with the
amount  being  purchased  or sold  by  each.  There  may be  circumstances  when
purchases or sales of portfolio  securities for one or more clients will have an
adverse effect on other clients.

BROKERAGE AND RESEARCH SERVICES

Transactions on U.S. stock exchanges and other agency  transactions  involve the
payment  by a Fund  or  Portfolio  of  negotiated  brokerage  commissions.  Such
commissions vary among different  brokers.  Also, a particular broker may charge
different  commissions  according to such factors as the  difficulty and size of
the  transaction.  Transactions  in foreign  securities  generally  involve  the
payment of fixed brokerage commissions, which are generally higher than those in
the United States.  Since most brokerage  transactions  for the Schroder EM Core
Portfolio   and   International   Portfolio   will  be   placed   with   foreign
broker-dealers,  certain portfolio transaction costs for these Portfolios may be

                                       32
<PAGE>

higher than fees for similar transactions executed on U.S. securities exchanges.
There is generally no stated  commission in the case of securities traded in the
over-the-counter  markets, but the price paid by the Funds or Portfolios usually
includes an undisclosed dealer commission or mark-up. In underwritten offerings,
the price paid by the Funds or Portfolios includes a disclosed, fixed commission
or discount retained by the underwriter or dealer.

The Investment Advisory Agreements  authorize and direct the investment advisers
to place  orders for the  purchase  and sale of assets  with  brokers or dealers
selected  by the  investment  advisers  in their  discretion  and to seek  "best
execution" of such portfolio transactions. An investment adviser places all such
orders for the  purchase  and sale of  portfolio  securities  and buys and sells
securities for a Fund or Portfolio  through a substantial  number of brokers and
dealers. In so doing, the investment adviser uses its best efforts to obtain for
the Fund or Portfolio the most favorable price and execution available. The Fund
or Portfolio may, however, pay higher than the lowest available commission rates
when the investment  adviser  believes it is reasonable to do so in light of the
value of the brokerage and research  services  provided by the broker  effecting
the  transaction.  In  seeking  the most  favorable  price  and  execution,  the
investment  adviser,  having in mind the Fund's or Portfolio's  best  interests,
considers  all factors it deems  relevant,  including,  by way of  illustration,
price, the size of the  transaction,  the nature of the market for the security,
the amount of the commission,  the timing of the transaction taking into account
market prices and trends, the reputation,  experience and financial stability of
the  broker-dealers  involved  and  the  quality  of  service  rendered  by  the
broker-dealers in other transactions.

It has for many years been a common practice in the investment advisory business
as conducted in certain countries,  including the United States, for advisers of
investment  companies  and other  institutional  investors  to receive  research
services  from  broker-dealers  which  execute  portfolio  transactions  for the
clients of such advisers.  Consistent with this practice, and investment adviser
may  receive  research  services  from  broker-dealers  with which it places the
Fund's or Portfolio's  portfolio  transactions.  These  services,  which in some
cases may also be purchased for cash, include such items as general economic and
security market reviews, industry and company reviews, evaluations of securities
and  recommendations  as to the purchase and sale of  securities.  Some of these
services  are of value to the  investment  adviser  in  advising  various of its
clients  (including the Fund or  Portfolio),  although not all of these services
are  necessarily  useful and of value in managing the Portfolio.  The investment
advisory fee paid by a Portfolio is not reduced  because the investment  adviser
and its affiliates receive such services.

As  permitted  by  Section  28(e) of the  Securities  Exchange  Act of 1934 (the
"Act"),  an  investment  adviser  may  cause  a  Fund  or  Portfolio  to  pay  a
broker-dealer  which provides  "brokerage and research  services" (as defined in
the Act) to it an amount of  disclosed  commission  for  effecting a  securities
transaction in excess of the commission which another  broker-dealer  would have
charged for effecting that transaction.

SCMI places all orders for purchases  and sales of Schroder EM Core  Portfolio's
and International Portfolios' securities. In selecting broker-dealers,  SCMI may
consider  research and brokerage  services  furnished to it and its  affiliates.
Schroder & Wertheim & Co. and Schroder Securities  Limited,  affiliates of SCMI,
may  receive  brokerage  commissions  from the  Portfolios  in  accordance  with
procedures  adopted by the Trust's  Trustees or Schroder Core Trustees under the
1940 Act which require periodic review of these transactions. Subject to seeking
the most  favorable  price and execution  available,  SCMI may consider sales of
shares of the Funds as a factor in the selection of  broker-dealers.  The annual
portfolio  turnover  rate of a Fund (or  Portfolio)  may exceed 50% but will not
ordinarily exceed 100%.

8.  ADDITIONAL PURCHASE AND REDEMPTION INFORMATION

Detailed  information  pertaining  to the  purchase  of  shares  of  each  Fund,
redemption of shares and the determination of the net asset value of Fund shares
is set forth in the Prospectus under "Purchases and Redemptions of Shares".

Shares of each Fund are sold on a continuous basis by the distributor.

                                       33
<PAGE>

Set forth below is an example of the method of computing the offering price of a
Fund's shares.  The example assumes a purchase of shares of beneficial  interest
aggregating  less than  $100,000  subject to the  schedule of sales  charges set
forth in the Prospectus at a price based on the net asset value per share of the
Fund on April 14, 1998.

Net Asset Value Per Share                   $ 11.60

Sales Charge, 4.00% of offering
price (4.17% of net asset value
per share)                                  $ 0.48

Offering to Public                          $ 12.08

In addition to the situations  described in the Prospectus  under "Purchases and
Redemptions of Shares," the Trust may redeem shares involuntarily,  from time to
time,  to reimburse a Fund for any loss  sustained by reason of the failure of a
shareholder to make full payment for shares  purchased by the  shareholder or to
collect  any charge  relating  to  transactions  effected  for the  benefit of a
shareholder  which  is  applicable  to  a  Fund's  shares  as  provided  in  the
Prospectus.

The  Trust  has  filed a  formal  election  with  the  Securities  and  Exchange
Commission  pursuant to which a Fund will only effect a redemption  in portfolio
securities if a shareholder  is redeeming more than $250,000 or 1% of the Fund's
total net assets, whichever is less, during any 90-day period.

REDEMPTION IN KIND

In the event  that  payment  for  redeemed  shares  is made  wholly or partly in
portfolio  securities,  brokerage  costs may be incurred by the  shareholder  in
converting  the  securities  to  cash.  An in  kind  distribution  of  portfolio
securities will be less liquid than cash. The shareholder may have difficulty in
finding a buyer for  portfolio  securities  received  in  payment  for  redeemed
shares. Portfolio securities may decline in value between the time of receipt by
the  shareholder  and  conversion  to  cash.  A  redemption  in kind of a Fund's
portfolio securities could result in a less diversified portfolio of investments
for the Fund and could affect adversely the liquidity of the Fund's portfolio.

EXCHANGE PRIVILEGE

The  exchange  privilege  permits  shareholders  of each Fund to exchange  their
shares  for  shares of any other  fund of the Trust or shares of  certain  other
portfolios  of  investment  companies  which  retain FAdS or its  affiliates  as
investment  adviser or distributor and which participate in the Trust's exchange
privilege  program  ("Participating  Fund").  For Federal  income tax  purposes,
exchange  transactions  are treated as sales on which a purchaser will realize a
capital gain or loss  depending  on whether the value of the shares  redeemed is
more or less than his basis in such shares at the time of the transaction.

By use of the exchange privilege,  the shareholder authorizes the Transfer Agent
to act upon the instruction of any person representing  himself to either be, or
to have the  authority  to act on behalf of, the  investor  and  believed by the
Transfer  Agent  to be  genuine.  The  records  of the  Transfer  Agent  of such
instructions are binding. Proceeds of an exchange transaction may be invested in
another Participating Fund in the name of the shareholder.

Exchange transactions will be made on the basis of relative net asset values per
share at the time of the exchange  transaction plus any sales charge  applicable
to the  Participating  Fund  whose  shares  are  being  acquired.  Shares of any
Participating Fund may be redeemed and the proceeds used to purchase,  without a
sales charge,  shares of any other Participating Fund that are offered without a
sales charge. Shares of any Participating Fund purchased with a sales charge may
be redeemed and the proceeds used to purchase, without a sales charge, shares of
any other  Participating  Fund otherwise sold with the same sales charge. If the
Participating Fund purchased in the exchange  transaction imposes a higher sales
charge than was paid originally on the exchanged shares, the shareholder will be
responsible  for the difference  between the two sales charges.  Shares acquired
through the reinvestment of dividends


                                       34
<PAGE>

and  distributions  are deemed to have been  acquired  with a sales  charge rate
equal to that paid on the shares on which the dividend or distribution was paid.

The terms of the exchange privilege are subject to change, and the privilege may
be  terminated  by any of the  Participating  Funds or the  Trust.  However  the
privilege  will not be  terminated,  and no material  change that  restricts the
availability  of the  privilege to  shareholders  will be  implemented,  without
reasonable advance notice to shareholders.

9.  TAXATION

The Funds intend to qualify as a regulated investment company under Subchapter M
of the Internal  Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code").  To qualify as a
regulated  investment  company the Fund intends to distribute to shareholders at
least 90% of its net  investment  income  (which  includes,  among other  items,
dividends,  interest and the excess of any net short-term capital gains over net
long-term capital losses), and to meet certain diversification of assets, source
of income,  and other  requirements of the Code. By so doing, a Fund will not be
subject to  Federal  income tax on its net  investment  income and net  realized
capital  gains (the excess of net long-term  capital  gains over net  short-term
capital  losses)  distributed  to  shareholders.  If a Fund does not meet all of
these Code requirements,  it will be taxed as an ordinary  corporation,  and its
distributions will be taxable to shareholders as ordinary income.

Amounts not  distributed  on a timely basis in  accordance  with a calendar year
distribution  requirement  are  subject to a 4%  nondeductible  excise  tax.  To
prevent  imposition of the excise tax, a Fund must  distribute for each calendar
year  an  amount  equal  to the sum of (1) at  least  98%  its  ordinary  income
(excluding  any capital gains or losses) for the calendar year, (2) at least 98%
of the excess of its  capital  gains over  capital  losses  realized  during the
one-year  period  ending  October  31, of such year,  and (3) all such  ordinary
income and capital  gains for previous  years that were not  distributed  during
such years. A  distribution  will be treated as paid during the calendar year if
it is declared  by the Fund in October,  November or December of the year with a
record date in such month and paid by the Fund during  January of the  following
year. Such distributions will be taxable to shareholders in the calendar year in
which the distributions are declared, rather than the calendar year in which the
distributions are received.

Under the Code,  gains or losses  attributable to fluctuations in exchange rates
which occur  between the time the Fund accrues  interest or other  receivable or
accrues expenses or other liabilities  denominated in a foreign currency and the
time the  Fund  actually  collects  such  receivable  or pays  such  liabilities
generally are treated as ordinary income or ordinary loss.  Similarly,  gains or
losses on  disposition  of debt  securities  denominated  in a foreign  currency
attributable to fluctuations  in the value of the foreign  currency  between the
date of acquisition of the security and the date of disposition as well as gains
or losses from  certain  foreign  currency  transactions  and options on certain
foreign currency  transactions,  generally are treated as ordinary gain or loss.
These  gains or losses,  referred  to under the Code as  "Section  988" gains or
losses,  may increase or decrease the amount of the Fund's net investment income
to be distributed to its shareholders as ordinary income.

Generally,  the  hedging  transactions  undertaken  by the  Fund  may be  deemed
"straddles"  for Federal income tax purposes.  The straddle rules may affect the
character  of gains (or  losses)  realized  by the  Fund.  In  addition,  losses
realized by the Fund on  positions  that are part of a straddle  may be deferred
under the straddle  rules,  rather than being taken into account in  calculating
the  taxable  income for the  taxable  year in which the  losses  are  realized.
Because  only a few  regulations  implementing  the  straddle  rules  have  been
promulgated,  the tax  consequences to the Fund of hedging  transactions are not
entirely clear.  The hedging  transactions may increase the amount of short-term
capital  gain  realized  by a Fund  which  is  taxed  as  ordinary  income  when
distributed to shareholders.

A Fund may make one or more of the elections  available under the Code which are
applicable to  straddles.  If the Fund makes any of the  elections,  the amount,
character  and timing of the  recognition  of gains or losses from the  affected
straddle  positions  will be determined  under rules that vary  according to the
election(s)  made.  The rules  applicable  under  certain of the  elections  may
operate to  accelerate  the  recognition  of gains or losses  from the  affected
straddle positions.

                                       35
<PAGE>

Because  application  of the straddle rules may affect the character of gains or
losses,  defer losses and/or  accelerate the recognition of gains or losses from
the  affected  straddle  positions,  the  amount  which must be  distributed  to
shareholders  and which  will be taxed to  shareholders  as  ordinary  income or
long-term capital gain, may be increased or decreased as compared to a fund that
did not engage in such hedging transactions.

The requirements  applicable to regulated  investment companies such as the Fund
may limit the extent to which the Fund will be able to engage in transactions in
options and forward contracts.

Distributions  of net  investment  income  (including  realized  net  short-term
capital gain) are taxable to shareholders as ordinary income. It is not expected
that such  distributions  will be eligible for the dividends  received deduction
available to corporations.

Distributions  of net  long-term  capital  gain are taxable to  shareholders  as
long-term  capital  gain,  regardless of the length of time the Fund shares have
been held by a  shareholder,  and are not  eligible for the  dividends  received
deduction.  A loss realized by a  shareholder  on the sale of shares of the Fund
with respect to which capital gain  dividends have been paid will, to the extent
of such capital gain  dividends,  be treated as long-term  capital loss although
such shares may have been held by the shareholder for one year or less. Further,
a loss  realized on a  disposition  will be  disallowed to the extent the shares
disposed of are replaced (whether by reinvestment or distributions or otherwise)
within a period of 61 days beginning 30 days before and ending 30 days after the
shares are disposed of. In such a case, the basis of the shares acquired will be
adjusted to reflect the disallowed loss.

All  distributions  are  taxable  to  the  shareholder   whether  reinvested  in
additional shares or received in cash.  Shareholders receiving  distributions in
the form of  additional  shares  will have a cost basis for  Federal  income tax
purposes in each share  received  equal to the net asset value of a share of the
Fund on the reinvestment date.  Shareholders will be notified annually as to the
Federal tax status of distributions.

Distributions by a Fund reduce the net asset value of the Fund's shares.  Should
a distribution reduce the net asset value below a shareholder's cost basis, such
distribution nevertheless would be taxable to the shareholder as ordinary income
or capital gain as described above, even though, from an investment  standpoint,
it may constitute a partial return of capital.  In particular,  investors should
be careful to consider  the tax  implications  of buying  shares just prior to a
distribution.  The price of shares purchased at that time includes the amount of
the forthcoming distribution. Those purchasing just prior to a distribution will
receive a distribution which will nevertheless be taxable to them.

Upon redemption or sale of his shares, a shareholder will realize a taxable gain
or loss depending upon his basis in his shares. Such gain or loss generally will
be  treated as capital  gain or loss if the  shares  are  capital  assets in the
shareholder's hands. Such gain or loss generally will be long-term or short-term
depending upon the shareholder's holding period for the shares.

The Funds intend to minimize  foreign income and withholding  taxes by investing
in obligations  the payments with respect to which will be subject to minimal or
no such taxes  insofar as this  objective is  consistent  with the Funds' income
objective.  However,  since a Fund may incur foreign taxes, it intends, if it is
eligible  to do so,  to  elect  under  Section  853 of the  Code to  treat  each
shareholder as having received an additional  distribution from the Fund, in the
amount indicated in a notice furnished to him, as his pro rata portion of income
taxes paid to or  withheld  by foreign  governments  with  respect to  interest,
dividends and gain on the Fund's foreign portfolio investments.  The shareholder
then may take the  amount of such  foreign  taxes paid or  withheld  as a credit
against  his  Federal  income  tax,  subject  to  certain  limitations.  If  the
shareholder finds it more to his advantage to do so, he may, in the alternative,
deduct the foreign  tax  withheld as an itemized  deduction,  in  computing  his
taxable income.  Each shareholder is referred to his tax adviser with respect to
the availability of the foreign tax credit.

The Funds will be required to report to the Internal Revenue Service (the "IRS")
all  distributions  as well as gross  proceeds  from the  redemption of the Fund
shares,   except  in  the  case  of  certain  exempt   shareholders.   All  such
distributions  and proceeds  generally will be subject to withholding of Federal
income  tax at a rate of 31%  ("backup  withholding")  in the case of  nonexempt
shareholders  if (1) the  shareholder  fails to  furnish  the  Fund  with and to

                                       36
<PAGE>

certify  the  shareholder's  correct  taxpayer  identification  number or social
security  number,  (2) the IRS notifies the Fund that the shareholder has failed
to  report  properly  certain  interest  and  dividend  income to the IRS and to
respond  to  notices  to  that  effect,  or (3)  when  required  to do  so,  the
shareholder  fails to certify that he is not subject to backup  withholding.  If
the withholding  provisions are applicable,  any such distributions or proceeds,
whether reinvested in additional shares or taken in cash, will be reduced by the
amount required to be withheld. Any amounts withheld may be credited against the
shareholder's Federal income tax liability.  Investors may wish to consult their
tax advisers about the applicability of the backup withholding provisions.

The foregoing discussion relates only to Federal income tax law as applicable to
U.S. persons (i.e., U.S. citizens and residents and U.S. domestic  corporations,
partnerships, trusts and estates). Distributions by the Fund also may be subject
to state and local taxes,  and their  treatment under state and local income tax
laws may differ  from the  Federal  income tax  treatment.  Shareholders  should
consult  their tax  advisors  with respect to  particular  questions of Federal,
state and local taxation.  Shareholders  who are not U.S. persons should consult
their tax advisors  regarding U.S. and foreign tax  consequences of ownership of
shares of the Fund including the likelihood that  distributions to them would be
subject to withholding of U.S. tax at a rate of 30% (or a lower rate under a tax
treaty).

10.  OTHER INFORMATION

THE TRUST AND ITS SHARES

The Trust was originally  incorporated in Maryland on March 24, 1980 and assumed
the name of Forum  Funds,  Inc.  on March 16,  1987.  On January 5, 1996,  Forum
Funds,  Inc. was  reorganized  as a Delaware  business  trust.  The Trust has an
unlimited  number of authorized  shares of beneficial  interest.  The Board may,
without  shareholder  approval,  divide the authorized  shares into an unlimited
number of separate portfolios or series (such as the Fund) and may in the future
divide portfolios or series into two or more classes of shares (such as Investor
and  Institutional  Shares).  Currently the  authorized  shares of the Trust are
divided into 16 separate series.

Each  share of each  fund of the  Trust  and  each  class of  shares  has  equal
dividend,  distribution,  liquidation and voting rights,  and fractional  shares
have  those  rights  proportionately,   except  that  expenses  related  to  the
distribution  of the shares of each class (and certain  other  expenses  such as
transfer  agency and  administration  expenses) are borne solely by those shares
and each class votes separately with respect to the provisions of any Rule 12b-1
plan  which  pertain to the class and other  matters  for which  separate  class
voting is appropriate under applicable law.  Generally,  shares will be voted in
the aggregate  without reference to a particular  portfolio or class,  except if
the matter  affects only one  portfolio or class or voting by portfolio or class
is required by law, in which case shares will be voted  separately  by portfolio
or class, as appropriate. Delaware law does not require the Trust to hold annual
meetings of shareholders,  and it is anticipated that shareholder  meetings will
be held only when  specifically  required by Federal or state law.  Shareholders
(and Trustees) have  available  certain  procedures for the removal of Trustees.
There are no conversion or  preemptive  rights in connection  with shares of the
Trust.  All shares when issued in accordance with the terms of the offering will
be fully paid and  nonassessable.  Shares are redeemable at net asset value,  at
the option of the shareholders,  subject to any contingent deferred sales charge
that may apply.  A shareholder  in a portfolio is entitled to the  shareholder's
pro rata share of all dividends and distributions  arising from that portfolio's
assets and, upon redeeming  shares,  will receive the portion of the portfolio's
net assets represented by the redeemed shares.

CORE TRUST AND SCHRODER CORE

Core Trust is a business trust  organized under the law of the State of Delaware
in September 1994.  Schroder Core is a business trust organized under the law of
the State of Delaware in September  1995.  Core Trust and Schroder Core are each
registered  under  the  Act  as  an  open-end  management   investment  company.
Currently,  Core Trust has [ ] separate  portfolios,  and Schroder  Core has six
separate portfolios.  The assets of each Schroder Core Portfolio or Core Trust ,
and of any other  portfolios of each respective trust now existing or created in
the future, belong only to the Portfolio or those other portfolios,  as the case
may be. The assets  belonging to a portfolio are charged with the liabilities of
and all expenses,  costs,  charges and reserves  attributable to that portfolio.
Under each of Core Trust's and Schroder  Core's Trust  Instrument,  the Trustees
are authorized to issue beneficial interest in one or more separate and distinct
series. Investments in a Portfolio have no preference, preemptive, conversion or
similar rights and are fully paid and 


                                       37
<PAGE>

nonassessable,  except as set forth  below.  Each  investor  in a  Portfolio  is
entitled  to a vote in  proportion  to the  amount  of its  investment  therein.
Investors in a Portfolio and other series  (collectively,  the  "portfolios") of
Core Trust or  Schroder  Core will all vote  together  in certain  circumstances
(e.g., election of the Trustees and ratification of auditors, as required by the
1940 Act and the rules  thereunder).  One or more  portfolios  could control the
outcome of these votes.  Investors do not have  cumulative  voting  rights,  and
investors  holding more than 50% of the aggregate  interests in Core Trust or in
Schroder Core or in a Portfolio,  as the case may be, may control the outcome of
votes.  The Trust is not  required  and has no current  intention to hold annual
meetings of  investors,  but Core Trust and Schroder Core each will hold special
meetings of investors when (1) a majority of the Trustees determines to do so or
(2)  investors  holding at least 10% of the  interests in Core Trust or Schroder
Core (or a Portfolio) request in writing a meeting of investors in Core Trust or
Schroder  Core  (or  a  Portfolio).  Except  for  certain  matters  specifically
described in the Trust  Instruments,  the  Trustees may amend the Trust's  Trust
Instrument without the vote of investors.

Either Core Trust or Schroder Core may enter into a merger or consolidation with
respect  to a  Portfolio  or sell all or  substantially  all of its  assets,  if
approved by the applicable Board (without approval of the interestholders of the
Portfolio).  A Portfolio may be terminated (1) upon liquidation and distribution
of its  assets,  if  approved  by the  vote  of a  majority  of the  Portfolio's
outstanding  voting  securities  (as  defined  in the 1940  Act);  or (2) by the
Trustees of Core Trust or  Schroder  Core on written  notice to the  Portfolio's
investors.  Upon  liquidation or  dissolution  of any  Portfolio,  the investors
therein  would be  entitled  to share pro rata in its net assets  available  for
distribution to investors.

Core Trust and Schroder  Core are each  organized as a business  trust under the
law of the State of Delaware.  Each trust's  interestholders  are not personally
liable  for the  obligations  of the trust  under  Delaware  law.  The  Delaware
Business Trust Act provides that an  interestholder of a Delaware business trust
shall be entitled to the same  limitation of liability  extended to shareholders
of private  corporations  for profit.  However,  no similar  statutory  or other
authority limiting business trust interestholder  liability exists in many other
states,  including Texas. As a result, to the extent that Core Trust or Schroder
Core or an  interestholder  is  subject to the  jurisdiction  of courts in those
states,  the courts may not apply  Delaware  law,  and may thereby  subject Core
Trust or Schroder  Core to  liability.  To guard  against  this risk,  the Trust
Instruments  of Core Trust and Schroder  Core  disclaims  liability  for acts or
obligations of the trust and requires that notice of such disclaimer be given in
each agreement,  obligation and instrument entered into by Core Trust,  Schroder
Core or their respective Trustees, and provides for indemnification out of Trust
property of any  interestholder  held  personally  liable for the obligations of
Core Trust and Schroder  Core.  Thus,  the risk of an  interestholder  incurring
financial loss beyond his investment because of shareholder liability is limited
to  circumstances  in which:  (1) a court refuses to apply  Delaware law; (2) no
contractual limitation of liability is in effect; and (3) Core Trust or Schroder
Core,  as  applicable,  itself is unable  to meet its  obligations.  In light of
Delaware law, the nature of the trusts' business,  and the nature of its assets,
the Board believes that the risk of personal liability to a Trust interestholder
is remote.

PLACEMENT AGENT

Forum Financial  Services,  Inc., Two Portland  Square,  Portland,  Maine 04101,
serves as Core Trust's and Schroder  Core's  placement  agent.  FFSI receives no
compensation for such placement agent services.

COUNSEL

Legal  matters in connection  with the issuance of  beneficial  interests of the
Trust are passed  upon by the law firm of Seward & Kissel,  1200 G Street,  N.W.
Washington, D.C. 20005.

Kirkpatrick & Lockhart,  1800 Massachusetts Avenue, N.W., Washington D.C. 20036,
counsel to Core Trust, passes upon certain legal matters in connection with Core
Trust.

Ropes & Gray, One International  Place,  Boston,  Massachusetts,  counsel to the
Schroder Core  Portfolio,  passes upon certain legal matters in connection  with
the interests in the Portfolio.

                                       38
<PAGE>

INDEPENDENT ACCOUNTANTS

Deloitte  &  Touche  LLP,  125  Summer  Street,  Boston,  Massachusetts,  02110,
independent auditors, act as auditors for the Trust.

Coopers & Lybrand LLP ("Coopers & Lybrand")  serves as  independent  accountants
for the Schroder Core Portfolio.  Coopers & Lybrand  provides audit services and
consultation  in  connection  with  review  of  U.S.   Securities  and  Exchange
Commission  filings.  Coopers &  Lybrand's  address is One Post  Office  Square,
Boston, Massachusetts 02109.



                                       39
<PAGE>


APPENDIX A - DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES RATINGS

1.  CORPORATE BONDS

MOODY'S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC. ("MOODY'S")

Bonds which are rated Aaa are judged by Moody's to be of the best quality.  They
carry the smallest  degree of investment  risk and are generally  referred to as
"gilt edge." Interest  payments are protected by a large or by an  exceptionally
stable margin and principal is secure. While the various protective elements are
likely to change,  such changes as can be visualized are most unlikely to impair
the fundamentally strong position of such issues.

Bonds  which are rated Aa are  judged to be of high  quality  by all  standards.
Together  with  the Aaa  group,  they  comprise  what  are  generally  known  as
high-grade  bonds.  They are rated lower than the best bonds because  margins of
protection may not be as large as in Aaa securities or fluctuation of protective
elements  may be of greater  amplitude  or there may be other  elements  present
which make the long-term risks appear somewhat larger than in Aaa securities.

Bonds which are rated A possess many favorable investment  attributes and are to
be  considered as upper medium grade  obligations.  Factors  giving  security to
principal and interest are considered adequate but elements may be present which
suggest a susceptibility to impairment some time in the future.

Note:  Those bonds in the Aa and A groups  which  Moody's  believes  possess the
strongest investment attributes are designated by the symbols Aa1 and A1.

STANDARD AND POOR'S CORPORATION ("S&P")

Bonds  rated  AAA have the  highest  rating  assigned  by S&P.  Capacity  to pay
interest and repay principal is extremely strong.

Bonds rated AA have a very strong  capacity to pay interest and repay  principal
and differ from the highest rated issues only in small degree.

Bonds  rated A have a strong  capacity  to pay  interest  and  repay  principal,
although they are somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in
circumstances   and  economic   conditions  than  debt  rated  in  higher  rated
categories.

Note:  The ratings for AA and A may be modified by the addition of a plus (+) or
minus (-) sign to show the relative standing within the rating category.

FITCH IBCA, INC.. ("FITCH")

AAA Bonds are  considered  to be  investment  grade  and of the  highest  credit
quality.  The obligor has an  exceptionally  strong  ability to pay interest and
repay  principal,  which is unlikely to be  affected by  reasonably  foreseeable
events.

AA Bonds are considered to be investment  grade and of very high credit quality.
The  obligor's  ability to pay  interest  and repay  principal  is very  strong,
although not quite as strong as bonds rated AAA.  Because bonds rated in the AAA
and AA  categories  are  not  significantly  vulnerable  to  foreseeable  future
developments, shorter-term debt of these issuers is generally rate F-1+.

A Bonds are considered to be investment  grade and of high credit  quality.  The
obligor's  ability to pay  interest  and repay  principal  is  considered  to be
strong, but may be more vulnerable to adverse changes in economic conditions and
circumstances than bonds with higher ratings.

                                      A-1
<PAGE>

Plus (+) and  minus (-) signs  are used  with a rating  symbol to  indicate  the
relative position of a credit within the rating category.  Plus and minus signs,
however, are not used in the AAA categories.

2.  COMMERCIAL PAPER

MOODY'S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC.

Moody's two highest ratings for short-term debt, including commercial paper, are
Prime-1 and Prime-2.  Both are judged investment grade, to indicate the relative
repayment ability of rated issuers.

Issuers rated Prime-1 have a superior ability for repayment of senior short-term
debt  obligations.  Prime-1 repayment ability will often be evidenced by many of
the following characteristics:

          --      Leading market positions in well-established industries.
          --      High rates of return on funds employed.
          --      Conservative capitalization structure with moderate reliance 
                  on debt and ample asset protection.
          --      Broad margins in earnings coverage of fixed financial charges
                  and high internal cash generation.
          --      Well-established access to a range of financial markets and
                  assured sources of alternate liquidity.

Issuers rated  Prime-2 by Moody's have a strong  ability for repayment of senior
short-term  debt  obligations.  This will  normally be  evidenced by many of the
characteristics of issuers rated Prime-1 but to a lesser degree. Earnings trends
and  coverage   ratios,   while  sound,   may  be  more  subject  to  variation.
Capitalization characteristics, while still appropriate, may be more affected by
external conditions. Ample alternate liquidity is maintained.

STANDARD AND POOR'S CORPORATION

S&P's two highest  commercial  paper  ratings are A and B. Issues  assigned an A
rating are regarded as having the greatest  capacity for timely payment.  Issues
in this  category  are  delineated  with the numbers 1, 2 and 3 to indicate  the
relative  degree of  safety.  An A-1  designation  indicates  that the degree of
safety  regarding  timely payment is either  overwhelming or very strong.  Those
issues determined to possess  overwhelming  safety  characteristics  are denoted
with a plus (+) sign designation. The capacity for timely payment on issues with
an A-2 designation is strong.  However,  the relative degree of safety is not as
high as for issues  designated A-1. A-3 issues have a satisfactory  capacity for
timely  payment.  They are,  however,  somewhat  more  vulnerable to the adverse
effects  of  changes  in  circumstances  than  obligations  carrying  the higher
designations.  Issues rated B are  regarded as having only an adequate  capacity
for timely payment. However, such capacity may be damaged by changing conditions
or short-term adversities.

FITCH IBCA, INC..

Fitch's  short-term ratings apply to debt obligations that are payable on demand
or have original maturities of generally up to three years, including commercial
paper, certificates of deposit,  medium-term notes, and municipal and investment
notes.

F-1+. Issues assigned this rating are regarded as having the strongest degree of
assurance for timely payment.

F-1.  Issues  assigned this rating  reflect an assurance of timely  payment only
slightly less in degree than issues rated F-1+.

F-2.  Issues  assigned this rating have a  satisfactory  degree of assurance for
timely payment,  but the margin of safety is not as great as for issues assigned
F-1+ or F-1 ratings.

                                      A-2
<PAGE>

APPENDIX B
TEXT OF FORUM BROCHURE

In connection with its  advertisements,  a Fund may provide a description of the
Fund's investment adviser and its affiliates, which are service providers to the
Fund. Text which is currently in use is set forth below.

"FORUM FINANCIAL GROUP OF COMPANIES

Forum Financial  Group of Companies  represent more than a decade of diversified
experience  with every  aspect of mutual  funds.  The Forum  Family of Funds has
benefited from the informed,  sharply  focused  perspective on mutual funds that
experience makes possible.

The Forum Family of Funds has been created and managed by  affiliated  companies
of Portland-based  Forum Financial Group, among the nation's largest mutual fund
administrators  providing clients with a full line of services for every type of
mutual fund.

The Forum  Family of Funds is designed to give  investment  representatives  and
investors a broad choice of carefully  structured  and  diversified  portfolios,
portfolios  that can satisfy a wide  variety of  immediate  as well as long-term
investment goals.

Forum  Financial Group has developed its "brand name" family of mutual funds and
has made them available to the investment public and to institutions on both the
national and regional levels.

For more than a decade Forum has had direct  experience with mutual funds from a
different  perspective,  a perspective  made  possible by Forum's  position as a
leading designer and full-service  administrator  and manager of mutual funds of
all types.

Today Forum  Financial  Group  administers  and  provides  services for over 120
mutual  funds for 17  different  fund  managers,  with more than $30  billion in
client assets. Forum has its headquarters in Portland, Maine, and has offices in
Seattle, Bermuda, and Warsaw, Poland. In a joint venture with Bank Handlowy, the
largest  and  oldest  commercial  bank  in  Poland,   Forum  operates  the  only
independent  transfer agent and mutual fund accounting business in Poland. Forum
directs an off-shore and hedge fund administration  business through its Bermuda
office. It employs more than 230 professionals worldwide.

From the  beginning,  Forum  developed a plan of action that was effective  with
both start- up funds, and funds that needed  restructuring and improved services
in order to live up to their potential.  The success of its innovative  approach
is  evident  in  Forum's  growth  rate over the  years,  a growth  rate that has
consistently outstripped that of the mutual fund industry as a whole, as well as
that of the fund service outsource industry.

Forum has worked with both  domestic  and  international  mutual fund  sponsors,
designing  unique  mutual  fund  structures,  positioning  new funds  within the
sponsors' own corporate planning and targeted markets.

Forum's staff of experienced lawyers, many of whom have been associated with the
Securities  and  Exchange  Commission,  have  been  available  to work with fund
sponsors to customize  fund  components and to evaluate the potential of various
fund structures.

Forum has introduced fund sponsors to its unique proprietary Core and Gateway(R)
partnership,  helping them to take advantage of this full-service  master/feeder
structure.

Fund sponsors  understand that even the most efficiently and creatively designed
fund can disappoint  shareholders  if it is inadequately  serviced.  That is the
reason why fund  sponsors  have relied on Forum to meet all of a fund's  complex
compliance, regulatory, and filing needs.

                                      B-1
<PAGE>

Forum's full service commitment  includes providing state-of- the-art accounting
support (Forum has 8 CPAs on staff, as well as senior  accountants who have been
associated with Big 6 accounting firms).  Forum's proprietary  accounting system
is continually upgraded and can provide custom-built modules to satisfy a fund's
specific  requirements.   This  service  is  joined  with  transfer  agency  and
shareholder  service  groups that draw their strength both from the high caliber
of the people staffing each unit and from Forum's  advanced  technology  support
system.

More than a decade of  experience  with mutual  funds has given Forum  practical
hands-on  experience and knowledge of how mutual funds function "from the inside
out."

Forum has put that  experience to work by creating the Forum Family of Funds,  a
family where each member is designed  and  positioned  for your best  investment
advantage,  and where each fund is  serviced  with the utmost  attention  to the
delivery of timely, accurate, and comprehensive shareholder information.

INVESTMENT ADVISERS

Forum Investment  Advisors,  LLC offers the services of portfolio  managers with
the highest  qualifications--because without such direction, a comprehensive and
goal-oriented  investment  program  and  ongoing  investment  strategy  are  not
possible.  Serving  as  portfolio  managers  for the  Forum  Family of Funds are
individuals  with  decades  of  experience  with  some  of the  country's  major
financial institutions.

Individual  funds in the Forum Family of Funds invest in portfolios that have as
their investment adviser nationally recognized institutions,  including Schroder
Capital Management International, Inc., a major figure in worldwide mutual funds
that, with its affiliates, managed over $175 billion as of September 30, 1997.

Forum Funds are also  managed by the  portfolio  managers of H.M.  Payson & Co.,
founded in Portland, Maine in 1854 and one of the oldest investment firms in the
country.  Payson has approximately $1 billion in assets under  management,  with
clients that include  pension plans,  endowment  funds,  and  institutional  and
individual accounts.

FORUM INVESTMENT ADVISORS, LLC

Forum Investment  Advisors,  LLC is the largest Maine based  investment  adviser
with  approximately  $1.4  billion in assets  under  management.  The  portfolio
managers have decades of combined experience in a cross section of the country's
financial  markets.  The managers have  specific,  day-to-day  experience in the
asset class  portfolios  they manage,  bringing  critical  focus to meeting each
fund's explicit investment objectives. The portfolio managers have been involved
in investing the assets of large  insurance  companies,  banks,  pension  plans,
individuals,  and of course mutual funds. Forum Investment  Advisors,  LLC has a
staff of analysts and investment  administrators  to meet the demands of serving
shareholders in our funds.

FORUM FAMILY OF FUNDS

It has been said that  mutual  fund  investment  offerings--of  which  there are
nearly  10,000,  with assets spread across stock,  bond,  and money market funds
worth  more  than  $4  trillion--come  in  a  rainbow  of  varieties.  A  better
description  would be a "spectrum" of varieties,  the spectrum graded from green
through  amber  and on to red.  In  simpler  terms,  from low risk  investments,
through moderate to high risk. The lower the risk, the lower the possible reward
- -- the higher the risk, the higher the potential reward.

The Forum Family of Funds provides  conservative  investment  opportunities that
reduce the risk of loss of capital,  using underlying  money market  investments
U.S. Government  securities  (although the shares of the Forum Funds are neither
insured nor guaranteed by the U.S. Government or its agencies),  thus cushioning
the investment  against  market  volatility.  These funds offer regular  income,
ready access to your money, and flexibility to buy or sell at any time.

                                      B-2
<PAGE>

In the less  conservative  but still not  aggressive  category  are funds in the
Forum Family that seek to provide steady income and, in certain cases,  tax-free
earnings.  Such investments  provide important  diversification to an investment
portfolio.

Growth funds in the Forum Family more  aggressively  pursue a high return at the
risk of market volatility.  These funds include domestic and international stock
mutual funds."


                                      B-3
<PAGE>


APPENDIX C
PEOPLES HERITAGE NEWS RELEASE

Peoples Heritage Financial Group, Inc. (NASDAQ:PHBK) announced today that it has
formed an alliance with a major mutual fund provider and an investment  advisory
firm to expand its mutual fund  offerings.  The  alliance  with Forum  Financial
Group and H.M.  Payson & Company will result in 18 funds,  including  the unique
Maine Municipal Bond Fund and New Hampshire Bond Fund, being offered through the
branches  of Peoples'  affiliate  banks in Maine,  New  Hampshire  and  northern
Massachusetts and the Company's trust and investment subsidiaries

'There is no secret to where  financial  services  are moving,  under one roof,"
said William J. Ryan, Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer of Peoples
Heritage.   "One  only  has  to  watch  the  virtually  daily  announcements  of
consolidations  in  the  financial  sector  to  understand  that  customers  are
demanding and receiving 'one-stop' financial services.

"We think we are adding the additional  competitive  advantage of funds that are
managed and administered close to home."

Eighteen  Forum funds will be offered  including two Payson funds.  The tax-free
Maine and New Hampshire  state bond funds are the only two such funds  available
and usually  invest 80% of total  assets in  municipal  securities.  Other funds
being  provided by the alliance  include money  market,  fixed income and equity
funds.

Forum Financial, based in Portland, Maine since 1987, administers 146 funds with
more than $36 billion in assets.  Forum  manages  mutual  funds for  independent
investment advisors such as Payson and for banks. Forum Investment Advisors, LLC
an affiliate,  is the largest Maine-based  investment advisor with approximately
$1.7 billion in fund assets under management.

"We are providing a great product set to the customers served by Peoples' nearly
200 branches in northern New  England,"  said John Y.  Keffer,  Forum  Financial
president,  "The key today is to link a wide variety of investment  options with
convergent, easy access for customers. I believe this alliance does just that."

H.M.  Payson & Co.,  founded in 1854, is one of the nation's  oldest  investment
firms with  nearly $1 billion in assets  under  management  and $300  million in
non-managed  custodial accounts.  The Payson value Fund and Payson Balanced Fund
are among the 18 offerings.

"I believe we have all the  ingredients  of a  tremendous  alliance,"  said John
Walker,  Payson president and managing  director.  "We have the region's premier
community banking company,  a community-based  investment  advisor,  and a local
mutual fund company that operates  nationally  and  specializes  in working with
banks. We are poised to provide solid investment performance and service."

Peoples Heritage Financial Group is a $10 billion multi-state bank and financial
services  holding company  headquartered  in Portland,  Maine. Its Maine banking
affiliate,  Peoples Heritage Bank, has the state's leading deposit market share.
Its New Hampshire  banking  affiliate,  Bank of New  Hampshire,  has the state's
leading deposit market share. Family Bank, the Company's  Massachusetts  banking
subsidiary,  has the state's tenth largest  deposit market share and the leading
market  share  in many of the  northern  Massachusetts  communities  it  serves.
Peoples  affiliate  banks  also  operate  subsidiaries  in  leasing,  trust  and
investment services and insurance.

                                      C-1
<PAGE>


FORUM FINANCIAL GROUP:

Headquarters:  Two Portland Square, Portland, Maine 04101
President:  John Y. Keffer
Offices:  Portland, Seattle, Warsaw, Bermuda
*Established  in 1986 to  administer  mutual  funds for  independent  investment
advisors and banks *Among the nation's largest  third-party fund  administrators
*Uses proprietary in-house systems and custom programming capabilities
         *ADMINISTRATION  AND  DISTRIBUTION   SERVICES:  Regulatory, compliance,
          expense  accounting, budgeting for all funds
         *FUND  ACCOUNTING  SERVICES:  Portfolio valuation, accounting, dividend
          declaration,  and tax  advice
         *SHAREHOLDER SERVICES: Preparation of statements, distribution support,
          inquiries  and  processing of trades
*CLIENT ASSETS UNDER ADMINISTRATION AND DISTRIBUTION:  $36.9 billion
*CLIENT ASSETS PROCESSED BY FUND ACCOUNTING:  $47.6 billion
*CLIENT FUNDS UNDER ADMINISTRATION AND DISTRIBUTION:  146 mutual funds with 219
share classes
*INTERNATIONAL VENTURES:
         Joint  venture  with Bank  Handlowy in Warsaw,  Poland,  using  Forum's
         proprietary   transfer  agency  and  distribution   systems   Off-shore
         investment  fund  administration,  using  Bermuda as Forum's  center of
         operations
*FORUM EMPLOYEES:  United States -198, Poland - 61, Bermuda - 3

FORUM CONTACTS:
Mark Kaplan, Managing Director and Portfolio Manager, Forum Investment Advisors,
LLC,
(207) 879-1900 X 6123
Tony Santaniello, Director of Marketing, (207) 879-1900 X 6175

                                      C-2
<PAGE>


H.M. PAYSON & CO.:

Headquarters:  One Portland Square, Portland, Maine
President and Managing Director: John Walker
Quality investment services and conservative wealth management since 1854
*Assets under Management: $1 Billion
*Custody Income Assets: $300 Million
*Client Base: 85% individuals; 15% institutional
*Owned by 11 shareholders; 11 managing directors
*Payson Balanced Fund and Payson Value Fund  (administrative  and shareholder
 services  provided by Forum
Financial Group)
*Employees: 45


H.M. PAYSON & CO. CONTACT:
Joel Harris, Portfolio/Marketing Coordinator, (207) 772-3761

                                      C-3
<PAGE>



                              INVESTORS GROWTH FUND

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Account Information and
Shareholder Servicing:                 Distributor:
         Forum Financial Corp.                  Forum Financial Services, Inc.
         P.O. Box 446                           Two Portland Square
         Portland, Maine 04112                  Portland, Maine  04101
         207-879-0001                           207-879-1900
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                       STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

                                DECEMBER 1, 1997,
                            AS AMENDED APRIL 15, 1998

Investors  Growth Fund (the "Fund") is a series of Forum Funds (the "Trust"),  a
registered,   open-end   investment   company.   This  Statement  of  Additional
Information supplements the Prospectus dated December 1, 1997 offering shares of
the Fund, and should be read only in conjunction with the Prospectus,  a copy of
which may be obtained by an investor  without  charge by contacting  the Trust's
Distributor at the address listed above.

THIS  STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL  INFORMATION IS NOT A PROSPECTUS AND IS AUTHORIZED
FOR DISTRIBUTION TO PROSPECTIVE  INVESTORS ONLY IF PRECEDED OR ACCOMPANIED BY AN
EFFECTIVE PROSPECTUS.

                                TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                                                            PAGE

 1.       General......................................................       2
 2.       Investment Policies..........................................       3
 3.       Investment Limitations.......................................       5
 4.       Performance Data.............................................       7
 5.       Management...................................................       8
 6.       Determination of Net Asset Value.............................      12
 7.       Portfolio Transactions.......................................      13
 8.       Additional Purchase and
             Redemption Information....................................      14
 9.       Taxation.....................................................      15
 10.      Other Information............................................      17

 Appendix A - Description of Securities Ratings
 Appendix B - Text of Forum Brochure
 Appendix C - Text of Peoples Heritage News Release


<PAGE>

1.  GENERAL

THE  TRUST.  The Trust is  registered  with the SEC as an  open-end,  management
investment  company and was organized as a business  trust under the laws of the
State of Delaware on August 29, 1995. On January 5, 1996 the Trust  succeeded to
the  assets  and  liabilities  of  Forum  Funds,  Inc.  Forum  Funds,  Inc.  was
incorporated  on March 24,  1980 and assumed  the name of Forum  Funds,  Inc. on
March 16, 1987.  The Board has the  authority  to issue an  unlimited  number of
shares of beneficial interest of separate series with no par value per share and
to create  separate  classes of shares within each series.  The Trust  currently
offers  shares of  eighteen  series and has two series  that have not  commenced
operation as of the date of this SAI. The series of the Trust are as follows:

Investors Bond Fund                        Maine Municipal Bond Fund
TaxSaver Bond Fund                         New Hampshire Bond Fund
Daily Assets Treasury Fund                 Austin Global Equity Fund
Daily Assets Treasury Obligations Fund     Oak Hall Equity Fund
Daily Assets Cash Fund                     Quadra Limited Maturity Treasury Fund
Daily Assets Government Fund               Quadra Value Equity Fund
Daily Assets Tax Exempt Fund               Quadra Growth Fund
Payson Value Fund                          Quadra International Equity Fund
Payson Balanced Fund                       Quadra Opportunistic Bond Fund


DEFINITIONS. As used in this Statement of Additional Information,  the following
terms shall have the meanings listed:

"Board" means the Board of Trustees of Forum Funds.

"FAS" means Forum Administrative Services, LLC.

"FAcS" means Forum Accounting Services, LLC.

"FFC" means Forum Financial Corp.

"Forum" means Forum Financial Services, Inc.

"Forum Advisors" means Forum Advisors, Inc.

"Fund" means Investors Growth Fund, a separate series of Forum Funds.

"Fund Business Day" has the meaning ascribed  thereto in the current  Prospectus
of the Fund.

"NRSRO" means a nationally recognized statistical rating organization.

"SAI" means this Statement of Additional Information.

 "SEC" means the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.

"Trust" means Forum Funds, a Delaware business trust.

"U.S.  Government  Securities" has the meaning  ascribed  thereto by the current
Prospectus of the Funds.

"1940 Act" means the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.


                                       2
<PAGE>

2. INVESTMENT POLICIES

INTRODUCTION

The following  information  supplements the discussion  found under  "Investment
Objective and Policies" and "Additional Investment Policies" in the Prospectus.

For temporary defensive purposes, to accumulate cash for investments, or to meet
anticipated  redemptions,  the Fund may  invest  in (or  enter  into  repurchase
agreements  with banks and broker  dealers  with  respect  to)  short-term  debt
securities,  including Treasury bills and other U.S. Government securities,  and
certificates of deposit and bankers' acceptances of U.S. banks.

ILLIQUID AND RESTRICTED SECURITIES

"Illiquid and Restricted  Securities" under "Additional  Investment Policies" in
the  Prospectus  sets  forth the  circumstances  in which the Fund may invest in
"restricted  securities".  In connection  with the Fund's  original  purchase of
restricted  securities  it may  negotiate  rights  with the  issuer to have such
securities  registered  for  sale at a later  time.  Further,  the  registration
expenses of illiquid  restricted  securities  may also be negotiated by the Fund
with the issuer at the time such  securities  are  purchased  by the Fund.  When
registration is required,  however, a considerable period may elapse between the
decision to sell the securities and the time the Fund would be permitted to sell
such securities. A similar delay might be experienced in attempting to sell such
securities pursuant to an exemption from registration. Thus, the Fund may not be
able to  obtain  as  favorable  a price  as that  prevailing  at the time of the
decision to sell.

U.S. GOVERNMENT SECURITIES

The Fund may invest in obligations  issued or guaranteed by the U.S.  Government
or  its  agencies  or  instrumentalities  which  have  remaining  maturates  not
exceeding one year. Agencies and instrumentalities which issue or guarantee debt
securities and which have been  established or sponsored by the U.S.  Government
include the Bank for  Cooperatives,  the  Export-Import  Bank,  the Federal Farm
Credit  System,  the Federal  Home Loan Banks,  the Federal  Home Loan  Mortgage
Corporation,  the Federal Intermediate Credit Banks, the Federal Land Banks, the
Federal  National  Mortgage   Association,   the  Government  National  Mortgage
Association and the Student Loan Marketing  Association.  Except for obligations
issued by the U.S. Treasury and the Government  National  Mortgage  Association,
none of the obligations of the other agencies or  instrumentalities  referred to
above are backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S.
Government.

BANK OBLIGATIONS

The Fund may invest in  obligations  of U.S. banks  (including  certificates  of
deposit and bankers' acceptances) having total assets at the time of purchase in
excess  of $1  billion.  Such  banks  must be  members  of the  Federal  Deposit
Insurance Corporation or the Federal Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation.

The Fund also may invest in  certificates  of deposit  issued by foreign  banks,
denominated in any major foreign  currency.  The Fund will invest in instruments
issued by foreign  banks which,  in the view of its  investment  adviser and the
Trustees of the Trust, are of  credit-worthiness  and financial stature in their
respective countries comparable to U.S. banks used by the Fund.

A certificate of deposit is an interest-bearing negotiable certificate issued by
a bank  against  funds  deposited  in  the  bank.  A  bankers'  acceptance  is a
short-term draft drawn on a commercial bank by a borrower, usually in connection
with an international  commercial  transaction.  Although the borrower is liable
for payment of the draft, the bank  unconditionally  guarantees to pay the draft
at its face value on the maturity date.

                                       3
<PAGE>

LOANS OF PORTFOLIO SECURITIES

The Fund may lend its portfolio securities subject to the restrictions stated in
the Prospectus.  Under applicable regulatory  requirements (which are subject to
change),  the loan  collateral must (a) on each business day, at least equal the
market value of the loaned securities and (b) must consist of cash, bank letters
of credit,  U.S. Government  securities,  or other cash equivalents in which the
Fund is permitted to invest.  To be acceptable as collateral,  letters of credit
must obligate a bank to pay amounts demanded by the Fund if the demand meets the
terms of the letter. Such terms and the issuing bank must be satisfactory to the
Fund. When lending portfolio securities,  the Fund receives from the borrower an
amount  equal to the  interest  paid or the  dividends  declared  on the  loaned
securities  during  the term of the loan  plus the  interest  on the  collateral
securities (less any finders' or administrative  fees the Fund pays in arranging
the  loan).  A Fund  may  share  the  interest  it  receives  on the  collateral
securities with the borrower as long as it realizes at least a minimum amount of
interest required by the lending  guidelines  established by the Board. The Fund
will not lend its  portfolio  securities to any officer,  director,  employee or
affiliate of the Fund or the  investment  adviser to the Fund.  The terms of the
Fund's loans must meet certain tests under the Internal  Revenue Code and permit
the Fund to reacquire loaned securities on five business days' notice or in time
to vote on any important matter.

SHORT-TERM DEBT SECURITIES

The Fund may invest in commercial paper, that is short-term unsecured promissory
notes issued in bearer form by bank holding companies,  corporations and finance
companies.  The commercial  paper purchased by the Fund for temporary  defensive
purposes  consists of direct  obligations of domestic issuers which, at the time
of investment, are rated "P-1" by Moody's Investors Service, Inc. ("Moody's") or
"A-1" by Standard & Poor's  Corporation  ("S&P"),  or securities  which,  if not
rated,  are issued by companies having an outstanding debt issue currently rated
Aa by Moody's or AAA or AA by S&P.  The rating  "P-1" is the highest  commercial
paper rating assigned by Moody's and the rating "A-1" is the highest  commercial
paper ratings assigned by S&P.

REPURCHASE AGREEMENTS

The Fund may invest in  securities  subject to repurchase  agreements  with U.S.
banks or broker-dealers  maturing in seven days or less. In a typical repurchase
agreement  the  seller of a security  commits  itself at the time of the sale to
repurchase  that  security  from the buyer at a  mutually  agreed-upon  time and
price.  The repurchase  price exceeds the sale price,  reflecting an agreed-upon
interest rate  effective  for the period the buyer owns the security  subject to
repurchase.  The  agreed-upon  rate is unrelated  to the  interest  rate on that
security. The Fund's investment adviser will monitor the value of the underlying
security at the time the transaction is entered into and at all times during the
term of the repurchase agreement to insure that the value of the security always
equals or exceeds the  repurchase  price.  In the event of default by the seller
under the repurchase agreement, the Fund may have difficulties in exercising its
rights to the  underlying  securities  and may incur costs and  experience  time
delays in  connection  with the  disposition  of such  securities.  To  evaluate
potential risks, the investment adviser reviews the  credit-worthiness  of those
banks and dealers with which the Fund enters into repurchase agreements.

CONVERTIBLE SECURITIES

The Fund may  invest  in  convertible  preferred  stocks  and  convertible  debt
securities.  A convertible security is a bond, debenture,  note, preferred stock
or other  security  that may be  converted  into or  exchanged  for a prescribed
amount of common  stock of the same or a different  issuer  within a  particular
period of time at a specified  price or  formula.  Convertible  securities  rank
senior to common stocks in a  corporation's  capital  structure and,  therefore,
carry less risk than the corporation's  common stock. The value of a convertible
security  is a function  of its  "investment  value" (its value as if it did not
have a conversion  privilege),  and its "conversion value" (the security's worth
if it were to be  exchanged  for  the  underlying  security,  at  market  value,
pursuant to its conversion privilege).

                                       4
<PAGE>

DEPOSITORY RECEIPTS

Investments in securities of foreign  issuers may be in the form of sponsored or
unsponsored   American  Depository  Receipts  ("ADRs")  or  European  Depository
Receipts ("EDRs"),  or other similar  securities  convertible into securities of
foreign issuers. These securities may not necessarily be denominated in the same
currency as the securities  into which they may be converted.  ADRs are receipts
typically  issued in the United  States by a bank or trust  company,  evidencing
ownership of the  underlying  securities.  EDRs are  typically  issued in Europe
under a similar arrangement.  Generally,  ADRs, in registered form, are designed
for use in the U.S.  securities  markets and EDRs, in bearer form,  are designed
for use in European securities markets.  Unsponsored ADRs may be created without
the  participation  of the foreign issuer.  Holders of these ADRs generally bear
all the  costs of the ADR  facility,  whereas  foreign  issuers  typically  bear
certain  costs in a sponsored  ADR. The bank or trust  company  depository of an
unsponsored   ADR  may  be  under  no  obligation   to  distribute   shareholder
communications  received  from the  foreign  issuer  or to pass  through  voting
rights.

FOREIGN SECURITIES

Investment in the securities of foreign issuers may involve risks in addition to
those normally  associated with  investments in the securities of U.S.  issuers.
There may be less publicly  available  information about foreign issuers than is
available  for U.S.  issuers,  and foreign  auditing,  accounting  and financial
reporting practices may differ from U.S.  practices.  Foreign securities markets
may be less  active  than U.S.  markets,  trading  may be thin and  consequently
securities prices may be more volatile.  The Fund's investment adviser, will, in
general,  invest only in securities of companies  and  governments  of countries
which,  in  its  judgment,   are  both  politically  and  economically   stable.
Nevertheless,  all foreign investments are subject to risks of foreign political
and economic  instability,  adverse  movements in foreign  exchange  rates,  the
imposition  or  tightening  of  exchange  controls or other  limitations  on the
repatriation  of foreign capital and changes in foreign  governmental  attitudes
toward  private  investment,  possibly  leading  to  nationalization,  increased
taxation, or confiscation of Fund assets.

WARRANTS AND STOCK RIGHTS

The Fund may  invest  in  warrants,  which are  options  to  purchase  an equity
security  at  a  specified  price  (usually  representing  a  premium  over  the
applicable  market value of the  underlying  equity  security at the time of the
warrant's  issuance).  A Fund may not invest  more than 5% of its net assets (at
the time of investment) in warrants (other than those that have been acquired in
units or attached to other securities). No more than 2% of the Fund's net assets
(at the time of  investment)  may be invested in warrants that are not listed on
the New York or  American  Stock  Exchanges.  Investments  in  warrants  involve
certain risks,  including the possible lack of a liquid market for the resale of
the warrants,  potential price  fluctuations as a result of speculation or other
factors and failure of the price of the underlying  security to reach a level at
which the  warrant  can be  prudently  exercised  (in which case the warrant may
expire  without  being  exercised,  resulting  in the loss of the Fund's  entire
investment therein).  The prices of warrants do not necessarily move parallel to
the prices of the underlying securities. Warrants have no voting rights, receive
no dividends and have no rights with respect to the assets of the issuer.

In  addition,  the  Fund  may  invest  up to 5% of its  assets  (at the  time of
investment)  in stock rights.  A stock right is an option given to a shareholder
to buy  additional  shares at a  predetermined  price  during a  specified  time
period.

3.  INVESTMENT LIMITATIONS

The  following  investment  restrictions  restate  or are in  addition  to those
described under "Investment  Objective and Policies" and "Additional  Investment
Policies and Risk  Considerations"  in the Prospectus.  The Fund has adopted the
following  investment  limitations  which are fundamental  policies of the Fund,
unless otherwise stated.

(a)  Diversification:

         The  Fund  may not,  with  respect  to 75% of its  assets,  purchase  a
         security  if as a  result:  (i)  more  than 5% of its  assets  would be
         invested in the  securities of any single issuer or (ii) the Fund would
         own more than 10% 


                                       5
<PAGE>

          of the  outstanding  voting  securities  of any  single  issuer.  This
          restriction   does  not  apply  to  securities   issued  by  the  U.S.
          Government, its agencies or instrumentalities.

(b)      Illiquid Securities

         The Fund will not invest  more than 10% of its net assets in  "illiquid
         securities",  which are  securities  that  cannot be disposed of within
         seven  days  at  their  then  current  value.   For  purposes  of  this
         limitation,   "illiquid   securities"   includes,   except   in   those
         circumstances described below, (i) "restricted  securities",  which are
         securities  that  cannot be resold to the public  without  registration
         under the  Federal  securities  laws,  and (ii)  securities  of issuers
         having a record  (together  with all  predecessors)  of less than three
         years of continuous operation.

(c)      Concentration

         The Fund will not invest  25% or more of the value of its total  assets
         in any one industry.

(d)      Underwriting Activities

         The Fund will not underwrite  securities issued by other persons except
         to the extent that, in connection with the disposition of its portfolio
         investments,  it  may  be  deemed  to  be  an  underwriter  under  U.S.
         securities laws.

(e)      Borrowing

         The  Fund  may  borrow  money  for  temporary  or  emergency  purposes,
         including the meeting of redemption  requests,  but not in excess of 33
         13% of the value of the Fund's total assets (computed immediately after
         the borrowing).

(f)      Pledging

         As a  non-fundamental  policy,  the  Fund  may  not  pledge,  mortgage,
         hypothecate  or encumber any of its assets  except to secure  permitted
         borrowings or to secure other permitted transactions.

(g)      Margin and Short Sales

         The Fund may not purchase securities on margin;  however,  the Fund may
         make margin deposits in connection with any Hedging Instruments,  which
         it may use as permitted by any of its other fundamental policies.

         The Fund may not sell securities short.

(h)      Investing for Control

         The Fund may not make investments for the purpose of exercising control
         or management.

(i)      Real Estate

         The Fund may not purchase or sell real estate,  provided  that the Fund
         may  invest in  securities  issued by  companies  which  invest in real
         estate or interests therein.

(j)      Lending

         The Fund will not lend money except in connection  with the acquisition
         of that  portion  of  publicly-distributed  debt  securities  which the
         Fund's investment  policies and restrictions permit it to purchase (see

                                       6
<PAGE>

         "Investment  Objective" and "Investment  Policies" in the  Prospectus);
         the Fund may also make loans of  portfolio  securities  (see  "Loans of
         Portfolio  Securities")  and  enter  into  repurchase  agreements  (see
         "Repurchase Agreements");

(k)      Senior Securities

         The Fund will not issue senior securities except pursuant to Section 18
         of the Investment  Company Act of 1940 ("1940 Act") and except that the
         Fund may borrow money  subject to investment  limitations  specified in
         the Fund's Prospectus

(l)      Purchases and Sales of Commodities

         The Fund will not invest in commodities or commodity  contracts  (other
         than  Hedging  Instruments  which it may use as permitted by any of its
         other fundamental policies,  whether or not any such Hedging Instrument
         is considered to be a commodity or a commodity contract);

(m)      Options and Futures Contracts

         The Fund may not purchase or write puts or calls except as permitted by
         any of its other fundamental investment policies.

(n)      Warrants

         The Fund may not  invest  in  warrants,  valued at the lower of cost or
         market,  more than 5% of the value of the Fund's  net assets  (included
         within that amount, but not to exceed 2% of the value of the Fund's net
         assets,  may be  warrants  which  are not  listed  on the  New  York or
         American  Stock  Exchange.  Warrants  acquired  by the Fund in units or
         attached to securities may be deemed to be without value).

4.  PERFORMANCE DATA

The Fund may, from time to time,  include quotations of its average annual total
return in advertisements or reports to shareholders or prospective investors.

Quotations  of average  annual  total  return will be  expressed in terms of the
average annual  compounded  rate of return of a  hypothetical  investment in the
Fund over periods of 1, 5 and 10 years (up to the life of the Fund),  calculated
pursuant to the following formula:

                                    P (1+T)n = ERV

(where P = a  hypothetical  initial  payment of $1,000,  T = the average  annual
total return, n = the number of years, and ERV = the ending  redeemable value of
a hypothetical  $1,000  payment made at the beginning of the period).  All total
return  figures will  reflect the  deduction  of Fund  expenses  (net of certain
reimbursed  expenses) on an annual basis, and will assume that all dividends and
distributions are reinvested when paid.

Quotations of total return will reflect only the  performance  of a hypothetical
investment in the Fund during the particular time period shown. Total return for
the Fund will vary based on changes  in market  conditions  and the level of the
Fund's  expenses,  and no reported  performance  figure  should be considered an
indication of performance which may be expected in the future.

In  connection  with  communicating  total  return  to  current  or  prospective
investors,  the Fund also may compare these figures to the  performance of other
mutual  funds  tracked by mutual  fund  rating  services  or to other  unmanaged
indexes which may assume  reinvestment of dividends but generally do not reflect
deductions for administrative and management costs.

                                       7
<PAGE>

Investors who purchase and redeem shares of the Fund through a customer  account
maintained at a Service Organization may be charged one or more of the following
types of fees as agreed upon by the Service Organization and the investor,  with
respect to the customer services provided by the Service  Organization:  account
fees (a fixed  amount per month or per year);  transaction  fees (a fixed amount
per transaction processed);  compensating balance requirements (a minimum dollar
amount a customer  must  maintain in order to obtain the services  offered);  or
account  maintenance  fees (a periodic  charge  based upon a  percentage  of the
assets in the account or of the dividends paid on these assets).  Such fees will
have the effect of reducing  the  average  annual  total  return of the Fund for
those investors.

5.  MANAGEMENT

TRUSTEES AND OFFICERS

THE TRUST

The trustees and officers of the Trust and their  principal  occupations  during
the past five years are set forth  below.  Each  Trustee  who is an  "interested
person" (as defined by the 1940 Act) of the Trust is indicated by an asterisk.

John Y. Keffer,* Chairman and President (age 56)

          President and Director,  Forum Financial Services,  Inc. (a registered
          broker-dealer),  Forum  Administrative  Services,  LLC (a mutual  fund
          administrator),  Forum Financial  Corp. (a registered  transfer agent)
          and Forum Advisors, Inc. (a registered investment adviser). Mr. Keffer
          is a Trustee and/or officer of various registered investment companies
          for which  Forum  Administrative  Services,  LLC  serves as manager or
          administrator and for which Forum Financial  Services,  Inc. serves as
          manager, administrator and/or distributor. His address is Two Portland
          Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

Costas Azariadis, Trustee (age 53)

          Professor of Economics,  University of California,  Los Angeles, since
          July 1992. Prior thereto,  Dr. Azariadis was Professor of Economics at
          the  University  of   Pennsylvania.   His  address  is  Department  of
          Economics,  University of California, Los Angeles, 405 Hilgard Avenue,
          Los Angeles, California 90024.

James C. Cheng, Trustee (age 54)

          President of Technology  Marketing  Associates (a marketing consulting
          company) since September 1991. Prior thereto,  Mr. Cheng was President
          and Chief  Executive  Officer of  Network  Dynamics,  Incorporated  (a
          software  development  company).  His  address  is 27  Temple  Street,
          Belmont, Massachusetts 02178.

J. Michael Parish, Trustee (age 53)

          Partner at the law firm of Reid and Priest,  LLP,  since  1995.  Prior
          thereto, he was a partner at the law firm of Winthrop Stimson Putnam &
          Roberts from 1989 to 1995 and was a partner at LeBoeuf,  Lamb, Leiby &
          MacRae,  a law firm of which he was a member  from  1974 to 1989.  His
          address is 40 Wall Street, New York, New York 10005.

Mark D. Kaplan, Vice President, Assistant Treasurer and Assistant Secretary (age
42)

          Managing  Director at Forum Financial  Services,  Inc. since September
          1995. Prior thereto,  Mr. Kaplan was Managing Director and Director of
          Research  at H.M.  Payson & Co. His  address is Two  Portland  Square,
          Portland, Maine 04101.

                                       8
<PAGE>

David I. Goldstein, Secretary (age 36)

          Counsel,  Forum  Financial  Services,  Inc.,  with  which  he has been
          associated  since 1991.  Prior thereto,  Mr.  Goldstein was associated
          with the law firm of  Kirkpatrick  & Lockhart.  Mr.  Goldstein is also
          Secretary or  Assistant  Secretary  of various  registered  investment
          companies  for  which  Forum  Administrative  Services,  LLC or  Forum
          Financial  Services,  Inc.  serves as  manager,  administrator  and/or
          distributor.  His  address is Two  Portland  Square,  Portland,  Maine
          04101.

Max Berueffy, Assistant Secretary (age 46)

          Counsel,  Forum  Financial  Services,  Inc.,  with  which  he has been
          associated since 1994. Prior thereto, Mr. Berueffy was on the staff of
          the U.S.  Securities and Exchange Commission for seven years, first in
          the appellate branch of the Office of the General  Counsel,  then as a
          counsel to  Commissioner  Grundfest  and  finally as a senior  special
          counsel in the Division of Investment Management. Mr. Berueffy is also
          Secretary or  Assistant  Secretary  of various  registered  investment
          companies  for  which  Forum  Administrative  Services,  LLC or  Forum
          Financial  Services,  Inc.  serves as  manager,  administrator  and/or
          distributor.  His  address is Two  Portland  Square,  Portland,  Maine
          04101.

Cheryl O. Tumlin, Assistant Secretary (age 31)

         Assistant Counsel,  Forum Financial Services,  Inc., with which she has
         been associated since July 1996.  Prior thereto,  Ms. Tumlin was on the
         staff of the U.S.  Securities and Exchange Commission as an attorney in
         the Division of Market  Regulation  and prior thereto Ms. Tumlin was an
         associate  with the law firm of Robinson  Silverman  Pearce  Aronsohn &
         Berman in New York, New York. Ms. Tumlin is also Assistant Secretary of
         various registered  investment companies for which Forum Administrative
         Services,  LLC or Forum  Financial  Services,  Inc.  serves as manager,
         administrator  and/or distributor.  Her address is Two Portland Square,
         Portland, Maine 04101.

TRUSTEE COMPENSATION

Each  Trustee of the Trust  (other  than John Y.  Keffer,  who is an  interested
person of the Trust) is paid $1,000 for each Board meeting attended  (whether in
person or by  electronic  communication)  and is paid $1,000 for each  committee
meeting  attended  on a date when a Board  meeting is not held.  As of March 31,
1997,  in  addition  to $1,000 for each Board  meeting  attended,  each  Trustee
receives $100 per active portfolio of the Trust. To the extent a meeting relates
to only  certain  portfolios  of the Trust,  Trustees are paid the $100 fee only
with respect to those  portfolios.  Trustees are also  reimbursed for travel and
related expenses incurred in attending  meetings of the Board. No officer of the
Trust is compensated by the Trust.

The following  table provides the aggregate  compensation  paid to each Trustee.
The Trust has not  adopted  any form of  retirement  plan  covering  Trustees or
officers. Information is presented for the fiscal year ended March 31, 1997.

<TABLE>
           <S>                          <C>                 <C>              <C>               <C>
                                                           ACCRUED           ANNUAL
                                        AGGREGATE          PENSION        BENEFITS UPON       TOTAL
         TRUSTEE                      COMPENSATION        BENEFITS         RETIREMENT      COMPENSATION
         -------                      ------------        --------         ----------      ------------
         Mr. Keffer                       None              None              None             None
         Mr. Azariadis                   $4,000             None              None            $4,000
         Mr. Cheng                       $4,000             None              None            $4,000
         Mr. Parish                      $4,000             None              None            $4,000
</TABLE>

TRUSTEE COMPENSATION FOR CORE TRUST (DELWARE). Each of the Trustees of the Trust
is also a Trustee of Core Trust (Delaware),  a registered,  open-end  management
investment  company ("Core Trust").  Each Trustee of Core Trust (other than John
Y. Keffer,  who is an  interested  person of Core Trust) is paid $1,000 for each
Core  Trust  Board  meeting  attended   (whether  in  person  or  by  electronic
communication)  plus $100 per active  portfolio of Core Trust and is paid $1,000
for each committee meeting attended on a date when a Core Trust Board meeting is
not 


                                       9
<PAGE>

held. To the extent a meeting relates to only certain  portfolios of Core Trust,
trustees are paid the $100 fee only with respect to those portfolios. Core Trust
trustees  are also  reimbursed  for  travel and  related  expenses  incurred  in
attending  meetings of the Core Trust Board. For the fiscal year ended March 31,
1997, each Core Trust trustee received fees totalling $7,200.

INVESTMENT ADVISER

Forum  Advisors,  Inc.  serves as  investment  adviser to Investors  Growth Fund
pursuant to an  investment  advisory  agreement  with the Trust.  Subject to the
general  control of the Board,  Forum  Advisors is  responsible  for among other
things,  developing a continuing  investment  program for the Fund in accordance
with its  investment  objective  and  reviewing the  investment  strategies  and
policies of the Fund. Forum Advisors was incorporated under the laws of Delaware
in 1987 and is registered  under the  Investment  Advisers Act of 1940.  For its
services,  Forum Advisors receives an advisory fee at an annual rate of 0.65% of
Investor Growth Fund's average daily net assets.

Pursuant to the investment advisory agreement, Forum Advisors is responsible for
managing the investment and  reinvestment of the assets included in the Fund and
for   continuously   reviewing,   supervising  and   administering   the  Fund's
investments.  In this regard, it is the responsibility of Forum Advisors to make
decisions  relating to the Fund's  investments  and to place  purchase  and sale
orders  regarding such investments with brokers or dealers selected by it in its
discretion.  Forum  Advisors  also  furnishes  to the Board,  which has  overall
responsibility  for the business and affairs of the Trust,  periodic  reports on
the investment performance of the Fund.

Under the terms of the investment advisory agreement, Forum Advisors is required
to manage the Fund's investment portfolio in accordance with applicable laws and
regulations.  In making its  investment  decisions,  Forum Advisors does not use
material  information  that may be in its possession or in the possession of its
affiliates.

The  investment  advisory  agreement  will  continue  in  effect  provided  such
continuance  is  approved  annually  (i) by the  holders  of a  majority  of the
outstanding voting securities of the Fund (as defined by the 1940 Act) or by the
Board  and  (ii) by a  majority  of the  Trustees  who are not  parties  to such
agreement  or  "interested  persons"  (as  defined  in the 1940 Act) of any such
party. The investment  advisory  agreement may be terminated  without penalty by
vote of the or the  shareholders  of the Fund on 60 days' written  notice to the
Adviser,  or by the Adviser on 60 days' written  notice to the Trust and it will
terminate  automatically  if assigned.  The investment  advisory  agreement also
provides  that,  with  respect  to the  Fund,  neither  Forum  Advisors  nor its
personnel shall be liable for any error of judgment or mistake of law or for any
act or omission in the  performance  of its or their duties to the Fund,  except
for willful  misfeasance,  bad faith or gross  negligence in the  performance of
Forum  Advisors  or their  duties or by reason of reckless  disregard  of its or
their obligations and duties under the investment advisory agreement.

ADMINISTRATIVE SERVICES

Forum Administrative Services, LLC ("FAS") acts as administrator to the Trust on
behalf of the Fund pursuant to an  Administration  Agreement with the Trust.  As
administrator,  FAS provides management and administrative services necessary to
the  operation  of the  Trust  (which  include,  among  other  responsibilities,
negotiation  of contracts  and fees with,  and  monitoring  of  performance  and
billing of, the transfer  agent and custodian and arranging for  maintenance  of
books and records of the Trust),  and  provides  the Trust with  general  office
facilities.  The Administration  Agreement will remain in effect for a period of
twelve months with respect to the Fund and thereafter is  automatically  renewed
each year for an additional term of one year.

The Administration  Agreement terminates automatically if it is assigned and may
be  terminated  without  penalty  with respect to the Fund by vote of the Fund's
shareholders  or by either party on not more than 60 days' written  notice.  The
Administration  Agreement  also  provides  that FAS shall not be liable  for any
error  of  judgment  or  mistake  of law  or for  any  act  or  omission  in the
administration or management of the Trust, except for willful  misfeasance,  bad
faith or gross  negligence  in the  performance  of FAS's duties or by reason of
reckless  disregard  of its  obligations  and  duties  under the  Administration
Agreement.

                                       10
<PAGE>

At the request of the Board, FAS provides  persons  satisfactory to the Board to
serve as  officers  of the  Trust.  Those  officers,  as well as  certain  other
employees and Trustees of the Trust, may be directors,  officers or employees of
FAS, the Adviser or their affiliates.

DISTRIBUTOR

Forum Financial Services,  Inc.  ("Forum"),  an affiliate of FAS, is the Trust's
distributor  and acts as the agent of the Trust in connection  with the offering
of shares of the Fund pursuant to a  Distribution  Agreement.  The  Distribution
Agreement  will continue in effect for twelve months and will continue in effect
thereafter only if its continuance is specifically approved at least annually by
the Board or by vote of the shareholders entitled to vote thereon, and in either
case, by a majority of the Trustees who (i) are not parties to the  Distribution
Agreement, (ii) are not interested persons of any such party or of the Trust and
(iii) with  respect to any class for which the Trust has adopted a  distribution
plan,  have no direct or indirect  financial  interest in the  operation of that
distribution plan or in the Distribution  Agreement, at a meeting called for the
purpose of voting on the Distribution  Agreement.  All  subscriptions for shares
obtained by Forum are directed to the Trust for  acceptance  and are not binding
on  the  Trust  until  accepted  by  it.  Forum  receives  no   compensation  or
reimbursement of expenses for the distribution services provided pursuant to the
Distribution Agreement and is under no obligation to sell any specific amount of
Fund shares.

The Distribution Agreement provides that Forum shall not be liable for any error
of  judgment  or mistake of law or in any event  whatsoever,  except for willful
misfeasance,  bad faith or gross negligence in the performance of Forum's duties
or by reason of  reckless  disregard  of its  obligations  and duties  under the
Distribution Agreement.

The  Distribution  Agreement  is  terminable  with  respect to the Fund  without
penalty by the Trust on 60 days' written notice when  authorized  either by vote
of the Fund's  shareholders or by a vote of a majority of the Board, or by Forum
on 60 days'  written  notice.  The  Distribution  Agreement  will  automatically
terminate in the event of its assignment.

Forum may enter into  agreements with selected  broker-dealers,  banks, or other
financial  institutions  for distribution of shares of the Fund. These financial
institutions  may charge a fee for their  services and may receive  shareholders
service fees even though  shares of the Fund are sold without  sales  charges or
distribution fees. These financial  institutions may otherwise act as processing
agents, and will be responsible for promptly transmitting  purchase,  redemption
and other requests to the Fund.

Investors who purchase  shares in this manner will be subject to the  procedures
of the institution through whom they purchase shares, which may include charges,
investment  minimums,  cutoff  times and other  restrictions  in addition to, or
different  from,  those listed  herein.  Information  concerning  any charges or
services will be provided to customers by the financial  institution.  Investors
purchasing  shares of the Fund in this manner should  acquaint  themselves  with
their  institution's  procedures and should read this  Prospectus in conjunction
with any materials and information provided by their institution.  The financial
institution  and not its customers will be the  shareholder of record,  although
customers  may have the right to vote shares  depending  upon their  arrangement
with the institution.

TRANSFER AGENT

Forum Financial Corp.  ("FFC") acts as transfer agent of the Trust pursuant to a
transfer agency agreement (the "Transfer Agency Agreement"). The Transfer Agency
Agreement  provided,  with respect to the Fund,  for an initial term of one year
from its  effective  date  and for its  continuance  in  effect  for  successive
twelve-month  periods  thereafter,  provided that the agreement is  specifically
approved at least  annually by the Board or, with respect to either  Fund,  by a
vote of the  shareholders  of that Fund, and in either case by a majority of the
directors  who are not parties to the Transfer  Agency  Agreement or  interested
persons of any such party at a meeting  called for the  purpose of voting on the
Transfer Agency Agreement.

Among the  responsibilities  of FFC as agent for the Trust  are:  (1)  answering
customer  inquiries  regarding  account status and history,  the manner in which
purchases  and  redemptions  of shares of the Fund may be  effected  and 


                                       11
<PAGE>

certain other  matters  pertaining to the Fund;  (2) assisting  shareholders  in
initiating  and changing  account  designations  and  addresses;  (3)  providing
necessary  personnel  and  facilities  to  establish  and  maintain  shareholder
accounts  and  records,   assisting  in  processing   purchase  and   redemption
transactions  and receiving wired funds; (4) transmitting and receiving funds in
connection  with  customer  orders to purchase or redeem  shares;  (5) verifying
shareholder  signatures  in  connection  with  changes  in the  registration  of
shareholder  accounts;  (6) furnishing  periodic statements and confirmations of
purchases  and  redemptions;   (7)  arranging  for  the  transmission  of  proxy
statements, annual reports, prospectuses and other communications from the Trust
to its shareholders;  (8) arranging for the receipt, tabulation and transmission
to the Trust of proxies  executed by  shareholders  with  respect to meetings of
shareholders of the Trust;  and (9) providing such other related services as the
Trust or a shareholder may reasonably request.

FFC or any  sub-transfer  agent or  processing  agent  may also act and  receive
compensation as custodian,  investment manager,  nominee, agent or fiduciary for
its customers or clients who are shareholders of the Fund with respect to assets
invested in the Fund. FFC or any  sub-transfer  agent or other  processing agent
may elect to credit  against the fees  payable to it by its clients or customers
all or a portion of any fee received  from the Trust or from FFC with respect to
assets  of  those  customers  or  clients  invested  in the  Fund.  FFC,  FAS or
sub-transfer  agents or  processing  agents  retained  by FFC may be  Processing
Organizations  (as defined in the Prospectus)  and, in the case of sub- transfer
agents or processing agents, may also be affiliated persons of FFC or FAS.

For its services under the Transfer Agency Agreement, FFC receives: (i) a fee at
an annual rate of 0.25  percent of the average  daily net assets of the Fund and
(ii) a fee of $24,000 per year;  such amounts to be computed and paid monthly in
arrears by the Fund; and (iii) Annual  Shareholder  Account Fees of $25.00 for a
retail and $125.00 for an  institutional  shareholder  account;  such fees to be
computed as of the last business day of the prior month.

FFC or any  sub-transfer  agent or  processing  agent  may also act and  receive
compensation  for acting as custodian,  investment  manager,  nominee,  agent or
fiduciary  for its  customers or clients who are  shareholders  of the Fund with
respect to assets invested in the Fund.

FUND ACCOUNTING

Forum Accounting  Services,  LLC ("FAcS") performs portfolio accounting services
for the Fund pursuant to the Fund Accounting  Agreement with the Trust. The Fund
Accounting  Agreement  will  continue  in  effect  only if such  continuance  is
specifically approved at least annually by the Board of Trustees or by a vote of
the  shareholders  of the Trust and in either case by a majority of the Trustees
who are not parties to the Fund  Accounting  Agreement or interested  persons of
any such  party,  at a  meeting  called  for the  purpose  of voting on the Fund
Accounting Agreement. Under its agreement, FAcS prepares and maintains books and
records  prepares and  maintains  books and records of the Fund on behalf of the
Trust as required  under the 1940 Act,  calculates the net asset value per share
of the Fund and dividends and capital gain  distributions  and prepares periodic
reports to  shareholders  and the  Securities and Exchange  Commission.  For its
services,  FAcS  receives  from  the  Trust  with  respect  to the Fund a fee of
$12,000.

6.  DETERMINATION OF NET ASSET VALUE

         The Trust  determines  the net asset  value per share of the Fund as of
4:00 p.m.,  Eastern Time, on each Fund Business Day by dividing the value of the
Fund's net assets (I.E., the value of its portfolio  securities and other assets
less its  liabilities)  by the number of that Fund's shares  outstanding  at the
time the  determination  is made.  Securities  owned by the Fund  listed  on the
recognized stock exchanges are valued at the last reported trade price, prior to
the time when the assets are valued, on the exchange on which the securities are
principally traded. Listed securities traded on recognized stock exchanges where
last trade prices are not available are valued at mid-market prices.  Securities
traded in  over-the-counter  markets, or listed securities for which no trade is
reported  on the  valuation  date,  are  valued  at  the  most  recent  reported
mid-market  price.  Other securities and assets for which market  quotations are
not readily available are valued at fair value as determined in good faith using
methods approved by the Board.

                                       12
<PAGE>

Trading in  securities  on European  and Far Eastern  Securities  exchanges  and
over-the-counter markets may not take place on every day that the New York Stock
Exchange  is open for  trading.  Furthermore,  trading  takes  place in  various
foreign  markets on days on which the Fund's  NAV is not  calculated.  If events
materially affecting the value of foreign securities occur between the time when
their price is determined and the time when net asset value is calculated,  such
securities  will be  valued at fair  value as  determined  in good  faith by the
Board.

All assets and  liabilities of the Fund  denominated  in foreign  currencies are
converted  to U.S.  dollars  at the mid price of such  currencies  against  U.S.
dollars  last  quoted by a major  bank prior to the time when NAV of the Fund is
calculated.

7.  PORTFOLIO TRANSACTIONS

INVESTMENT DECISIONS

Investment  decisions for the Fund and for the other investment advisory clients
of the investment  advisers are made with a view to achieving  their  respective
investment  objectives.  Investment decisions are the product of many factors in
addition to basic  suitability  for the  particular  client  involved.  Thus,  a
particular  security  may be bought or sold for certain  clients  even though it
could have been bought or sold for other clients at the same time.  Likewise,  a
particular  security  may be  bought  for one or more  clients  when one or more
clients are  selling  the  security.  In some  instances,  one client may sell a
particular  security to another  client.  It also sometimes  happens that two or
more clients  simultaneously  purchase or sell the same security, in which event
each day's  transactions in such security are, insofar as is possible,  averaged
as to  price  and  allocated  between  such  clients  in a  manner  which in the
investment  adviser's  opinion is equitable to each and in  accordance  with the
amount  being  purchased  or sold  by  each.  There  may be  circumstances  when
purchases or sales of portfolio  securities for one or more clients will have an
adverse effect on other clients.

BROKERAGE AND RESEARCH SERVICES

Transactions on U.S. stock exchanges and other agency  transactions  involve the
payment by the Fund of negotiated brokerage  commissions.  Such commissions vary
among  different  brokers.  Also,  a  particular  broker  may  charge  different
commissions  according  to  such  factors  as the  difficulty  and  size  of the
transaction. Transactions in foreign securities generally involve the payment of
fixed brokerage commissions, which are generally higher than those in the United
States. There is generally no stated commission in the case of securities traded
in the over-the-counter markets, but the price paid by the Fund usually includes
an undisclosed  dealer  commission or mark-up.  In underwritten  offerings,  the
price paid by the Fund  includes  a  disclosed,  fixed  commission  or  discount
retained by the underwriter or dealer.

The Investment Advisory Agreement  authorizes and directs the investment adviser
to place  orders for the  purchase  and sale of assets  with  brokers or dealers
selected  by the  investment  advisers  in their  discretion  and to seek  "best
execution" of such portfolio transactions. An investment adviser places all such
orders for the  purchase  and sale of  portfolio  securities  and buys and sells
securities for the Fund through a substantial number of brokers and dealers.  In
so doing,  the  investment  adviser uses its best efforts to obtain for the Fund
the most favorable price and execution  available.  The Fund may,  however,  pay
higher than the lowest available  commission  rates when the investment  adviser
believes it is  reasonable  to do so in light of the value of the  brokerage and
research services  provided by the broker effecting the transaction.  In seeking
the most favorable price and execution,  the investment adviser,  having in mind
the Fund's best interests,  considers all factors it deems relevant,  including,
by way of illustration,  price,  the size of the transaction,  the nature of the
market  for the  security,  the  amount  of the  commission,  the  timing of the
transaction  taking  into  account  market  prices and trends,  the  reputation,
experience  and  financial  stability  of the  broker-dealers  involved  and the
quality of service rendered by the broker-dealers in other transactions.

It has for many years been a common practice in the investment advisory business
as conducted in certain countries,  including the United States, for advisers of
investment  companies  and other  institutional  investors  to receive  research
services  from  broker-dealers  which  execute  portfolio  transactions  for the
clients of such advisers.  Consistent with this practice, and investment adviser
may  receive  research  services  from  broker-dealers  with which


                                       13
<PAGE>

it places the Fund's portfolio transactions. These services, which in some cases
may also be  purchased  for cash,  include  such items as general  economic  and
security market reviews, industry and company reviews, evaluations of securities
and  recommendations  as to the purchase and sale of  securities.  Some of these
services  are of value to the  investment  adviser  in  advising  various of its
clients (including the Fund), although not all of these services are necessarily
useful and of value in managing the Fund.  The  investment  advisory fee paid by
the Fund is not  reduced  because  the  investment  adviser  and its  affiliates
receive such services.

As  permitted  by  Section  28(e) of the  Securities  Exchange  Act of 1934 (the
"Act"),  an investment  adviser may cause the Fund to pay a broker-dealer  which
provides  "brokerage  and  research  services"  (as defined in the Act) to it an
amount of disclosed commission for effecting a securities  transaction in excess
of the commission which another  broker-dealer  would have charged for effecting
that transaction.

The  annual  portfolio  turnover  rate of the Fund may  exceed  50% but will not
ordinarily exceed 100%.

8.  ADDITIONAL PURCHASE AND REDEMPTION INFORMATION

Detailed  information  pertaining  to  the  purchase  of  shares  of  the  Fund,
redemption of shares and the determination of the net asset value of Fund shares
is set forth in the Prospectus under "Purchases and Redemptions of Shares".

Shares of the Fund are sold on a continuous basis by the distributor.

Set forth below is an example of the method of computing  the offering  price of
the  Fund's  shares.  The  example  assumes a purchase  of shares of  beneficial
interest aggregating less than $100,000 subject to the schedule of sales charges
set forth in the Prospectus at a price based on the net asset value per share of
the Fund on April 14, 1998.


Net Asset Value Per Share                   $ 11.42

Sales Charge, 4.00% of offering
price (4.17% of net asset value
per share)                                  $ 0.48

Offering to Public                          $ 11.90

In addition to the situations  described in the Prospectus  under "Purchases and
Redemptions of Shares," the Trust may redeem shares involuntarily,  from time to
time, to reimburse the Fund for any loss sustained by reason of the failure of a
shareholder to make full payment for shares  purchased by the  shareholder or to
collect  any charge  relating  to  transactions  effected  for the  benefit of a
shareholder  which  is  applicable  to the  Fund's  shares  as  provided  in the
Prospectus.

The  Trust  has  filed a  formal  election  with  the  Securities  and  Exchange
Commission pursuant to which the Fund will only effect a redemption in portfolio
securities if a shareholder  is redeeming more than $250,000 or 1% of the Fund's
total net assets, whichever is less, during any 90-day period.

REDEMPTION IN KIND

In the event  that  payment  for  redeemed  shares  is made  wholly or partly in
portfolio  securities,  brokerage  costs may be incurred by the  shareholder  in
converting  the  securities  to  cash.  An in  kind  distribution  of  portfolio
securities will be less liquid than cash. The shareholder may have difficulty in
finding a buyer for  portfolio  securities  received  in  payment  for  redeemed
shares. Portfolio securities may decline in value between the time of receipt by
the  shareholder  and  conversion  to cash. A  redemption  in kind of the Fund's
portfolio securities could result in a less diversified portfolio of investments
for the Fund and could affect adversely the liquidity of the Fund's portfolio.



                                       14
<PAGE>

EXCHANGE PRIVILEGE

The exchange privilege permits shareholders of the Fund to exchange their shares
for shares of any other fund of the Trust or shares of certain other  portfolios
of investment companies which retain FAS or its affiliates as investment adviser
or distributor and which  participate in the Trust's exchange  privilege program
("Participating  Fund"). For Federal income tax purposes,  exchange transactions
are treated as sales on which a purchaser  will  realize a capital  gain or loss
depending  on whether the value of the shares  redeemed is more or less than his
basis in such shares at the time of the transaction.

By use of the exchange privilege,  the shareholder authorizes the Transfer Agent
to act upon the instruction of any person representing  himself to either be, or
to have the  authority  to act on behalf of, the  investor  and  believed by the
Transfer  Agent  to be  genuine.  The  records  of the  Transfer  Agent  of such
instructions are binding. Proceeds of an exchange transaction may be invested in
another Participating Fund in the name of the shareholder.

Exchange transactions will be made on the basis of relative net asset values per
share at the time of the exchange  transaction plus any sales charge  applicable
to the  Participating  Fund  whose  shares  are  being  acquired.  Shares of any
Participating Fund may be redeemed and the proceeds used to purchase,  without a
sales charge,  shares of any other Participating Fund that are offered without a
sales charge. Shares of any Participating Fund purchased with a sales charge may
be redeemed and the proceeds used to purchase, without a sales charge, shares of
any other  Participating  Fund otherwise sold with the same sales charge. If the
Participating Fund purchased in the exchange  transaction imposes a higher sales
charge than was paid originally on the exchanged shares, the shareholder will be
responsible  for the difference  between the two sales charges.  Shares acquired
through the reinvestment of dividends and  distributions are deemed to have been
acquired  with a sales charge rate equal to that paid on the shares on which the
dividend or distribution was paid.

The terms of the exchange privilege are subject to change, and the privilege may
be  terminated  by any of the  Participating  Funds or the  Trust.  However  the
privilege  will not be  terminated,  and no material  change that  restricts the
availability  of the  privilege to  shareholders  will be  implemented,  without
reasonable advance notice to shareholders.

9.  TAXATION

The Fund intends to qualify as a regulated investment company under Subchapter M
of the Internal  Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code").  To qualify as a
regulated  investment  company the Fund intends to distribute to shareholders at
least 90% of its net  investment  income  (which  includes,  among other  items,
dividends,  interest and the excess of any net short-term capital gains over net
long-term capital losses), and to meet certain diversification of assets, source
of income, and other requirements of the Code. By so doing, the Fund will not be
subject to  Federal  income tax on its net  investment  income and net  realized
capital  gains (the excess of net long-term  capital  gains over net  short-term
capital losses)  distributed to  shareholders.  If the Fund does not meet all of
these Code requirements,  it will be taxed as an ordinary  corporation,  and its
distributions will be taxable to shareholders as ordinary income.

Amounts not  distributed  on a timely basis in  accordance  with a calendar year
distribution  requirement  are  subject to a 4%  nondeductible  excise  tax.  To
prevent imposition of the excise tax, the Fund must distribute for each calendar
year  an  amount  equal  to the sum of (1) at  least  98%  its  ordinary  income
(excluding  any capital gains or losses) for the calendar year, (2) at least 98%
of the excess of its  capital  gains over  capital  losses  realized  during the
one-year  period  ending  October  31, of such year,  and (3) all such  ordinary
income and capital  gains for previous  years that were not  distributed  during
such years. A  distribution  will be treated as paid during the calendar year if
it is declared  by the Fund in October,  November or December of the year with a
record date in such month and paid by the Fund during  January of the  following
year. Such distributions will be taxable to shareholders in the calendar year in
which the distributions are declared, rather than the calendar year in which the
distributions are received.

                                       15
<PAGE>

In addition to satisfying the distribution  requirement,  a regulated investment
company must derive at least 90% of its gross income from  dividends,  interest,
certain payments with respect to securities loans,  gains from the sale or other
disposition  of stock or  securities or foreign  currencies  (to the extent such
currency  gains are  directly  related  to the  regulated  investment  company's
principal  business  of  investing  in stock or  securities)  and  other  income
(including but not limited to gain from options,  futures or forward  contracts)
derived with respect to its business of investing in such stock,  securities  or
currencies.

Distributions  of net  investment  income  (including  realized  net  short-term
capital gain) are taxable to shareholders as ordinary income. It is not expected
that such  distributions  will be eligible for the dividends  received deduction
available to corporations.

Distributions  of net  long-term  capital  gain are taxable to  shareholders  as
long-term  capital  gain,  regardless of the length of time the Fund shares have
been held by a  shareholder,  and are not  eligible for the  dividends  received
deduction.  A loss realized by a  shareholder  on the sale of shares of the Fund
with respect to which capital gain  dividends have been paid will, to the extent
of such capital gain  dividends,  be treated as long-term  capital loss although
such shares may have been held by the shareholder for one year or less. Further,
a loss  realized on a  disposition  will be  disallowed to the extent the shares
disposed of are replaced (whether by reinvestment or distributions or otherwise)
within a period of 61 days beginning 30 days before and ending 30 days after the
shares are disposed of. In such a case, the basis of the shares acquired will be
adjusted to reflect the disallowed loss.

All  distributions  are  taxable  to  the  shareholder   whether  reinvested  in
additional shares or received in cash.  Shareholders receiving  distributions in
the form of  additional  shares  will have a cost basis for  Federal  income tax
purposes in each share  received  equal to the net asset value of a share of the
Fund on the reinvestment date.  Shareholders will be notified annually as to the
Federal tax status of distributions.

Distributions  by the Fund  reduce  the net asset  value of the  Fund's  shares.
Should a  distribution  reduce the net asset  value below a  shareholder's  cost
basis,  such  distribution  nevertheless  would be taxable to the shareholder as
ordinary  income or  capital  gain as  described  above,  even  though,  from an
investment  standpoint,  it may  constitute  a  partial  return of  capital.  In
particular,  investors  should be careful to consider  the tax  implications  of
buying  shares just prior to a  distribution.  The price of shares  purchased at
that time includes the amount of the forthcoming distribution.  Those purchasing
just prior to a distribution will receive a distribution which will nevertheless
be taxable to them.

Upon redemption or sale of his shares, a shareholder will realize a taxable gain
or loss depending upon his basis in his shares. Such gain or loss generally will
be  treated as capital  gain or loss if the  shares  are  capital  assets in the
shareholder's hands. Such gain or loss generally will be long-term or short-term
depending upon the shareholder's holding period for the shares.

The Fund intends to minimize  foreign income and withholding  taxes by investing
in obligations  the payments with respect to which will be subject to minimal or
no such taxes  insofar as this  objective is  consistent  with the Fund's income
objective. However, since the Fund may incur foreign taxes, it intends, if it is
eligible  to do so,  to  elect  under  Section  853 of the  Code to  treat  each
shareholder as having received an additional  distribution from the Fund, in the
amount indicated in a notice furnished to him, as his pro rata portion of income
taxes paid to or  withheld  by foreign  governments  with  respect to  interest,
dividends and gain on the Fund's foreign portfolio investments.  The shareholder
then may take the  amount of such  foreign  taxes paid or  withheld  as a credit
against  his  Federal  income  tax,  subject  to  certain  limitations.  If  the
shareholder finds it more to his advantage to do so, he may, in the alternative,
deduct the foreign  tax  withheld as an itemized  deduction,  in  computing  his
taxable income.  Each shareholder is referred to his tax adviser with respect to
the availability of the foreign tax credit.

The Fund will be required to report to the Internal  Revenue Service (the "IRS")
all  distributions  as well as gross  proceeds  from the  redemption of the Fund
shares,   except  in  the  case  of  certain  exempt   shareholders.   All  such
distributions  and proceeds  generally will be subject to withholding of Federal
income  tax at a rate of 31%  ("backup  withholding")  in the case of  nonexempt
shareholders  if (1) the  shareholder  fails to  furnish  the  Fund  with and to
certify  the  shareholder's  correct  taxpayer  identification  number or social
security  number,  (2) the IRS notifies the 


                                       16
<PAGE>

Fund that the  shareholder has failed to report  properly  certain  interest and
dividend income to the IRS and to respond to notices to that effect, or (3) when
required to do so, the  shareholder  fails to certify  that he is not subject to
backup  withholding.  If the  withholding  provisions are  applicable,  any such
distributions or proceeds,  whether  reinvested in additional shares or taken in
cash,  will be  reduced by the  amount  required  to be  withheld.  Any  amounts
withheld may be credited against the shareholder's Federal income tax liability.
Investors may wish to consult their tax advisers about the  applicability of the
backup withholding provisions.

The foregoing discussion relates only to Federal income tax law as applicable to
U.S. persons (i.e., U.S. citizens and residents and U.S. domestic  corporations,
partnerships, trusts and estates). Distributions by the Fund also may be subject
to state and local taxes,  and their  treatment under state and local income tax
laws may differ  from the  Federal  income tax  treatment.  Shareholders  should
consult  their tax  advisors  with respect to  particular  questions of Federal,
state and local taxation.  Shareholders  who are not U.S. persons should consult
their tax advisors  regarding U.S. and foreign tax  consequences of ownership of
shares of the Fund including the likelihood that  distributions to them would be
subject to withholding of U.S. tax at a rate of 30% (or a lower rate under a tax
treaty).

10.  OTHER INFORMATION

ORGANIZATION

THE TRUST AND ITS SHARES

The Trust was originally  incorporated in Maryland on March 24, 1980 and assumed
the name of Forum  Funds,  Inc.  on March 16,  1987.  On January 5, 1996,  Forum
Funds,  Inc. was  reorganized  as a Delaware  business  trust.  The Trust has an
unlimited  number of authorized  shares of beneficial  interest.  The Board may,
without  shareholder  approval,  divide the authorized  shares into an unlimited
number of separate portfolios or series (such as the Fund) and may in the future
divide portfolios or series into two or more classes of shares (such as Investor
and  Institutional  Shares).  Currently the  authorized  shares of the Trust are
divided into 16 separate series.

Each  share of each  fund of the  Trust  and  each  class of  shares  has  equal
dividend,  distribution,  liquidation and voting rights,  and fractional  shares
have  those  rights  proportionately,   except  that  expenses  related  to  the
distribution  of the shares of each class (and certain  other  expenses  such as
transfer  agency and  administration  expenses) are borne solely by those shares
and each class votes separately with respect to the provisions of any Rule 12b-1
plan  which  pertain to the class and other  matters  for which  separate  class
voting is appropriate under applicable law.  Generally,  shares will be voted in
the aggregate  without reference to a particular  portfolio or class,  except if
the matter  affects only one  portfolio or class or voting by portfolio or class
is required by law, in which case shares will be voted  separately  by portfolio
or class, as appropriate. Delaware law does not require the Trust to hold annual
meetings of shareholders,  and it is anticipated that shareholder  meetings will
be held only when  specifically  required by Federal or state law.  Shareholders
have  available  certain  procedures  for the removal of Trustees.  There are no
conversion or  preemptive  rights in  connection  with shares of the Trust.  All
shares when issued in  accordance  with the terms of the offering  will be fully
paid and nonassessable.  Shares are redeemable at net asset value, at the option
of the  shareholders,  subject to any contingent  deferred sales charge that may
apply.  A shareholder in a portfolio is entitled to the  shareholder's  pro rata
share of all dividends and  distributions  arising from that portfolio's  assets
and, upon  redeeming  shares,  will receive the portion of the  portfolio's  net
assets represented by the redeemed shares.

COUNSEL

Legal matters in connection  with the issuance of shares of beneficial  interest
of the Trust are passed upon by the law firm of Seward & Kissel,  1200 G Street,
N.W. Washington, D.C. 20005.

INDEPENDENT ACCOUNTANTS

Deloitte  &  Touche  LLP,  125  Summer  Street,  Boston,  Massachusetts,  02110,
independent auditors, act as auditors for the Trust.




                                       17
<PAGE>


APPENDIX A - DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES RATINGS

1.  PREFERRED STOCK

         (A) MOODY'S

         Moody's rates preferred stock issues as follows:

         An issue  which is rated aaa is a  top-quality  preferred  stock.  This
rating indicates good asset protection and the least risk of dividend impairment
among preferred stock issues.

         An issue  which is rated "aa" is a  high-grade  preferred  stock.  This
rating  indicates  that there is a reasonable  assurance that earnings and asset
protection will remain relatively well maintained in the foreseeable future.

         An issue which is rated "a" is an upper-medium  grade preferred  stock.
While  risks  are  judged  to be  somewhat  greater  than  in  the  aaa  and  aa
classification,  earnings and asset protection are, nevertheless, expected to be
maintained at adequate levels.

         An issue  which  is rated  "baa"  is a  medium-grade  preferred  stock,
neither  highly  protected  nor poorly  secured.  Earnings and asset  protection
appear  adequate at present  but may be  questionable  over any great  length of
time.

         An issue which is rated "ba" has  speculative  elements  and its future
cannot be considered  well assured.  Earnings and asset  protection  may be very
moderate  and not  well  safeguarded  during  adverse  periods.  Uncertainty  of
position characterizes preferred stocks in this class.

         An issue which is rated "b" generally  lacks the  characteristics  of a
desirable  investment.  Assurance of dividend  payments and maintenance of other
terms of the issue over any long period of time may be small.

         An issue  which is rated  "caa" is likely to be in arrears on  dividend
payments. This rating designation does not purport to indicate the future status
of payments.

         An issue  which is rated "ca" is  speculative  in a high  degree and is
likely to be in arrears on dividends with little likelihood of eventual payment.

         An issue which is rated "c" can be regarded  as having  extremely  poor
prospects of ever  attaining any real  investment  standing.  This is the lowest
rated class of preferred or preference stock.

         (B) STANDARD & POOR'S

         Standard & Poor's rates preferred stock issues as follows:

         "AAA" is the  highest  rating  that is  assigned  by S&P to a preferred
stock issue and  indicates an  extremely  strong  capacity to pay the  preferred
stock obligations.

         A preferred  stock issue rated "AA" also  qualifies  as a  high-quality
fixed income security.  The capacity to pay preferred stock  obligations is very
strong, although not as overwhelming as for issues rated "AAA."

         An issue rated "A" is backed by a sound  capacity to pay the  preferred
stock  obligations,  although it is  somewhat  more  susceptible  to the adverse
effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions.

         An issue rated  "BBB" is regarded as backed by an adequate  capacity to
pay the  preferred  stock  obligations.  While  it  normally  exhibits  adequate
protection parameters, adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are
more  likely to lead to a weakened  capacity  to make  payments  for a preferred
stock in this category than for issues in the "A" category.

                                       A-1
<PAGE>

         Preferred stock rated "BB," "B," and "CCC" are regarded, on balance, as
predominantly speculative with respect to the issuer's capacity to pay preferred
stock obligations. "BB" indicates the lowest degree of speculation and "CCC" the
highest degree of  speculation.  While such issues will likely have some quality
and protective  characteristics,  these are outweighed by large uncertainties or
major risk exposures to adverse conditions.

         The rating "CC" is reserved  for a preferred  stock issue in arrears on
dividends or sinking fund payments but that is currently paying.

         A preferred stock rated "C" is a non-paying issue.

         A preferred  stock rated "D" is a  non-paying  issue with the issuer in
default on debt instruments.

         To provide more detailed  indications of preferred  stock quality,  the
ratings  from "AA" to "B" may be modified by the addition of a plus (+) or minus
(-) sign to show relative standing


2.  CORPORATE BONDS INCLUDING CONVERTIBLE DEBT

         (A) MOODY'S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC. ("MOODY'S")

         Moody's rates corporate bond issues, including convertible debt issues,
as follows:

         Bonds  which  are rated Aaa are  judged  by  Moody's  to be of the best
quality.  They carry the smallest  degree of  investment  risk and are generally
referred to as "gilt edge." Interest  payments are protected by a large or by an
exceptionally   stable  margin  and  principal  is  secure.  While  the  various
protective  elements are likely to change, such changes as can be visualized are
most unlikely to impair the fundamentally strong position of such issues.

         Bonds  which  are  rated Aa are  judged  to be of high  quality  by all
standards.  Together with the Aaa group,  they comprise what are generally known
as high-grade bonds. They are rated lower than the best bonds because margins of
protection may not be as large as in Aaa securities or fluctuation of protective
elements  may be of greater  amplitude  or there may be other  elements  present
which make the long term risks appear somewhat larger than in Aaa securities.

         Bonds which are rated A possess many  favorable  investment  attributes
and are to be  considered  as upper medium  grade  obligations.  Factors  giving
security to principal and interest are  considered  adequate but elements may be
present which suggest a susceptibility to impairment sometime in the future.

         Bonds which are rated Baa are  considered as medium grade  obligations,
i.e., they are neither highly protected nor poorly secured. Interest payment and
principal  security  appear  adequate  for the present  but  certain  protective
elements may be lacking or may be  characteristically  unreliable over any great
length of time. Such bonds lack outstanding  investment  characteristics  and in
fact have speculative characteristics as well.

         Bonds which are rated Ba are judged to have speculative elements; their
future cannot be considered  as well assured.  Often the  protection of interest
and  principal  payments may be very  moderate and thereby not well  safeguarded
during  both  good  and bad  times  over the  future.  Uncertainty  of  position
characterizes bonds in this class.

         Bonds which are rated B generally lack characteristics of the desirable
investment.  Assurance of interest and principal  payments of or  maintenance of
other terms of the contract over any long period of time may be small.

         Bonds which are rated Caa are of poor  standing.  Such issues may be in
default or there may be present  elements of danger with respect to principal or
interest.

                                      A-2
<PAGE>

         Bonds which are rated Ca represent obligations which are speculative in
a  high  degree.  Such  issues  are  often  in  default  or  have  other  marked
shortcomings.

         Bonds which are rated C are the lowest  rated class of bonds and issues
so rated can be regarded as having  extremely  poor  prospects of ever attaining
any real investment standing.

         Note:  Those  bonds in the Aa, A,  Baa,  Ba or B groups  which  Moody's
believes  possess the  strongest  investment  attributes  are  designated by the
symbols Aa1, A1, Baa1, Ba1, and B1.

         (B) STANDARD & POOR'S CORPORATION ("S&P")

         S&P rates corporate bond issues,  including convertible debt issues, as
follows:

         Bonds rated AAA have the highest  rating  assigned by S&P.  Capacity to
pay interest and repay principal is extremely strong.

         Bonds rated AA have a very strong  capacity to pay  interest  and repay
principal and differ from the highest rated issues only in small degree.

         Bonds  rated  A have  a  strong  capacity  to pay  interest  and  repay
principal, although they are somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of
changes in circumstances and economic conditions than debt rated in higher rated
categories.

         Bonds  rated BBB are  regarded  as having an  adequate  capacity to pay
interest and repay principal. Whereas, they normally exhibit adequate protection
parameters,  adverse  economic  conditions  or changing  circumstances  are more
likely to lead to weakened capacity to pay interest and repay principal for debt
in this category than in higher rated categories.

         Bonds  rated  BB,  B,  CCC,  CC  and C are  regarded,  on  balance,  as
predominantly  speculative with respect to the issuer's capacity to pay interest
and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the obligation. BB indicates
the lowest degree of speculation and C the highest degree of speculation.  While
such bonds will likely have some quality and protective  characteristics,  these
are  outweighed  by large  uncertainties  or major  risk  exposures  to  adverse
conditions.  Bonds rated `BB' have less near-term  vulnerability to default than
other  speculative  issues.  However,  they face major ongoing  uncertainties or
exposure to adverse business, financial, or economic conditions which could lead
to inadequate capacity to meet timely interest and principal payments.

         Bonds rated `B' have a greater  vulnerability  to default but currently
have the capacity to meet  interest  payments and  principal  payments.  Adverse
business,  financial,  or economic  conditions  will likely  impair  capacity or
willingness to pay interest and repay principal.

         Bonds rated `CCC' have currently identifiable vulnerability to default,
and are dependent upon favorable business, financial, and economic conditions to
meet timely  payment of interest  and  repayment of  principal.  In the event of
adverse business, financial, or economic conditions, they are not likely to have
the capacity to pay interest and repay principal.

         The `C'  rating  may be used to cover a  situation  where a  bankruptcy
petition has been filed,  but debt service  payments are  continued.  The rating
`Cl' is reserved for income bonds on which no interest is being paid.

         Bonds are rated D when the issue is in payment default,  or the obligor
has filed for bankruptcy. Bonds rated `D' are in payment default. The `D' rating
category is used when  interest  payments or principal  payments are not made on
the date due even if the  applicable  grace period has not  expired,  unless S&P
believes that such  payments will made during such grace period.  The `D' rating
also  will be used upon the  filing of a  bankruptcy  petition  if debt  service
payments are jeopardized.

                                      A-3
<PAGE>

         Note:  The ratings  from AA to CCC may be modified by the addition of a
plus (+) or minus  (-) sign to show the  relative  standing  within  the  rating
category.

3.  COMMERCIAL PAPER

         MOODY'S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC.

Moody's two highest ratings for short-term debt, including commercial paper, are
Prime-1 and Prime-2.  Both are judged investment grade, to indicate the relative
repayment ability of rated issuers.

Issuers rated Prime-1 have a superior ability for repayment of senior short-term
debt  obligations.  Prime-1 repayment ability will often be evidenced by many of
the following characteristics:

          --      Leading market positions in well-established industries.
          --      High rates of return on funds employed.
          --      Conservative  capitalization structure with moderate  reliance
                  on debt and ample asset protection.
          --      Broad  margins in earnings coverage of fixed financial charges
                  and high internal cash generation.
          --      Well-established access to a range of financial markets and
                  assured  sources  of alternate liquidity.

Issuers rated  Prime-2 by Moody's have a strong  ability for repayment of senior
short-term  debt  obligations.  This will  normally be  evidenced by many of the
characteristics of issuers rated Prime-1 but to a lesser degree. Earnings trends
and  coverage   ratios,   while  sound,   may  be  more  subject  to  variation.
Capitalization characteristics, while still appropriate, may be more affected by
external conditions. Ample alternate liquidity is maintained.

         STANDARD AND POOR'S CORPORATION

S&P's two highest  commercial  paper  ratings are A and B. Issues  assigned an A
rating are regarded as having the greatest  capacity for timely payment.  Issues
in this  category  are  delineated  with the numbers 1, 2 and 3 to indicate  the
relative  degree of  safety.  An A-1  designation  indicates  that the degree of
safety  regarding  timely payment is either  overwhelming or very strong.  Those
issues determined to possess  overwhelming  safety  characteristics  are denoted
with a plus (+) sign designation. The capacity for timely payment on issues with
an A-2 designation is strong.  However,  the relative degree of safety is not as
high as for issues  designated A-1. A-3 issues have a satisfactory  capacity for
timely  payment.  They are,  however,  somewhat  more  vulnerable to the adverse
effects  of  changes  in  circumstances  than  obligations  carrying  the higher
designations.  Issues rated B are  regarded as having only an adequate  capacity
for timely payment. However, such capacity may be damaged by changing conditions
or short-term adversities.

         FITCH IBCA, INC..

Fitch's  short-term ratings apply to debt obligations that are payable on demand
or have original maturities of generally up to three years, including commercial
paper, certificates of deposit,  medium-term notes, and municipal and investment
notes.

F-1+. Issues assigned this rating are regarded as having the strongest degree of
assurance for timely payment.

F-1.  Issues  assigned this rating  reflect an assurance of timely  payment only
slightly less in degree than issues rated F-1+.

F-2.  Issues  assigned this rating have a  satisfactory  degree of assurance for
timely payment,  but the margin of safety is not as great as for issues assigned
F-1+ or F-1 ratings.

                                      A-4
<PAGE>


APPENDIX B - TEXT OF FORUM BROCHURE

In connection with its  advertisements,  a Fund may provide a description of the
Fund's investment adviser and its affiliates, which are service providers to the
Fund. Text which is currently in use is set forth below.

"FORUM FINANCIAL GROUP OF COMPANIES

Forum Financial  Group of Companies  represent more than a decade of diversified
experience  with every  aspect of mutual  funds.  The Forum  Family of Funds has
benefited from the informed,  sharply  focused  perspective on mutual funds that
experience makes possible.

The Forum Family of Funds has been created and managed by  affiliated  companies
of Portland-based  Forum Financial Group, among the nation's largest mutual fund
administrators  providing clients with a full line of services for every type of
mutual fund.

The Forum  Family of Funds is designed to give  investment  representatives  and
investors a broad choice of carefully  structured  and  diversified  portfolios,
portfolios  that can satisfy a wide  variety of  immediate  as well as long-term
investment goals.

Forum  Financial Group has developed its "brand name" family of mutual funds and
has made them available to the investment public and to institutions on both the
national and regional levels.

For more than a decade Forum has had direct  experience with mutual funds from a
different  perspective,  a perspective  made  possible by Forum's  position as a
leading designer and full-service  administrator  and manager of mutual funds of
all types.

Today Forum  Financial  Group  administers  and  provides  services for over 120
mutual  funds for 17  different  fund  managers,  with more than $30  billion in
client assets. Forum has its headquarters in Portland, Maine, and has offices in
Seattle, Bermuda, and Warsaw, Poland. In a joint venture with Bank Handlowy, the
largest  and  oldest  commercial  bank  in  Poland,   Forum  operates  the  only
independent  transfer agent and mutual fund accounting business in Poland. Forum
directs an off-shore and hedge fund administration  business through its Bermuda
office. It employs more than 230 professionals worldwide.

From the  beginning,  Forum  developed a plan of action that was effective  with
both start- up funds, and funds that needed  restructuring and improved services
in order to live up to their potential.  The success of its innovative  approach
is  evident  in  Forum's  growth  rate over the  years,  a growth  rate that has
consistently outstripped that of the mutual fund industry as a whole, as well as
that of the fund service outsource industry.

Forum has worked with both  domestic  and  international  mutual fund  sponsors,
designing  unique  mutual  fund  structures,  positioning  new funds  within the
sponsors' own corporate planning and targeted markets.

Forum's staff of experienced lawyers, many of whom have been associated with the
Securities  and  Exchange  Commission,  have  been  available  to work with fund
sponsors to customize  fund  components and to evaluate the potential of various
fund structures.

Forum has introduced fund sponsors to its unique proprietary Core and Gateway(R)
partnership,  helping them to take advantage of this full-service  master/feeder
structure.

Fund sponsors  understand that even the most efficiently and creatively designed
fund can disappoint  shareholders  if it is inadequately  serviced.  That is the
reason why fund  sponsors  have relied on Forum to meet all of a fund's  complex
compliance, regulatory, and filing needs.

                                      B-1
<PAGE>

Forum's full service commitment  includes providing state-of- the-art accounting
support (Forum has 8 CPAs on staff, as well as senior  accountants who have been
associated with Big 6 accounting firms).  Forum's proprietary  accounting system
is continually upgraded and can provide custom-built modules to satisfy a fund's
specific  requirements.   This  service  is  joined  with  transfer  agency  and
shareholder  service  groups that draw their strength both from the high caliber
of the people staffing each unit and from Forum's  advanced  technology  support
system.

More than a decade of  experience  with mutual  funds has given Forum  practical
hands-on  experience and knowledge of how mutual funds function "from the inside
out."

Forum has put that  experience to work by creating the Forum Family of Funds,  a
family where each member is designed  and  positioned  for your best  investment
advantage,  and where each fund is  serviced  with the utmost  attention  to the
delivery of timely, accurate, and comprehensive shareholder information.

INVESTMENT ADVISERS

Forum Investment  Advisors,  LLC offers the services of portfolio  managers with
the highest  qualifications--because without such direction, a comprehensive and
goal-oriented  investment  program  and  ongoing  investment  strategy  are  not
possible.  Serving  as  portfolio  managers  for the  Forum  Family of Funds are
individuals  with  decades  of  experience  with  some  of the  country's  major
financial institutions.

Individual  funds in the Forum Family of Funds invest in portfolios that have as
their investment adviser nationally recognized institutions,  including Schroder
Capital Management International, Inc., a major figure in worldwide mutual funds
that, with its affiliates, managed over $175 billion as of September 30, 1997.

Forum Funds are also  managed by the  portfolio  managers of H.M.  Payson & Co.,
founded in Portland, Maine in 1854 and one of the oldest investment firms in the
country.  Payson has approximately $1 billion in assets under  management,  with
clients that include  pension plans,  endowment  funds,  and  institutional  and
individual accounts.

FORUM INVESTMENT ADVISORS, LLC

Forum Investment  Advisors,  LLC is the largest Maine based  investment  adviser
with  approximately  $1.4  billion in assets  under  management.  The  portfolio
managers have decades of combined experience in a cross section of the country's
financial  markets.  The managers have  specific,  day-to-day  experience in the
asset class  portfolios  they manage,  bringing  critical  focus to meeting each
fund's explicit investment objectives. The portfolio managers have been involved
in investing the assets of large  insurance  companies,  banks,  pension  plans,
individuals,  and of course mutual funds. Forum Investment  Advisors,  LLC has a
staff of analysts and investment  administrators  to meet the demands of serving
shareholders in our funds.

FORUM FAMILY OF FUNDS

It has been said that  mutual  fund  investment  offerings--of  which  there are
nearly  10,000,  with assets spread across stock,  bond,  and money market funds
worth  more  than  $4  trillion--come  in  a  rainbow  of  varieties.  A  better
description  would be a "spectrum" of varieties,  the spectrum graded from green
through  amber  and on to red.  In  simpler  terms,  from low risk  investments,
through moderate to high risk. The lower the risk, the lower the possible reward
- -- the higher the risk, the higher the potential reward.

The Forum Family of Funds provides  conservative  investment  opportunities that
reduce the risk of loss of capital,  using underlying  money market  investments
U.S. Government  securities  (although the shares of the Forum Funds are neither
insured nor guaranteed by the U.S. Government or its agencies),  thus

                                      B-2
<PAGE>

cushioning the investment against market  volatility.  These funds offer regular
income, ready access to your money, and flexibility to buy or sell at any time.

In the less  conservative  but still not  aggressive  category  are funds in the
Forum Family that seek to provide steady income and, in certain cases,  tax-free
earnings.  Such investments  provide important  diversification to an investment
portfolio.

Growth funds in the Forum Family more  aggressively  pursue a high return at the
risk of market volatility.  These funds include domestic and international stock
mutual funds."


                                      B-3
<PAGE>


APPENDIX C - PEOPLES HERITAGE NEWS RELEASE

Peoples Heritage Financial Group, Inc. (NASDAQ:PHBK) announced today that it has
formed an alliance with a major mutual fund provider and an investment  advisory
firm to expand its mutual fund  offerings.  The  alliance  with Forum  Financial
Group and H.M.  Payson & Company will result in 18 funds,  including  the unique
Maine Municipal Bond Fund and New Hampshire Bond Fund, being offered through the
branches  of Peoples'  affiliate  banks in Maine,  New  Hampshire  and  northern
Massachusetts and the Company's trust and investment subsidiaries

'There is no secret to where  financial  services  are moving,  under one roof,"
said William J. Ryan, Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer of Peoples
Heritage.   "One  only  has  to  watch  the  virtually  daily  announcements  of
consolidations  in  the  financial  sector  to  understand  that  customers  are
demanding and receiving 'one-stop' financial services.

"We think we are adding the additional  competitive  advantage of funds that are
managed and administered close to home."

Eighteen  Forum funds will be offered  including two Payson funds.  The tax-free
Maine and New Hampshire  state bond funds are the only two such funds  available
and usually  invest 80% of total  assets in  municipal  securities.  Other funds
being  provided by the alliance  include money  market,  fixed income and equity
funds.

Forum Financial, based in Portland, Maine since 1987, administers 146 funds with
more than $36 billion in assets.  Forum  manages  mutual  funds for  independent
investment advisors such as Payson and for banks. Forum Investment Advisors, LLC
an affiliate,  is the largest Maine-based  investment advisor with approximately
$1.7 billion in fund assets under management.

"We are providing a great product set to the customers served by Peoples' nearly
200 branches in northern New  England,"  said John Y.  Keffer,  Forum  Financial
president,  "The key today is to link a wide variety of investment  options with
convergent, easy access for customers. I believe this alliance does just that."

H.M.  Payson & Co.,  founded in 1854, is one of the nation's  oldest  investment
firms with  nearly $1 billion in assets  under  management  and $300  million in
non-managed  custodial accounts.  The Payson value Fund and Payson Balanced Fund
are among the 18 offerings.

"I believe we have all the  ingredients  of a  tremendous  alliance,"  said John
Walker,  Payson president and managing  director.  "We have the region's premier
community banking company,  a community-based  investment  advisor,  and a local
mutual fund company that operates  nationally  and  specializes  in working with
banks. We are poised to provide solid investment performance and service."

Peoples Heritage Financial Group is a $10 billion multi-state bank and financial
services  holding company  headquartered  in Portland,  Maine. Its Maine banking
affiliate,  Peoples Heritage Bank, has the state's leading deposit market share.
Its New Hampshire  banking  affiliate,  Bank of New  Hampshire,  has the state's
leading deposit market share. Family Bank, the Company's  Massachusetts  banking
subsidiary,  has the state's tenth largest  deposit market share and the leading
market  share  in many of the  northern  Massachusetts  communities  it  serves.
Peoples  affiliate  banks  also  operate  subsidiaries  in  leasing,  trust  and
investment services and insurance.


                                      C-1
<PAGE>


FORUM FINANCIAL GROUP:

Headquarters:  Two Portland Square, Portland, Maine 04101
President:  John Y. Keffer
Offices:  Portland, Seattle, Warsaw, Bermuda
*Established  in 1986 to  administer  mutual  funds for  independent  investment
advisors and banks *Among the nation's largest  third-party fund  administrators
*Uses proprietary in-house systems and custom programming capabilities
         *ADMINISTRATION  AND  DISTRIBUTION   SERVICES:  Regulatory, compliance,
          expense  accounting, budgeting for all funds
         *FUND  ACCOUNTING SERVICES: Portfolio  valuation, accounting, dividend
          declaration,  and tax advice
         *SHAREHOLDER SERVICES: Preparation of statements, distribution support,
          inquiries  and processing of trades
*CLIENT ASSETS UNDER ADMINISTRATION AND DISTRIBUTION:  $36.9 billion
*CLIENT ASSETS PROCESSED BY FUND ACCOUNTING:  $47.6 billion
*CLIENT FUNDS UNDER ADMINISTRATION AND DISTRIBUTION:  146 mutual funds with 219
 share classes
*INTERNATIONAL VENTURES:
         Joint  venture  with Bank  Handlowy in Warsaw,  Poland,  using  Forum's
         proprietary   transfer  agency  and  distribution   systems   Off-shore
         investment  fund  administration,  using  Bermuda as Forum's  center of
         operations
*FORUM EMPLOYEES:  United States -198, Poland - 61, Bermuda - 3

FORUM CONTACTS:
Mark Kaplan, Managing Director and Portfolio Manager, Forum Investment Advisors,
LLC,
(207) 879-1900 X 6123
Tony Santaniello, Director of Marketing, (207) 879-1900 X 6175


                                      C-2
<PAGE>


H.M. PAYSON & CO.:

Headquarters:  One Portland Square, Portland, Maine
President and Managing Director: John Walker
Quality investment services and conservative wealth management since 1854
*Assets under Management: $1 Billion
*Custody Income Assets: $300 Million
*Client Base: 85% individuals; 15% institutional
*Owned by 11 shareholders; 11 managing directors
*Payson Balanced Fund and Payson Value Fund  (administrative  and shareholder 
 services  provided by Forum
Financial Group)
*Employees: 45


H.M. PAYSON & CO. CONTACT:
Joel Harris, Portfolio/Marketing Coordinator, (207) 772-3761


                                      C-3
<PAGE>



                                PAYSON VALUE FUND
                              PAYSON BALANCED FUND

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Investment Advisor:                     Account Information and
         H.M. Payson & Co.                       Shareholder Servicing:
         One Portland Square                     Forum Financial Corp.
         P.O. Box 31                             P.O. Box 446
         Portland, Maine  04112                  Portland, Maine  04112
         207-772-3761                            207-879-0009
         800-456-6710
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                       STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
                                 August 1, 1997,
                            as amended April 15, 1998


Forum Funds (the  "Trust") is a registered  open-end  investment  company.  This
Statement of Additional  Information  supplements the Prospectus dated August 1,
1997 offering shares of Payson Value Fund and Payson Balanced Fund (collectively
the "Funds" and  individually  a "Fund") and should be read only in  conjunction
with  the  Prospectus,  a copy  of  which  may be  obtained  without  charge  by
contacting the Trust's Distributor, Forum Financial Services, Inc., Two Portland
Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                            PAGE

  1.       Investment Policies..........................................       2
  2.       Investment Limitations.......................................       5
  3.       Performance Data.............................................       7
  4.       Management...................................................       8
  5.       Determination of Net Asset Value.............................      14
  6.       Portfolio Transactions.......................................      15
  7.       Additional Purchase and
              Redemption Information....................................      15
  8.       Taxation.....................................................      17
  9.       Other Information............................................      18

           Appendix A - Description of Securities Ratings
           Appendix B - Text of Forum Brochure
           Appendix C - Text of Peoples Heritage News Release

THIS  STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL  INFORMATION IS NOT A PROSPECTUS AND IS AUTHORIZED
FOR DISTRIBUTION TO PROSPECTIVE  INVESTORS ONLY IF PRECEDED OR ACCOMPANIED BY AN
EFFECTIVE PROSPECTUS.


<PAGE>


1.  INVESTMENT POLICIES

RATINGS AS INVESTMENT CRITERIA

Moody's  Investors  Service,  Inc.  ("Moody's"),  Standard & Poor's  Corporation
("S&P")  and  other  nationally  recognized   statistical  rating  organizations
("NRSROs")  are private  services that provide  ratings of the credit quality of
debt obligations,  including convertible securities.  A description of the range
of ratings  assigned to bonds and other securities by several NRSROs is included
in Appendix A to this  Statement of  Additional  Information.  The Funds may use
these  ratings  to  determine  whether  to  purchase,  sell or hold a  security.
However,  ratings  are  general  and  are not  absolute  standards  of  quality.
Consequently,  securities  with the same maturity,  interest rate and rating may
have different market prices. If an issue of securities ceases to be rated or if
its rating is reduced after it has been purchased by a Fund,  H.M.  Payson & Co.
(the "Advisor"),  the Funds' investment advisor, will determine whether the Fund
should continue to hold the  obligation.  Credit ratings attempt to evaluate the
safety of  principal  and  interest  payments  and do not  evaluate the risks of
fluctuations  in market  value.  Also,  rating  agencies may fail to make timely
changes in credit ratings. An issuer's current financial condition may be better
or worse than a rating indicates.

Each Fund may retain  securities  whose rating has been lowered below the lowest
permissible  rating  category (or that are unrated and determined by the Advisor
to be of  comparable  quality) if the Advisor  determines  that  retaining  such
security is in the best interests of the Fund.

WHEN-ISSUED SECURITIES AND FORWARD COMMITMENTS

Each Fund may  purchase  securities  offered  on a  "when-issued"  basis and may
purchase  or  sell  securities  on  a  "forward  commitment"  basis.  When  such
transactions are negotiated,  the price,  which is generally  expressed in yield
terms, is fixed at the time the commitment is made, but delivery and payment for
the securities take place at a later date. Normally,  the settlement date occurs
within two months after the  transaction,  but  settlements  delayed  beyond two
months may be negotiated. During the period between a commitment and settlement,
no payment is made for the  securities  purchased by the purchaser and, thus, no
dividends or interest accrues to the purchaser from the transaction. At the time
a Fund makes the  commitment to purchase  securities on a when-issued or delayed
delivery  basis,  the  Fund  will  record  the  transaction  as a  purchase  and
thereafter  reflect the value each day of such securities in determining its net
asset value.

The use of when-issued transactions and forward commitments enables the Funds to
hedge against anticipated changes in interest rates and prices. For instance, in
periods of rising  interest  rates and falling  bond  prices,  a Fund might sell
securities which it owned on a forward commitment basis to limit its exposure to
falling prices.  In periods of falling  interest rates and rising bond prices, a
Fund might sell a security  and  purchase  the same or a similar  security  on a
when-issued  or forward  commitment  basis,  thereby  obtaining  the  benefit of
currently  higher  cash  yields.  However,  if  the  Advisor  were  to  forecast
incorrectly the direction of interest rate movements, the Fund might be required
to  complete  such  when-issued  or forward  commitment  transactions  at prices
inferior to the current market values.

When-issued  securities  and  forward  commitments  may  be  sold  prior  to the
settlement  date, but the Funds enter into  when-issued  and forward  commitment
transactions  only with the intention of actually  receiving or  delivering  the
securities,  as the case may be. If a Fund  chooses  to  dispose of the right to
acquire a when-issued  security  prior to its  acquisition  or to dispose of its
right to deliver or receive against a forward commitment, it can incur a gain or
loss.  When-issued  securities may include bonds purchased on a "when, as and if
issued"  basis  under  which the  issuance of the  securities  depends  upon the
occurrence of a subsequent event. Any significant  commitment of a Fund's assets
to the purchase of securities  on a "when,  as and if issued" basis may increase
the volatility of its net asset value.

Each Fund will establish and maintain with its custodian a separate account with
cash, U.S. Government Securities (as defined in the Prospectus) and other liquid
assets in an amount at least equal to its commitments to purchase  securities on
a when-issued or forward commitment basis.

                                       2
<PAGE>

ILLIQUID SECURITIES

Each Fund may invest up to 15% of its net  assets in  illiquid  securities.  The
term  "illiquid  securities"  for this purpose means  securities  that cannot be
disposed  of  within  seven  days  in  the   ordinary   course  of  business  at
approximately  the  amount  at which  the Fund has  valued  the  securities  and
includes,  among other  things,  purchased  over-the-counter  (OTC)  options and
repurchase agreements maturing in more than seven days.

The Trust's  Board of Trustees  ("Board")  has the ultimate  responsibility  for
determining  whether specific  securities are liquid or illiquid.  The Board has
delegated the function of making  day-to-day  determinations of liquidity to the
Advisor,  pursuant to guidelines  approved by the Board.  The Advisor takes into
account a number of factors in reaching liquidity  decisions,  including but not
limited to: (1) the frequency of trades and quotations for the security; (2) the
number of dealers  willing to  purchase or sell the  security  and the number of
other  potential  buyers;  (3) the willingness of dealers to undertake to make a
market in the security; and (4) the nature of the marketplace trades,  including
the time needed to dispose of the security,  the method of soliciting offers and
the  mechanics  of the  transfer.  The Advisor  monitors  the  liquidity  of the
securities in each Fund's  portfolio and reports  periodically on such decisions
to the Board.

CONVERTIBLE SECURITIES

The Funds may invest in  convertible  securities.  A  convertible  security is a
bond,  debenture,  note, preferred stock or other security that may be converted
into or  exchanged  for a  prescribed  amount of  common  stock of the same or a
different  issuer  within a  particular  period of time at a specified  price or
formula. A convertible  security entitles the holder to receive interest paid or
accrued on debt or the dividend  paid on preferred  stock until the  convertible
security  matures or is redeemed,  converted or  exchanged.  Before  conversion,
convertible  securities  have  characteristics  similar to  nonconvertible  debt
securities  in that  they  ordinarily  provide a stable  stream  of income  with
generally  higher  yields  than  those of common  stocks of the same or  similar
issuers.  Convertible  securities rank senior to common stock in a corporation's
capital  structure but are usually  subordinated  to  comparable  nonconvertible
securities.  Although no securities  investment is without some risk, investment
in  convertible  securities  generally  entails  less risk than in the  issuer's
common stock. However, the extent to which such risk is reduced depends in large
measure upon the degree to which the convertible  security sells above its value
as a fixed  income  security.  Convertible  securities  have  unique  investment
characteristics  in that they  generally  (1) have  higher  yields  than  common
stocks,  but lower yields than comparable  non-convertible  securities,  (2) are
less subject to fluctuation in value than the underlying  stocks since they have
fixed  income   characteristics  and  (3)  provide  the  potential  for  capital
appreciation if the market price of the underlying common stock increases.

The value of a  convertible  security  is a function of its  "investment  value"
(determined  by its yield  comparison  with the  yields of other  securities  of
comparable maturity and quality that do not have a conversion privilege) and its
"conversion value" (the security's worth, at market value, if converted into the
underlying  common  stock).  The investment  value of a convertible  security is
influenced by changes in interest  rates,  with  investment  value  declining as
interest rates  increase and  increasing as interest  rates decline.  The credit
standing  of the  issuer  and  other  factors  also  may have an  effect  on the
convertible  security's  investment value. The conversion value of a convertible
security is determined by the market price of the  underlying  common stock.  If
the conversion  value is low relative to the investment  value, the price of the
convertible  security  is  governed  principally  by its  investment  value  and
generally the conversion value decreases as the convertible  security approaches
maturity.  To the  extent  the  market  price  of the  underlying  common  stock
approaches  or  exceeds  the  conversion  price,  the  price of the  convertible
security will be increasingly influenced by its conversion value. In addition, a
convertible  security generally will sell at a premium over its conversion value
determined by the extent to which  investors place value on the right to acquire
the underlying common stock while holding a fixed income security.

A convertible  security may be subject to redemption at the option of the issuer
at a price established in the convertible security's governing instrument.  If a
convertible  security held by a Fund is called for redemption,  the Fund will be
required  to permit  the  issuer to redeem  the  security,  convert  it into the
underlying common stock or sell it to a third party.

                                       3
<PAGE>

TEMPORARY DEFENSIVE POSITION.

When a Fund assumes a temporary  defensive  position it may invest without limit
in (i) short-term  U.S.  Government  Securities,  (ii)  certificates of deposit,
bankers' acceptances and  interest-bearing  savings deposits of commercial banks
doing business in the United States that have, at the time of investment,  total
assets in excess of one  billion  dollars  and that are  insured by the  Federal
Deposit  Insurance  Corporation,  (iii)  commercial paper of prime quality rated
Prime-2  or  higher  by  Moody's  or A-2 or  higher  by S&P  or,  if not  rated,
determined  by  the  Advisor  to  be  of  comparable  quality,  (iv)  repurchase
agreements  covering any of the securities in which the Fund may invest directly
and (v) money market mutual funds.

SECURITIES OF INVESTMENT COMPANIES

The Funds may invest in the securities of other investment  companies within the
limits proscribed by the 1940 Act. Under normal circumstances, each Fund intends
to invest less than 5% of the value of its net assets in the securities of other
investment companies.  In addition to the Fund's expenses (including the various
fees), as a shareholder in another investment company, a Fund would bear its pro
rata portion of the other investment company's expenses (including fees).

FUTURES CONTRACTS AND OPTIONS

Each Fund may in the  future  seek to hedge  against  a decline  in the value of
securities it owns or an increase in the price of  securities  which it plans to
purchase   through   the   writing   and   purchase   of   exchange-traded   and
over-the-counter  options and the  purchase  and sale of futures  contracts  and
options  on those  futures  contracts.  Payson  Value Fund may buy or sell stock
index  futures  contracts,  such as contracts  on the S&P 500 stock  index,  and
Payson Balanced Fund may buy and sell bond index futures contracts. In addition,
both Funds may buy or sell futures  contracts on Treasury bills,  Treasury bonds
and other  financial  instruments.  The Funds may write covered  options and buy
options on the futures contracts in which they may invest.

In addition, the Funds may write (sell) covered put and call options and may buy
put and call options on debt  securities and bond indices.  An option is covered
if, so long as the Fund is  obligated  under the option,  it owns an  offsetting
position in the underlying  security,  currency or futures contract or maintains
cash, U.S. Government Securities or other liquid, assets in a segregated account
with a value at all times  sufficient to cover the Fund's  obligation  under the
option.

The Funds' use of options  and  futures  contracts  would  subject  the Funds to
certain investment risks and transaction costs to which they might not otherwise
be subject.  These risks  include:  (1)  dependence on the Advisor's  ability to
predict movements in the prices of individual securities and fluctuations in the
general securities markets;  (2) imperfect  correlation between movements in the
prices of options,  futures  contracts or related  options and  movements in the
price of the securities  hedged or used for cover;  (3) the fact that skills and
techniques  needed to trade these instruments are different from those needed to
select the other  securities  in which the Funds  invest;  (4) lack of assurance
that a liquid secondary  market will exist for any particular  instrument at any
particular  time;  and (5) the  possible  need to defer  closing  out of certain
options,   futures   contracts   and  related   options  to  avoid  adverse  tax
consequences.  Other risks  include the  inability of the Fund, as the writer of
covered  call  options,  to  benefit  from the  appreciation  of the  underlying
securities  above the exercise price and the possible loss of the entire premium
paid for options purchased by the Fund.

Neither  Fund will  hedge more than 30% of its total  assets by selling  futures
contracts,  buying put options and writing call  options.  In addition,  neither
Fund will buy futures  contracts  or write put options  whose  underlying  value
exceeds 10% of the Fund's total assets and will not purchase call options if the
value of purchased  call options would exceed 5% of the Fund's total  assets.  A
Fund will not enter into futures  contracts and options  thereon if  immediately
thereafter  more  than 5% of the  value  of the  Fund's  total  assets  would be
invested in these options or committed to margin on futures contracts.

                                       4
<PAGE>

A Fund will only invest in futures and options  contracts after providing notice
to its  shareholders  and  filing a notice  of  eligibility  (if  required)  and
otherwise  complying  with the  requirements  of the Commodity  Futures  Trading
Commission  ("CFTC").  The CFTC's rules  provide that the Funds are permitted to
purchase  such  futures  or  options  contracts  only (1) for bona fide  hedging
purposes within the meaning of the rules of the CFTC; provided, however, that in
the  alternative  with  respect  to each long  position  in a futures or options
contract entered into by a Fund, the underlying commodity value of such contract
at all times does not  exceed the sum of cash,  short-term  United  States  debt
obligations or other United States dollar  denominated  short-term  money market
instruments  set  aside for this  purpose  by the  Fund,  accrued  profit on the
contract held with a futures commission merchant and cash proceeds from existing
Fund investments due in 30 days; and (2) subject to certain other limitations.

2.  INVESTMENT LIMITATIONS

The Funds have adopted the following  fundamental  investment  limitations which
are in addition to those contained in the Funds' Prospectus and which may not be
changed without shareholder approval. Neither Fund may:

         (1)      Borrow  money,  except for  temporary  or  emergency  purposes
                  (including the meeting of redemption  requests) and except for
                  entering into reverse repurchase agreements, and provided that
                  borrowings  do not exceed 33 1/3% of the Fund's  total  assets
                  (computed immediately after the borrowing).

         (2)      Purchase  securities,  other than U.S. Government  Securities,
                  if,  immediately  after  each  purchase,  more than 25% of the
                  Fund's total assets taken at market value would be invested in
                  securities  of issuers  conducting  their  principal  business
                  activity in the same industry.

         (3)      With respect to 75% of its assets, purchase securities,  other
                  than U.S.  Government  Securities,  of any one issuer,  if (a)
                  more than 5% of the Fund's  total assets taken at market value
                  would at the time of purchase be invested in the securities of
                  that  issuer,  or (b)  such  purchase  would  at the  time  of
                  purchase  cause  the  Fund  to  hold  more  than  10%  of  the
                  outstanding voting securities of that issuer.

         (4)      Act as an underwriter  of securities of other issuers,  except
                  to the extent that,  in  connection  with the  disposition  of
                  portfolio  securities,  the  Fund  may  be  deemed  to  be  an
                  underwriter for purposes of the Securities Act of 1933.

         (5)      Make  loans to other  persons  except  for loans of  portfolio
                  securities and except through the use of repurchase agreements
                  and  through  the  purchase  of   commercial   paper  or  debt
                  securities which are otherwise permissible investments.

         (6)      Purchase or sell real estate or any interest  therein,  except
                  that the Fund may invest in securities issued or guaranteed by
                  corporate or governmental  entities  secured by real estate or
                  interests   therein,   such  as  mortgage   pass-throughs  and
                  collateralized  mortgage  obligations,  or issued by companies
                  that invest in real estate or interests therein.

         (7)      Purchase or sell physical commodities or contracts relating to
                  physical    commodities,    provided   that   currencies   and
                  currency-related  contracts  will not be deemed to be physical
                  commodities.

         (8)      Issue senior  securities  except pursuant to Section 18 of the
                  Investment  Company Act of 1940  ("1940  Act") and except that
                  the Fund may borrow money  subject to  investment  limitations
                  specified in the Fund's Prospectus.

         (9)      Invest  in  interests  in oil or gas  or  interests  in  other
                  mineral exploration or development programs.

Each Fund has adopted the following  nonfundamental  investment limitations that
may be changed by the Board without shareholder approval. Neither Fund may:

                                       5
<PAGE>

         (a)      Pledge,  mortgage or hypothecate its assets,  except to secure
                  permitted indebtedness. The deposit in escrow of securities in
                  connection   with  the  writing  of  put  and  call   options,
                  collateralized loans of securities and collateral arrangements
                  with respect to margin for futures contracts are not deemed to
                  be pledges or hypothecations for this purpose.

         (b)      Invest in securities of another registered investment company,
                  except in connection with a merger, consolidation, acquisition
                  or  reorganization;  and  except  that the Fund may  invest in
                  money  market  funds  and  privately-issued  mortgage  related
                  securities to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act.

         (c)      Purchase   securities  on  margin,  or  make  short  sales  of
                  securities,  except for the use of short-term credit necessary
                  for  the   clearance  of  purchases  and  sales  of  portfolio
                  securities,   but  the  Fund  may  make  margin   deposits  in
                  connection  with permitted  transactions  in options,  futures
                  contracts and options on futures contracts.

         (d)      Invest in  securities  (other than  fully-collateralized  debt
                  obligations)   issued  by   companies   that  have   conducted
                  continuous operations for less than three years, including the
                  operations of predecessors,  unless guaranteed as to principal
                  and interest by an issuer in whose  securities  the Fund could
                  invest,  if as a  result,  more  than 5% of the  value  of the
                  Fund's total assets would be so invested.

         (e)      Invest in or hold  securities  of any issuer if  officers  and
                  Trustees  of the  Trust or the  Advisor,  individually  owning
                  beneficially  more  than  1/2 of 1% of the  securities  of the
                  issuer,  in the  aggregate  own more  than 5% of the  issuer's
                  securities.

         (f)      Purchase   securities  for  investment   while  any  borrowing
                  equaling 10% or more of the Fund's total assets is outstanding
                  or borrow for purposes  other than meeting  redemptions  in an
                  amount exceeding 10% of the value of the Fund's total assets.

         (g)      Acquire  securities  or  invest in repurchase  agreements with
                  respect to  any securities  if, as a result, more than (i) 15%
                  of the Fund's net  assets  (taken  at current  value) would be
                  invested in repurchase  agreements  not  entitling  the holder
                  to payment of principal  within  seven days and in  securities
                  which are not readily marketable,  including  securities  that
                  are illiquid by virtue of  restrictions  on  the sale  of such
                  securities  to  the  public  without  registration  under  the
                  Securities  Act of 1933 ("Restricted  Securities") or (ii) 10%
                  of the Fund's  total  assets would  be invested in  Restricted
                  Securities.

         (h)      Invest in oil, gas or other mineral exploration or development
                  programs,  or  leases,  provided  that the Fund may  invest in
                  securities issued by companies engaged in such activities.

         (i)      Purchase or sell real property  (including limited partnership
                  interests but excluding readily  marketable  interests in real
                  estate investment trusts or readily  marketable  securities of
                  companies which invest in real estate.)

         (j)      Invest  in  warrants  if (i) more  than 5% of the value of the
                  Fund's net assets will be invested in warrants  (valued at the
                  lower of cost or  market) or (ii) more than 2% of the value of
                  the Fund's net assets would be invested in warrants  which are
                  not  listed on the New York  Stock  Exchange  or the  American
                  Stock  Exchange.  For  purpose  of this  limitation,  warrants
                  acquired by the Fund in units or attached  to  securities  are
                  deemed to have no value.

Except as required by the 1940 Act, if any percentage  restriction on investment
or  utilization  of assets is adhered to at the time an  investment  is made,  a
later change in percentage  resulting  from a change in the market values of the
Fund's  assets or purchases and  redemptions  of shares will not be considered a
violation of the limitation.

                                       6
<PAGE>

3.  PERFORMANCE DATA

The Funds may quote  performance  in various ways. All  performance  information
supplied  by the Funds in  advertising  is  historical  and is not  intended  to
indicate  future  returns.  A Fund's  net asset  value,  yield and total  return
fluctuate in response to market  conditions and other factors,  and the value of
Fund shares when redeemed may be more or less than their original cost.

Total return information for the Funds as of March 31,1997,  is set forth in the
following table:
<TABLE>
<S>                                 <C>                <C>              <C>
                                    Total Return 1    Total Return     Total Return Since
                                    Year              5 Year           Inception*
                                    ----              ------           ----------

PAYSON VALUE FUND                   13.01%            N/A              14.77%

PAYSON BALANCED FUND                9.42%             11.69%           11.52%
</TABLE>

*Payson Value Fund commenced  operations on July 31, 1992.  Payson Balanced Fund
commenced operations on November 25, 1991.

In  advertising  performance,  the Funds may  compare  any of their  performance
information  with data published by independent  evaluators such as Morningstar,
Lipper Analytical Services, Inc., IBC/Donoghue,  Inc., CDC/Wiesenberger or other
companies which track the investment  performance of investment companies ("Fund
Tracking  Companies").  In addition,  a Fund may compare any of its  performance
information  with the performance of recognized  stock,  bond and other indexes,
including  but not limited to the Salomon  Brothers  Bond  Index,  the  Shearson
Lehman Bond Index,  the Standard & Poor's 500 Composite  Stock Price Index,  the
Dow Jones  Industrial  Average,  and  changes  in the  Consumer  Price  Index as
published by the U.S. Department of Commerce. A Fund may refer in such materials
to mutual fund  performance  rankings and other data  published by Fund Tracking
Companies.  Performance  advertising may also refer to discussions of a Fund and
comparative  mutual fund data and ratings  reported in independent  periodicals,
such as newspapers and financial magazines.

YIELD CALCULATIONS

Yields  for a Fund used in  advertising  are  computed  by  dividing  the Fund's
interest income for a given 30-day or one-month period, net of expenses,  by the
average number of shares  entitled to receive  distributions  during the period,
dividing  this  figure by the Fund's net asset value per share at the end of the
period and annualizing the result  (assuming  compounding of income) in order to
arrive at an annual percentage rate. In general, interest income is reduced with
respect to bonds  purchased at a premium over their par value by  subtracting  a
portion of the  premium  from income on a daily  basis,  and is  increased  with
respect to bonds  purchased at a discount by adding a portion of the discount to
daily  income.   Capital  gain  and  loss  generally  are  excluded  from  these
calculations.

Income  calculated  for the purpose of  determining  a Fund's yield differs from
income as determined  for other  accounting  purposes.  Because of the different
accounting  methods  used,  and  because  of the  compounding  assumed  in yield
calculations,  the  yield  quoted  for a  Fund  may  differ  from  the  rate  of
distribution  the Fund paid over the same period or the rate of income  reported
in the Fund's financial statements.

Although  published  yield  information  is useful to  investors  in reviewing a
Fund's performance,  investors should be aware that a Fund's yield for any given
period is not an  indication or  representation  by the Fund of future yields or
rates of return on the Fund's shares. Also, Processing Organizations (as defined
in the Prospectus) may charge their customers  direct fees in connection with an
investment  in a Fund,  which  will have the effect of  reducing  the Fund's net
yield  to  those  shareholders.  The  yields  of  each  Fund  are not  fixed  or
guaranteed,  and  an  investment  in  a  Fund  is  not  insured  or  guaranteed.
Accordingly,  yield information may not necessarily be used to compare shares of
a Fund with investment alternatives which, like money market instruments or bank
accounts, may provide a fixed rate of interest.  Also, it may not be appropriate
to compare a Fund's yield information directly to similar information  regarding
investment alternatives which are insured or guaranteed.

                                       7
<PAGE>

TOTAL RETURN CALCULATIONS

Each  of  the  Funds  may  advertise  total  return.  Total  returns  quoted  in
advertising  reflect all  aspects of a Fund's  return,  including  the effect of
reinvesting  dividends  and capital  gain  distributions,  and any change in the
Fund's net asset value per share over the  period.  Average  annual  returns are
calculated  by  determining  the growth or  decline  in value of a  hypothetical
historical  investment in a Fund over a stated period,  and then calculating the
annually compounded  percentage rate that would have produced the same result if
the rate of growth or decline in value had been constant over the period.  While
average  annual  returns  are  a  convenient   means  of  comparing   investment
alternatives, investors should realize that the performance is not constant over
time but changes from year to year, and that average  annual  returns  represent
averaged figures as opposed to the actual year-to-year performance of the Funds.

Average  annual  total  return is  calculated  by  finding  the  average  annual
compounded  rates of return of a  hypothetical  investment  over a given  period
according to the following formula:

                  P(1+T)n = ERV

         Where:

                  P = a  hypothetical  initial  payment of  $1,000; 
                  T = average annual  total  return; 
                  n = number of years;  and 
                  ERV = ending redeemable value.

ERV is the value, at the end of the applicable period, of a hypothetical  $1,000
payment made at the beginning of the applicable period.

In  addition  to  average  annual  returns,  each Fund may quote  unaveraged  or
cumulative total returns  reflecting the simple change in value of an investment
over a stated period.  Total returns may be broken down into their components of
income and capital  (including capital gain and changes in share price) in order
to illustrate the relationship of these factors and their contributions to total
return.  Total returns,  yields and other performance  information may be quoted
numerically or in a table, graph or similar illustration.

         Period total return is calculated according to the following formula:

                  PT = (ERV/P-1)

         Where:

                  PT = period total return.
                           The other definitions are the same as in
                           average annual total return above.

4.  MANAGEMENT

The trustees and officers of the Trust and their  principal  occupations  during
the past five years are set forth  below.  Each  Trustee  who is an  "interested
person" (as defined by the 1940 Act) of the Trust is indicated by an asterisk.

The trustees and officers of the Trust and their  principal  occupations  during
the past five years are set forth  below.  Each  Trustee  who is an  "interested
person" (as defined by the 1940 Act) of the Trust is indicated by an asterisk.

                                       8
<PAGE>

John Y. Keffer,* Chairman and President (age 56)

     President  and  Director,  Forum  Financial  Services,  Inc. (a  registered
     broker-dealer),   Forum  Administrative   Services,   LLC  (a  mutual  fund
     administrator),  Forum  Financial  Corp. (a registered  transfer agent) and
     Forum Advisors,  Inc. (a registered  investment  adviser).  Mr. Keffer is a
     Trustee and/or officer of various registered investment companies for which
     Forum Administrative  Services,  LLC serves as manager or administrator and
     for which Forum Financial Services,  Inc. serves as manager,  administrator
     and/or  distributor.  His address is Two Portland Square,  Portland,  Maine
     04101.

Costas Azariadis, Trustee (age 53)

     Professor of Economics,  University of California,  Los Angeles, since July
     1992.  Prior  thereto,  Dr.  Azariadis  was  Professor  of Economics at the
     University  of  Pennsylvania.  His  address  is  Department  of  Economics,
     University of California,  Los Angeles,  405 Hilgard  Avenue,  Los Angeles,
     California 90024.

James C. Cheng, Trustee (age 54)

     President  of  Technology  Marketing  Associates  (a  marketing  consulting
     company) since September 1991.  Prior thereto,  Mr. Cheng was President and
     Chief  Executive  Officer of Network  Dynamics,  Incorporated  (a  software
     development   company).   His  address  is  27  Temple   Street,   Belmont,
     Massachusetts 02178.

J. Michael Parish, Trustee (age 53)

     Partner at the law firm of Reid and Priest, LLP, since 1995. Prior thereto,
     he was a partner at the law firm of Winthrop  Stimson Putnam & Roberts from
     1989 to 1995 and was a partner at LeBoeuf, Lamb, Leiby & MacRae, a law firm
     of which he was a member from 1974 to 1989.  His address is 40 Wall Street,
     New York, New York 10005.

Mark D. Kaplan, Vice President, Assistant Treasurer and Assistant Secretary (age
42)

     Managing Director at Forum Financial  Services,  Inc. since September 1995.
     Prior thereto, Mr. Kaplan was Managing Director and Director of Research at
     H.M.  Payson & Co. His  address is Two  Portland  Square,  Portland,  Maine
     04101.

David I. Goldstein, Secretary (age 36)

     Counsel, Forum Financial Services,  Inc., with which he has been associated
     since 1991.  Prior thereto,  Mr. Goldstein was associated with the law firm
     of  Kirkpatrick & Lockhart.  Mr.  Goldstein is also  Secretary or Assistant
     Secretary  of  various  registered  investment  companies  for which  Forum
     Administrative  Services,  LLC or Forum Financial Services,  Inc. serves as
     manager,  administrator  and/or  distributor.  His address is Two  Portland
     Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

Max Berueffy, Assistant Secretary (age 46)

     Counsel, Forum Financial Services,  Inc., with which he has been associated
     since  1994.  Prior  thereto,  Mr.  Berueffy  was on the  staff of the U.S.
     Securities and Exchange  Commission for seven years, first in the appellate
     branch  of  the  Office  of the  General  Counsel,  then  as a  counsel  to
     Commissioner  Grundfest  and  finally  as a senior  special  counsel in the
     Division  of  Investment  Management.  Mr.  Berueffy is also  Secretary  or
     Assistant  Secretary of various registered  investment  companies for which
     Forum Administrative Services, LLC or Forum Financial Services, Inc. serves
     as manager,  administrator and/or distributor.  His address is Two Portland
     Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

                                       9
<PAGE>

Cheryl O. Tumlin, Assistant Secretary (age 31)

     Assistant Counsel, Forum Financial Services,  Inc., with which she has been
     associated since July 1996.  Prior thereto,  Ms. Tumlin was on the staff of
     the U.S.  Securities and Exchange Commission as an attorney in the Division
     of Market Regulation and prior thereto Ms. Tumlin was an associate with the
     law firm of Robinson  Silverman  Pearce  Aronsohn & Berman in New York, New
     York.  Ms.  Tumlin  is  also  Assistant  Secretary  of  various  registered
     investment companies for which Forum Administrative  Services, LLC or Forum
     Financial   Services,   Inc.  serves  as  manager,   administrator   and/or
     distributor. Her address is Two Portland Square, Portland, Maine 04101.

TRUSTEE COMPENSATION.  Each Trustee of the Trust (other than John Y. Keffer, who
is an  interested  person of the Trust) is paid  $1,000  for each Board  meeting
attended (whether in person or by electronic  communication)  and is paid $1,000
for each committee  meeting attended on a date when a Board meeting is not held.
As of March 31,  1997,  in addition to $1,000 for each Board  meeting  attended,
each Trustee  receives $100 per active  portfolio of the Trust.  To the extent a
meeting relates to only certain  portfolios of the Trust,  Trustees are paid the
$100 fee only with respect to those portfolios. Trustees are also reimbursed for
travel and related  expenses  incurred in  attending  meetings of the Board.  No
officer of the Trust is compensated by the Trust.

The following  table provides the aggregate  compensation  paid to each Trustee.
The Trust has not  adopted  any form of  retirement  plan  covering  Trustees or
officers. Information is presented for the fiscal year ended March 31, 1997.
<TABLE>
          <S>                          <C>                  <C>             <C>                <C>
                                                           ACCRUED           ANNUAL
                                        AGGREGATE          PENSION        BENEFITS UPON       TOTAL
         TRUSTEE                      COMPENSATION        BENEFITS         RETIREMENT      COMPENSATION
         -------                      ------------        --------         ----------      ------------
         Mr. Keffer                       None              None              None             None
         Mr. Azariadis                   $4,000             None              None            $4,000
         Mr. Cheng                       $4,000             None              None            $4,000
         Mr. Parish                      $4,000             None              None            $4,000
</TABLE>

ADVISOR

Pursuant  to an  Investment  Advisory  Agreement  with the Trust (the  "Advisory
Agreement"),  the Advisor furnishes at its own expense all services,  facilities
and personnel  necessary in connection with managing each Fund's investments and
effecting  portfolio  transactions  for each  Fund,  pursuant  to an  investment
advisory agreement between the Advisor and the Trust (the "Advisory Agreement").
The Advisory Agreement provides,  with respect to each Fund, for an initial term
of two years  from its  effective  date and for its  continuance  in effect  for
successive   twelve-month   periods   thereafter,   provided  the  agreement  is
specifically  approved at least annually by the Board or, with respect to either
Fund, by vote of the shareholders of that Fund, and in either case by a majority
of the  Trustees who are not parties to the  Advisory  Agreement  or  interested
persons of any such party.

The Advisory  Agreement is terminable  without penalty by the Trust with respect
to a Fund on 60 days'  written  notice  when  authorized  either  by vote of the
Fund's  shareholders  or by a vote of a majority of the Board, or by the Advisor
on not more  than 60 days'  nor less  than 30  days'  written  notice,  and will
automatically  terminate in the event of its assignment.  The Advisory Agreement
also provides  that,  with respect to each Fund, the Advisor shall not be liable
for any error of  judgment  or mistake of law or for any act or  omission in the
performance of its duties to the Fund, except for willful misfeasance, bad faith
or gross  negligence in the performance of the Advisor's  duties or by reason of
reckless  disregard of its obligations and duties under the Advisory  Agreement.
In addition,  under the Advisory  Agreement,  if the Advisor  ceases to act as a
Fund's investment  advisor,  or in the event the Advisor so requests in writing,
the Trust will change a Fund's name so as not to include the word  "Payson." The
Advisory Agreement provides that the Advisor may render services to others.

For its services  under the Investment  Advisory  Agreement,  H.M.  Payson & Co.
receives with respect to each Fund a fee at an annual rate of 0.80% and 0.60% of
the  average  daily net assets of Payson  Value Fund and Payson 


                                       10
<PAGE>

Balanced  Fund,  respectively.  Fees payable under the Advisory  Agreement  with
respect to each Fund are outlined in the following tables:
<TABLE>
<S>                           <C>                           <C>                      <C>
PAYSON VALUE FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                     GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                     ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $92,360                     $0                          $92,360
1996                         $71,662                     $0                          $71,662
1995                         $51,285                     $0                          $51,285

PAYSON BALANCED FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                     GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                     ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $107,243                    $0                          $107,243
1996                         $95,588                     $0                          $95,588
1995                         $75,058                     $0                          $75,058
</TABLE>

In addition to receiving  its advisory fee from the Funds,  the Advisor may also
act and be  compensated  as  investment  manager for its clients with respect to
assets which are invested in a Fund. In some  instances the Advisor may elect to
credit against any investment  management fee received from a client who is also
a shareholder in a Fund an amount equal to all or a portion of the fees received
by the Advisor or any  affiliate  of the Advisor from a Fund with respect to the
client's assets invested in that Fund.

ADMINISTRATOR

Pursuant  to an  Administration  Agreement  approved by the Board of Trustees on
June 19, 1997, Forum Administrative Services, LLC ("FAS") supervises the overall
management  of  the  Trust  (which  includes,   among  other   responsibilities,
negotiation  of contracts  and fees with,  and  monitoring  of  performance  and
billing of, the transfer agent,  fund accountant and custodian and arranging for
maintenance  of books and  records  of the  Trust).  FAS also  provides  persons
satisfactory to the Board to serve as officers of the Trust. Those officers,  as
well as certain  other  employees  and Trustees of the Trust,  may be directors,
officers  or  employees  of (and  persons  providing  services  to the Trust may
include) FAS, the Advisor or their respective affiliates. In addition, under the
Agreement,  FAS is directly  responsible for managing the Trust's regulatory and
legal compliance and overseeing the preparation of its  registration  statement.
Prior  to June 19,  1997,  administrative  services  were  provided  to the Fund
pursuant to a Management and Distribution Agreement between the Trust and FFSI.

For its services under the Management and Distribution Agreement,  FFSI received
with respect to each Fund a fee at an annual rate of 0.20% of the average  daily
net assets of the Fund.  Fees  payable  under the  Management  and  Distribution
Agreement with respect to each Fund are set forth in the following tables:


<TABLE>
<S>                           <C>                           <C>                      <C>
PAYSON VALUE FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                    GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                    ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $23,090                     $23,090                     $0
1996                         $17,916                     $17,916                     $0
1995                         $12,821                     $12,821                     $0
</TABLE>


                                       11
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<S>                           <C>                           <C>                      <C>
PAYSON BALANCED FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                    GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                    ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $35,748                     $35,748                     $0
1996                         $31,863                     $31,863                     $0
1995                         $25,019                     $25,019                     $0
</TABLE>

Subject to the obligations of FAS to reimburse the Trust for its excess expenses
as described in the  Prospectus,  the Trust has confirmed its  obligation to pay
all of its other expenses,  including:  interest charges,  taxes, brokerage fees
and commissions; certain insurance premiums; fees, interest charges and expenses
of   the   custodian,    transfer   agent   and   dividend   disbursing   agent;
telecommunications  expenses;  auditing, legal and compliance expenses; costs of
forming the corporation and maintaining corporate existence;  costs of preparing
and printing the Trust's  prospectuses,  statements of  additional  information,
account  application  forms  and  shareholder  reports  and  delivering  them to
existing and prospective  shareholders;  costs of maintaining  books of original
entry for portfolio and fund  accounting  and other  required books and accounts
and of  calculating  the net  asset  value  of  shares  of the  Trust;  costs of
reproduction,  stationery and supplies;  compensation of directors, officers and
employees of the Trust and costs of other personnel  performing services for the
Trust who are not officers of the Advisor,  FAS or their respective  affiliates;
costs of corporate meetings;  SEC registration fees and related expenses;  costs
incurred  pursuant to state  securities  laws; fees payable to the Advisor under
the Advisory  Agreement and to FAS under the  Administration  and all other fees
and expenses paid by the Trust under the Distribution Plan.

DISTRIBUTION

FFSI  acts as  distributor  of the  Fund's  shares  pursuant  to a  Distribution
Agreement with the Trust approved by the Board of Trustees on June 19, 1997 (the
"Distribution Agreement").  The Distribution Agreement will remain in effect for
a period of twelve months from the date of its  effectiveness  and will continue
in effect  thereafter only if its continuance is specifically  approved at least
annually by the Board of Trustees or by the shareholders and, in either case, by
a majority of the  Trustees who are not parties to the  agreement or  interested
persons  of any such  party  and do not have any  direct or  indirect  financial
interest in the Distribution Agreement.

The Distribution Agreement terminates automatically if it is assigned and may be
terminated  without  penalty  with  respect  to the  Fund by vote of the  Fund's
shareholders  or by either party to the agreement on 60 days' written  notice to
the Trust.  The  Distribution  Agreement  also  provides  that FFSI shall not be
liable for any error of judgment or mistake of law or for any act or omission in
the administration or management of the Trust,  except for willful  misfeasance,
bad faith or gross  negligence in the  performance of its duties or by reason of
reckless  disregard  of  its  obligations  and  duties  under  the  Distribution
Agreement.

Pursuant  to the  Distribution  Agreement,  FFSI  receives,  and may  reallow to
certain financial institutions,  the sales charge paid by the purchasers of each
Fund's shares.

DISTRIBUTION PLAN

In  accordance  with  Rule  12b-1  under  the 1940  Act,  the  Trust  adopted  a
distribution  plan (the  "Plan")  which  provides  that all  written  agreements
relating to the Plan must be in a form  satisfactory  to the Board. In addition,
the  Plan  requires  the  Trust,  the  Advisor  and  FFSI to  prepare,  at least
quarterly,  written reports setting forth all amounts  expended for distribution
purposes by the Trust, the Advisor and FFSI pursuant to the Plan and identifying
the distribution activities for which those expenditures were made.

The Plan  provides  that it will  remain in effect for one year from the date of
its adoption and thereafter  shall continue in effect provided it is approved at
least  annually  by the  shareholders  or by the Board,  including a majority of

                                       12
<PAGE>

directors who are not interested  persons of the Trust and who have no direct or
indirect  interest in the operation of the Plan or in any  agreement  related to
the Plan.  The Plan  further  provides  that it may not be amended  to  increase
materially the costs which may be borne by the Trust for  distribution  pursuant
to the Plan without  shareholder  approval and that other material amendments of
the Plan  must be  approved  by the  Trustees  in the  manner  described  in the
preceding  sentence.  The  Plan may be  terminated  at any time by a vote of the
Board or, with respect to either Fund, by the Fund's shareholders.

During the fiscal year ended March 31, 1997,  neither Fund paid any distribution
related expenses pursuant to the Distribution Plan.

TRANSFER AGENT

Forum Financial Corp. (the "Transfer Agent") acts as transfer agent of the Trust
pursuant to a transfer agency agreement (the "Transfer Agency  Agreement").  The
Transfer Agency  Agreement  provides,  with respect to each Fund, for an initial
term of one year from its effective  date and for its  continuance in effect for
successive  twelve-month  periods  thereafter,  provided  that the  agreement is
specifically  approved at least annually by the Board or, with respect to either
Fund,  by a vote of the  shareholders  of that  Fund,  and in  either  case by a
majority of the Trustees who are not parties to the Transfer Agency Agreement or
interested  persons  of any such party at a meeting  called  for the  purpose of
voting on the Transfer Agency Agreement.

Among the responsibilities of the Transfer Agent as agent for the Trust are: (1)
answering customer inquiries regarding account status and history, the manner in
which  purchases  and  redemptions  of shares of the Funds may be  effected  and
certain other matters  pertaining to the Funds;  (2) assisting  shareholders  in
initiating  and changing  account  designations  and  addresses;  (3)  providing
necessary  personnel  and  facilities  to  establish  and  maintain  shareholder
accounts  and  records,   assisting  in  processing   purchase  and   redemption
transactions  and receiving wired funds; (4) transmitting and receiving funds in
connection  with  customer  orders to purchase or redeem  shares;  (5) verifying
shareholder  signatures  in  connection  with  changes  in the  registration  of
shareholder  accounts;  (6) furnishing  periodic statements and confirmations of
purchases  and  redemptions;   (7)  arranging  for  the  transmission  of  proxy
statements, annual reports, prospectuses and other communications from the Trust
to its shareholders;  (8) arranging for the receipt, tabulation and transmission
to the Trust of proxies  executed by  shareholders  with  respect to meetings of
shareholders of the Trust;  and (9) providing such other related services as the
Trust or a shareholder may reasonably request.

The Transfer Agent or any  sub-transfer  agent or processing  agent may also act
and receive compensation for acting as custodian,  investment manager,  nominee,
agent or  fiduciary  for its  customers or clients who are  shareholders  of the
Funds with respect to assets  invested in the Funds.  The Transfer  Agent or any
sub-transfer  agent or other  processing  agent may elect to credit  against the
fees  payable  to it by its  clients  or  customers  all or a portion of any fee
received  from the Trust or from the  Transfer  Agent with  respect to assets of
those customers or clients  invested in the Funds.  The Transfer Agent,  FFSI or
sub-transfer  agents or processing  agents retained by the Transfer Agent may be
Processing  Organizations  (as  defined in the  Prospectus)  and, in the case of
sub-transfer  agents or processing agents, may also be affiliated persons of the
Transfer Agent or Forum.

For its  services  under the  Transfer  Agency  Agreement,  the  Transfer  Agent
receives,  with  respect  to each  Series:  (i) a fee at an annual  rate of 0.25
percent of the average  daily net assets of the Series and (ii) a fee of $12,000
per year;  such  amounts to be computed and paid monthly in arrears by the Fund;
and (iii) Annual  Shareholder  Account Fees of $18.00 per  shareholder  account;
such fees to be computed as of the last  business day of the prior  month.  Fees
payable  under the Transfer  Agent  Agreement  with respect to each Fund are set
forth in the following tables:



                                       13
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<S>                           <C>                           <C>                      <C>
PAYSON VALUE FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                    GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                    ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $45,916                     $27,131                     $18,785
1996                         $38,519                     $21,273                     $17,246
1995                         $16,027                     $3,820                      $12,207

PAYSON BALANCED FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED 
MARCH 31                    GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                    ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $63,723                     $42,011                     $21,712
1996                         $58,767                     $37,798                     $20,969
1995                         $31,274                     $19,059                     $12,215
</TABLE>

Pursuant to a Fund  Accounting  Agreement,  the Transfer Agent also provides the
Fund with  portfolio  accounting,  including the  calculation  of the Fund's net
asset  value.  For these  services,  the Transfer  Agent  receives an annual fee
ranging from $36,000 to $60,000 depending upon the amount and type of the Fund's
portfolio  transactions  and positions.  Fees payable under the Fund  Accounting
Agreement with respect to fund accounting services for the Fund are set forth in
the following table:
<TABLE>
<S>                           <C>                           <C>                      <C>
PAYSON VALUE FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDED
MARCH 31                     GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                     ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $36,000                     $0                          $36,000
1996                         $37,000                     $0                          $37,000
1995                         $36,000                     $0                          $36,000

PAYSON BALANCED FUND

FISCAL YEAR ENDE
MARCH 31                     GROSS FEE                   WAIVED FEE                  NET FEE
- --------                     ---------                   ----------                  -------
1997                         $37,000                     $0                          $37,000
1996                         $38,000                     $0                          $38,000
1995                         $36,000                     $0                          $36,000
</TABLE>

5.  DETERMINATION OF NET ASSET VALUE

The Trust  determines the net asset value of the Funds on each Fund Business Day
as defined in the  Prospectus.  The Trust does not  determine net asset value on
the following holidays: New Year's Day, Martin Luther King, Jr. Day, Presidents'
Day, Good Friday,  Memorial Day,  Independence Day, Labor Day,  Thanksgiving and
Christmas.  Purchases  and  redemptions  are  effected  at the  time of the next
determination  of net asset  value  following  the  receipt of any  purchase  or
redemption order.



                                       14
<PAGE>

6.  PORTFOLIO TRANSACTIONS

Purchases  and sales of debt  securities  for Payson  Balanced  Fund usually are
principal  transactions.  Debt  securities for that Fund are normally  purchased
directly  from  the  issuer  or from an  underwriter  or  market  maker  for the
securities.  There usually are no brokerage commissions paid for such purchases.
Purchases  from  underwriters  of portfolio  securities  include a commission or
concession  paid by the issuer to the  underwriter,  and purchases  from dealers
serving as market makers include the spread between the bid and asked prices.

Payson Value Fund and Payson  Balanced Fund (with respect to purchases of equity
securities)   will  effect  purchases  and  sales  through  brokers  who  charge
commissions.  Allocations  of  transactions  to  brokers  and  dealers  and  the
frequency of transactions are determined by the Advisor in its best judgment and
in a manner deemed to be in the best interest of shareholders of the Fund rather
than by any formula. The primary  consideration is prompt execution of orders in
an effective  manner and at the most favorable  price available to the Fund. For
the fiscal years ended March 31, 1997,  1996, and 1995, the aggregate  brokerage
commissions  paid by  Payson  Value  Fund were  $17,303,  $27,008  and  $15,276,
respectively.  For the fiscal years ended March 31, 1997,  1996,  and 1995,  the
aggregate  brokerage  commissions  paid by Payson  Balanced  Fund were  $37,474,
$36,756 and  $27,143,  respectively.  For the fiscal year ended March 31,  1997,
$600, or 1.6% of aggregate  brokerage  commissions paid, was paid to H.M. Payson
an  affiliated  broker  and 0.18% of the  total  dollar  amount of  transactions
involving payment of commission was effected through an affiliated broker.

A Fund may not always pay the lowest commission or spread available.  Rather, in
determining the amount of commission,  including certain dealer spreads, paid in
connection with Fund  transactions,  the Advisor takes into account such factors
as size of the order,  difficulty  of  execution,  efficiency  of the  executing
broker's  facilities  (including  the  services  described  below)  and any risk
assumed by the executing broker. The Advisor may also take into account payments
made by  brokers  effecting  transactions  for a Fund (i) to the Fund or (ii) to
other  persons on behalf of the Fund for  services  provided  to it for which it
would be obligated to pay.

In  addition,  the Advisor may give  consideration  to research  and  investment
analysis services furnished by brokers or dealers to the Advisor for its use and
may cause the Fund to pay these brokers a higher  amount of commission  than may
be  charged  by other  brokers.  Such  research  and  analysis  is of the  types
described  in  Section  28(e)(3)  of the  Securities  Exchange  Act of 1934,  as
amended,  and is designed to augment the  Advisor's  own  internal  research and
investment strategy capabilities.  The Advisor may use the research and analysis
in connection  with  services to clients other than the Fund,  and the Advisor's
fee is not reduced by reason of the Advisor's receipt of the research services.

Investment decisions for the Funds will be made independently from those for any
other account or investment  company that is or may in the future become managed
by the  Advisor or its  affiliates.  If,  however,  a Fund and other  investment
companies or accounts  managed by the Advisor are  contemporaneously  engaged in
the purchase or sale of the same security,  the  transactions may be averaged as
to price and  allocated  equitably to each account.  In some cases,  this policy
might  adversely  affect the price paid or received by a Fund or the size of the
position  obtainable  for the Fund. In addition,  when purchases or sales of the
same security for a Fund and for other investment companies and accounts managed
by the  Advisor  occur  contemporaneously,  the  purchase  or sale orders may be
aggregated  in  order  to  obtain  any  price  advantages   available  to  large
denomination purchases or sales.

In the future  the  Funds,  consistent  with the  policy of  obtaining  best net
results, may conduct brokerage  transactions  through the Advisor's  affiliates,
affiliates of those persons or FFSI. If a Fund anticipates  conducting brokerage
transactions   through  these  persons,  the  Board  will  adopt  procedures  in
conformity with applicable rules under the 1940 Act to ensure that all brokerage
commissions paid to these persons are reasonable and fair.

7.  ADDITIONAL PURCHASE AND REDEMPTION INFORMATION

Shares of each Fund are sold on a continuous basis by FFSI.

                                       15
<PAGE>

Set forth below is an example of the method of computing  the offering  price of
each  Fund's  shares.  The example  assumes a purchase  of shares of  beneficial
interest aggregating less than $100,000 subject to the schedule of sales charges
set forth in the  Prospectuses at a price based on the net asset value per share
of each Fund on March 31, 1997.

                                                 Payson           Payson
                                                  Value          Balanced
                                                  Fund             Fund
                                                  ----             ----

Net Asset Value Per Share                        $16.10           $13.20

Sales Charge, 4.00% of offering
price (4.17% of net asset value
per share)                                        $0.67            $0.55

Offering to Public                               $16.77           $13.75

In addition to the situations  described in the Prospectus  under "Purchases and
Redemptions of Shares," the Trust may redeem shares involuntarily,  from time to
time,  to reimburse a Fund for any loss  sustained by reason of the failure of a
shareholder to make full payment for shares  purchased by the  shareholder or to
collect  any charge  relating  to  transactions  effected  for the  benefit of a
shareholder  which  is  applicable  to  a  Fund's  shares  as  provided  in  the
Prospectus.

The Trust has filed an election  with the SEC pursuant to which a Fund will only
effect a redemption in portfolio  securities if a shareholder  is redeeming more
than  $250,000 or 1% of the Fund's total net assets,  whichever is less,  during
any 90-day period.

EXCHANGE PRIVILEGE

The  exchange  privilege  permits  shareholders  of the Funds to exchange  their
shares  for  shares of any other  fund of the Trust or shares of  certain  other
portfolios of investment  companies  which retain FAS or FFSI or its  affiliates
administrator  or  distributor  and which  participate  in the Trust's  exchange
privilege  program  ("Participating  Fund").  For Federal  income tax  purposes,
exchange  transactions  are treated as sales on which a purchaser will realize a
capital gain or loss  depending  on whether the value of the shares  redeemed is
more or less than his basis in such shares at the time of the transaction.

By use of the exchange privilege,  the shareholder authorizes the Transfer Agent
to act upon the instruction of any person representing  himself to either be, or
to have the  authority  to act on behalf of, the  investor  and  believed by the
Transfer  Agent  to be  genuine.  The  records  of the  Transfer  Agent  of such
instructions are binding. Proceeds of an exchange transaction may be invested in
another Participating Fund in the name of the shareholder.

Exchange transactions will be made on the basis of relative net asset values per
share at the time of the exchange  transaction plus any sales charge  applicable
to the  Participating  Fund  whose  shares  are  being  acquired.  Shares of any
Participating Fund may be redeemed and the proceeds used to purchase,  without a
sales charge,  shares of any other Participating Fund that are offered without a
sales charge. Shares of any Participating Fund purchased with a sales charge may
be redeemed and the proceeds used to purchase, without a sales charge, shares of
any other  Participating  Fund  otherwise  sold with the same or a lesser  sales
charge. If the Participating Fund purchased in the exchange  transaction imposes
a higher sales charge than was paid  originally  on the  exchanged  shares,  the
shareholder  will  be  responsible  for the  difference  between  the two  sales
charges. Shares acquired through the reinvestment of dividends and distributions
are deemed to have been  acquired with a sales charge rate equal to that paid on
the shares on which the dividend or distribution was paid.

The terms of the exchange privilege are subject to change, and the privilege may
be  terminated  by any of the  Participating  Funds or the  Trust.  However  the
privilege  will not be  terminated,  and no material  change that  restricts 


                                       16
<PAGE>

the availability of the privilege to shareholders  will be implemented,  without
reasonable advance notice to shareholders.

PAYROLL PURCHASE PROGRAM

Shares of the Funds may be purchased by employees of employers  participating in
the Payroll  Purchase  Program  ("PPP").  Employers  wishing to participate must
arrange  payroll  deduction or other bulk  transmission  of  investments  to the
Funds.  An employer may not participate  unless,  at all times, at least five of
the employer's employees are participating in this program.

Once an employer  chooses to participate  in PPP through a payroll  deduction or
other bulk  purchase  plan,  subsequent  investments  will be automatic and will
continue until such time as the investor  notifies the  applicable  Fund and his
employer to discontinue  further  investments.  Due to the varying procedures to
prepare,  process and forward the transmission to the Fund, there may be a delay
between the time of the  deduction  and the time the money  reaches the Fund. An
investment in the Fund will be made at the applicable  offering price determined
on the day that both the check and the payroll  deduction  data are  received in
required form by the Transfer Agent.

INDIVIDUAL RETIREMENT CUSTODIAL ACCOUNT

The Funds offer an individual  retirement  plan (an "IRA") for  individuals  who
wish to use shares of the Funds as a medium for  funding  individual  retirement
savings.  Under the IRA, distributions of net investment income and capital gain
will be  automatically  reinvested in the IRA established for the investor.  The
Funds'  custodian  furnishes  custodial  services to the IRAs for a service fee.
Shareholders  wishing to invest through an IRA should contact the Transfer Agent
for further details and information.

8.  TAXATION

Qualification as a regulated  investment company under the Internal Revenue Code
of 1986, as amended does not involve  governmental  supervision of management or
investment practices or policies. Investors should consult their own counsel for
a complete  understanding of the requirements the Funds must meet to qualify for
such  treatment.  The  information set forth in the Prospectus and the following
discussion  relate solely to Federal income taxes on dividends and distributions
by a Fund and assume that each Fund qualifies as a regulated investment company.
Investors  should  consult  their own counsel  for  further  details and for the
application of state and local tax laws to the investor's particular situation.

Payson  Value Fund  expects to derive a  substantial  amount of its gross income
(exclusive of capital gain) from  dividends.  Accordingly,  that portion of that
Fund's  dividends so derived will qualify for the  dividends-received  deduction
for  corporations.  Payson Balanced Fund expects to derive  substantially all of
its gross income  (exclusive of capital gain) from sources other than dividends.
Accordingly,  it is expected that most of that Fund's dividends or distributions
will not qualify for the dividends-received deduction for corporations.

Certain listed options and regulated futures  contracts are considered  "section
1256 contracts" for Federal income tax purposes.  Section 1256 contracts held by
a Fund at the end of each  taxable  year will be "marked to market"  and treated
for Federal income tax purposes as though sold for fair market value on the last
business day of such taxable  year.  Gain or loss  realized by a Fund on section
1256  contracts  generally  will be considered  60% long-term and 40% short-term
capital  gain or loss.  A Fund can elect to exempt its  section  1256  contracts
which are part of a "mixed straddle" from the application of section 1256.

With respect to equity or  over-the-counter  put and call options,  gain or loss
realized by a Fund upon the lapse or sale of such  options held by the Fund will
be either  long-term  or  short-term  capital  gain or loss  depending  upon the
respective Fund's holding period with respect to such option.  However,  gain or
loss  realized upon the lapse or closing out of such options that are written by
a Fund will be treated as short-term capital gain or loss. In general, if a Fund
exercises an option, or if an option that a Fund has written is exercised,  gain
or loss on the option will not be


                                       17
<PAGE>

separately  recognized but the premium  received or paid will be included in the
calculation  of gain or loss upon  disposition  of the property  underlying  the
option.

In  addition,  the  use of  certain  hedging  strategies  such  as  writing  and
purchasing options,  futures contracts and options on futures contracts involves
complex  rules that will  determine  for income tax purposes the  character  and
timing of recognition of income received in connection therewith.

9.  OTHER INFORMATION

CUSTODIAN

Pursuant  to a  Custodian  Agreement,  The First  National  Bank of Boston,  100
Federal Street,  Boston,  MA 02106,  acts as the custodian of the Funds' assets.
The custodian's responsibilities include safeguarding and controlling the Funds'
cash  and  securities,  determining  income  and  collecting  interest  on  Fund
investments.

COUNSEL

Legal matters in connection  with the issuance of shares of beneficial  interest
of the Trust are passed upon by the law firm of Seward & Kissel,  1200 G Street,
N.W., Washington, D.C. 20005

AUDITORS

Deloitte  &  Touche  LLP,  125  Summer  Street,  Boston,  Massachusetts,  02110,
independent auditors, act as auditors for the Trust.

THE TRUST AND ITS SHARES

The Trust was originally  incorporated in Maryland on March 24, 1980 and assumed
the name of Forum  Funds,  Inc.  on March 16,  1987.  On January 5, 1996,  Forum
Funds,  Inc. was  reorganized  as a Delaware  business  trust.  The Trust has an
unlimited  number of authorized  shares of beneficial  interest.  The Board may,
without  shareholder  approval,  divide the authorized  shares into an unlimited
number of  separate  portfolios  or series  (such as the  Funds)  and may in the
future  divide  portfolios or series into two or more classes of shares (such as
Investor and Institutional Shares). Currently the authorized shares of the Trust
are divided into 15 separate series.

Each  share of each  fund of the  Trust  and  each  class of  shares  has  equal
dividend,  distribution,  liquidation and voting rights,  and fractional  shares
have  those  rights  proportionately,   except  that  expenses  related  to  the
distribution  of the shares of each class (and certain  other  expenses  such as
transfer  agency and  administration  expenses) are borne solely by those shares
and each class votes separately with respect to the provisions of any Rule 12b-1
plan  which  pertain to the class and other  matters  for which  separate  class
voting is appropriate under applicable law.  Generally,  shares will be voted in
the aggregate  without reference to a particular  portfolio or class,  except if
the matter  affects only one  portfolio or class or voting by portfolio or class
is required by law, in which case shares will be voted  separately  by portfolio
or class, as appropriate. Delaware law does not require the Trust to hold annual
meetings of shareholders,  and it is anticipated that shareholder  meetings will
be held only when required by Federal or state law.  Shareholders (and Trustees)
have  available  certain  procedures  for the removal of Trustees.  There are no
conversion or  preemptive  rights in  connection  with shares of the Trust.  All
shares when issued in  accordance  with the terms of the offering  will be fully
paid and nonassessable.  Shares are redeemable at net asset value, at the option
of  the  shareholders.   A  shareholder  in  a  portfolio  is  entitled  to  the
shareholder's  pro rata share of all  dividends and  distributions  arising from
that portfolio's assets and, upon redeeming shares,  will receive the portion of
the portfolio's net assets represented by the redeemed shares.

As of July 1, 1997,  the  officers  and  Directors of the Trust as a group owned
less than 1% of the  outstanding  shares of each Fund. Also as of that date, the
shareholders  listed below owned or owned of record more than 5% of either Fund.
From time to time, certain shareholders may own a large percentage of the shares
of a Fund. Accordingly, those shareholders may be able to greatly affect (if not
determine)  the  outcome  of a  shareholder  vote.  As noted, 


                                       18
<PAGE>

certain of these  shareholders  are known to the Trust to hold  their  shares of
record only and have no beneficial interest, including the right to vote, in the
shares.

PAYSON VALUE FUND

                                                        PERCENTAGE OF FUND
                                                        SHARES OWNED
SHAREHOLDER                                             ------------
- -----------
Payse & Co.
c/o H.M. Payson & Co.
P.O. Box 31
Portland, ME 04112                                      20.50%

Ala & Co.
c/o H.M. Payson & Co.
P.O. Box 31
Portland, ME 04112                                      16.72%


PAYSON BALANCED FUND

                                                        PERCENTAGE OF FUND
                                                        SHARES OWNED
SHAREHOLDER                                             ------------
- -----------
Ala & Co.
c/o H.M. Payson & Co.
P.O. Box 31
Portland, ME 04112                                      17.75%

Payse & Co.
c/o H.M. Payson & Co.
P.O. Box 31
Portland, ME 04112                                      15.38%

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

The financial  statements  of Payson  Balanced Fund for the year ended March 31,
1997,  which are included in the Annual Report to  Shareholders of the Trust and
delivered along with this Statement of Additional Information,  are incorporated
herein by reference.



                                       19
<PAGE>

                                PAYSON VALUE FUND
                              PAYSON BALANCED FUND

                 APPENDIX A - DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES RATINGS


1.       CORPORATE BONDS

MOODY'S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC. ("MOODY'S")

Moody's rates  corporate  bond issues,  including  convertible  debt issues,  as
follows:

Bonds which are rated Aaa are judged by Moody's to be of the best quality.  They
carry the smallest  degree of investment  risk and are generally  referred to as
"gilt edge." Interest  payments are protected by a large or by an  exceptionally
stable margin and principal is secure. While the various protective elements are
likely to change,  such changes as can be visualized are most unlikely to impair
the fundamentally strong position of such issues.

Bonds  which are rated Aa are  judged to be of high  quality  by all  standards.
Together  with  the Aaa  group,  they  comprise  what  are  generally  known  as
high-grade  bonds.  They are rated lower than the best bonds because  margins of
protection may not be as large as in Aaa securities or fluctuation of protective
elements  may be of greater  amplitude  or there may be other  elements  present
which make the long term risks appear somewhat larger than in Aaa securities.

Bonds which are rated A possess many favorable investment  attributes and are to
be  considered as upper medium grade  obligations.  Factors  giving  security to
principal and interest are considered adequate but elements may be present which
suggest a susceptibility to impairment some time in the future.

Bonds which are rated Baa are considered as medium grade obligations, i.e., they
are neither highly protected nor poorly secured.  Interest payment and principal
security appear adequate for the present but certain protective  elements may be
lacking or may be  characteristically  unreliable over any great length of time.
Such  bonds  lack  outstanding  investment  characteristics  and  in  fact  have
speculative characteristics as well.

Bonds which are rated Ba are judged to have speculative  elements;  their future
cannot be  considered  as well  assured.  Often the  protection  of interest and
principal  payments may be very moderate and thereby not well safeguarded during
both good and bad times over the future.  Uncertainty of position  characterizes
bonds in this class.

Bonds  which  are  rated  B  generally  lack  characteristics  of the  desirable
investment.  Assurance of interest and principal  payments or of  maintenance of
other terms of the contract over any long period of time may be small.

Bonds which are rated Caa are of poor standing. Such issues may be in default or
there may be present elements of danger with respect to principal or interest.

Bonds which are rated Ca represent  obligations  which are speculative in a high
degree. Such issues are often in default or have other marked shortcomings.

Bonds which are rated C are the lowest  rated class of bonds and issues so rated
can be regarded as having  extremely  poor  prospects of ever attaining any real
investment standing.

Note:  Those  bonds in the Aa, A, Baa,  Ba or B groups  which  Moody's  believes
possess the strongest  investment  attributes are designated by the symbols Aa1,
A1, Baa1, Ba1, and B1.

                                      A-1
<PAGE>


STANDARD AND POOR'S CORPORATION ("S&P")

S&P rates corporate bond issues, including convertible debt issues, as follows:

Bonds  rated  AAA have the  highest  rating  assigned  by S&P.  Capacity  to pay
interest and repay principal is extremely strong.

Bonds rated AA have a very strong  capacity to pay interest and repay  principal
and differ from the highest rated issues only in small degree.

Bonds  rated A have a strong  capacity  to pay  interest  and  repay  principal,
although they are somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in
circumstances   and  economic   conditions  than  debt  rated  in  higher  rated
categories.

Bonds rated BBB are regarded as having an adequate  capacity to pay interest and
repay principal.  Whereas they normally exhibit adequate protection  parameters,
adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are more likely to lead to
weakened  capacity to pay interest and repay principal for debt in this category
than in higher rated categories.

Bonds rated BB, B, CCC, CC and C are  regarded,  on  balance,  as  predominantly
speculative  with  respect to the  issuer's  capacity to pay  interest and repay
principal in  accordance  with the terms of the  obligation.  BB  indicates  the
lowest degree of speculation and C the highest degree of speculation. While such
bonds will likely have some quality and  protective  characteristics,  these are
outweighed by large uncertainties or major risk exposures to adverse conditions.
Bonds  rated  BB  have  less  near-term  vulnerability  to  default  than  other
speculative issues.  However,  they face major ongoing uncertainties or exposure
to adverse  business,  financial,  or  economic  conditions  which could lead to
inadequate capacity to meet timely interest and principal payments.

Bonds rated B have a greater  vulnerability  to default but  currently  have the
capacity to meet interest payments and principal  repayments.  Adverse business,
financial,  or economic conditions will likely impair capacity or willingness to
pay interest and repay principal.

Bonds rated CCC have currently  identifiable  vulnerability to default,  and are
dependent upon favorable  business,  financial,  and economic conditions to meet
timely  payment of interest and repayment of principal.  In the event of adverse
business,  financial,  or economic  conditions,  they are not likely to have the
capacity to pay interest and repay principal.

Bonds rated CC typically are debt  subordinated to senior debt which is assigned
an actual or implied CCC debt  rating.  This rating may also be used to indicate
imminent default.

The C rating may be used to cover a situation  where a  bankruptcy  petition has
been filed, but debt service  payments are continued.  The rating Cl is reserved
for income bonds on which no interest is being paid.

Bonds are rated D when the issue is in payment default, or the obligor has filed
for  bankruptcy.  Bonds rated D are in payment  default or the obligor has filed
for  bankruptcy.  The D  rating  category  is used  when  interest  payments  or
principal  payments are not made on the date due, even if the  applicable  grace
period has not expired,  unless S&P believes that such payments will made during
such grace period.

Note:  The ratings  from AA to CCC may be modified by the addition of a plus (+)
or minus (-) sign to show the relative standing within the rating category.

FITCH IBCA, INC. ("FITCH")

Fitch rates  corporate  bond  issues,  including  convertible  debt  issues,  as
follows:

                                      A-2
<PAGE>

AAA Bonds are  considered  to be  investment  grade  and of the  highest  credit
quality.  The obligor has an  exceptionally  strong  ability to pay interest and
repay  principal,  which is unlikely to be  affected by  reasonably  foreseeable
events.

AA Bonds are considered to be investment  grade and of very high credit quality.
The  obligor's  ability to pay  interest  and repay  principal  is very  strong,
although not quite as strong as bonds rated AAA.  Because bonds rated in the AAA
and AA  categories  are  not  significantly  vulnerable  to  foreseeable  future
developments, shorter-term debt of these issuers is generally rated F-1+.

A Bonds are considered to be investment  grade and of high credit  quality.  The
obligor's  ability to pay  interest  and repay  principal  is  considered  to be
strong, but may be more vulnerable to adverse changes in economic conditions and
circumstances than bonds with higher ratings.

BBB Bonds are  considered  to be  investment  grade and of  satisfactory  credit
quality. The obligor's ability to pay interest and repay principal is considered
to be  adequate.  Adverse  changes in  economic  conditions  and  circumstances,
however,  are more likely to have adverse  impact on these bonds,  and therefore
impair timely payment.  The likelihood that the ratings of these bonds will fall
below investment grade is higher than for bonds with higher ratings.

BB Bonds are considered  speculative.  The obligor's ability to pay interest and
repay principal may be affected over time by adverse economic changes.  However,
business and financial  alternatives  can be  identified  which could assist the
obligor in satisfying its debt service requirements.

B Bonds  are  considered  highly  speculative.  While  bonds in this  class  are
currently meeting debt service requirements, the probability of continued timely
payment of principal  and  interest  reflects the  obligor's  limited  margin of
safety and the need for reasonable business and economic activity throughout the
life of the issue.

CCC Bonds have certain identifiable  characteristics which, if not remedied, may
lead to  default.  The  ability to meet  obligations  requires  an  advantageous
business and economic environment.

CC Bonds  are  minimally  protected.  Default  in  payment  of  interest  and/or
principal seems probable over time.

C Bonds are in imminent default in payment of interest or principal.

DDD, DD, and D Bonds are in default on interest and/or principal payments.  Such
bonds  are  extremely  speculative  and  should  be valued on the basis of their
ultimate  recovery value in liquidation or  reorganization  of the obligor.  DDD
represents the highest  potential for recovery on these bonds,  and D represents
the lowest potential for recovery.

Plus (+) and  minus (-) signs  are used  with a rating  symbol to  indicate  the
relative position of a credit within the rating category.  Plus and minus signs,
however, are not used in the AAA, DDD, DD, or D categories.

2.       PREFERRED STOCK

MOODY'S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC.

Moody's rates preferred stock as follows:

An issue rated aaa is  considered  to be a  top-quality  preferred  stock.  This
rating indicates good asset protection and the least risk of dividend impairment
among preferred stock issues.

An issue  rated aa is  considered  a  high-grade  preferred  stock.  This rating
indicates  that  there  is  a  reasonable  assurance  that  earnings  and  asset
protection will remain relatively well maintained in the foreseeable future.

                                      A-3
<PAGE>

An issue rated a is  considered to be an  upper-medium  grade  preferred  stock.
While  risks  are  judged  to be  somewhat  greater  than  in  the  aaa  and  aa
classification,  earnings and asset protection are, nevertheless, expected to be
maintained at adequate levels.

An issue rated baa is considered to be a medium-grade,  neither highly protected
nor poorly secured. Earnings and asset protection appear adequate at present but
may be questionable over any great length of time.

An issue rated ba is  considered  to have  speculative  elements  and its future
cannot be considered  well assured.  Earnings and asset  protection  may be very
moderate  and not  well  safeguarded  during  adverse  periods.  Uncertainty  of
position characterizes preferred stocks in this class.

An issue which is rated b  generally  lacks the  characteristics  of a desirable
investment. Assurance of dividend payments and maintenance of other terms of the
issue over any long period of time may be small.

An issue  which is rated caa is likely to be in  arrears on  dividend  payments.
This  rating  designation  does not  purport to  indicate  the future  status of
payments.

An issue which is rated ca is  speculative  in a high degree and is likely to be
in arrears on dividends with little likelihood of eventual payment.

An issue which is rated c can be regarded as having  extremely poor prospects of
ever attaining any real investment  standing.  This is the lowest rated class of
preferred or preference stock.

Note:   Moody's  applies  numerical   modifiers  1,  2  and  3  in  each  rating
classification  from aa through b in its  preferred  stock  rating  system.  The
modifier 1 indicates  that the  security  ranks in the higher end of its generic
rating category;  the modifier 2 indicates a mid-range ranking; and the modifier
3  indicates  that the  issuer  ranks in the  lower  end of its  generic  rating
category.

STANDARD & POOR'S CORPORATION

S&P rates preferred stock as follows:

AAA is the highest rating that is assigned by S&P to a preferred stock issue and
indicates an extremely strong capacity to pay the preferred stock obligations.

A preferred  stock issue rated AA also qualifies as a high-quality  fixed income
security.  The  capacity to pay  preferred  stock  obligations  is very  strong,
although not as overwhelming as for issues rated AAA.

An issue  rated A is  backed  by a sound  capacity  to pay the  preferred  stock
obligations,  although it is somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of
changes in circumstances and economic conditions.

An issue  rated BBB is  regarded  as backed by an  adequate  capacity to pay the
preferred stock  obligations.  Whereas it normally exhibits adequate  protection
parameters,  adverse  economic  conditions  or changing  circumstances  are more
likely to lead to a weakened  capacity to make payments for a preferred stock in
this category than for issues in the A category.

Preferred stock rated BB, B, and CCC are regarded,  on balance, as predominantly
speculative  with  respect  to the  issuer's  capacity  to pay  preferred  stock
obligations.  BB indicates the lowest degree of speculation  and CCC the highest
degree of  speculation.  While such issues  will  likely  have some  quality and
protective characteristics, these are outweighed by large uncertainties or major
risk exposures to adverse conditions.

The rating CC is reserved for a preferred stock issue in arrears on dividends or
sinking fund payments but that is currently paying.

                                      A-4
<PAGE>

A preferred stock rated C is a non-paying issue.

A preferred  stock rated D is a  non-paying  issue with the issuer in default on
debt instruments.

To provide more detailed  indications of preferred  stock  quality,  the ratings
from AA to CCC may be modified  by the  addition of a plus (+) or minus (-) sign
to show relative standing within the major rating categories.

3.       SHORT-TERM DEBT (COMMERCIAL PAPER)

MOODY'S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC.

Moody's two highest ratings for short-term debt, including commercial paper, are
Prime-1 and Prime-2,  both are judged investment grade, to indicate the relative
repayment ability of rated issuers.

Issuers rated Prime-1 have a superior ability for repayment of senior short-term
debt  obligations.  Prime-1 repayment ability will often be evidenced by many of
the following characteristics:

          --      Leading market positions in well-established industries.
          --      High rates of return on funds employed.
          --      Conservative capitalization  structure  with moderate reliance
                  on debt and ample asset protection.
          --      Broad  margins in earnings coverage of fixed financial charges
                  and high internal cash  generation.
          --      Well-established  access  to a  range  of  financial  markets
                  and  assured  sources  of  alternate liquidity.

Issuers rated  Prime-2 by Moody's have a strong  ability for repayment of senior
short-term  debt  obligations.  This will  normally be  evidenced by many of the
characteristics of issuers rated Prime-1 but to a lesser degree. Earnings trends
and  coverage   ratios,   while  sound,   may  be  more  subject  to  variation.
Capitalization characteristics, while still appropriate, may be more affected by
external conditions. Ample alternate liquidity is maintained.

STANDARD AND POOR'S CORPORATION

S&P's two highest  commercial  paper  ratings are A and B. Issues  assigned an A
rating are regarded as having the greatest  capacity for timely payment.  Issues
in this  category  are  delineated  with the numbers 1, 2 and 3 to indicate  the
relative  degree of  safety.  An A-1  designation  indicates  that the degree of
safety  regarding  timely payment is either  overwhelming or very strong.  Those
issues determined to possess  overwhelming  safety  characteristics  are denoted
with a plus (+) sign designation. The capacity for timely payment on issues with
an A-2 designation is strong.  However,  the relative degree of safety is not as
high as for issues  designated A-1. A-3 issues have a satisfactory  capacity for
timely  payment.  They are,  however,  somewhat  more  vulnerable to the adverse
effects  of  changes  in  circumstances  than  obligations  carrying  the higher
designations.  Issues rated B are  regarded as having only an adequate  capacity
for timely payment. However, such capacity may be damaged by changing conditions
or short-term adversities.

FITCH IBCA, INC..

Fitch's  short-term ratings apply to debt obligations that are payable on demand
or have original maturities of generally up to three years, including commercial
paper, certificates of deposit,  medium-term notes, and municipal and investment
notes.

F-1+. Issues assigned this rating are regarded as having the strongest degree of
assurance for timely payment.

F-1.  Issues  assigned this rating  reflect an assurance of timely  payment only
slightly less in degree than issues rated F-1+.

F-2.  Issues  assigned this rating have a  satisfactory  degree of assurance for
timely payment,  but the margin of safety is not as great as for issues assigned
F-1+ or F-1 ratings.

                                      A-5
<PAGE>

F-3. Issues assigned this rating have characteristics suggesting that the degree
of assurance for timely payment is adequate,  however, near-term adverse changes
could cause these securities to be rated below investment grade.

F-S.  Issues  assigned  this rating have  characteristics  suggesting  a minimal
degree of assurance for timely payment and are  vulnerable to near-term  adverse
changes in financial and economic conditions.

D.   Issues assigned this rating are in actual or imminent payment default.


                                      A-6
<PAGE>

                                   APPENDIX B
                             TEXT OF FORUM BROCHURE

In connection with its  advertisements,  a Fund may provide a description of the
Fund's investment adviser and its affiliates, which are service providers to the
Fund. Text which is currently in use is set forth below.

"FORUM FINANCIAL GROUP OF COMPANIES

Forum Financial  Group of Companies  represent more than a decade of diversified
experience  with every  aspect of mutual  funds.  The Forum  Family of Funds has
benefited from the informed,  sharply  focused  perspective on mutual funds that
experience makes possible.

The Forum Family of Funds has been created and managed by  affiliated  companies
of Portland-based  Forum Financial Group, among the nation's largest mutual fund
administrators  providing clients with a full line of services for every type of
mutual fund.

The Forum  Family of Funds is designed to give  investment  representatives  and
investors a broad choice of carefully  structured  and  diversified  portfolios,
portfolios  that can satisfy a wide  variety of  immediate  as well as long-term
investment goals.

Forum  Financial Group has developed its "brand name" family of mutual funds and
has made them available to the investment public and to institutions on both the
national and regional levels.

For more than a decade Forum has had direct  experience with mutual funds from a
different  perspective,  a perspective  made  possible by Forum's  position as a
leading designer and full-service  administrator  and manager of mutual funds of
all types.

Today Forum  Financial  Group  administers  and  provides  services for over 120
mutual  funds for 17  different  fund  managers,  with more than $30  billion in
client assets. Forum has its headquarters in Portland, Maine, and has offices in
Seattle, Bermuda, and Warsaw, Poland. In a joint venture with Bank Handlowy, the
largest  and  oldest  commercial  bank  in  Poland,   Forum  operates  the  only
independent  transfer agent and mutual fund accounting business in Poland. Forum
directs an off-shore and hedge fund administration  business through its Bermuda
office. It employs more than 230 professionals worldwide.

From the  beginning,  Forum  developed a plan of action that was effective  with
both start- up funds, and funds that needed  restructuring and improved services
in order to live up to their potential.  The success of its innovative  approach
is  evident  in  Forum's  growth  rate over the  years,  a growth  rate that has
consistently outstripped that of the mutual fund industry as a whole, as well as
that of the fund service outsource industry.

Forum has worked with both  domestic  and  international  mutual fund  sponsors,
designing  unique  mutual  fund  structures,  positioning  new funds  within the
sponsors' own corporate planning and targeted markets.

Forum's staff of experienced lawyers, many of whom have been associated with the
Securities  and  Exchange  Commission,  have  been  available  to work with fund
sponsors to customize  fund  components and to evaluate the potential of various
fund structures.

Forum has introduced fund sponsors to its unique proprietary Core and Gateway(R)
partnership,  helping them to take advantage of this full-service  master/feeder
structure.

Fund sponsors  understand that even the most efficiently and creatively designed
fund can disappoint  shareholders  if it is inadequately  serviced.  That is the
reason why fund  sponsors  have relied on Forum to meet all of a fund's  complex
compliance, regulatory, and filing needs.

                                      B-1
<PAGE>

Forum's full service commitment  includes providing state-of- the-art accounting
support (Forum has 8 CPAs on staff, as well as senior  accountants who have been
associated with Big 6 accounting firms).  Forum's proprietary  accounting system
is continually upgraded and can provide custom-built modules to satisfy a fund's
specific  requirements.   This  service  is  joined  with  transfer  agency  and
shareholder  service  groups that draw their strength both from the high caliber
of the people staffing each unit and from Forum's  advanced  technology  support
system.

More than a decade of  experience  with mutual  funds has given Forum  practical
hands-on  experience and knowledge of how mutual funds function "from the inside
out."

Forum has put that  experience to work by creating the Forum Family of Funds,  a
family where each member is designed  and  positioned  for your best  investment
advantage,  and where each fund is  serviced  with the utmost  attention  to the
delivery of timely, accurate, and comprehensive shareholder information.

INVESTMENT ADVISERS

Forum Investment  Advisors,  LLC offers the services of portfolio  managers with
the highest  qualifications--because without such direction, a comprehensive and
goal-oriented  investment  program  and  ongoing  investment  strategy  are  not
possible.  Serving  as  portfolio  managers  for the  Forum  Family of Funds are
individuals  with  decades  of  experience  with  some  of the  country's  major
financial institutions.

Individual  funds in the Forum Family of Funds invest in portfolios that have as
their investment adviser nationally recognized institutions,  including Schroder
Capital Management International, Inc., a major figure in worldwide mutual funds
that, with its affiliates, managed over $175 billion as of September 30, 1997.

Forum Funds are also  managed by the  portfolio  managers of H.M.  Payson & Co.,
founded in Portland, Maine in 1854 and one of the oldest investment firms in the
country.  Payson has approximately $1 billion in assets under  management,  with
clients that include  pension plans,  endowment  funds,  and  institutional  and
individual accounts.

FORUM INVESTMENT ADVISORS, LLC

Forum Investment  Advisors,  LLC is the largest Maine based  investment  adviser
with  approximately  $1.4  billion in assets  under  management.  The  portfolio
managers have decades of combined experience in a cross section of the country's
financial  markets.  The managers have  specific,  day-to-day  experience in the
asset class  portfolios  they manage,  bringing  critical  focus to meeting each
fund's explicit investment objectives. The portfolio managers have been involved
in investing the assets of large  insurance  companies,  banks,  pension  plans,
individuals,  and of course mutual funds. Forum Investment  Advisors,  LLC has a
staff of analysts and investment  administrators  to meet the demands of serving
shareholders in our funds.

FORUM FAMILY OF FUNDS

It has been said that  mutual  fund  investment  offerings--of  which  there are
nearly  10,000,  with assets spread across stock,  bond,  and money market funds
worth  more  than  $4  trillion--come  in  a  rainbow  of  varieties.  A  better
description  would be a "spectrum" of varieties,  the spectrum graded from green
through  amber  and on to red.  In  simpler  terms,  from low risk  investments,
through moderate to high risk. The lower the risk, the lower the possible reward
- -- the higher the risk, the higher the potential reward.

The Forum Family of Funds provides  conservative  investment  opportunities that
reduce the risk of loss of capital,  using underlying  money market  investments
U.S. Government  securities  (although the shares of the Forum Funds are neither
insured nor guaranteed by the U.S. Government or its agencies),  thus

                                      B-2
<PAGE>

cushioning the investment against market  volatility.  These funds offer regular
income, ready access to your money, and flexibility to buy or sell at any time.

In the less  conservative  but still not  aggressive  category  are funds in the
Forum Family that seek to provide steady income and, in certain cases,  tax-free
earnings.  Such investments  provide important  diversification to an investment
portfolio.

Growth funds in the Forum Family more  aggressively  pursue a high return at the
risk of market volatility.  These funds include domestic and international stock
mutual funds."

                                      B-3
<PAGE>


                                   APPENDIX C
                      TEXT OF PEOPLES HERITAGE NEWS RELEASE

Peoples Heritage Financial Group, Inc. (NASDAQ:PHBK) announced today that it has
formed an alliance with a major mutual fund provider and an investment  advisory
firm to expand its mutual fund  offerings.  The  alliance  with Forum  Financial
Group and H.M.  Payson & Company will result in 18 funds,  including  the unique
Maine Municipal Bond Fund and New Hampshire Bond Fund, being offered through the
branches  of Peoples'  affiliate  banks in Maine,  New  Hampshire  and  northern
Massachusetts and the Company's trust and investment subsidiaries

'There is no secret to where  financial  services  are moving,  under one roof,"
said William J. Ryan, Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer of Peoples
Heritage.   "One  only  has  to  watch  the  virtually  daily  announcements  of
consolidations  in  the  financial  sector  to  understand  that  customers  are
demanding and receiving 'one-stop' financial services.

"We think we are adding the additional  competitive  advantage of funds that are
managed and administered close to home."

Eighteen  Forum funds will be offered  including two Payson funds.  The tax-free
Maine and New Hampshire  state bond funds are the only two such funds  available
and usually  invest 80% of total  assets in  municipal  securities.  Other funds
being  provided by the alliance  include money  market,  fixed income and equity
funds.

Forum Financial, based in Portland, Maine since 1987, administers 146 funds with
more than $36 billion in assets.  Forum  manages  mutual  funds for  independent
investment advisors such as Payson and for banks. Forum Investment Advisors, LLC
an affiliate,  is the largest Maine-based  investment advisor with approximately
$1.7 billion in fund assets under management.

"We are providing a great product set to the customers served by Peoples' nearly
200 branches in northern New  England,"  said John Y.  Keffer,  Forum  Financial
president,  "The key today is to link a wide variety of investment  options with
convergent, easy access for customers. I believe this alliance does just that."

H.M.  Payson & Co.,  founded in 1854, is one of the nation's  oldest  investment
firms with  nearly $1 billion in assets  under  management  and $300  million in
non-managed  custodial accounts.  The Payson value Fund and Payson Balanced Fund
are among the 18 offerings.

"I believe we have all the  ingredients  of a  tremendous  alliance,"  said John
Walker,  Payson president and managing  director.  "We have the region's premier
community banking company,  a community-based  investment  advisor,  and a local
mutual fund company that operates  nationally  and  specializes  in working with
banks. We are poised to provide solid investment performance and service."

Peoples Heritage Financial Group is a $10 billion multi-state bank and financial
services  holding company  headquartered  in Portland,  Maine. Its Maine banking
affiliate,  Peoples Heritage Bank, has the state's leading deposit market share.
Its New Hampshire  banking  affiliate,  Bank of New  Hampshire,  has the state's
leading deposit market share. Family Bank, the Company's  Massachusetts  banking
subsidiary,  has the state's tenth largest  deposit market share and the leading
market  share  in many of the  northern  Massachusetts  communities  it  serves.
Peoples  affiliate  banks  also  operate  subsidiaries  in  leasing,  trust  and
investment services and insurance.

                                      C-1
<PAGE>


FORUM FINANCIAL GROUP:

Headquarters:  Two Portland Square, Portland, Maine 04101
President:  John Y. Keffer
Offices:  Portland, Seattle, Warsaw, Bermuda
*Established  in 1986 to  administer  mutual  funds for  independent  investment
advisors and banks *Among the nation's largest  third-party fund  administrators
*Uses proprietary in-house systems and custom programming capabilities
         *ADMINISTRATION  AND  DISTRIBUTION  SERVICES:   Regulatory, compliance,
          expense  accounting,  budgeting for all funds
         *FUND  ACCOUNTING  SERVICES:  Portfolio valuation, accounting, dividend
          declaration,  and tax   advice
         *SHAREHOLDER   SERVICES:   Preparation  of  statements,   distribution
          support,   inquiries  and    processing of trades
*CLIENT ASSETS UNDER ADMINISTRATION AND DISTRIBUTION:  $36.9 billion
*CLIENT ASSETS PROCESSED BY FUND ACCOUNTING:  $47.6 billion
*CLIENT FUNDS UNDER ADMINISTRATION AND DISTRIBUTION:  146 mutual funds with 219
 share classes
*INTERNATIONAL VENTURES:
         Joint  venture  with Bank  Handlowy in Warsaw,  Poland,  using  Forum's
         proprietary   transfer  agency  and  distribution   systems   Off-shore
         investment  fund  administration,  using  Bermuda as Forum's  center of
         operations
*FORUM EMPLOYEES:  United States -198, Poland - 61, Bermuda - 3

FORUM CONTACTS:
Mark Kaplan, Managing Director and Portfolio Manager, Forum Investment Advisors,
LLC,
(207) 879-1900 X 6123
Tony Santaniello, Director of Marketing, (207) 879-1900 X 6175

                                      C-2
<PAGE>


H.M. PAYSON & CO.:

Headquarters:  One Portland Square, Portland, Maine
President and Managing Director: John Walker
Quality investment services and conservative wealth management since 1854
*Assets under Management: $1 Billion
*Custody Income Assets: $300 Million
*Client Base: 85% individuals; 15% institutional
*Owned by 11 shareholders; 11 managing directors
*Payson Balanced Fund and Payson Value Fund  (administrative  and shareholde
 services  provided by Forum Financial Group)
*Employees: 45


H.M. PAYSON & CO. CONTACT:
Joel Harris, Portfolio/Marketing Coordinator, (207) 772-3761


                                      C-3


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission